Features • Incorporates the ARM7TDMI® ARM® Thumb® Processor • • • • • • • • • • – High-performance 32-bit RISC Architecture – High-density 16-bit Instruction Set – Leader in MIPS/Watt – EmbeddedICE™ In-circuit Emulation, Debug Communication Channel Support Internal High-speed Flash – 512 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC512) Organized in Two Banks of 1024 Pages of 256 Bytes (Dual Plane) – 256 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC256) Organized in 1024 Pages of 256 Bytes (Single Plane) – 128 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC128) Organized in 512 Pages of 256 Bytes (Single Plane) • Single Cycle Access at Up to 30 MHz in Worst Case Conditions • Prefetch Buffer Optimizing Thumb Instruction Execution at Maximum Speed • Page Programming Time: 6 ms, Including Page Auto-erase, Full Erase Time: 15 ms • 10,000 Write Cycles, 10-year Data Retention Capability, Sector Lock Capabilities, Flash Security Bit • Fast Flash Programming Interface for High Volume Production Internal High-speed SRAM, Single-cycle Access at Maximum Speed – 128 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC512) – 64 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC256) – 32 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC128) Memory Controller (MC) – Embedded Flash Controller, Abort Status and Misalignment Detection Reset Controller (RSTC) – Based on Power-on Reset Cells and Low-power Factory-calibrated Brownout Detector – Provides External Reset Signal Shaping and Reset Source Status Clock Generator (CKGR) – Low-power RC Oscillator, 3 to 20 MHz On-chip Oscillator and one PLL Power Management Controller (PMC) – Power Optimization Capabilities, Including Slow Clock Mode (Down to 500 Hz) and Idle Mode – Four Programmable External Clock Signals Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) – Individually Maskable, Eight-level Priority, Vectored Interrupt Sources – Two External Interrupt Sources and One Fast Interrupt Source, Spurious Interrupt Protected Debug Unit (DBGU) – 2-wire UART and Support for Debug Communication Channel interrupt, Programmable ICE Access Prevention – Mode for General Purpose 2-wire UART Serial Communication Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) – 20-bit Programmable Counter plus 12-bit Interval Counter Windowed Watchdog (WDT) – 12-bit Key-protected Programmable Counter – Provides Reset or Interrupt Signals to the System – Counter May Be Stopped While the Processor is in Debug State or in Idle Mode AT91 ARM Thumb-based Microcontrollers AT91SAM7XC512 AT91SAM7XC256 AT91SAM7XC128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Real-time Timer (RTT) • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • 2 – 32-bit Free-running Counter with Alarm – Runs Off the Internal RC Oscillator Two Parallel Input/Output Controllers (PIO) – Sixty-two Programmable I/O Lines Multiplexed with up to Two Peripheral I/Os – Input Change Interrupt Capability on Each I/O Line – Individually Programmable Open-drain, Pull-up Resistor and Synchronous Output Seventeen Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) Channels One Advanced Encryption System (AES) – 256-, 192-, 128-bit Key Algorithm, Compliant with FIPS PUB 197 Specifications (AT91SAM7XC512) – 128-bit Key Algorithm, Compliant with FIPS PUB 197 Specifications (AT91SAM7XC256/128) – Buffer Encryption/Decryption Capabilities with PDC One Triple Data Encryption System (TDES) – Two-key or Three-key Algorithms, Compliant with FIPS PUB 46-3 Specifications – Optimized for Triple Data Encryption Capability One USB 2.0 Full Speed (12 Mbits per second) Device Port – On-chip Transceiver, 1352-byte Configurable Integrated FIFOs One Ethernet MAC 10/100 base-T – Media Independent Interface (MII) or Reduced Media Independent Interface (RMII) – Integrated 28-byte FIFOs and Dedicated DMA Channels for Transmit and Receive One Part 2.0A and Part 2.0B Compliant CAN Controller – Eight Fully-programmable Message Object Mailboxes, 16-bit Time Stamp Counter One Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) – Independent Clock and Frame Sync Signals for Each Receiver and Transmitter – I²S Analog Interface Support, Time Division Multiplex Support – High-speed Continuous Data Stream Capabilities with 32-bit Data Transfer Two Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Receiver Transmitters (USART) – Individual Baud Rate Generator, IrDA Infrared Modulation/Demodulation – Support for ISO7816 T0/T1 Smart Card, Hardware Handshaking, RS485 Support – Full Modem Line Support on USART1 Two Master/Slave Serial Peripheral Interfaces (SPI) – 8- to 16-bit Programmable Data Length, Four External Peripheral Chip Selects One Three-channel 16-bit Timer/Counter (TC) – Three External Clock Inputs, Two Multi-purpose I/O Pins per Channel – Double PWM Generation, Capture/Waveform Mode, Up/Down Capability One Four-channel 16-bit Power Width Modulation Controller (PWMC) One Two-wire Interface (TWI) – Master Mode Support Only, All Two-wire Atmel EEPROMs and I2C Compatible Devices Supported One 8-channel 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter, Four Channels Multiplexed with Digital I/Os SAM-BA® Boot Assistant – Default Boot program – Interface with SAM-BA Graphic User Interface IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan on All Digital Pins 5V-tolerant I/Os, Including Four High-current Drive I/O lines, Up to 16 mA Each Power Supplies – Embedded 1.8V Regulator, Drawing up to 100 mA for the Core and External Components – 3.3V VDDIO I/O Lines Power Supply, Independent 3.3V VDDFLASH Flash Power Supply – 1.8V VDDCORE Core Power Supply with Brownout Detector AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • Fully Static Operation: Up to 55 MHz at 1.65V and 85° C Worst Case Conditions • Available in 100-lead LQFP Green and 100-ball TFBGA Green Packages 3 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 1. Description Atmel's AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 is a member of a series of highly integrated Flash microcontrollers based on the 32-bit ARM RISC processor. It features 512/256/128 Kbyte high-speed Flash and 128/64/32 Kbyte SRAM, a large set of peripherals, including an 802.3 Ethernet MAC, a CAN controller, an AES 128 Encryption accelerator and a Triple Data Encryption System. A complete set of system functions minimizes the number of external components. The embedded Flash memory can be programmed in-system via the JTAG-ICE interface or via a parallel interface on a production programmer prior to mounting. Built-in lock bits and a security bit protect the firmware from accidental overwrite and preserve its confidentiality. The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 system controller includes a reset controller capable of managing the power-on sequence of the microcontroller and the complete system. Correct device operation can be monitored by a built-in brownout detector and a watchdog running off an integrated RC oscillator. By combining the ARM7TDMI processor with on-chip Flash and SRAM, and a wide range of peripheral functions, including USART, SPI, CAN Controller, Ethernet MAC, AES 128 accelerator, TDES, Timer Counter, RTT and Analog-to-Digital Converters on a monolithic chip, the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 is a powerful device that provides a flexible, cost-effective solution to many embedded control applications requiring secure communication over, for example, Ethernet, CAN wired and Zigbee™ wireless networks. 1.1 Configuration Summary of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 The AT91SAM7XC512, AT91SAM7XC256 and AT91SAM7XC128 differ only in memory sizes. Table 1-1 summarizes the configurations of the two devices. Table 1-1. Configuration Summary Device Flash Flash Organization SRAM AES TDES AT91SAM7XC512 512K bytes dual plane 128K bytes 1 AES 256/192/128 1 AT91SAM7XC256 256K bytes single plane 64K bytes 1 AES 128 1 AT91SAM7XC128 128K bytes single plane 32K bytes 1 AES 128 1 4 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 2. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Block Diagram Figure 2-1. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Block Diagram TDI TDO TMS TCK ICE JTAG SCAN ARM7TDMI Processor JTAGSEL 1.8 V Voltage Regulator System Controller TST FIQ VDDCORE AIC DRXD DTXD VDDIO Memory Controller PIO IRQ0-IRQ1 DBGU VDDIN GND VDDOUT PDC SRAM Embedded Flash Controller Address Decoder Abort Status Misalignment Detection 128/64/32 Kbytes PDC PCK0-PCK3 PLLRC PLL XIN XOUT OSC VDDFLASH Flash ERASE 512/256/128 Kbytes PMC RCOSC Peripheral Bridge VDDCORE VDDFLASH BOD Peripheral DMA Controller VDDCORE POR Reset Controller ROM PGMRDY PGMNVALID PGMNOE PGMCK PGMM0-PGMM3 PGMD0-PGMD15 PGMNCMD PGMEN0-PGMEN1 Fast Flash Programming Interface 17 Channels NRST PIT APB SAM-BA WDT RTT DMA FIFO PIOB PIO PIOA Ethernet MAC 10/100 PDC USART0 PDC PDC USB Device USART1 PDC Transceiver VDDFLASH FIFO PWMC PDC PIO PDC SPI0 SSC PDC PDC PIO RXD0 TXD0 SCK0 RTS0 CTS0 RXD1 TXD1 SCK1 RTS1 CTS1 DCD1 DSR1 DTR1 RI1 SPI0_NPCS0 SPI0_NPCS1 SPI0_NPCS2 SPI0_NPCS3 SPI0_MISO SPI0_MOSI SPI0_SPCK SPI1_NPCS0 SPI1_NPCS1 SPI1_NPCS2 SPI1_NPCS3 SPI1_MISO SPI1_MOSI SPI1_SPCK ADTRG AD0 AD1 AD2 AD3 AD4 AD5 AD6 AD7 ETXCK-ERXCK-EREFCK ETXEN-ETXER ECRS-ECOL, ECRSDV ERXER-ERXDV ERX0-ERX3 ETX0-ETX3 EMDC EMDIO EF100 PDC Timer Counter SPI1 TC0 PDC PDC TC1 TC2 TWI ADC CAN DDM DDP PWM0 PWM1 PWM2 PWM3 TF TK TD RD RK RF TCLK0 TCLK1 TCLK2 TIOA0 TIOB0 TIOA1 TIOB1 TIOA2 TIOB2 TWD TWCK CANRX CANTX PDC ADVREF AES 128 PDC PDC TDES PDC 5 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 3. Signal Description Table 3-1. Signal Name Signal Description List Function Type Active Level Comments Power VDDIN Voltage Regulator and ADC Power Supply Input Power 3V to 3.6V VDDOUT Voltage Regulator Output Power 1.85V VDDFLASH Flash and USB Power Supply Power 3V to 3.6V VDDIO I/O Lines Power Supply Power 3V to 3.6V VDDCORE Core Power Supply Power 1.65V to 1.95V VDDPLL PLL Power 1.65V to 1.95V GND Ground Ground Clocks, Oscillators and PLLs XIN Main Oscillator Input XOUT Main Oscillator Output PLLRC PLL Filter PCK0 - PCK3 Programmable Clock Output Input Output Input Output ICE and JTAG TCK Test Clock Input No pull-up resistor TDI Test Data In Input No pull-up resistor TDO Test Data Out TMS Test Mode Select Input No pull-up resistor JTAGSEL JTAG Selection Input Pull-down resistor(1) Output Flash Memory Flash and NVM Configuration Bits Erase Command ERASE Input High Pull-down resistor(1) I/O Low Pull-Up resistor, Open Drain Output. Input High Pull-down resistor(1) Reset/Test NRST Microcontroller Reset TST Test Mode Select DRXD Debug Receive Data Input DTXD Debug Transmit Data Output IRQ0 - IRQ1 External Interrupt Inputs Input FIQ Fast Interrupt Input Input Debug Unit AIC PIO PA0 - PA30 Parallel IO Controller A I/O Pulled-up input at reset. PB0 - PB30 Parallel IO Controller B I/O Pulled-up input at reset. 6 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 3-1. Signal Description List (Continued) Signal Name Function Type Active Level Comments USB Device Port DDM USB Device Port Data - Analog DDP USB Device Port Data + Analog USART SCK0 - SCK1 Serial Clock I/O TXD0 - TXD1 Transmit Data I/O RXD0 - RXD1 Receive Data Input RTS0 - RTS1 Request To Send CTS0 - CTS1 Clear To Send Input DCD1 Data Carrier Detect Input DTR1 Data Terminal Ready DSR1 Data Set Ready Input RI1 Ring Indicator Input Output Output Synchronous Serial Controller TD Transmit Data Output RD Receive Data Input TK Transmit Clock I/O RK Receive Clock I/O TF Transmit Frame Sync I/O RF Receive Frame Sync I/O Timer/Counter TCLK0 - TCLK2 External Clock Inputs Input TIOA0 - TIOA2 I/O Line A I/O TIOB0 - TIOB2 I/O Line B I/O PWM Controller PWM0 - PWM3 PWM Channels Output Serial Peripheral Interface - SPIx SPIx_MISO Master In Slave Out I/O SPIx_MOSI Master Out Slave In I/O SPIx_SPCK SPI Serial Clock I/O SPIx_NPCS0 SPI Peripheral Chip Select 0 I/O Low SPIx_NPCS1-NPCS3 SPI Peripheral Chip Select 1 to 3 Output Low Two-wire Interface TWD Two-wire Serial Data I/O TWCK Two-wire Serial Clock I/O 7 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 3-1. Signal Description List (Continued) Signal Name Function Type Active Level Comments Analog-to-Digital Converter AD0-AD3 Analog Inputs Analog Digital pulled-up inputs at reset. AD4-AD7 Analog Inputs Analog Analog Inputs ADTRG ADC Trigger ADVREF ADC Reference Input Analog Fast Flash Programming Interface PGMEN0-PGMEN1 Programming Enabling Input PGMM0-PGMM3 Programming Mode Input PGMD0-PGMD15 Programming Data I/O PGMRDY Programming Ready Output High PGMNVALID Data Direction Output Low PGMNOE Programming Read Input Low PGMCK Programming Clock Input PGMNCMD Programming Command Input Low CAN Controller CANRX CAN Input CANTX CAN Output Input Output Ethernet MAC 10/100 EREFCK Reference Clock Input RMII only ETXCK Transmit Clock Input MII only ERXCK Receive Clock Input MII only ETXEN Transmit Enable Output ETX0 - ETX3 Transmit Data Output ETX0 - ETX1 only in RMII ETXER Transmit Coding Error Output MII only ERXDV Receive Data Valid Input MII only ECRSDV Carrier Sense and Data Valid Input RMII only ERX0 - ERX3 Receive Data Input ERX0 - ERX1 only in RMII ERXER Receive Error Input ECRS Carrier Sense Input MII only ECOL Collision Detected Input MII only EMDC Management Data Clock EMDIO Management Data Input/Output EF100 Force 100 Mbits/sec. Note: 8 Output I/O Output High RMII only 1. Refer to Section 6. ”I/O Lines Considerations”. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 4. Package The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 is available in 100-lead LQFP Green and 100-ball TFBGA RoHS-compliant packages. 4.1 100-lead LQFP Package Outline Figure 4-1 shows the orientation of the 100-lead LQFP package. A detailed mechanical description is given in the Mechanical Characteristics section of the full datasheet. Figure 4-1. 100-lead LQFP Package Outline (Top View) 75 51 76 50 100 26 1 25 9 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 4.2 100-lead LQFP Pinout Table 4-1. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 10 Pinout in 100-lead LQFP Package ADVREF GND AD4 AD5 AD6 AD7 VDDOUT VDDIN PB27/AD0 PB28/AD1 PB29/AD2 PB30/AD3 PA8/PGMM0 PA9/PGMM1 VDDCORE GND VDDIO PA10/PGMM2 PA11/PGMM3 PA12/PGMD0 PA13/PGMD1 PA14/PGMD2 PA15/PGMD3 PA16/PGMD4 PA17/PGMD5 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 PA18/PGMD6 PB9 PB8 PB14 PB13 PB6 GND VDDIO PB5 PB15 PB17 VDDCORE PB7 PB12 PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB10 PB11 PA19/PGMD7 PA20/PGMD8 VDDIO PA21/PGMD9 PA22/PGMD10 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 TDI GND PB16 PB4 PA23/PGMD11 PA24/PGMD12 NRST TST PA25/PGMD13 PA26/PGMD14 VDDIO VDDCORE PB18 PB19 PB20 PB21 PB22 GND PB23 PB24 PB25 PB26 PA27/PGMD15 PA28 PA29 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 TDO JTAGSEL TMS TCK PA30 PA0/PGMEN0 PA1/PGMEN1 GND VDDIO PA3 PA2 VDDCORE PA4/PGMNCMD PA5/PGMRDY PA6/PGMNOE PA7/PGMNVALID ERASE DDM DDP VDDFLASH GND XIN/PGMCK XOUT PLLRC VDDPLL AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 4.3 100-ball TFBGA Package Outline Figure 4-2 shows the orientation of the 100-ball TFBGA package. A detailed mechanical description is given in the Mechanical Characteristics section of the full datasheet. Figure 4-2. 100-ball TFBGA Package Orientation (Top View) TOP VIEW 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 A BALL A1 4.4 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 B10 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C D E F G H J K 100-ball TFBGA Pinout Table 4-2. Pin B Pinout in 100-ball TFBGA Package Signal Name PA22/PGMD10 PA21/PGMD9 PA20/PGMD8 PB1 PB7 PB5 PB8 PB9 PA18/PGMD6 VDDIO TDI PA19/PGMD7 PB11 PB2 PB12 PB15 PB14 PA14/PGMD2 PA16/PGMD4 PA17/PGMD5 PB16 PB4 PB10 PB3 PB0 Pin C6 C7 C8 C9 C10 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 E1 E2 E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 E9 E10 Signal Name PB17 PB13 PA13/PGMD1 PA12/PGMD0 PA15/PGMD3 PA23/PGMD11 PA24/PGMD12 NRST TST PB19 PB6 PA10/PGMM2 VDDIO PB27/AD0 PA11/PGMM3 PA25/PGMD13 PA26/PGMD14 PB18 PB20 TMS GND VDDIO PB28/AD1 VDDIO GND Pin F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 F10 G1 G2 G3 G4 G5 G6 G7 G8 G9 G10 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 Signal Name PB21 PB23 PB25 PB26 TCK PA6/PGMNOE ERASE VDDCORE GND VDDIN PB22 PB24 PA27/PGMD15 TDO PA2 PA5/PGMRDY VDDCORE GND PB30/AD3 VDDOUT VDDCORE PA28 JTAGSEL PA3 PA4/PGMNCMD Pin H6 H7 H8 H9 H10 J1 J2 J3 J4 J5 J6 J7 J8 J9 J10 K1 K2 K3 K4 K5 K6 K7 K8 K9 K10 Signal Name PA7/PGMNVALID PA9/PGMM1 PA8/PGMM0 PB29/AD2 PLLRC PA29 PA30 PA0/PGMEN0 PA1/PGMEN1 VDDFLASH GND XIN/PGMCK XOUT GND VDDPLL VDDCORE VDDCORE DDP DDM GND AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 ADVREF 11 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 5. Power Considerations 5.1 Power Supplies The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 has six types of power supply pins and integrates a voltage regulator, allowing the device to be supplied with only one voltage. The six power supply pin types are: • VDDIN pin. It powers the voltage regulator and the ADC; voltage ranges from 3.0V to 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. In order to decrease current consumption, if the voltage regulator and the ADC are not used, VDDIN, ADVREF,AD4, AD5, AD6 and AD7 should be connected to GND. In this case, VDDOUT should be left unconnected. • VDDOUT pin. It is the output of the 1.8V voltage regulator. • VDDIO pin. It powers the I/O lines; voltage ranges from 3.0V to 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. • VDDFLASH pin. It powers the USB transceivers and a part of the Flash and is required for the Flash to operate correctly; voltage ranges from 3.0V to 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. • VDDCORE pins. They power the logic of the device; voltage ranges from 1.65V to 1.95V, 1.8V typical. It can be connected to the VDDOUT pin with decoupling capacitor. VDDCORE is required for the device, including its embedded Flash, to operate correctly. • VDDPLL pin. It powers the oscillator and the PLL. It can be connected directly to the VDDOUT pin. No separate ground pins are provided for the different power supplies. Only GND pins are provided and should be connected as shortly as possible to the system ground plane. 5.2 Power Consumption The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 has a static current of less than 60 µA on VDDCORE at 25°C, including the RC oscillator, the voltage regulator and the power-on reset when the brownout detector is deactivated. Activating the brownout detector adds 28 µA static current. The dynamic power consumption on VDDCORE is less than 90 mA at full speed when running out of the Flash. Under the same conditions, the power consumption on VDDFLASH does not exceed 10 mA. 5.3 Voltage Regulator The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds a voltage regulator that is managed by the System Controller. In Normal Mode, the voltage regulator consumes less than 100 µA static current and draws 100 mA of output current. The voltage regulator also has a Low-power Mode. In this mode, it consumes less than 25 µA static current and draws 1 mA of output current. Adequate output supply decoupling is mandatory for VDDOUT to reduce ripple and avoid oscillations. The best way to achieve this is to use two capacitors in parallel: one external 470 pF (or 1 nF) NPO capacitor should be connected between VDDOUT and GND as close to the chip as possible. One external 2.2 µF (or 3.3 µF) X7R capacitor should be connected between VDDOUT and GND. 12 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Adequate input supply decoupling is mandatory for VDDIN in order to improve startup stability and reduce source voltage drop. The input decoupling capacitor should be placed close to the chip. For example, two capacitors can be used in parallel: 100 nF NPO and 4.7 µF X7R. 5.4 Typical Powering Schematics The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 supports a 3.3V single supply mode. The internal regulator input connected to the 3.3V source and its output feeds VDDCORE and the VDDPLL. Figure 51 shows the power schematics to be used for USB bus-powered systems. Figure 5-1. 3.3V System Single Power Supply Schematic VDDFLASH Power Source ranges from 4.5V (USB) to 18V DC/DC Converter VDDIO VDDIN Voltage Regulator 3.3V VDDOUT VDDCORE VDDPLL 13 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 6. I/O Lines Considerations 6.1 JTAG Port Pins TMS, TDI and TCK are schmitt trigger inputs and are not 5-V tolerant. TMS, TDI and TCK do not integrate a pull-up resistor. TDO is an output, driven at up to VDDIO, and has no pull-up resistor. The JTAGSEL pin is used to select the JTAG boundary scan when asserted at a high level. The JTAGSEL pin integrates a permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 kΩ. To eliminate any risk of spuriously entering the JTAG boundary scan mode due to noise on JTAGSEL, it should be tied externally to GND if boundary scan is not used, or pulled down with an external low-value resistor (such as 1 kΩ) . 6.2 Test Pin The TST pin is used for manufacturing test or fast programming mode of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 when asserted high. The TST pin integrates a permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 kΩ to GND. To eliminate any risk of entering the test mode due to noise on the TST pin, it should be tied to GND if the FFPI is not used, or pulled down with an external low-value resistor (such as 1 kΩ) . To enter fast programming mode, the TST pin and the PA0 and PA1 pins should be tied high and PA2 tied to low. Driving the TST pin at a high level while PA0 or PA1 is driven at 0 leads to unpredictable results. 6.3 Reset Pin The NRST pin is bidirectional with an open drain output buffer. It is handled by the on-chip reset controller and can be driven low to provide a reset signal to the external components or asserted low externally to reset the microcontroller. There is no constraint on the length of the reset pulse, and the reset controller can guarantee a minimum pulse length. This allows connection of a simple push-button on the NRST pin as system user reset, and the use of the signal NRST to reset all the components of the system. The NRST pin integrates a permanent pull-up resistor to VDDIO. 6.4 ERASE Pin The ERASE pin is used to re-initialize the Flash content and some of its NVM bits. It integrates a permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 kΩ to GND. To eliminate any risk of erasing the Flash due to noise on the ERASE pin, it shoul be tied externally to GND, which prevents erasing the Flash from the applicatiion, or pulled down with an external low-value resistor (such as 1 kΩ) . This pin is debounced by the RC oscillator to improve the glitch tolerance. Minimum debouncing time is 200 ms. 6.5 PIO Controller Lines All the I/O lines, PA0 to PA30 and PB0 to PB30, are 5V-tolerant and all integrate a programmable pull-up resistor. Programming of this pull-up resistor is performed independently for each I/O line through the PIO controllers. 14 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 5V-tolerant means that the I/O lines can drive voltage level according to VDDIO, but can be driven with a voltage of up to 5.5V. However, driving an I/O line with a voltage over VDDIO while the programmable pull-up resistor is enabled will create a current path through the pull-up resistor from the I/O line to VDDIO. Care should be taken, in particular at reset, as all the I/O lines default to input with pull-up resistor enabled at reset. 6.6 I/O Lines Current Drawing The PIO lines PA0 to PA3 are high-drive current capable. Each of these I/O lines can drive up to 16 mA permanently. The remaining I/O lines can draw only 8 mA. However, the total current drawn by all the I/O lines cannot exceed 200 mA. 15 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 7. Processor and Architecture 7.1 ARM7TDMI Processor • RISC processor based on ARMv4T Von Neumann architecture – Runs at up to 55 MHz, providing 0.9 MIPS/MHz • Two instruction sets – ARM® high-performance 32-bit instruction set – Thumb® high code density 16-bit instruction set • Three-stage pipeline architecture – Instruction Fetch (F) – Instruction Decode (D) – Execute (E) 7.2 Debug and Test Features • Integrated embedded in-circuit emulator – Two watchpoint units – Test access port accessible through a JTAG protocol – Debug communication channel • Debug Unit – Two-pin UART – Debug communication channel interrupt handling – Chip ID Register • IEEE1149.1 JTAG Boundary-scan on all digital pins 7.3 Memory Controller • Programmable Bus Arbiter – Handles requests from the ARM7TDMI, the Ethernet MAC and the Peripheral DMA Controller • Address decoder provides selection signals for – Three internal 1 Mbyte memory areas – One 256 Mbyte embedded peripheral area • Abort Status Registers – Source, Type and all parameters of the access leading to an abort are saved – Facilitates debug by detection of bad pointers • Misalignment Detector – Alignment checking of all data accesses – Abort generation in case of misalignment • Remap Command – Remaps the SRAM in place of the embedded non-volatile memory – Allows handling of dynamic exception vectors 16 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • Embedded Flash Controller – Embedded Flash interface, up to three programmable wait states – Prefetch buffer, buffering and anticipating the 16-bit requests, reducing the required wait states – Key-protected program, erase and lock/unlock sequencer – Single command for erasing, programming and locking operations – Interrupt generation in case of forbidden operation 7.4 Peripheral DMA Controller • Handles data transfer between peripherals and memories • Seventeen channels – Two for each USART – Two for the Debug Unit – Two for the Serial Synchronous Controller – Two for each Serial Peripheral Interface – Two for the Advanced Encryption Standard 128-bit accelerator – Two for the Triple Data Encryption Standard 128-bit accelerator – One for the Analog-to-digital Converter • Low bus arbitration overhead – One Master Clock cycle needed for a transfer from memory to peripheral – Two Master Clock cycles needed for a transfer from peripheral to memory • Next Pointer management for reducing interrupt latency requirements 17 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 8. Memory 8.1 AT91SAM7XC512 • 512 Kbytes of dual-plane Flash Memory – 2 contiguous banks of 1024 pages of 256 bytes – Fast access time, 30 MHz single-cycle access in Worst Case conditions – Page programming time: 6 ms, including page auto-erase – Page programming without auto-erase: 3 ms – Full chip erase time: 15 ms – 10,000 write cycles, 10-year data retention capability – 32 lock bits, protecting 32 sectors of 64 pages – Protection Mode to secure contents of the Flash • 128 Kbytes of Fast SRAM – Single-cycle access at full speed 8.2 AT91SAM7XC256 • 256 Kbytes of Flash Memory – 1024 pages of 256 bytes – Fast access time, 30 MHz single-cycle access in Worst Case conditions – Page programming time: 6 ms, including page auto-erase – Page programming without auto-erase: 3 ms – Full chip erase time: 15 ms – 10,000 write cycles, 10-year data retention capability – 16 lock bits, each protecting 16 sectors of 64 pages – Protection Mode to secure contents of the Flash • 64 Kbytes of Fast SRAM – Single-cycle access at full speed 8.3 AT91SAM7XC128 • 128 Kbytes of Flash Memory – 512 pages of 256 bytes – Fast access time, 30 MHz single-cycle access in Worst Case conditions – Page programming time: 6 ms, including page auto-erase – Page programming without auto-erase: 3 ms – Full chip erase time: 15 ms – 10,000 write cycles, 10-year data retention capability – 8 lock bits, each protecting 8 sectors of 64 pages – Protection Mode to secure contents of the Flash • 32 Kbytes of Fast SRAM – Single-cycle access at full speed 18 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 8-1. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Memory Mapping Internal Memory Mapping Note: (1) Can be ROM, Flash or SRAM depending on GPNVM2 and REMAP 0x0000 0000 Boot Memory (1) Flash before Remap SRAM after Remap 1 MBytes Internal Flash 1 MBytes Internal SRAM 1 MBytes Internal ROM 1 MBytes 0x000F FFF 0x0010 0000 0x001F FFF 0x0020 0000 0x002F FFF 0x0030 0000 Address Memory Space 0x0000 0000 0x003F FFF 0x0040 0000 Internal Memories 256 MBytes Reserved 252 MBytes 0x0FFF FFFF 0x0FFF FFFF System Controller Mapping 0x1000 0000 0xFFFF F000 Peripheral Mapping 0xF000 0000 AIC 512 Bytes/128 registers DBGU 512 Bytes/128 registers PIOA 512 Bytes/128 registers PIOB 512 Bytes/128 registers Reserved 0xFFF9 FFFF 0xFFFA 0000 Undefined (Abort) 14 x 256 MBytes 3,584 MBytes 0xFFFA 3FFF 0xFFFA 4000 0xFFFA 7FFF 0xFFFA 8000 0xFFFA BFFF 0xFFFA C000 0xFFFA FFFF 0xFFFB 0000 TC0, TC1, TC2 16 Kbytes AES 128 16 Kbytes TDES 16 Kbytes 0xFFFF F1FF 0xFFFF F200 0xFFFF F3FF 0xFFFF F400 Reserved UDP 16 Kbytes 0xFFFB 3FFF 0xFFFB 4000 0xFFFF F5FF 0xFFFF F600 Reserved 0xFFFB 7FFF 0xFFFB 8000 0xFFFB BFFF 0xFFFB C000 0xEFFF FFFF 0xFFFB FFFF 0xFFFC 0000 0xF000 0000 0xFFFC 3FFF 0xFFFC 4000 Internal Peripherals 0xFFFF FFFF 256 MBytes TWI 16 Kbytes Reserved Reserved USART0 16 Kbytes USART1 16 Kbytes 0xFFFC 7FFF 0xFFFC 8000 Reserved 0xFFFC BFFF 0xFFFC C000 PWMC 16 Kbytes CAN 16 Kbytes SSC 16 Kbytes ADC 16 Kbytes EMAC 16 Kbytes SPI0 16 Kbytes SPI1 16 Kbytes 0xFFFC FFFF 0xFFFD 0000 0xFFFD 3FFF 0xFFFD 4000 0xFFFD 7FFF 0xFFFD 8000 0xFFFD BFFF 0xFFFD C000 0xFFFD FFFF 0xFFFE 0000 0xFFFE 3FFF 0xFFFE 4000 0xFFFE 7FFF 0xFFFE 8000 0xFFFF FFFF 0xFFFF FBFF 0xFFFF FC00 0xFFFF FCFF 0xFFFF FD00 0xFFFF FD0F PMC 256 Bytes/64 registers RSTC 16 Bytes/4 registers Reserved 0xFFFF FD20 0xFFFF FC2F 0xFFFF FD30 0xFFFF FC3F 0xFFFF FD40 0xFFFF FD4F Reserved 0xFFFF EFFF 0xFFFE F000 0xFFFF F7FF 0xFFFF F800 RTT 16 Bytes/4 registers PIT 16 Bytes/4 registers WDT 16 Bytes/4 registers Reserved 0xFFFF FD60 0xFFFF FC6F 0xFFFF FD70 0xFFFF FEFF 0xFFFF FF00 VREG 4 Bytes/1 register Reserved MC 256 Bytes/64 registers SYSC 0xFFFF FFFF 19 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 8.4 8.4.1 Memory Mapping Internal RAM • The AT91SAM7XC512 embeds a high-speed 128-Kbyte SRAM bank. • The AT91SAM7XC256 embeds a high-speed 64-Kbyte SRAM bank. • The AT91SAM7XC128 embeds a high-speed 32-Kbyte SRAM bank. After reset and until the Remap Command is performed, the SRAM is only accessible at address 0x0020 0000. After Remap, the SRAM also becomes available at address 0x0. 8.4.2 Internal ROM The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds an Internal ROM. At any time, the ROM is mapped at address 0x30 0000. The ROM contains the FFPI and the SAM-BA program. 8.4.3 Internal Flash • The AT91SAM7XC512 features two banks (dual plane) of 256 Kbytes of Flash. • The AT91SAM7XC256 features one bank (single plane) of 256 Kbytes of Flash. • The AT91SAM7XC128 features one bank (single plane) of 128 Kbytes of Flash. At any time, the Flash is mapped to address 0x0010 0000. It is also accessible at address 0x0 after the reset, if GPNVM bit 2 is set and before the Remap Command. A general purpose NVM (GPNVM) bit is used to boot either on the ROM (default) or from the Flash. This GPNVM bit can be cleared or set respectively through the commands “Clear General-purpose NVM Bit” and “Set General-purpose NVM Bit” of the EFC User Interface. Setting the GPNVM Bit 2 selects the boot from the Flash. Asserting ERASE clears the GPNVM Bit 2 and thus selects the boot from the ROM by default. Figure 8-2. Internal Memory Mapping with GPNVM Bit 2 = 0 (default) 0x0000 0000 0x000F FFFF ROM Before Remap SRAM After Remap 1 M Bytes 0x0010 0000 Internal FLASH 1 M Bytes Internal SRAM 1 M Bytes Internal ROM 1 M Bytes 0x001F FFFF 0x0020 0000 256M Bytes 0x002F FFFF 0x0030 0000 0x003F FFFF 0x0040 0000 Undefined Areas (Abort) 252 M Bytes 0x0FFF FFFF 20 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 8-3. Internal Memory Mapping with GPNVM Bit 2 = 1 0x0000 0000 0x000F FFFF Flash Before Remap SRAM After Remap 1 M Bytes 0x0010 0000 Internal FLASH 1 M Bytes Internal SRAM 1 M Bytes Internal ROM 1 M Bytes 0x001F FFFF 0x0020 0000 256M Bytes 0x002F FFFF 0x0030 0000 0x003F FFFF 0x0040 0000 Undefined Areas (Abort) 252 M Bytes 0x0FFF FFFF 8.5 Embedded Flash 8.5.1 Flash Overview • The Flash of the AT91SAM7XC512 is organized in two banks (dual plane) 0f 1254 pages of 256 bytes. The 524, 288 bytes are organized in 32-bit words. • The Flash of the AT91SAM7XC256 is organized in 1024 pages of 256 bytes (single plane). It reads as 65,536 32-bit words. • The Flash of the AT91SAM7XC128 is organized in 512 pages of 256 bytes (single plane). It reads as 32,768 32-bit words. The Flash contains a 256-byte write buffer, accessible through a 32-bit interface. The Flash benefits from the integration of a power reset cell and from the brownout detector. This prevents code corruption during power supply changes, even in the worst conditions. When Flash is not used (read or write access), it is automatically placed into standby mode. 8.5.2 Embedded Flash Controller The Embedded Flash Controller (EFC) manages accesses performed by the masters of the system. It enables reading the Flash and writing the write buffer. It also contains a User Interface, mapped within the Memory Controller on the APB. The User Interface allows: • programming of the access parameters of the Flash (number of wait states, timings, etc.) • starting commands such as full erase, page erase, page program, NVM bit set, NVM bit clear, etc. • getting the end status of the last command • getting error status • programming interrupts on the end of the last commands or on errors The Embedded Flash Controller also provides a dual 32-bit Prefetch Buffer that optimizes 16-bit access to the Flash. This is particularly efficient when the processor is running in Thumb mode. Two EFCs are embedded in the AT91SAM7XC512 to control each bank of 256 KBytes. Dualplane organization allows concurrent read and program functionality. Read from one memory 21 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 plane may be performed even while program or erase functions are being executed in the other memory plane. One EFC is embedded in the AT91SAM7XC256/128 to control the single plane of 256/128 KBytes. 8.5.3 8.5.3.1 Lock Regions AT91SAM7XC512 Two Embedded Flash Controllers each manage 16 lock bits to protect 16 regions of the flash against inadvertent flash erasing or programming commands. The AT91SAM7XC512 contains 32 lock regions and each lock region contains 64 pages of 256 bytes. Each lock region has a size of 16 Kbytes. If a locked-region’s erase or program command occurs, the command is aborted and the EFC trigs an interrupt. The 32 NVM bits are software programmable through both of the EFC User Interfaces. The command “Set Lock Bit” enables the protection. The command “Clear Lock Bit” unlocks the lock region. Asserting the ERASE pin clears the lock bits, thus unlocking the entire Flash. 8.5.3.2 AT91SAM7XC256 The Embedded Flash Controller manages 16 lock bits to protect 16 regions of the flash against inadvertent flash erasing or programming commands. The AT91SAM7XC256 contains 16 lock regions and each lock region contains 64 pages of 256 bytes. Each lock region has a size of 16 Kbytes. If a locked-region’s erase or program command occurs, the command is aborted and the EFC trigs an interrupt. The 16 NVM bits are software programmable through the EFC User Interface. The command “Set Lock Bit” enables the protection. The command “Clear Lock Bit” unlocks the lock region. Asserting the ERASE pin clears the lock bits, thus unlocking the entire Flash. 8.5.3.3 AT91SAM7XC128 The Embedded Flash Controller manages 8 lock bits to protect 8 regions of the flash against inadvertent flash erasing or programming commands. The AT91SAM7XC128 contains 8 lock regions and each lock region contains 64 pages of 256 bytes. Each lock region has a size of 16 Kbytes. If a locked-region’s erase or program command occurs, the command is aborted and the EFC trigs an interrupt. The 8 NVM bits are software programmable through the EFC User Interface. The command “Set Lock Bit” enables the protection. The command “Clear Lock Bit” unlocks the lock region. Asserting the ERASE pin clears the lock bits, thus unlocking the entire Flash. 8.5.4 22 Security Bit Feature The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 features a security bit, based on a specific NVM-Bit. When the security is enabled, any access to the Flash, either through the ICE interface or through the Fast AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Flash Programming Interface, is forbidden. This ensures the confidentiality of the code programmed in the Flash. This security bit can only be enabled, through the Command “Set Security Bit” of the EFC User Interface. Disabling the security bit can only be achieved by asserting the ERASE pin at 1, and after a full flash erase is performed. When the security bit is deactivated, all accesses to the flash are permitted. It is important to note that the assertion of the ERASE pin should always be longer than 220 ms. As the ERASE pin integrates a permanent pull-down, it can be left unconnected during normal operation. However, it is safer to connect it directly to GND for the final application. 8.5.5 Non-volatile Brownout Detector Control Two general purpose NVM (GPNVM) bits are used for controlling the brownout detector (BOD), so that even after a power loss, the brownout detector operations remain in their state. These two GPNVM bits can be cleared or set respectively through the commands “Clear General-purpose NVM Bit” and “Set General-purpose NVM Bit” of the EFC User Interface. • GPNVM Bit 0 is used as a brownout detector enable bit. Setting the GPNVM Bit 0 enables the BOD, clearing it disables the BOD. Asserting ERASE clears the GPNVM Bit 0 and thus disables the brownout detector by default. • The GPNVM Bit 1 is used as a brownout reset enable signal for the reset controller. Setting the GPNVM Bit 1 enables the brownout reset when a brownout is detected, Clearing the GPNVM Bit 1 disables the brownout reset. Asserting ERASE disables the brownout reset by default. 8.5.6 8.6 Calibration Bits Eight NVM bits are used to calibrate the brownout detector and the voltage regulator. These bits are factory configured and cannot be changed by the user. The ERASE pin has no effect on the calibration bits. Fast Flash Programming Interface The Fast Flash Programming Interface allows programming the device through either a serial JTAG interface or through a multiplexed fully-handshaked parallel port. It allows gang-programming with market-standard industrial programmers. The FFPI supports read, page program, page erase, full erase, lock, unlock and protect commands. The Fast Flash Programming Interface is enabled and the Fast Programming Mode is entered when the TST pin and the PA0 and PA1 pins are all tied high. 8.7 SAM-BA Boot Assistant The SAM-BA Boot Assistant is a default Boot Program that provides an easy way to program insitu the on-chip Flash memory. The SAM-BA Boot Assistant supports serial communication via the DBGU or the USB Device Port. • Communication via the DBGU supports a wide range of crystals from 3 to 20 MHz via software auto-detection. 23 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Communication via the USB Device Port is limited to an 18.432 MHz crystal. The SAM-BA Boot provides an interface with SAM-BA Graphic User Interface (GUI). The SAM-BA Boot is in ROM and is mapped at address 0x0 when the GPNVM Bit 2 is set to 0. When GPNVM bit 2 is set to 1, the device boots from the Flash. When GPNVM bit 2 is set to 0, the device boots from ROM (SAM-BA). 24 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 9. System Controller The System Controller manages all vital blocks of the microcontroller: interrupts, clocks, power, time, debug and reset. The System Controller peripherals are all mapped to the highest 4 Kbytes of address space, between addresses 0xFFFF F000 and 0xFFFF FFFF. Figure 9-1 on page 26 shows the System Controller Block Diagram. Figure 8-1 on page 19 shows the mapping of the User Interface of the System Controller peripherals. Note that the Memory Controller configuration user interface is also mapped within this address space. 25 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 9-1. System Controller Block Diagram System Controller jtag_nreset Boundary Scan TAP Controller nirq irq0-irq1 Advanced Interrupt Controller fiq periph_irq[2..19] nfiq proc_nreset ARM7TDMI PCK int debug pit_irq rtt_irq wdt_irq dbgu_irq pmc_irq rstc_irq efc_irq power_on_reset force_ntrst MCK periph_nreset dbgu_irq Debug Unit force_ntrst dbgu_txd dbgu_rxd security_bit MCK debug periph_nreset SLCK power_on_reset Periodic Interval Timer pit_irq Real-Time Timer rtt_irq Watchdog Timer wdt_irq flash_poe cal gpnvm[0] flash_wrdis BOD power_on_reset jtag_nreset POR efc_irq bod_rst_en proc_nreset Reset Controller periph_nreset proc_nreset flash_poe NRST SLCK XOUT Voltage Regulator Mode Controller standby Voltage Regulator cal SLCK MAINCK Memory Controller MCK rstc_irq OSC gpnvm[0..2] wdt_fault WDRPROC gpnvm[1] en XIN Embedded Flash cal SLCK debug idle proc_nreset RCOSC flash_wrdis periph_clk[2..18] Power Management Controller UDPCK pck[0-3] periph_clk[11] PCK periph_nreset UDPCK USB Device Port periph_irq[11] MCK usb_suspend PLLRC PLL PLLCK pmc_irq int idle periph_nreset periph_clk[4..19] usb_suspend periph_nreset irq0-irq1 periph_clk[2-3] dbgu_rxd Embedded Peripherals periph_irq{2-3] periph_nreset PIO Controller fiq periph_irq[4..19] dbgu_txd in PA0-PA30 PB0-PB30 26 out enable AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 9.1 Reset Controller • Based on one power-on reset cell and one brownout detector • Status of the last reset, either Power-up Reset, Software Reset, User Reset, Watchdog Reset, Brownout Reset • Controls the internal resets and the NRST pin output • Allows to shape a signal on the NRST line, guaranteeing that the length of the pulse meets any requirement. 9.1.1 Brownout Detector and Power-on Reset The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds one brownout detection circuit and a power-on reset cell. The power-on reset is supplied with and monitors VDDCORE. Both signals are provided to the Flash to prevent any code corruption during power-up or powerdown sequences or if brownouts occur on the power supplies. The power-on reset cell has a limited-accuracy threshold at around 1.5V. Its output remains low during power-up until VDDCORE goes over this voltage level. This signal goes to the reset controller and allows a full re-initialization of the device. The brownout detector monitors the VDDCORE and VDDFLASH levels during operation by comparing them to a fixed trigger level. It secures system operations in the most difficult environments and prevents code corruption in case of brownout on the VDDCORE or VDDFLASH. When the brownout detector is enabled and VDDCORE decreases to a value below the trigger level (Vbot18-, defined as Vbot18 - hyst/2), the brownout output is immediately activated. When VDDCORE increases above the trigger level (Vbot18+, defined as Vbot18 + hyst/2), the reset is released. The brownout detector only detects a drop if the voltage on VDDCORE stays below the threshold voltage for longer than about 1µs. The VDDCORE threshold voltage has a hysteresis of about 50 mV, to ensure spike free brownout detection. The typical value of the brownout detector threshold is 1.68V with an accuracy of ± 2% and is factory calibrated. When the brownout detector is enabled and VDDFLASH decreases to a value below the trigger level (Vbot33-, defined as Vbot33 - hyst/2), the brownout output is immediately activated. When VDDFLASH increases above the trigger level (Vbot33+, defined as Vbot33 + hyst/2), the reset is released. The brownout detector only detects a drop if the voltage on VDDCORE stays below the threshold voltage for longer than about 1µs. The VDDFLASH threshold voltage has a hysteresis of about 50 mV, to ensure spike free brownout detection. The typical value of the brownout detector threshold is 2.80V with an accuracy of ± 3.5% and is factory calibrated. The brownout detector is low-power, as it consumes less than 28 µA static current. However, it can be deactivated to save its static current. In this case, it consumes less than 1µA. The deactivation is configured through the GPNVM bit 0 of the Flash. 27 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 9.2 Clock Generator The Clock Generator embeds one low-power RC Oscillator, one Main Oscillator and one PLL with the following characteristics: • RC Oscillator ranges between 22 KHz and 42 KHz • Main Oscillator frequency ranges between 3 and 20 MHz • Main Oscillator can be bypassed • PLL output ranges between 80 and 200 MHz It provides SLCK, MAINCK and PLLCK. Figure 9-2. Clock Generator Block Diagram Clock Generator XIN Embedded RC Oscillator Slow Clock SLCK Main Oscillator Main Clock MAINCK PLL and Divider PLL Clock PLLCK XOUT PLLRC Status Control Power Management Controller 28 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 9.3 Power Management Controller The Power Management Controller uses the Clock Generator outputs to provide: • the Processor Clock PCK • the Master Clock MCK • the USB Clock UDPCK • all the peripheral clocks, independently controllable • four programmable clock outputs The Master Clock (MCK) is programmable from a few hundred Hz to the maximum operating frequency of the device. The Processor Clock (PCK) switches off when entering processor idle mode, thus allowing reduced power consumption while waiting for an interrupt. Figure 9-3. Power Management Controller Block Diagram Processor Clock Controller Master Clock Controller SLCK MAINCK PLLCK PCK int Idle Mode Prescaler /1,/2,/4,...,/64 MCK Peripherals Clock Controller periph_clk[2..18] ON/OFF Programmable Clock Controller SLCK MAINCK PLLCK Prescaler /1,/2,/4,...,/64 pck[0..3] USB Clock Controller ON/OFF PLLCK 9.4 Divider /1,/2,/4 UDPCK Advanced Interrupt Controller • Controls the interrupt lines (nIRQ and nFIQ) of an ARM Processor • Individually maskable and vectored interrupt sources – Source 0 is reserved for the Fast Interrupt Input (FIQ) – Source 1 is reserved for system peripherals (RTT, PIT, EFC, PMC, DBGU, etc.) – Other sources control the peripheral interrupts or external interrupts – Programmable edge-triggered or level-sensitive internal sources – Programmable positive/negative edge-triggered or high/low level-sensitive external sources • 8-level Priority Controller – Drives the normal interrupt nIRQ of the processor – Handles priority of the interrupt sources 29 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 – Higher priority interrupts can be served during service of lower priority interrupt • Vectoring – Optimizes interrupt service routine branch and execution – One 32-bit vector register per interrupt source – Interrupt vector register reads the corresponding current interrupt vector • Protect Mode – Easy debugging by preventing automatic operations • Fast Forcing – Permits redirecting any interrupt source on the fast interrupt • General Interrupt Mask – Provides processor synchronization on events without triggering an interrupt 9.5 Debug Unit • Comprises: – One two-pin UART – One Interface for the Debug Communication Channel (DCC) support – One set of Chip ID Registers – One Interface providing ICE Access Prevention • Two-pin UART – USART-compatible User Interface – Programmable Baud Rate Generator – Parity, Framing and Overrun Error – Automatic Echo, Local Loopback and Remote Loopback Channel Modes • Debug Communication Channel Support – Offers visibility of COMMRX and COMMTX signals from the ARM Processor • Chip ID Registers – Identification of the device revision, sizes of the embedded memories, set of peripherals – Chip ID is 0x271C 0A40 (VERSION 0) for AT91SAM7XC512 – Chip ID is 0x271B 0940 (VERSION 0) for AT91SAM7XC256 – Chip ID is 0x271A 0740 (VERSION 0) for AT91SAM7XC128 9.6 Periodic Interval Timer • 20-bit programmable counter plus 12-bit interval counter 9.7 Watchdog Timer • 12-bit key-protected Programmable Counter running on prescaled SLCK • Provides reset or interrupt signals to the system • Counter may be stopped while the processor is in debug state or in idle mode 9.8 Real-time Timer • 32-bit free-running counter with alarm running on prescaled SLCK 30 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • Programmable 16-bit prescaler for SLCK accuracy compensation 9.9 PIO Controllers • Two PIO Controllers, each controlling 31 I/O lines • Fully programmable through set/clear registers • Multiplexing of two peripheral functions per I/O line • For each I/O line (whether assigned to a peripheral or used as general-purpose I/O) – Input change interrupt – Half a clock period glitch filter – Multi-drive option enables driving in open drain – Programmable pull-up on each I/O line – Pin data status register, supplies visibility of the level on the pin at any time • Synchronous output, provides Set and Clear of several I/O lines in a single write 9.10 Voltage Regulator Controller The purpose of this controller is to select the Power Mode of the Voltage Regulator between Normal Mode (bit 0 is cleared) or Standby Mode (bit 0 is set). 31 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 10. Peripherals 10.1 User Interface The User Peripherals are mapped in the 256 MBytes of address space between 0xF000 0000 and 0xFFFE FFFF. Each peripheral is allocated 16 Kbytes of address space. A complete memory map is provided in Figure 8-1 on page 19. 10.2 Peripheral Identifiers The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds a wide range of peripherals. Table 10-1 defines the Peripheral Identifiers of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128. Unique peripheral identifiers are defined for both the Advanced Interrupt Controller and the Power Management Controller. Table 10-1. Peripheral ID Peripheral Mnemonic Peripheral Name External Interrupt 0 AIC Advanced Interrupt Controller FIQ (1) 1 SYSC System 2 PIOA Parallel I/O Controller A 3 PIOB Parallel I/O Controller B 4 SPI0 Serial Peripheral Interface 0 5 SPI1 Serial Peripheral Interface 1 6 US0 USART 0 7 US1 USART 1 8 SSC Synchronous Serial Controller 9 TWI Two-wire Interface 10 PWMC Pulse Width Modulation Controller 11 UDP USB device Port 12 TC0 Timer/Counter 0 13 TC1 Timer/Counter 1 14 TC2 Timer/Counter 2 15 CAN CAN Controller 16 EMAC 17 ADC (1) 18 AES Advanced Encryption Standard 128-bit 19 TDES Triple Data Encryption Standard 20-29 Reserved 30 AIC Advanced Interrupt Controller IRQ0 31 AIC Advanced Interrupt Controller IRQ1 Note: 32 Peripheral Identifiers Ethernet MAC Analog-to Digital Converter 1. Setting SYSC and ADC bits in the clock set/clear registers of the PMC has no effect. The System Controller and ADC are continuously clocked. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 10.3 Peripheral Multiplexing on PIO Lines The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 features two PIO controllers, PIOA and PIOB, that multiplex the I/O lines of the peripheral set. Each PIO Controller controls 31 lines. Each line can be assigned to one of two peripheral functions, A or B. Some of them can also be multiplexed with the analog inputs of the ADC Controller. Table 10-2 on page 34 and Table 10-3 on page 35 defines how the I/O lines of the peripherals A, B or the analog inputs are multiplexed on the PIO Controller A and PIO Controller B. The two columns “Function” and “Comments” have been inserted for the user’s own comments; they may be used to track how pins are defined in an application. Note that some peripheral functions that are output only, may be duplicated in the table. At reset, all I/O lines are automatically configured as input with the programmable pull-up enabled, so that the device is maintained in a static state as soon as a reset is detected. 33 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 10.4 PIO Controller A Multiplexing Table 10-2. Multiplexing on PIO Controller A PIO Controller A 34 Peripheral B Application Usage I/O Line Peripheral A Comments PA0 RXD0 High-Drive PA1 TXD0 High-Drive PA2 SCK0 SPI1_NPCS1 High-Drive PA3 RTS0 SPI1_NPCS2 High-Drive PA4 CTS0 SPI1_NPCS3 PA5 RXD1 PA6 TXD1 PA7 SCK1 SPI0_NPCS1 PA8 RTS1 SPI0_NPCS2 PA9 CTS1 SPI0_NPCS3 PA10 TWD PA11 TWCK PA12 SPI_NPCS0 PA13 SPI0_NPCS1 PCK1 PA14 SPI0_NPCS2 IRQ1 PA15 SPI0_NPCS3 TCLK2 PA16 SPI0_MISO PA17 SPI0_MOSI PA18 SPI0_SPCK PA19 CANRX PA20 CANTX PA21 TF SPI1_NPCS0 PA22 TK SPI1_SPCK PA23 TD SPI1_MOSI PA24 RD SPI1_MISO PA25 RK SPI1_NPCS1 PA26 RF SPI1_NPCS2 PA27 DRXD PCK3 PA28 DTXD PA29 FIQ SPI1_NPCS3 PA30 IRQ0 PCK2 Function Comments AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 10.5 PIO Controller B Multiplexing Table 10-3. Multiplexing on PIO Controller B PIO Controller B Application Usage I/O Line Peripheral A Peripheral B Comments PB0 ETXCK/EREFCK PCK0 PB1 ETXEN PB2 ETX0 PB3 ETX1 PB4 ECRS PB5 ERX0 PB6 ERX1 PB7 ERXER PB8 EMDC PB9 EMDIO PB10 ETX2 SPI1_NPCS1 PB11 ETX3 SPI1_NPCS2 PB12 ETXER TCLK0 PB13 ERX2 SPI0_NPCS1 PB14 ERX3 SPI0_NPCS2 PB15 ERXDV/ECRSDV PB16 ECOL SPI1_NPCS3 PB17 ERXCK SPI0_NPCS3 PB18 EF100 ADTRG PB19 PWM0 TCLK1 PB20 PWM1 PCK0 PB21 PWM2 PCK1 PB22 PWM3 PCK2 PB23 TIOA0 DCD1 PB24 TIOB0 DSR1 PB25 TIOA1 DTR1 PB26 TIOB1 RI1 PB27 TIOA2 PWM0 AD0 PB28 TIOB2 PWM1 AD1 PB29 PCK1 PWM2 AD2 PB30 PCK2 PWM3 AD3 Function Comments 35 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 10.6 Ethernet MAC • DMA Master on Receive and Transmit Channels • Compatible with IEEE Standard 802.3 • 10 and 100 Mbit/s operation • Full- and half-duplex operation • Statistics Counter Registers • MII/RMII interface to the physical layer • Interrupt generation to signal receive and transmit completion • 28-byte transmit FIFO and 28-byte receive FIFO • Automatic pad and CRC generation on transmitted frames • Automatic discard of frames received with errors • Address checking logic supports up to four specific 48-bit addresses • Support Promiscuous Mode where all valid received frames are copied to memory • Hash matching of unicast and multicast destination addresses • Physical layer management through MDIO interface • Half-duplex flow control by forcing collisions on incoming frames • Full-duplex flow control with recognition of incoming pause frames • Support for 802.1Q VLAN tagging with recognition of incoming VLAN and priority tagged frames • Multiple buffers per receive and transmit frame • Jumbo frames up to 10240 bytes supported 10.7 Serial Peripheral Interface • Supports communication with external serial devices – Four chip selects with external decoder allow communication with up to 15 peripherals – Serial memories, such as DataFlash® and 3-wire EEPROMs – Serial peripherals, such as ADCs, DACs, LCD Controllers, CAN Controllers and Sensors – External co-processors • Master or slave serial peripheral bus interface – 8- to 16-bit programmable data length per chip select – Programmable phase and polarity per chip select – Programmable transfer delays per chip select, between consecutive transfers and between clock and data – Programmable delay between consecutive transfers – Selectable mode fault detection – Maximum frequency at up to Master Clock 36 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 10.8 Two-wire Interface • Master Mode only • Compatibility with I2C compatible devices (refer to the TWI section of the datasheet) • One, two or three bytes internal address registers for easy Serial Memory access • 7-bit or 10-bit slave addressing • Sequential read/write operations 10.9 USART • Programmable Baud Rate Generator • 5- to 9-bit full-duplex synchronous or asynchronous serial communications – 1, 1.5 or 2 stop bits in Asynchronous Mode – 1 or 2 stop bits in Synchronous Mode – Parity generation and error detection – Framing error detection, overrun error detection – MSB or LSB first – Optional break generation and detection – By 8 or by 16 over-sampling receiver frequency – Hardware handshaking RTS - CTS – Modem Signals Management DTR-DSR-DCD-RI on USART1 – Receiver time-out and transmitter timeguard – Multi-drop Mode with address generation and detection • RS485 with driver control signal • ISO7816, T = 0 or T = 1 Protocols for interfacing with smart cards – NACK handling, error counter with repetition and iteration limit • IrDA modulation and demodulation – Communication at up to 115.2 Kbps • Test Modes – Remote Loopback, Local Loopback, Automatic Echo 10.10 Serial Synchronous Controller • Provides serial synchronous communication links used in audio and telecom applications • Contains an independent receiver and transmitter and a common clock divider • Offers a configurable frame sync and data length • Receiver and transmitter can be programmed to start automatically or on detection of different event on the frame sync signal • Receiver and transmitter include a data signal, a clock signal and a frame synchronization signal 37 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 10.11 Timer Counter • Three 16-bit Timer Counter Channels – Two output compare or one input capture per channel • Wide range of functions including: – Frequency measurement – Event counting – Interval measurement – Pulse generation – Delay timing – Pulse Width Modulation – Up/down capabilities • Each channel is user-configurable and contains: – Three external clock inputs • Five internal clock inputs, as defined in Table 10-4 Table 10-4. Timer Counter Clocks Assignment TC Clock input Clock TIMER_CLOCK1 MCK/2 TIMER_CLOCK2 MCK/8 TIMER_CLOCK3 MCK/32 TIMER_CLOCK4 MCK/128 TIMER_CLOCK5 MCK/1024 – Two multi-purpose input/output signals – Two global registers that act on all three TC channels 10.12 Pulse Width Modulation Controller • Four channels, one 16-bit counter per channel • Common clock generator, providing thirteen different clocks – One Modulo n counter providing eleven clocks – Two independent linear dividers working on modulo n counter outputs • Independent channel programming – Independent enable/disable commands – Independent clock selection – Independent period and duty cycle, with double buffering – Programmable selection of the output waveform polarity – Programmable center or left aligned output waveform 38 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 10.13 USB Device Port • USB V2.0 full-speed compliant,12 Mbits per second • Embedded USB V2.0 full-speed transceiver • Embedded 1352-byte dual-port RAM for endpoints • Six endpoints – Endpoint 0: 8 bytes – Endpoint 1 and 2: 64 bytes ping-pong – Endpoint 3: 64 bytes – Endpoint 4 and 5: 256 bytes ping-pong – Ping-pong Mode (two memory banks) for bulk endpoints • Suspend/resume logic 10.14 CAN Controller • Fully compliant with CAN 2.0A and 2.0B • Bit rates up to 1Mbit/s • Eight object oriented mailboxes each with the following properties: – CAN Specification 2.0 Part A or 2.0 Part B Programmable for each Message – Object configurable to receive (with overwrite or not) or transmit – Local tag and mask filters up to 29-bit identifier/channel – 32-bit access to data registers for each mailbox data object – Uses a 16-bit time stamp on receive and transmit message – Hardware concatenation of ID unmasked bitfields to speedup family ID processing – 16-bit internal timer for time stamping and network synchronization – Programmable reception buffer length up to 8 mailbox objects – Priority management between transmission mailboxes – Autobaud and listening mode – Low power mode and programmable wake-up on bus activity or by the application – Data, remote, error and overload frame handling 10.15 128-bit Advanced Encryption Standard • Compliant with FIPS Publication 197, Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) • 128-bit (AT91SAM7XC256/128) or 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit (AT91SAM7XC512) Cryptographic Key • 12-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time (AT91SAM7XC256/128) • 12/13/14-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time (AT91SAM7XC512) • Support of the Five Standard Modes of Operation specified in the NIST Special Publication 800-38A: – Electronic Codebook (ECB) – Cipher Block Chaining (CBC) – Cipher Feedback (CFB) – Output Feedback (OFB) 39 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 – Counter (CTR) • 8-, 16-, 32-, 64- and 128-bit Data Sizes Possible in CFB Mode • Last Output Data Mode allowing Message Authentication Code (MAC) generation • Hardware Countermeasures against Differential Power Analysis attacks • Connection to PDC Channel Capabilities Optimizes Data Transfers for all Operating Modes: – One Channel for the Receiver, One Channel for the Transmitter – Next Buffer Support 10.16 Triple Data Encryption Standard • Single Data Encryption Standard (DES) and Triple Data Encryption • Algorithm (TDEA or TDES) supports • Compliant with FIPS Publication 46-3, Data Encryption Standard (DES) • 64-bit Cryptographic Key • Two-key or Three-key Algorithms • 18-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time for DES • 50-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time for TDES • Support the Four Standard Modes of Operation specified in the FIPS Publication 81, DES • Modes of Operation: – Electronic Codebook (ECB) – Cipher Block Chaining (CBC) – Cipher Feedback (CFB) – Output Feedback (OFB) • 8-, 16-, 32- and 64- Data Sizes Possible in CFB Mode • Last Output Data Mode allowing Optimized Message (Data) Authentication Code (MAC) generation • Connection to PDC Channel Capabilities Optimizes Data Transfers for all Operating Modes: – One Channel for the Receiver, One Channel for the Transmitter – Next Buffer Support 10.17 Analog-to-Digital Converter • 8-channel ADC • 10-bit 384 Ksamples/sec. Successive Approximation Register ADC • ±2 LSB Integral Non Linearity, ±1 LSB Differential Non Linearity • Integrated 8-to-1 multiplexer, offering eight independent 3.3V analog inputs • External voltage reference for better accuracy on low voltage inputs • Individual enable and disable of each channel • Multiple trigger sources – Hardware or software trigger – External trigger pin – Timer Counter 0 to 2 outputs TIOA0 to TIOA2 trigger • Sleep Mode and conversion sequencer 40 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary – Automatic wakeup on trigger and back to sleep mode after conversions of all enabled channels • Four of eight analog inputs shared with digital signals 41 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 42 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 11. ARM7TDMI Processor Overview 11.1 Overview The ARM7TDMI core executes both the 32-bit ARM® and 16-bit Thumb® instruction sets, allowing the user to trade off between high performance and high code density.The ARM7TDMI processor implements Von Neuman architecture, using a three-stage pipeline consisting of Fetch, Decode, and Execute stages. The main features of the ARM7tDMI processor are: • ARM7TDMI Based on ARMv4T Architecture • Two Instruction Sets – ARM® High-performance 32-bit Instruction Set – Thumb® High Code Density 16-bit Instruction Set • Three-Stage Pipeline Architecture – Instruction Fetch (F) – Instruction Decode (D) – Execute (E) 43 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 11.2 ARM7TDMI Processor For further details on ARM7TDMI, refer to the following ARM documents: ARM Architecture Reference Manual (DDI 0100E) ARM7TDMI Technical Reference Manual (DDI 0210B) 11.2.1 Instruction Type Instructions are either 32 bits long (in ARM state) or 16 bits long (in THUMB state). 11.2.2 Data Type ARM7TDMI supports byte (8-bit), half-word (16-bit) and word (32-bit) data types. Words must be aligned to four-byte boundaries and half words to two-byte boundaries. Unaligned data access behavior depends on which instruction is used where. 11.2.3 ARM7TDMI Operating Mode The ARM7TDMI, based on ARM architecture v4T, supports seven processor modes: User: The normal ARM program execution state FIQ: Designed to support high-speed data transfer or channel process IRQ: Used for general-purpose interrupt handling Supervisor: Protected mode for the operating system Abort mode: Implements virtual memory and/or memory protection System: A privileged user mode for the operating system Undefined: Supports software emulation of hardware coprocessors Mode changes may be made under software control, or may be brought about by external interrupts or exception processing. Most application programs execute in User mode. The non-user modes, or privileged modes, are entered in order to service interrupts or exceptions, or to access protected resources. 11.2.4 ARM7TDMI Registers The ARM7TDMI processor has a total of 37registers: • 31 general-purpose 32-bit registers • 6 status registers These registers are not accessible at the same time. The processor state and operating mode determine which registers are available to the programmer. At any one time 16 registers are visible to the user. The remainder are synonyms used to speed up exception processing. Register 15 is the Program Counter (PC) and can be used in all instructions to reference data relative to the current instruction. R14 holds the return address after a subroutine call. R13 is used (by software convention) as a stack pointer. 44 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 11-1. ARM7TDMI ARM Modes and Registers Layout User and System Mode Supervisor Mode Abort Mode Undefined Mode Interrupt Mode Fast Interrupt Mode R0 R0 R0 R0 R0 R0 R1 R1 R1 R1 R1 R1 R2 R2 R2 R2 R2 R2 R3 R3 R3 R3 R3 R3 R4 R4 R4 R4 R4 R4 R5 R5 R5 R5 R5 R5 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R7 R7 R7 R7 R7 R7 R8 R8 R8 R8 R8 R8_FIQ R9 R9 R9 R9 R9 R9_FIQ R10 R10 R10 R10 R10 R10_FIQ R11 R11 R11 R11 R11 R11_FIQ R12 R12 R12 R12 R12 R12_FIQ R13 R13_SVC R13_ABORT R13_UNDEF R13_IRQ R13_FIQ R14 R14_SVC R14_ABORT R14_UNDEF R14_IRQ R14_FIQ PC PC PC PC PC PC CPSR CPSR CPSR CPSR CPSR CPSR SPSR_SVC SPSR_ABORT SPSR_UNDEF SPSR_IRQ SPSR_FIQ Mode-specific banked registers Registers R0 to R7 are unbanked registers. This means that each of them refers to the same 32bit physical register in all processor modes. They are general-purpose registers, with no special uses managed by the architecture, and can be used wherever an instruction allows a generalpurpose register to be specified. Registers R8 to R14 are banked registers. This means that each of them depends on the current mode of the processor. 11.2.4.1 Modes and Exception Handling All exceptions have banked registers for R14 and R13. After an exception, R14 holds the return address for exception processing. This address is used to return after the exception is processed, as well as to address the instruction that caused the exception. R13 is banked across exception modes to provide each exception handler with a private stack pointer. The fast interrupt mode also banks registers 8 to 12 so that interrupt processing can begin without having to save these registers. 45 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 A seventh processing mode, System Mode, does not have any banked registers. It uses the User Mode registers. System Mode runs tasks that require a privileged processor mode and allows them to invoke all classes of exceptions. 11.2.4.2 Status Registers All other processor states are held in status registers. The current operating processor status is in the Current Program Status Register (CPSR). The CPSR holds: • four ALU flags (Negative, Zero, Carry, and Overflow) • two interrupt disable bits (one for each type of interrupt) • one bit to indicate ARM or Thumb execution • five bits to encode the current processor mode All five exception modes also have a Saved Program Status Register (SPSR) that holds the CPSR of the task immediately preceding the exception. 11.2.4.3 Exception Types The ARM7TDMI supports five types of exception and a privileged processing mode for each type. The types of exceptions are: • fast interrupt (FIQ) • normal interrupt (IRQ) • memory aborts (used to implement memory protection or virtual memory) • attempted execution of an undefined instruction • software interrupts (SWIs) Exceptions are generated by internal and external sources. More than one exception can occur in the same time. When an exception occurs, the banked version of R14 and the SPSR for the exception mode are used to save state. To return after handling the exception, the SPSR is moved to the CPSR, and R14 is moved to the PC. This can be done in two ways: • by using a data-processing instruction with the S-bit set, and the PC as the destination • by using the Load Multiple with Restore CPSR instruction (LDM) 11.2.5 ARM Instruction Set Overview The ARM instruction set is divided into: • Branch instructions • Data processing instructions • Status register transfer instructions • Load and Store instructions • Coprocessor instructions • Exception-generating instructions ARM instructions can be executed conditionally. Every instruction contains a 4-bit condition code field (bit[31:28]). Table 11-2 gives the ARM instruction mnemonic list. 46 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 11-2. 11.2.6 ARM Instruction Mnemonic List Mnemonic Operation Mnemonic Operation MOV Move CDP Coprocessor Data Processing ADD Add MVN Move Not SUB Subtract ADC Add with Carry RSB Reverse Subtract SBC Subtract with Carry CMP Compare RSC Reverse Subtract with Carry TST Test CMN Compare Negated AND Logical AND TEQ Test Equivalence EOR Logical Exclusive OR BIC Bit Clear MUL Multiply ORR Logical (inclusive) OR SMULL Sign Long Multiply MLA Multiply Accumulate SMLAL Signed Long Multiply Accumulate UMULL Unsigned Long Multiply MSR Move to Status Register UMLAL Unsigned Long Multiply Accumulate B Branch MRS Move From Status Register BX Branch and Exchange BL Branch and Link LDR Load Word SWI Software Interrupt LDRSH Load Signed Halfword STR Store Word LDRSB Load Signed Byte STRH Store Half Word LDRH Load Half Word STRB Store Byte LDRB Load Byte STRBT Store Register Byte with Translation LDRBT Load Register Byte with Translation STRT Store Register with Translation LDRT Load Register with Translation STM Store Multiple LDM Load Multiple SWPB Swap Byte SWP Swap Word MRC Move From Coprocessor MCR Move To Coprocessor STC Store From Coprocessor LDC Load To Coprocessor Thumb Instruction Set Overview The Thumb instruction set is a re-encoded subset of the ARM instruction set. The Thumb instruction set is divided into: • Branch instructions • Data processing instructions • Load and Store instructions • Load and Store Multiple instructions • Exception-generating instruction In Thumb mode, eight general-purpose registers, R0 to R7, are available that are the same physical registers as R0 to R7 when executing ARM instructions. Some Thumb instructions also access to the Program Counter (ARM Register 15), the Link Register (ARM Register 14) and the 47 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Stack Pointer (ARM Register 13). Further instructions allow limited access to the ARM registers 8 to 15. Table 11-3 gives the Thumb instruction mnemonic list. Table 11-3. 48 Thumb Instruction Mnemonic List Mnemonic Operation Mnemonic Operation MOV Move MVN Move Not ADD Add ADC Add with Carry SUB Subtract SBC Subtract with Carry CMP Compare CMN Compare Negated TST Test NEG Negate AND Logical AND BIC Bit Clear EOR Logical Exclusive OR ORR Logical (inclusive) OR LSL Logical Shift Left LSR Logical Shift Right ASR Arithmetic Shift Right ROR Rotate Right MUL Multiply B Branch BL Branch and Link BX Branch and Exchange SWI Software Interrupt LDR Load Word STR Store Word LDRH Load Half Word STRH Store Half Word LDRB Load Byte STRB Store Byte LDRSH Load Signed Halfword LDRSB Load Signed Byte LDMIA Load Multiple STMIA Store Multiple PUSH Push Register to stack POP Pop Register from stack AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 12. Debug and Test Features 12.1 Description The AT91SAM7XC Series features a number of complementary debug and test capabilities. A common JTAG/ICE (In-Circuit Emulator) port is used for standard debugging functions, such as downloading code and single-stepping through programs. The Debug Unit provides a two-pin UART that can be used to upload an application into internal SRAM. It manages the interrupt handling of the internal COMMTX and COMMRX signals that trace the activity of the Debug Communication Channel. A set of dedicated debug and test input/output pins gives direct access to these capabilities from a PC-based test environment. 12.2 Block Diagram Figure 12-1. Debug and Test Block Diagram TMS TCK TDI ICE/JTAG TAP Boundary TAP JTAGSEL TDO ICE POR Reset and Test TST PIO ARM7TDMI PDC DTXD DBGU DRXD 49 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 12.3 12.3.1 Application Examples Debug Environment Figure 12-2 shows a complete debug environment example. The ICE/JTAG interface is used for standard debugging functions, such as downloading code and single-stepping through the program. Figure 12-2. Application Debug Environment Example Host Debugger ICE/JTAG Interface ICE/JTAG Connector AT91SAMXCxx RS232 Connector Terminal AT91SAM7XCxx-based Application Board 50 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 12.3.2 Test Environment Figure 12-3 shows a test environment example. Test vectors are sent and interpreted by the tester. In this example, the “board in test” is designed using a number of JTAG-compliant devices. These devices can be connected to form a single scan chain. Figure 12-3. Application Test Environment Example Test Adaptor Tester JTAG Interface ICE/JTAG Connector Chip n AT91SAM7XCxx Chip 2 Chip 1 AT91SAM7XCxx-based Application Board In Test 12.4 Debug and Test Pin Description Table 12-1. Pin Name Debug and Test Pin List Function Type Active Level Input/Output Low Input High Reset/Test NRST Microcontroller Reset TST Test Mode Select ICE and JTAG TCK Test Clock Input TDI Test Data In Input TDO Test Data Out TMS Test Mode Select Input JTAGSEL JTAG Selection Input Output Debug Unit DRXD Debug Receive Data Input DTXD Debug Transmit Data Output 51 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 12.5 12.5.1 Functional Description Test Pin One dedicated pin, TST, is used to define the device operating mode. The user must make sure that this pin is tied at low level to ensure normal operating conditions. Other values associated with this pin are reserved for manufacturing test. 12.5.2 EmbeddedICE™ (Embedded In-circuit Emulator) The ARM7TDMI EmbeddedICE is supported via the ICE/JTAG port. The internal state of the ARM7TDMI is examined through an ICE/JTAG port. The ARM7TDMI processor contains hardware extensions for advanced debugging features: • In halt mode, a store-multiple (STM) can be inserted into the instruction pipeline. This exports the contents of the ARM7TDMI registers. This data can be serially shifted out without affecting the rest of the system. • In monitor mode, the JTAG interface is used to transfer data between the debugger and a simple monitor program running on the ARM7TDMI processor. There are three scan chains inside the ARM7TDMI processor that support testing, debugging, and programming of the EmbeddedICE. The scan chains are controlled by the ICE/JTAG port. EmbeddedICE mode is selected when JTAGSEL is low. It is not possible to switch directly between ICE and JTAG operations. A chip reset must be performed after JTAGSEL is changed. For further details on the EmbeddedICE, see the ARM7TDMI (Rev4) Technical Reference Manual (DDI0210B). 12.5.3 Debug Unit The Debug Unit provides a two-pin (DXRD and TXRD) USART that can be used for several debug and trace purposes and offers an ideal means for in-situ programming solutions and debug monitor communication. Moreover, the association with two peripheral data controller channels permits packet handling of these tasks with processor time reduced to a minimum. The Debug Unit also manages the interrupt handling of the COMMTX and COMMRX signals that come from the ICE and that trace the activity of the Debug Communication Channel. The Debug Unit allows blockage of access to the system through the ICE interface. A specific register, the Debug Unit Chip ID Register, gives information about the product version and its internal configuration. The AT91SAM7XC512 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x271C 0A40 on 32-bit width. The AT91SAM7XC256 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x271B 0940 on 32-bit width. The AT91SAM7XC128 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x271A 0740 on 32-bit width. For further details on the Debug Unit, see the Debug Unit section. 12.5.4 IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan allows pin-level access independent of the device packaging technology. IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan is enabled when JTAGSEL is high. The SAMPLE, EXTEST and BYPASS functions are implemented. In ICE debug mode, the ARM processor responds 52 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary with a non-JTAG chip ID that identifies the processor to the ICE system. This is not IEEE 1149.1 JTAG-compliant. It is not possible to switch directly between JTAG and ICE operations. A chip reset must be performed after JTAGSEL is changed. A Boundary-scan Descriptor Language (BSDL) file is provided to set up test. 12.5.4.1 JTAG Boundary-scan Register The Boundary-scan Register (BSR) contains 187 bits that correspond to active pins and associated control signals. Each AT91SAM7XC input/output pin corresponds to a 3-bit register in the BSR. The OUTPUT bit contains data that can be forced on the pad. The INPUT bit facilitates the observability of data applied to the pad. The CONTROL bit selects the direction of the pad. Table 12-2. Bit Number AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register Pin Name Pin Type 187 186 Associated BSR Cells INPUT PA30/IRQ0/PCK2 IN/OUT OUTPUT 185 CONTROL 184 INPUT 183 PA0/RXD0 IN/OUT 182 181 180 INPUT PA1/TXD0 IN/OUT 179 OUTPUT CONTROL 178 177 OUTPUT CONTROL INPUT PA3/RTS0/SPI1_NPCS2 IN/OUT OUTPUT 176 CONTROL 175 INPUT 174 PA2/SCK0/SPI1_NPCS1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 173 CONTROL 172 INPUT 171 PA4/CTS0/SPI1_NPCS3 IN/OUT OUTPUT 170 CONTROL 169 INPUT 168 PA5/RXD1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 167 CONTROL 166 CONTROL 165 PA6/TXD1 IN/OUT INPUT 164 OUTPUT 163 CONTROL 162 PA7/SCK1/SPI0_NPCS1 IN/OUT 161 160 INPUT OUTPUT ERASE IN INPUT 53 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 12-2. Bit Number AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued) Pin Name Pin Type 159 158 INPUT PB27/TIOA2/PWM0/AD0 IN/OUT OUTPUT 157 CONTROL 156 INPUT 155 PB28/TIOB2/PWM1/AD1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 154 CONTROL 153 INPUT 152 PB29/PCK1/PWM2/AD2 IN/OUT 151 149 INPUT PB30/PCK2/PWM3/AD3 IN/OUT 148 INPUT PA8/RTS1/SPI0_NPCS2 IN/OUT 145 OUTPUT CONTROL 144 143 OUTPUT CONTROL 147 146 OUTPUT CONTROL 150 INPUT PA9/CTS1/SPI0_NPCS3 IN/OUT OUTPUT 142 CONTROL 141 INPUT 140 PA10/TWD IN/OUT OUTPUT 139 CONTROL 138 INPUT 137 PA11/TWCK IN/OUT OUTPUT 136 CONTROL 135 INPUT 134 PA12/SPI0_NPCS0 IN/OUT OUTPUT 133 CONTROL 132 INPUT 131 PA13/SPI0_NPCS1/PCK1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 130 CONTROL 129 INPUT 128 PA14/SPI0_NPCS2/IRQ1 IN/OUT 127 125 INPUT PA15/SPI0_NPCS3/TCLK2 IN/OUT 124 INPUT PA16/SPI0_MISO IN/OUT 121 OUTPUT CONTROL 120 119 OUTPUT CONTROL 123 122 OUTPUT CONTROL 126 INPUT PA17/SPI0_MOSI 118 54 Associated BSR Cells IN/OUT OUTPUT CONTROL AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 12-2. Bit Number AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued) Pin Name Pin Type 117 116 Associated BSR Cells INPUT PA18/SPI0_SPCK IN/OUT OUTPUT 115 CONTROL 114 INPUT 113 PB9/EMDIO IN/OUT OUTPUT 112 CONTROL 111 INPUT 110 PB8/EMDC IN/OUT 109 108 107 INPUT PB14/ERX3/SPI0_NPCS2 IN/OUT 106 INPUT PB13/ERX2/SPI0_NPCS1 IN/OUT 103 OUTPUT CONTROL 102 101 OUTPUT CONTROL 105 104 OUTPUT CONTROL INPUT PB6/ERX1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 100 CONTROL 99 INPUT 98 PB5/ERX0 IN/OUT OUTPUT 97 CONTROL 96 INPUT 95 PB15/ERXDV/ECRSDV IN/OUT OUTPUT 94 CONTROL 93 INPUT 92 PB17/ERXCK/SPI0_NPCS3 IN/OUT OUTPUT 91 CONTROL 90 INPUT 89 PB7/ERXER IN/OUT OUTPUT 88 CONTROL 87 INPUT 86 PB12/ETXER/TCLK0 IN/OUT 85 84 83 INPUT PB0/ETXCK/EREFCK/PCK0 PB0/ETXCK/ERE FCK/PCK0 82 INPUT PB1/ETXEN PB1/ETXEN 79 76 OUTPUT CONTROL 78 77 OUTPUT CONTROL 81 80 OUTPUT CONTROL INPUT PB2/ETX0 PB2/ETX0 OUTPUT CONTROL 55 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 12-2. Bit Number AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued) Pin Name Pin Type 75 74 INPUT PB3/ETX1 PB3/ETX1 OUTPUT 73 CONTROL 72 INPUT 71 PB10/ETX2/SPI1_NPCS1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 70 CONTROL 69 INPUT 68 PB11/ETX3/SPI1_NPCS2 IN/OUT 67 65 INPUT PA19/CANRX IN/OUT 64 INPUT PA20/CANTX IN/OUT 61 OUTPUT CONTROL 60 59 OUTPUT CONTROL 63 62 OUTPUT CONTROL 66 INPUT PA21/TF/SPI1_NPCS0 IN/OUT OUTPUT 58 CONTROL 57 INPUT 56 PA22/TK/SPI1_SPCK IN/OUT OUTPUT 55 CONTROL 54 INPUT 53 PB16/ECOL/SPI1_NPCS3 IN/OUT OUTPUT 52 CONTROL 51 INPUT 50 PB4/ECRS IN/OUT OUTPUT 49 CONTROL 48 INPUT 47 PA23/TD/SPI1_MOSI IN/OUT OUTPUT 46 CONTROL 45 INPUT 44 PA24/RD/SPI1_MISO IN/OUT 43 INPUT PA25/RK/SPI1_NPCS1 IN/OUT 40 INPUT PA26/RF/SPI1_NPCS2 IN/OUT 37 OUTPUT CONTROL 36 35 OUTPUT CONTROL 39 38 OUTPUT CONTROL 42 41 INPUT PB18/EF100/ADTRG 34 56 Associated BSR Cells IN/OUT OUTPUT CONTROL AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 12-2. Bit Number AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued) Pin Name Pin Type 33 32 Associated BSR Cells INPUT PB19/PWM0/TCLK1 IN/OUT 31 OUTPUT CONTROL 30 INPUT 29 PB20/PWM1/PCK0 IN/OUT OUTPUT 28 CONTROL 27 INPUT 26 PB21/PWM2/PCK2 IN/OUT 25 24 23 INPUT PB22/PWM3/PCK2 IN/OUT 22 INPUT PB23/TIOA0/DCD1 IN/OUT 19 OUTPUT CONTROL 18 17 OUTPUT CONTROL 21 20 OUTPUT CONTROL INPUT PB24/TIOB0/DSR1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 16 CONTROL 15 INPUT 14 PB25/TIOA1/DTR1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 13 CONTROL 12 INPUT 11 PB26/TIOB1/RI1 IN/OUT OUTPUT 10 CONTROL 9 INPUT 8 PA27DRXD/PCK3 IN/OUT OUTPUT 7 CONTROL 6 INPUT 5 PA28/DTXD IN/OUT OUTPUT 4 CONTROL 3 INPUT 2 1 PA29/FIQ/SPI1_NPCS3 IN/OUT OUTPUT CONTROL 57 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 12.5.5 ID Code Register Access: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 VERSION 23 22 25 24 PART NUMBER 21 20 19 18 17 16 10 9 8 PART NUMBER 15 14 13 12 11 PART NUMBER 7 6 MANUFACTURER IDENTITY 5 4 3 2 MANUFACTURER IDENTITY 1 0 1 • VERSION[31:28]: Product Version Number Set to 0x0. • PART NUMBER[27:12]: Product Part Number AT91SAM7XC512: 0x5B19 AT91SAM7XC256: 0x5B10 AT91SAM7XC128: 0x5B0F • MANUFACTURER IDENTITY[11:1] Set to 0x01F. Bit[0] Required by IEEE Std. 1149.1. Set to 0x1. AT91SAM7XC512: JTAG ID Code value is 05B1_903F AT91SAM7XC256: JTAG ID Code value is 05B1_003F AT91SAM7XC128: JTAG ID Code value is 05B0_F03F 58 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13. Reset Controller (RSTC) The Reset Controller (RSTC), based on power-on reset cells, handles all the resets of the system without any external components. It reports which reset occurred last. The Reset Controller also drives independently or simultaneously the external reset and the peripheral and processor resets. A brownout detection is also available to prevent the processor from falling into an unpredictable state. 13.1 Block Diagram Figure 13-1. Reset Controller Block Diagram Reset Controller bod_rst_en Brownout Manager brown_out Main Supply POR bod_reset Reset State Manager Startup Counter rstc_irq proc_nreset user_reset NRST NRST Manager nrst_out periph_nreset exter_nreset WDRPROC wd_fault SLCK 59 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 13.2 Functional Description 13.2.1 Reset Controller Overview The Reset Controller is made up of an NRST Manager, a Brownout Manager, a Startup Counter and a Reset State Manager. It runs at Slow Clock and generates the following reset signals: • proc_nreset: Processor reset line. It also resets the Watchdog Timer. • periph_nreset: Affects the whole set of embedded peripherals. • nrst_out: Drives the NRST pin. These reset signals are asserted by the Reset Controller, either on external events or on software action. The Reset State Manager controls the generation of reset signals and provides a signal to the NRST Manager when an assertion of the NRST pin is required. The NRST Manager shapes the NRST assertion during a programmable time, thus controlling external device resets. The startup counter waits for the complete crystal oscillator startup. The wait delay is given by the crystal oscillator startup time maximum value that can be found in the section Crystal Oscillator Characteristics in the Electrical Characteristics section of the product documentation. 13.2.2 NRST Manager The NRST Manager samples the NRST input pin and drives this pin low when required by the Reset State Manager. Figure 13-2 shows the block diagram of the NRST Manager. Figure 13-2. NRST Manager RSTC_MR URSTIEN RSTC_SR URSTS NRSTL rstc_irq RSTC_MR URSTEN Other interrupt sources user_reset NRST RSTC_MR ERSTL nrst_out 13.2.2.1 External Reset Timer exter_nreset NRST Signal or Interrupt The NRST Manager samples the NRST pin at Slow Clock speed. When the line is detected low, a User Reset is reported to the Reset State Manager. However, the NRST Manager can be programmed to not trigger a reset when an assertion of NRST occurs. Writing the bit URSTEN at 0 in RSTC_MR disables the User Reset trigger. The level of the pin NRST can be read at any time in the bit NRSTL (NRST level) in RSTC_SR. As soon as the pin NRST is asserted, the bit URSTS in RSTC_SR is set. This bit clears only when RSTC_SR is read. The Reset Controller can also be programmed to generate an interrupt instead of generating a reset. To do so, the bit URSTIEN in RSTC_MR must be written at 1. 60 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.2.2.2 NRST External Reset Control The Reset State Manager asserts the signal ext_nreset to assert the NRST pin. When this occurs, the “nrst_out” signal is driven low by the NRST Manager for a time programmed by the field ERSTL in RSTC_MR. This assertion duration, named EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH, lasts 2(ERSTL+1) Slow Clock cycles. This gives the approximate duration of an assertion between 60 µs and 2 seconds. Note that ERSTL at 0 defines a two-cycle duration for the NRST pulse. This feature allows the Reset Controller to shape the NRST pin level, and thus to guarantee that the NRST line is driven low for a time compliant with potential external devices connected on the system reset. 13.2.3 Brownout Manager Brownout detection prevents the processor from falling into an unpredictable state if the power supply drops below a certain level. When VDDCORE drops below the brownout threshold, the brownout manager requests a brownout reset by asserting the bod_reset signal. The programmer can disable the brownout reset by setting low the bod_rst_en input signal, i.e.; by locking the corresponding general-purpose NVM bit in the Flash. When the brownout reset is disabled, no reset is performed. Instead, the brownout detection is reported in the bit BODSTS of RSTC_SR. BODSTS is set and clears only when RSTC_SR is read. The bit BODSTS can trigger an interrupt if the bit BODIEN is set in the RSTC_MR. At factory, the brownout reset is disabled. Figure 13-3. Brownout Manager bod_rst_en bod_reset RSTC_MR BODIEN RSTC_SR brown_out BODSTS rstc_irq Other interrupt sources 61 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 13.2.4 Reset States The Reset State Manager handles the different reset sources and generates the internal reset signals. It reports the reset status in the field RSTTYP of the Status Register (RSTC_SR). The update of the field RSTTYP is performed when the processor reset is released. 13.2.4.1 Power-up Reset When VDDCORE is powered on, the Main Supply POR cell output is filtered with a start-up counter that operates at Slow Clock. The purpose of this counter is to ensure that the Slow Clock oscillator is stable before starting up the device. The startup time, as shown in Figure 13-4, is hardcoded to comply with the Slow Clock Oscillator startup time. After the startup time, the reset signals are released and the field RSTTYP in RSTC_SR reports a Power-up Reset. When VDDCORE is detected low by the Main Supply POR Cell, all reset signals are asserted immediately. Figure 13-4. Power-up Reset SLCK Any Freq. MCK Main Supply POR output proc_nreset Startup Time Processor Startup = 3 cycles periph_nreset NRST (nrst_out) EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH = 2 cycles 62 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.2.4.2 User Reset The User Reset is entered when a low level is detected on the NRST pin and the bit URSTEN in RSTC_MR is at 1. The NRST input signal is resynchronized with SLCK to insure proper behavior of the system. The User Reset is entered as soon as a low level is detected on NRST. The Processor Reset and the Peripheral Reset are asserted. The User Reset is left when NRST rises, after a two-cycle resynchronization time and a threecycle processor startup. The processor clock is re-enabled as soon as NRST is confirmed high. When the processor reset signal is released, the RSTTYP field of the Status Register (RSTC_SR) is loaded with the value 0x4, indicating a User Reset. The NRST Manager guarantees that the NRST line is asserted for EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH Slow Clock cycles, as programmed in the field ERSTL. However, if NRST does not rise after EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH because it is driven low externally, the internal reset lines remain asserted until NRST actually rises. Figure 13-5. User Reset State SLCK MCK Any Freq. NRST Resynch. 2 cycles Resynch. 2 cycles Processor Startup = 3 cycles proc_nreset RSTTYP Any XXX 0x4 = User Reset periph_nreset NRST (nrst_out) >= EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH 63 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 13.2.4.3 Brownout Reset When the brown_out/bod_reset signal is asserted, the Reset State Manager immediately enters the Brownout Reset. In this state, the processor, the peripheral and the external reset lines are asserted. The Brownout Reset is left 3 Slow Clock cycles after the rising edge of brown_out/bod_reset after a two-cycle resynchronization. An external reset is also triggered. When the processor reset is released, the field RSTTYP in RSTC_SR is loaded with the value 0x5, thus indicating that the last reset is a Brownout Reset. Figure 13-6. Brownout Reset State SLCK MCK Any Freq. brown_out or bod_reset Resynch. 2 cycles Processor Startup = 3 cycles proc_nreset RSTTYP Any XXX 0x5 = Brownout Reset periph_nreset NRST (nrst_out) EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH 8 cycles (ERSTL=2) 64 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.2.4.4 Software Reset The Reset Controller offers several commands used to assert the different reset signals. These commands are performed by writing the Control Register (RSTC_CR) with the following bits at 1: • PROCRST: Writing PROCRST at 1 resets the processor and the watchdog timer. • PERRST: Writing PERRST at 1 resets all the embedded peripherals, including the memory system, and, in particular, the Remap Command. The Peripheral Reset is generally used for debug purposes. Except for Debug purposes, PERRST must always be used in conjuction with PROCRST (PERRST and PROCRST set both at 1 simultaneously). • EXTRST: Writing EXTRST at 1 asserts low the NRST pin during a time defined by the field ERSTL in the Mode Register (RSTC_MR). The software reset is entered if at least one of these bits is set by the software. All these commands can be performed independently or simultaneously. The software reset lasts 3 Slow Clock cycles. The internal reset signals are asserted as soon as the register write is performed. This is detected on the Master Clock (MCK). They are released when the software reset is left, i.e.; synchronously to SLCK. If EXTRST is set, the nrst_out signal is asserted depending on the programming of the field ERSTL. However, the resulting falling edge on NRST does not lead to a User Reset. If and only if the PROCRST bit is set, the Reset Controller reports the software status in the field RSTTYP of the Status Register (RSTC_SR). Other Software Resets are not reported in RSTTYP. As soon as a software operation is detected, the bit SRCMP (Software Reset Command in Progress) is set in the Status Register (RSTC_SR). It is cleared as soon as the software reset is left. No other software reset can be performed while the SRCMP bit is set, and writing any value in RSTC_CR has no effect. 65 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 13-7. Software Reset SLCK MCK Any Freq. Write RSTC_CR Resynch. 1 cycle Processor Startup = 3 cycles proc_nreset if PROCRST=1 RSTTYP Any XXX 0x3 = Software Reset periph_nreset if PERRST=1 NRST (nrst_out) if EXTRST=1 EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH 8 cycles (ERSTL=2) SRCMP in RSTC_SR 66 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.2.4.5 Watchdog Reset The Watchdog Reset is entered when a watchdog fault occurs. This state lasts 3 Slow Clock cycles. When in Watchdog Reset, assertion of the reset signals depends on the WDRPROC bit in WDT_MR: • If WDRPROC is 0, the Processor Reset and the Peripheral Reset are asserted. The NRST line is also asserted, depending on the programming of the field ERSTL. However, the resulting low level on NRST does not result in a User Reset state. • If WDRPROC = 1, only the processor reset is asserted. The Watchdog Timer is reset by the proc_nreset signal. As the watchdog fault always causes a processor reset if WDRSTEN is set, the Watchdog Timer is always reset after a Watchdog Reset, and the Watchdog is enabled by default and with a period set to a maximum. When the WDRSTEN in WDT_MR bit is reset, the watchdog fault has no impact on the reset controller. Figure 13-8. Watchdog Reset SLCK MCK Any Freq. wd_fault Processor Startup = 3 cycles proc_nreset RSTTYP Any XXX 0x2 = Watchdog Reset periph_nreset Only if WDRPROC = 0 NRST (nrst_out) EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH 8 cycles (ERSTL=2) 67 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 13.2.5 Reset State Priorities The Reset State Manager manages the following priorities between the different reset sources, given in descending order: • Power-up Reset • Brownout Reset • Watchdog Reset • Software Reset • User Reset Particular cases are listed below: • When in User Reset: – A watchdog event is impossible because the Watchdog Timer is being reset by the proc_nreset signal. – A software reset is impossible, since the processor reset is being activated. • When in Software Reset: – A watchdog event has priority over the current state. – The NRST has no effect. • When in Watchdog Reset: – The processor reset is active and so a Software Reset cannot be programmed. – A User Reset cannot be entered. 68 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.2.6 Reset Controller Status Register The Reset Controller status register (RSTC_SR) provides several status fields: • RSTTYP field: This field gives the type of the last reset, as explained in previous sections. • SRCMP bit: This field indicates that a Software Reset Command is in progress and that no further software reset should be performed until the end of the current one. This bit is automatically cleared at the end of the current software reset. • NRSTL bit: The NRSTL bit of the Status Register gives the level of the NRST pin sampled on each MCK rising edge. • URSTS bit: A high-to-low transition of the NRST pin sets the URSTS bit of the RSTC_SR register. This transition is also detected on the Master Clock (MCK) rising edge (see Figure 13-9). If the User Reset is disabled (URSTEN = 0) and if the interruption is enabled by the URSTIEN bit in the RSTC_MR register, the URSTS bit triggers an interrupt. Reading the RSTC_SR status register resets the URSTS bit and clears the interrupt. • BODSTS bit: This bit indicates a brownout detection when the brownout reset is disabled (bod_rst_en = 0). It triggers an interrupt if the bit BODIEN in the RSTC_MR register enables the interrupt. Reading the RSTC_SR register resets the BODSTS bit and clears the interrupt. Figure 13-9. Reset Controller Status and Interrupt MCK read RSTC_SR Peripheral Access 2 cycle resynchronization 2 cycle resynchronization NRST NRSTL URSTS rstc_irq if (URSTEN = 0) and (URSTIEN = 1) 69 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 13.3 Reset Controller (RSTC) User Interface Table 13-1. Register Mapping Offset Register Name 0x00 Control Register 0x04 0x08 70 Access Reset RSTC_CR Write-only - Status Register RSTC_SR Read-only 0x0000_0000 Mode Register RSTC_MR Read-write 0x0000_0000 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.3.1 Reset Controller Control Register Register Name: RSTC_CR Access Type: 31 Write-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 KEY 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 EXTRST 2 PERRST 1 – 0 PROCRST • PROCRST: Processor Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, resets the processor. • PERRST: Peripheral Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, resets the peripherals. • EXTRST: External Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, asserts the NRST pin. • KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation. 71 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 13.3.2 Reset Controller Status Register Register Name: RSTC_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 SRCMP 16 NRSTL 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 9 RSTTYP 8 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 BODSTS 0 URSTS • URSTS: User Reset Status 0 = No high-to-low edge on NRST happened since the last read of RSTC_SR. 1 = At least one high-to-low transition of NRST has been detected since the last read of RSTC_SR. • BODSTS: Brownout Detection Status 0 = No brownout high-to-low transition happened since the last read of RSTC_SR. 1 = A brownout high-to-low transition has been detected since the last read of RSTC_SR. • RSTTYP: Reset Type Reports the cause of the last processor reset. Reading this RSTC_SR does not reset this field. RSTTYP Reset Type Comments 0 0 0 Power-up Reset VDDCORE rising 0 1 0 Watchdog Reset Watchdog fault occurred 0 1 1 Software Reset Processor reset required by the software 1 0 0 User Reset NRST pin detected low 1 0 1 Brownout Reset Brownout reset occurred • NRSTL: NRST Pin Level Registers the NRST Pin Level at Master Clock (MCK). • SRCMP: Software Reset Command in Progress 0 = No software command is being performed by the reset controller. The reset controller is ready for a software command. 1 = A software reset command is being performed by the reset controller. The reset controller is busy. 72 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 13.3.3 Reset Controller Mode Register Register Name: RSTC_MR Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 KEY 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 BODIEN 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 10 9 8 7 – 6 – 5 4 URSTIEN 3 – 1 – 0 URSTEN ERSTL 2 – • URSTEN: User Reset Enable 0 = The detection of a low level on the pin NRST does not generate a User Reset. 1 = The detection of a low level on the pin NRST triggers a User Reset. • URSTIEN: User Reset Interrupt Enable 0 = USRTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 has no effect on rstc_irq. 1 = USRTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 asserts rstc_irq if URSTEN = 0. • BODIEN: Brownout Detection Interrupt Enable 0 = BODSTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 has no effect on rstc_irq. 1 = BODSTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 asserts rstc_irq. • ERSTL: External Reset Length This field defines the external reset length. The external reset is asserted during a time of 2(ERSTL+1) Slow Clock cycles. This allows assertion duration to be programmed between 60 µs and 2 seconds. • KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation. 73 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 74 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 14. Real-time Timer (RTT) 14.1 Overview The Real-time Timer is built around a 32-bit counter and used to count elapsed seconds. It generates a periodic interrupt or/and triggers an alarm on a programmed value. 14.2 Block Diagram Figure 14-1. Real-time Timer RTT_MR RTTRST RTT_MR RTPRES RTT_MR SLCK RTTINCIEN reload 16-bit Divider set 0 RTT_MR RTTRST RTTINC RTT_SR 1 reset 0 rtt_int 32-bit Counter read RTT_SR RTT_MR ALMIEN RTT_VR reset CRTV RTT_SR ALMS set rtt_alarm = RTT_AR 14.3 ALMV Functional Description The Real-time Timer is used to count elapsed seconds. It is built around a 32-bit counter fed by Slow Clock divided by a programmable 16-bit value. The value can be programmed in the field RTPRES of the Real-time Mode Register (RTT_MR). Programming RTPRES at 0x00008000 corresponds to feeding the real-time counter with a 1 Hz signal (if the Slow Clock is 32.768 Hz). The 32-bit counter can count up to 232 seconds, corresponding to more than 136 years, then roll over to 0. The Real-time Timer can also be used as a free-running timer with a lower time-base. The best accuracy is achieved by writing RTPRES to 3. Programming RTPRES to 1 or 2 is possible, but may result in losing status events because the status register is cleared two Slow Clock cycles after read. Thus if the RTT is configured to trigger an interrupt, the interrupt occurs during 2 Slow Clock cycles after reading RTT_SR. To prevent several executions of the interrupt handler, the interrupt must be disabled in the interrupt handler and re-enabled when the status register is clear. 75 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 The Real-time Timer value (CRTV) can be read at any time in the register RTT_VR (Real-time Value Register). As this value can be updated asynchronously from the Master Clock, it is advisable to read this register twice at the same value to improve accuracy of the returned value. The current value of the counter is compared with the value written in the alarm register RTT_AR (Real-time Alarm Register). If the counter value matches the alarm, the bit ALMS in RTT_SR is set. The alarm register is set to its maximum value, corresponding to 0xFFFF_FFFF, after a reset. The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR is set each time the Real-time Timer counter is incremented. This bit can be used to start a periodic interrupt, the period being one second when the RTPRES is programmed with 0x8000 and Slow Clock equal to 32.768 Hz. Reading the RTT_SR status register resets the RTTINC and ALMS fields. Writing the bit RTTRST in RTT_MR immediately reloads and restarts the clock divider with the new programmed value. This also resets the 32-bit counter. Note: Because of the asynchronism between the Slow Clock (SCLK) and the System Clock (MCK): 1) The restart of the counter and the reset of the RTT_VR current value register is effective only 2 slow clock cycles after the write of the RTTRST bit in the RTT_MR register. 2) The status register flags reset is taken into account only 2 slow clock cycles after the read of the RTT_SR (Status Register). Figure 14-2. RTT Counting APB cycle APB cycle MCK RTPRES - 1 Prescaler 0 RTT 0 ... ALMV-1 ALMV ALMV+1 ALMV+2 ALMV+3 RTTINC (RTT_SR) ALMS (RTT_SR) APB Interface read RTT_SR 76 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 14.4 Real-time Timer (RTT) User Interface Table 14-1. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Mode Register RTT_MR Read-write 0x0000_8000 0x04 Alarm Register RTT_AR Read-write 0xFFFF_FFFF 0x08 Value Register RTT_VR Read-only 0x0000_0000 0x0C Status Register RTT_SR Read-only 0x0000_0000 77 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 14.4.1 Real-time Timer Mode Register Register Name: RTT_MR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 RTTRST 17 RTTINCIEN 16 ALMIEN 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RTPRES 7 6 5 4 RTPRES • RTPRES: Real-time Timer Prescaler Value Defines the number of SLCK periods required to increment the real-time timer. RTPRES is defined as follows: RTPRES = 0: The Prescaler Period is equal to 216 RTPRES ≠ 0: The Prescaler Period is equal to RTPRES. • ALMIEN: Alarm Interrupt Enable 0 = The bit ALMS in RTT_SR has no effect on interrupt. 1 = The bit ALMS in RTT_SR asserts interrupt. • RTTINCIEN: Real-time Timer Increment Interrupt Enable 0 = The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR has no effect on interrupt. 1 = The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR asserts interrupt. • RTTRST: Real-time Timer Restart 1 = Reloads and restarts the clock divider with the new programmed value. This also resets the 32-bit counter. 78 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 14.4.2 Real-time Timer Alarm Register Register Name: RTT_AR Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ALMV 23 22 21 20 ALMV 15 14 13 12 ALMV 7 6 5 4 ALMV • ALMV: Alarm Value Defines the alarm value (ALMV+1) compared with the Real-time Timer. 14.4.3 Real-time Timer Value Register Register Name: RTT_VR Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 28 CRTV 23 22 21 20 CRTV 15 14 13 12 CRTV 7 6 5 4 CRTV • CRTV: Current Real-time Value Returns the current value of the Real-time Timer. 79 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 14.4.4 Real-time Timer Status Register Register Name: RTT_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 RTTINC 0 ALMS • ALMS: Real-time Alarm Status 0 = The Real-time Alarm has not occurred since the last read of RTT_SR. 1 = The Real-time Alarm occurred since the last read of RTT_SR. • RTTINC: Real-time Timer Increment 0 = The Real-time Timer has not been incremented since the last read of the RTT_SR. 1 = The Real-time Timer has been incremented since the last read of the RTT_SR. 80 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15. Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) 15.1 Overview The Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) manages up to 32 fully programmable input/output lines. Each I/O line may be dedicated as a general-purpose I/O or be assigned to a function of an embedded peripheral. This assures effective optimization of the pins of a product. Each I/O line is associated with a bit number in all of the 32-bit registers of the 32-bit wide User Interface. Each I/O line of the PIO Controller features: • An input change interrupt enabling level change detection on any I/O line. • A glitch filter providing rejection of pulses lower than one-half of clock cycle. • Multi-drive capability similar to an open drain I/O line. • Control of the the pull-up of the I/O line. • Input visibility and output control. The PIO Controller also features a synchronous output providing up to 32 bits of data output in a single write operation. 81 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.2 Block Diagram Figure 15-1. Block Diagram PIO Controller AIC PMC PIO Interrupt PIO Clock Data, Enable Up to 32 peripheral IOs Embedded Peripheral PIN 0 Data, Enable PIN 1 Up to 32 pins Embedded Peripheral Up to 32 peripheral IOs PIN 31 APB Figure 15-2. Application Block Diagram On-Chip Peripheral Drivers Keyboard Driver Control & Command Driver On-Chip Peripherals PIO Controller Keyboard Driver 82 General Purpose I/Os External Devices AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.3 Product Dependencies 15.3.1 Pin Multiplexing Each pin is configurable, according to product definition as either a general-purpose I/O line only, or as an I/O line multiplexed with one or two peripheral I/Os. As the multiplexing is hardware-defined and thus product-dependent, the hardware designer and programmer must carefully determine the configuration of the PIO controllers required by their application. When an I/O line is general-purpose only, i.e. not multiplexed with any peripheral I/O, programming of the PIO Controller regarding the assignment to a peripheral has no effect and only the PIO Controller can control how the pin is driven by the product. 15.3.2 External Interrupt Lines The interrupt signals FIQ and IRQ0 to IRQn are most generally multiplexed through the PIO Controllers. However, it is not necessary to assign the I/O line to the interrupt function as the PIO Controller has no effect on inputs and the interrupt lines (FIQ or IRQs) are used only as inputs. 15.3.3 Power Management The Power Management Controller controls the PIO Controller clock in order to save power. Writing any of the registers of the user interface does not require the PIO Controller clock to be enabled. This means that the configuration of the I/O lines does not require the PIO Controller clock to be enabled. However, when the clock is disabled, not all of the features of the PIO Controller are available. Note that the Input Change Interrupt and the read of the pin level require the clock to be validated. After a hardware reset, the PIO clock is disabled by default. The user must configure the Power Management Controller before any access to the input line information. 15.3.4 Interrupt Generation For interrupt handling, the PIO Controllers are considered as user peripherals. This means that the PIO Controller interrupt lines are connected among the interrupt sources 2 to 31. Refer to the PIO Controller peripheral identifier in the product description to identify the interrupt sources dedicated to the PIO Controllers. The PIO Controller interrupt can be generated only if the PIO Controller clock is enabled. 83 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.4 Functional Description The PIO Controller features up to 32 fully-programmable I/O lines. Most of the control logic associated to each I/O is represented in Figure 15-3. In this description each signal shown represents but one of up to 32 possible indexes. Figure 15-3. I/O Line Control Logic PIO_OER[0] PIO_OSR[0] PIO_PUER[0] PIO_ODR[0] PIO_PUSR[0] PIO_PUDR[0] 1 Peripheral A Output Enable 0 0 Peripheral B Output Enable 0 1 PIO_ASR[0] PIO_PER[0] PIO_ABSR[0] 1 PIO_PSR[0] PIO_BSR[0] PIO_PDR[0] Peripheral A Output 0 Peripheral B Output 1 PIO_MDER[0] PIO_MDSR[0] PIO_MDDR[0] 0 0 PIO_SODR[0] PIO_ODSR[0] 1 Pad PIO_CODR[0] 1 Peripheral A Input PIO_PDSR[0] 0 Edge Detector Glitch Filter Peripheral B Input PIO_ISR[0] (Up to 32 possible inputs) PIO Interrupt 1 PIO_IFER[0] PIO_IFSR[0] PIO_IFDR[0] PIO_IER[0] PIO_IMR[0] PIO_IDR[0] PIO_ISR[31] PIO_IER[31] PIO_IMR[31] PIO_IDR[31] 84 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.4.1 Pull-up Resistor Control Each I/O line is designed with an embedded pull-up resistor. The pull-up resistor can be enabled or disabled by writing respectively PIO_PUER (Pull-up Enable Register) and PIO_PUDR (Pullup Disable Resistor). Writing in these registers results in setting or clearing the corresponding bit in PIO_PUSR (Pull-up Status Register). Reading a 1 in PIO_PUSR means the pull-up is disabled and reading a 0 means the pull-up is enabled. Control of the pull-up resistor is possible regardless of the configuration of the I/O line. After reset, all of the pull-ups are enabled, i.e. PIO_PUSR resets at the value 0x0. 15.4.2 I/O Line or Peripheral Function Selection When a pin is multiplexed with one or two peripheral functions, the selection is controlled with the registers PIO_PER (PIO Enable Register) and PIO_PDR (PIO Disable Register). The register PIO_PSR (PIO Status Register) is the result of the set and clear registers and indicates whether the pin is controlled by the corresponding peripheral or by the PIO Controller. A value of 0 indicates that the pin is controlled by the corresponding on-chip peripheral selected in the PIO_ABSR (AB Select Status Register). A value of 1 indicates the pin is controlled by the PIO controller. If a pin is used as a general purpose I/O line (not multiplexed with an on-chip peripheral), PIO_PER and PIO_PDR have no effect and PIO_PSR returns 1 for the corresponding bit. After reset, most generally, the I/O lines are controlled by the PIO controller, i.e. PIO_PSR resets at 1. However, in some events, it is important that PIO lines are controlled by the peripheral (as in the case of memory chip select lines that must be driven inactive after reset or for address lines that must be driven low for booting out of an external memory). Thus, the reset value of PIO_PSR is defined at the product level, depending on the multiplexing of the device. 15.4.3 Peripheral A or B Selection The PIO Controller provides multiplexing of up to two peripheral functions on a single pin. The selection is performed by writing PIO_ASR (A Select Register) and PIO_BSR (Select B Register). PIO_ABSR (AB Select Status Register) indicates which peripheral line is currently selected. For each pin, the corresponding bit at level 0 means peripheral A is selected whereas the corresponding bit at level 1 indicates that peripheral B is selected. Note that multiplexing of peripheral lines A and B only affects the output line. The peripheral input lines are always connected to the pin input. After reset, PIO_ABSR is 0, thus indicating that all the PIO lines are configured on peripheral A. However, peripheral A generally does not drive the pin as the PIO Controller resets in I/O line mode. Writing in PIO_ASR and PIO_BSR manages PIO_ABSR regardless of the configuration of the pin. However, assignment of a pin to a peripheral function requires a write in the corresponding peripheral selection register (PIO_ASR or PIO_BSR) in addition to a write in PIO_PDR. 15.4.4 Output Control When the I/0 line is assigned to a peripheral function, i.e. the corresponding bit in PIO_PSR is at 0, the drive of the I/O line is controlled by the peripheral. Peripheral A or B, depending on the value in PIO_ABSR, determines whether the pin is driven or not. When the I/O line is controlled by the PIO controller, the pin can be configured to be driven. This is done by writing PIO_OER (Output Enable Register) and PIO_ODR (Output Disable Register). 85 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 The results of these write operations are detected in PIO_OSR (Output Status Register). When a bit in this register is at 0, the corresponding I/O line is used as an input only. When the bit is at 1, the corresponding I/O line is driven by the PIO controller. The level driven on an I/O line can be determined by writing in PIO_SODR (Set Output Data Register) and PIO_CODR (Clear Output Data Register). These write operations respectively set and clear PIO_ODSR (Output Data Status Register), which represents the data driven on the I/O lines. Writing in PIO_OER and PIO_ODR manages PIO_OSR whether the pin is configured to be controlled by the PIO controller or assigned to a peripheral function. This enables configuration of the I/O line prior to setting it to be managed by the PIO Controller. Similarly, writing in PIO_SODR and PIO_CODR effects PIO_ODSR. This is important as it defines the first level driven on the I/O line. 15.4.5 Synchronous Data Output Controlling all parallel busses using several PIOs requires two successive write operations in the PIO_SODR and PIO_CODR registers. This may lead to unexpected transient values. The PIO controller offers a direct control of PIO outputs by single write access to PIO_ODSR (Output Data Status Register). Only bits unmasked by PIO_OWSR (Output Write Status Register) are written. The masked bits in PIO_OWSR are set by writing to PIO_OWER (Output Write Enable Register) and cleared by writing to PIO_OWDR (Output Write Disable Register). After reset, the synchronous data output is disabled on all the I/O lines as PIO_OWSR resets at 0x0. 15.4.6 Multi Drive Control (Open Drain) Each I/O can be independently programmed in Open Drain by using the Multi Drive feature. This feature permits several drivers to be connected on the I/O line which is driven low only by each device. An external pull-up resistor (or enabling of the internal one) is generally required to guarantee a high level on the line. The Multi Drive feature is controlled by PIO_MDER (Multi-driver Enable Register) and PIO_MDDR (Multi-driver Disable Register). The Multi Drive can be selected whether the I/O line is controlled by the PIO controller or assigned to a peripheral function. PIO_MDSR (Multi-driver Status Register) indicates the pins that are configured to support external drivers. After reset, the Multi Drive feature is disabled on all pins, i.e. PIO_MDSR resets at value 0x0. 15.4.7 86 Output Line Timings Figure 15-4 shows how the outputs are driven either by writing PIO_SODR or PIO_CODR, or by directly writing PIO_ODSR. This last case is valid only if the corresponding bit in PIO_OWSR is set. Figure 15-4 also shows when the feedback in PIO_PDSR is available. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 15-4. Output Line Timings MCK Write PIO_SODR Write PIO_ODSR at 1 APB Access Write PIO_CODR Write PIO_ODSR at 0 APB Access PIO_ODSR 2 cycles 2 cycles PIO_PDSR 15.4.8 Inputs The level on each I/O line can be read through PIO_PDSR (Pin Data Status Register). This register indicates the level of the I/O lines regardless of their configuration, whether uniquely as an input or driven by the PIO controller or driven by a peripheral. Reading the I/O line levels requires the clock of the PIO controller to be enabled, otherwise PIO_PDSR reads the levels present on the I/O line at the time the clock was disabled. 15.4.9 Input Glitch Filtering Optional input glitch filters are independently programmable on each I/O line. When the glitch filter is enabled, a glitch with a duration of less than 1/2 Master Clock (MCK) cycle is automatically rejected, while a pulse with a duration of 1 Master Clock cycle or more is accepted. For pulse durations between 1/2 Master Clock cycle and 1 Master Clock cycle the pulse may or may not be taken into account, depending on the precise timing of its occurrence. Thus for a pulse to be visible it must exceed 1 Master Clock cycle, whereas for a glitch to be reliably filtered out, its duration must not exceed 1/2 Master Clock cycle. The filter introduces one Master Clock cycle latency if the pin level change occurs before a rising edge. However, this latency does not appear if the pin level change occurs before a falling edge. This is illustrated in Figure 15-5. The glitch filters are controlled by the register set; PIO_IFER (Input Filter Enable Register), PIO_IFDR (Input Filter Disable Register) and PIO_IFSR (Input Filter Status Register). Writing PIO_IFER and PIO_IFDR respectively sets and clears bits in PIO_IFSR. This last register enables the glitch filter on the I/O lines. When the glitch filter is enabled, it does not modify the behavior of the inputs on the peripherals. It acts only on the value read in PIO_PDSR and on the input change interrupt detection. The glitch filters require that the PIO Controller clock is enabled. 87 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 15-5. Input Glitch Filter Timing MCK up to 1.5 cycles Pin Level 1 cycle 1 cycle 1 cycle 1 cycle PIO_PDSR if PIO_IFSR = 0 2 cycles PIO_PDSR if PIO_IFSR = 1 15.4.10 up to 2.5 cycles 1 cycle up to 2 cycles Input Change Interrupt The PIO Controller can be programmed to generate an interrupt when it detects an input change on an I/O line. The Input Change Interrupt is controlled by writing PIO_IER (Interrupt Enable Register) and PIO_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register), which respectively enable and disable the input change interrupt by setting and clearing the corresponding bit in PIO_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register). As Input change detection is possible only by comparing two successive samplings of the input of the I/O line, the PIO Controller clock must be enabled. The Input Change Interrupt is available, regardless of the configuration of the I/O line, i.e. configured as an input only, controlled by the PIO Controller or assigned to a peripheral function. When an input change is detected on an I/O line, the corresponding bit in PIO_ISR (Interrupt Status Register) is set. If the corresponding bit in PIO_IMR is set, the PIO Controller interrupt line is asserted. The interrupt signals of the thirty-two channels are ORed-wired together to generate a single interrupt signal to the Advanced Interrupt Controller. When the software reads PIO_ISR, all the interrupts are automatically cleared. This signifies that all the interrupts that are pending when PIO_ISR is read must be handled. Figure 15-6. Input Change Interrupt Timings MCK Pin Level PIO_ISR Read PIO_ISR 88 APB Access APB Access AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.5 I/O Lines Programming Example The programing example as shown in Table 15-1 below is used to define the following configuration. • 4-bit output port on I/O lines 0 to 3, (should be written in a single write operation), open-drain, with pull-up resistor • Four output signals on I/O lines 4 to 7 (to drive LEDs for example), driven high and low, no pull-up resistor • Four input signals on I/O lines 8 to 11 (to read push-button states for example), with pull-up resistors, glitch filters and input change interrupts • Four input signals on I/O line 12 to 15 to read an external device status (polled, thus no input change interrupt), no pull-up resistor, no glitch filter • I/O lines 16 to 19 assigned to peripheral A functions with pull-up resistor • I/O lines 20 to 23 assigned to peripheral B functions, no pull-up resistor • I/O line 24 to 27 assigned to peripheral A with Input Change Interrupt and pull-up resistor Table 15-1. Programming Example Register Value to be Written PIO_PER 0x0000 FFFF PIO_PDR 0x0FFF 0000 PIO_OER 0x0000 00FF PIO_ODR 0x0FFF FF00 PIO_IFER 0x0000 0F00 PIO_IFDR 0x0FFF F0FF PIO_SODR 0x0000 0000 PIO_CODR 0x0FFF FFFF PIO_IER 0x0F00 0F00 PIO_IDR 0x00FF F0FF PIO_MDER 0x0000 000F PIO_MDDR 0x0FFF FFF0 PIO_PUDR 0x00F0 00F0 PIO_PUER 0x0F0F FF0F PIO_ASR 0x0F0F 0000 PIO_BSR 0x00F0 0000 PIO_OWER 0x0000 000F PIO_OWDR 0x0FFF FFF0 89 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6 Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) User Interface Each I/O line controlled by the PIO Controller is associated with a bit in each of the PIO Controller User Interface registers. Each register is 32 bits wide. If a parallel I/O line is not defined, writing to the corresponding bits has no effect. Undefined bits read zero. If the I/O line is not multiplexed with any peripheral, the I/O line is controlled by the PIO Controller and PIO_PSR returns 1 systematically. Table 15-2. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x0000 PIO Enable Register PIO_PER Write-only – 0x0004 PIO Disable Register PIO_PDR Write-only – PIO_PSR Read-only (1) 0x0008 PIO Status Register 0x000C Reserved 0x0010 Output Enable Register PIO_OER Write-only – 0x0014 Output Disable Register PIO_ODR Write-only – 0x0018 Output Status Register PIO_OSR Read-only 0x0000 0000 0x001C Reserved 0x0020 Glitch Input Filter Enable Register PIO_IFER Write-only – 0x0024 Glitch Input Filter Disable Register PIO_IFDR Write-only – 0x0028 Glitch Input Filter Status Register PIO_IFSR Read-only 0x0000 0000 0x002C Reserved 0x0030 Set Output Data Register PIO_SODR Write-only – 0x0034 Clear Output Data Register PIO_CODR Write-only 0x0038 Output Data Status Register PIO_ODSR Read-only or(2) Read-write 0x003C Pin Data Status Register PIO_PDSR Read-only (3) 0x0040 Interrupt Enable Register PIO_IER Write-only – 0x0044 Interrupt Disable Register PIO_IDR Write-only – 0x0048 Interrupt Mask Register PIO_IMR Read-only 0x00000000 0x004C Interrupt Status Register(4) PIO_ISR Read-only 0x00000000 0x0050 Multi-driver Enable Register PIO_MDER Write-only – 0x0054 Multi-driver Disable Register PIO_MDDR Write-only – 0x0058 Multi-driver Status Register PIO_MDSR Read-only 0x00000000 0x005C Reserved 0x0060 Pull-up Disable Register PIO_PUDR Write-only – 0x0064 Pull-up Enable Register PIO_PUER Write-only – 0x0068 Pad Pull-up Status Register PIO_PUSR Read-only 0x00000000 0x006C Reserved 90 – AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 15-2. Register Mapping (Continued) Offset Register 0x0070 0x0074 Name Peripheral A Select Register (5) Peripheral B Select Register (5) (5) Access Reset PIO_ASR Write-only – PIO_BSR Write-only – PIO_ABSR Read-only 0x00000000 0x0078 AB Status Register 0x007C to 0x009C Reserved 0x00A0 Output Write Enable PIO_OWER Write-only – 0x00A4 Output Write Disable PIO_OWDR Write-only – 0x00A8 Output Write Status Register PIO_OWSR Read-only 0x00000000 0x00AC Reserved Notes: 1. Reset value of PIO_PSR depends on the product implementation. 2. PIO_ODSR is Read-only or Read/Write depending on PIO_OWSR I/O lines. 3. Reset value of PIO_PDSR depends on the level of the I/O lines. Reading the I/O line levels requires the clock of the PIO Controller to be enabled, otherwise PIO_PDSR reads the levels present on the I/O line at the time the clock was disabled. 4. PIO_ISR is reset at 0x0. However, the first read of the register may read a different value as input changes may have occurred. 5. Only this set of registers clears the status by writing 1 in the first register and sets the status by writing 1 in the second register. 91 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.1 Name: PIO Controller PIO Enable Register PIO_PER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: PIO Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the PIO to control the corresponding pin (disables peripheral control of the pin). 15.6.2 Name: PIO Controller PIO Disable Register PIO_PDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: PIO Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the PIO from controlling the corresponding pin (enables peripheral control of the pin). 92 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.3 Name: PIO Controller PIO Status Register PIO_PSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: PIO Status 0 = PIO is inactive on the corresponding I/O line (peripheral is active). 1 = PIO is active on the corresponding I/O line (peripheral is inactive). 15.6.4 Name: PIO Controller Output Enable Register PIO_OER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the output on the I/O line. 93 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.5 Name: PIO Controller Output Disable Register PIO_ODR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the output on the I/O line. 15.6.6 Name: PIO Controller Output Status Register PIO_OSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Status 0 = The I/O line is a pure input. 1 = The I/O line is enabled in output. 94 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.7 Name: PIO Controller Input Filter Enable Register PIO_IFER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Filter Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the input glitch filter on the I/O line. 15.6.8 Name: PIO Controller Input Filter Disable Register PIO_IFDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Filter Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the input glitch filter on the I/O line. 95 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.9 Name: PIO Controller Input Filter Status Register PIO_IFSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Filer Status 0 = The input glitch filter is disabled on the I/O line. 1 = The input glitch filter is enabled on the I/O line. 15.6.10 Name: PIO Controller Set Output Data Register PIO_SODR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Set Output Data 0 = No effect. 1 = Sets the data to be driven on the I/O line. 96 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.11 Name: PIO Controller Clear Output Data Register PIO_CODR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Set Output Data 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears the data to be driven on the I/O line. 15.6.12 Name: PIO Controller Output Data Status Register PIO_ODSR Access Type: Read-only or Read/Write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Data Status 0 = The data to be driven on the I/O line is 0. 1 = The data to be driven on the I/O line is 1. 97 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.13 Name: PIO Controller Pin Data Status Register PIO_PDSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Data Status 0 = The I/O line is at level 0. 1 = The I/O line is at level 1. 15.6.14 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Enable Register PIO_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Input Change Interrupt on the I/O line. 98 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.15 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Disable Register PIO_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Input Change Interrupt on the I/O line. 15.6.16 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Mask Register PIO_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Mask 0 = Input Change Interrupt is disabled on the I/O line. 1 = Input Change Interrupt is enabled on the I/O line. 99 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.17 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Status Register PIO_ISR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Status 0 = No Input Change has been detected on the I/O line since PIO_ISR was last read or since reset. 1 = At least one Input Change has been detected on the I/O line since PIO_ISR was last read or since reset. 15.6.18 Name: PIO Multi-driver Enable Register PIO_MDER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Multi Drive Enable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables Multi Drive on the I/O line. 100 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.19 Name: PIO Multi-driver Disable Register PIO_MDDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Multi Drive Disable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables Multi Drive on the I/O line. 15.6.20 Name: PIO Multi-driver Status Register PIO_MDSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Multi Drive Status. 0 = The Multi Drive is disabled on the I/O line. The pin is driven at high and low level. 1 = The Multi Drive is enabled on the I/O line. The pin is driven at low level only. 101 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.21 Name: PIO Pull Up Disable Register PIO_PUDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Pull Up Disable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the pull up resistor on the I/O line. 15.6.22 Name: PIO Pull Up Enable Register PIO_PUER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Pull Up Enable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the pull up resistor on the I/O line. 102 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.23 Name: PIO Pull Up Status Register PIO_PUSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Pull Up Status. 0 = Pull Up resistor is enabled on the I/O line. 1 = Pull Up resistor is disabled on the I/O line. 15.6.24 Name: PIO Peripheral A Select Register PIO_ASR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Peripheral A Select. 0 = No effect. 1 = Assigns the I/O line to the Peripheral A function. 103 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.25 Name: PIO Peripheral B Select Register PIO_BSR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Peripheral B Select. 0 = No effect. 1 = Assigns the I/O line to the peripheral B function. 15.6.26 Name: PIO Peripheral A B Status Register PIO_ABSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Peripheral A B Status. 0 = The I/O line is assigned to the Peripheral A. 1 = The I/O line is assigned to the Peripheral B. 104 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 15.6.27 Name: PIO Output Write Enable Register PIO_OWER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Write Enable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables writing PIO_ODSR for the I/O line. 15.6.28 Name: PIO Output Write Disable Register PIO_OWDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Write Disable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables writing PIO_ODSR for the I/O line. 105 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 15.6.29 Name: PIO Output Write Status Register PIO_OWSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 P31 P30 P29 P28 P27 P26 P25 P24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 P23 P22 P21 P20 P19 P18 P17 P16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 P9 P8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0 • P0-P31: Output Write Status. 0 = Writing PIO_ODSR does not affect the I/O line. 1 = Writing PIO_ODSR affects the I/O line. 106 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 16. Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) 16.1 Overview The Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) provides the operating system’s scheduler interrupt. It is designed to offer maximum accuracy and efficient management, even for systems with long response time. 16.2 Block Diagram Figure 16-1. Periodic Interval Timer PIT_MR PIV =? PIT_MR PITIEN set 0 PIT_SR PITS pit_irq reset 0 MCK Prescaler 0 0 1 12-bit Adder 1 read PIT_PIVR 20-bit Counter MCK/16 CPIV PIT_PIVR CPIV PIT_PIIR PICNT PICNT 107 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 16.3 Functional Description The Periodic Interval Timer aims at providing periodic interrupts for use by operating systems. The PIT provides a programmable overflow counter and a reset-on-read feature. It is built around two counters: a 20-bit CPIV counter and a 12-bit PICNT counter. Both counters work at Master Clock /16. The first 20-bit CPIV counter increments from 0 up to a programmable overflow value set in the field PIV of the Mode Register (PIT_MR). When the counter CPIV reaches this value, it resets to 0 and increments the Periodic Interval Counter, PICNT. The status bit PITS in the Status Register (PIT_SR) rises and triggers an interrupt, provided the interrupt is enabled (PITIEN in PIT_MR). Writing a new PIV value in PIT_MR does not reset/restart the counters. When CPIV and PICNT values are obtained by reading the Periodic Interval Value Register (PIT_PIVR), the overflow counter (PICNT) is reset and the PITS is cleared, thus acknowledging the interrupt. The value of PICNT gives the number of periodic intervals elapsed since the last read of PIT_PIVR. When CPIV and PICNT values are obtained by reading the Periodic Interval Image Register (PIT_PIIR), there is no effect on the counters CPIV and PICNT, nor on the bit PITS. For example, a profiler can read PIT_PIIR without clearing any pending interrupt, whereas a timer interrupt clears the interrupt by reading PIT_PIVR. The PIT may be enabled/disabled using the PITEN bit in the PIT_MR register (disabled on reset). The PITEN bit only becomes effective when the CPIV value is 0. Figure 16-2 illustrates the PIT counting. After the PIT Enable bit is reset (PITEN= 0), the CPIV goes on counting until the PIV value is reached, and is then reset. PIT restarts counting, only if the PITEN is set again. The PIT is stopped when the core enters debug state. 108 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 16-2. Enabling/Disabling PIT with PITEN APB cycle APB cycle MCK 15 restarts MCK Prescaler MCK Prescaler 0 PITEN CPIV PICNT 0 1 PIV - 1 0 PIV 1 0 1 0 PITS (PIT_SR) APB Interface read PIT_PIVR 109 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 16.4 Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) User Interface Table 16-1. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Mode Register PIT_MR Read-write 0x000F_FFFF 0x04 Status Register PIT_SR Read-only 0x0000_0000 0x08 Periodic Interval Value Register PIT_PIVR Read-only 0x0000_0000 0x0C Periodic Interval Image Register PIT_PIIR Read-only 0x0000_0000 110 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 16.4.1 Periodic Interval Timer Mode Register Register Name: PIT_MR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 PITIEN 24 PITEN 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 PIV PIV 7 6 5 4 PIV • PIV: Periodic Interval Value Defines the value compared with the primary 20-bit counter of the Periodic Interval Timer (CPIV). The period is equal to (PIV + 1). • PITEN: Period Interval Timer Enabled 0 = The Periodic Interval Timer is disabled when the PIV value is reached. 1 = The Periodic Interval Timer is enabled. • PITIEN: Periodic Interval Timer Interrupt Enable 0 = The bit PITS in PIT_SR has no effect on interrupt. 1 = The bit PITS in PIT_SR asserts interrupt. 16.4.2 Periodic Interval Timer Status Register Register Name: PIT_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 – 0 PITS • PITS: Periodic Interval Timer Status 0 = The Periodic Interval timer has not reached PIV since the last read of PIT_PIVR. 1 = The Periodic Interval timer has reached PIV since the last read of PIT_PIVR. 111 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 16.4.3 Periodic Interval Timer Value Register Register Name: PIT_PIVR Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 PICNT 23 22 21 20 PICNT 15 14 CPIV 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 25 24 17 16 CPIV 7 6 5 4 CPIV Reading this register clears PITS in PIT_SR. • CPIV: Current Periodic Interval Value Returns the current value of the periodic interval timer. • PICNT: Periodic Interval Counter Returns the number of occurrences of periodic intervals since the last read of PIT_PIVR. 16.4.4 Periodic Interval Timer Image Register Register Name: PIT_PIIR Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 28 27 26 19 18 PICNT 23 22 21 20 PICNT 15 14 CPIV 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CPIV 7 6 5 4 CPIV • CPIV: Current Periodic Interval Value Returns the current value of the periodic interval timer. • PICNT: Periodic Interval Counter Returns the number of occurrences of periodic intervals since the last read of PIT_PIVR. 112 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 17. Watchdog Timer (WDT) 17.1 Overview The Watchdog Timer can be used to prevent system lock-up if the software becomes trapped in a deadlock. It features a 12-bit down counter that allows a watchdog period of up to 16 seconds (slow clock at 32.768 kHz). It can generate a general reset or a processor reset only. In addition, it can be stopped while the processor is in debug mode or idle mode. 17.2 Block Diagram Figure 17-1. Watchdog Timer Block Diagram write WDT_MR WDT_MR WDV WDT_CR WDRSTT reload 1 0 12-bit Down Counter WDT_MR WDD reload Current Value 1/128 SLCK <= WDD WDT_MR WDRSTEN = 0 wdt_fault (to Reset Controller) set set read WDT_SR or reset WDERR reset WDUNF reset wdt_int WDFIEN WDT_MR 113 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 17.3 Functional Description The Watchdog Timer can be used to prevent system lock-up if the software becomes trapped in a deadlock. It is supplied with VDDCORE. It restarts with initial values on processor reset. The Watchdog is built around a 12-bit down counter, which is loaded with the value defined in the field WV of the Mode Register (WDT_MR). The Watchdog Timer uses the Slow Clock divided by 128 to establish the maximum Watchdog period to be 16 seconds (with a typical Slow Clock of 32.768 kHz). After a Processor Reset, the value of WV is 0xFFF, corresponding to the maximum value of the counter with the external reset generation enabled (field WDRSTEN at 1 after a Backup Reset). This means that a default Watchdog is running at reset, i.e., at power-up. The user must either disable it (by setting the WDDIS bit in WDT_MR) if he does not expect to use it or must reprogram it to meet the maximum Watchdog period the application requires. The Watchdog Mode Register (WDT_MR) can be written only once. Only a processor reset resets it. Writing the WDT_MR register reloads the timer with the newly programmed mode parameters. In normal operation, the user reloads the Watchdog at regular intervals before the timer underflow occurs, by writing the Control Register (WDT_CR) with the bit WDRSTT to 1. The Watchdog counter is then immediately reloaded from WDT_MR and restarted, and the Slow Clock 128 divider is reset and restarted. The WDT_CR register is write-protected. As a result, writing WDT_CR without the correct hard-coded key has no effect. If an underflow does occur, the “wdt_fault” signal to the Reset Controller is asserted if the bit WDRSTEN is set in the Mode Register (WDT_MR). Moreover, the bit WDUNF is set in the Watchdog Status Register (WDT_SR). To prevent a software deadlock that continuously triggers the Watchdog, the reload of the Watchdog must occur while the Watchdog counter is within a window between 0 and WDD, WDD is defined in the WatchDog Mode Register WDT_MR. Any attempt to restart the Watchdog while the Watchdog counter is between WDV and WDD results in a Watchdog error, even if the Watchdog is disabled. The bit WDERR is updated in the WDT_SR and the “wdt_fault” signal to the Reset Controller is asserted. Note that this feature can be disabled by programming a WDD value greater than or equal to the WDV value. In such a configuration, restarting the Watchdog Timer is permitted in the whole range [0; WDV] and does not generate an error. This is the default configuration on reset (the WDD and WDV values are equal). The status bits WDUNF (Watchdog Underflow) and WDERR (Watchdog Error) trigger an interrupt, provided the bit WDFIEN is set in the mode register. The signal “wdt_fault” to the reset controller causes a Watchdog reset if the WDRSTEN bit is set as already explained in the reset controller programmer Datasheet. In that case, the processor and the Watchdog Timer are reset, and the WDERR and WDUNF flags are reset. If a reset is generated or if WDT_SR is read, the status bits are reset, the interrupt is cleared, and the “wdt_fault” signal to the reset controller is deasserted. Writing the WDT_MR reloads and restarts the down counter. While the processor is in debug state or in idle mode, the counter may be stopped depending on the value programmed for the bits WDIDLEHLT and WDDBGHLT in the WDT_MR. 114 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 17-2. Watchdog Behavior Watchdog Error Watchdog Underflow if WDRSTEN is 1 FFF Normal behavior if WDRSTEN is 0 WDV Forbidden Window WDD Permitted Window 0 Watchdog Fault WDT_CR = WDRSTT 115 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 17.4 Watchdog Timer (WDT) User Interface Table 17-1. Offset Register Mapping Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Control Register WDT_CR Write-only - 0x04 Mode Register WDT_MR Read/Write Once 0x3FFF_2FFF 0x08 Status Register WDT_SR Read-only 0x0000_0000 17.4.1 Watchdog Timer Control Register Register Name: WDT_CR Access Type: 31 Write-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 KEY 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 – 0 WDRSTT • WDRSTT: Watchdog Restart 0: No effect. 1: Restarts the Watchdog. • KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation. 116 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 17.4.2 Watchdog Timer Mode Register Register Name: WDT_MR Access Type: Read/Write Once 31 – 30 – 29 WDIDLEHLT 28 WDDBGHLT 27 26 23 22 21 20 19 18 11 10 25 24 17 16 9 8 1 0 WDD WDD 15 WDDIS 14 13 12 WDRPROC WDRSTEN WDFIEN 7 6 5 4 WDV 3 2 WDV • WDV: Watchdog Counter Value Defines the value loaded in the 12-bit Watchdog Counter. • WDFIEN: Watchdog Fault Interrupt Enable 0: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) has no effect on interrupt. 1: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) asserts interrupt. • WDRSTEN: Watchdog Reset Enable 0: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) has no effect on the resets. 1: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) triggers a Watchdog reset. • WDRPROC: Watchdog Reset Processor 0: If WDRSTEN is 1, a Watchdog fault (underflow or error) activates all resets. 1: If WDRSTEN is 1, a Watchdog fault (underflow or error) activates the processor reset. • WDD: Watchdog Delta Value Defines the permitted range for reloading the Watchdog Timer. If the Watchdog Timer value is less than or equal to WDD, writing WDT_CR with WDRSTT = 1 restarts the timer. If the Watchdog Timer value is greater than WDD, writing WDT_CR with WDRSTT = 1 causes a Watchdog error. • WDDBGHLT: Watchdog Debug Halt 0: The Watchdog runs when the processor is in debug state. 1: The Watchdog stops when the processor is in debug state. • WDIDLEHLT: Watchdog Idle Halt 0: The Watchdog runs when the system is in idle mode. 1: The Watchdog stops when the system is in idle state. • WDDIS: Watchdog Disable 0: Enables the Watchdog Timer. 1: Disables the Watchdog Timer. 117 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 17.4.3 Watchdog Timer Status Register Register Name: WDT_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 WDERR 0 WDUNF • WDUNF: Watchdog Underflow 0: No Watchdog underflow occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. 1: At least one Watchdog underflow occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. • WDERR: Watchdog Error 0: No Watchdog error occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. 1: At least one Watchdog error occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. 118 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 18. Voltage Regulator Mode Controller (VREG) 18.1 Overview The Voltage Regulator Mode Controller contains one Read/Write register, the Voltage Regulator Mode Register. Its offset is 0x60 with respect to the System Controller offset. This register controls the Voltage Regulator Mode. Setting PSTDBY (bit 0) puts the Voltage Regulator in Standby Mode or Low-power Mode. On reset, the PSTDBY is reset, so as to wake up the Voltage Regulator in Normal Mode. 119 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 18.2 Voltage Regulator Power Controller (VREG) User Interface Table 18-1. Register Mapping Offset Register Name 0x60 Voltage Regulator Mode Register VREG_MR Access Reset Read/Write 0x0 18.2.1 Voltage Regulator Mode Register Register Name: VREG_MR Access Type: Read/Write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 – 0 PSTDBY • PSTDBY: Periodic Interval Value 0 = Voltage regulator in normal mode. 1 = Voltage regulator in standby mode (low-power mode). 120 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 19. Memory Controller (MC) 19.1 Overview The Memory Controller (MC) manages the ASB bus and controls accesses requested by the masters, typically the ARM7TDMI processor and the Peripheral DMA Controller. It features a bus arbiter, an address decoder, an abort status, a misalignment detector and an Embedded Flash Controller. 19.2 Block Diagram Figure 19-1. Memory Controller Block Diagram Memory Controller ASB ARM7TDMI Processor Embedded Flash Controller Abort Internal Flash Abort Status Internal RAM EMAC DMA Bus Arbiter Misalignment Detector Address Decoder User Interface Peripheral DMA Controller APB Bridge Peripheral 0 Peripheral 1 APB From Master to Slave Peripheral N 121 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 19.3 Functional Description The Memory Controller handles the internal ASB bus and arbitrates the accesses of up to three masters. It is made up of: • A bus arbiter • An address decoder • An abort status • A misalignment detector • An Embedded Flash Controller The MC handles only little-endian mode accesses. The masters work in little-endian mode only. 19.3.1 Bus Arbiter The Memory Controller has a simple, hard-wired priority bus arbiter that gives the control of the bus to one of the three masters. The EMAC has the highest priority; the Peripheral DMA Controller has the medium priority; the ARM processor has the lowest one. 19.3.2 Address Decoder The Memory Controller features an Address Decoder that first decodes the four highest bits of the 32-bit address bus and defines three separate areas: • One 256-Mbyte address space for the internal memories • One 256-Mbyte address space reserved for the embedded peripherals • An undefined address space of 3584M bytes representing fourteen 256-Mbyte areas that return an Abort if accessed Figure 19-2 shows the assignment of the 256-Mbyte memory areas. Figure 19-2. Memory Areas 256M Bytes 0x0000 0000 Internal Memories 0x0FFF FFFF 0x1000 0000 14 x 256MBytes 3,584 Mbytes Undefined (Abort) 0xEFFF FFFF 256M Bytes 0xF000 0000 Peripherals 0xFFFF FFFF 122 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 19.3.2.1 Internal Memory Mapping Within the Internal Memory address space, the Address Decoder of the Memory Controller decodes eight more address bits to allocate 1-Mbyte address spaces for the embedded memories. The allocated memories are accessed all along the 1-Mbyte address space and so are repeated n times within this address space, n equaling 1M bytes divided by the size of the memory. When the address of the access is undefined within the internal memory area, the Address Decoder returns an Abort to the master. Figure 19-3. Internal Memory Mapping 0x0000 0000 Internal Memory Area 0 1 M Bytes 0x000F FFFF 0x0010 0000 0x001F FFFF 0x0020 0000 256M Bytes 0x002F FFFF 0x0030 0000 0x003F FFFF 0x0040 0000 Internal Memory Area 1 Internal Flash 1 M Bytes Internal Memory Area 2 Internal SRAM 1 M Bytes Internal Memory Area 3 Internal ROM 1 M Bytes Undefined Areas (Abort) 252 M Bytes 0x0FFF FFFF 19.3.2.2 Internal Memory Area 0 The first 32 bytes of Internal Memory Area 0 contain the ARM processor exception vectors, in particular, the Reset Vector at address 0x0. Before execution of the remap command, the on-chip Flash is mapped into Internal Memory Area 0, so that the ARM7TDMI reaches an executable instruction contained in Flash. After the remap command, the internal SRAM at address 0x0020 0000 is mapped into Internal Memory Area 0. The memory mapped into Internal Memory Area 0 is accessible in both its original location and at address 0x0. 19.3.3 Remap Command After execution, the Remap Command causes the Internal SRAM to be accessed through the Internal Memory Area 0. As the ARM vectors (Reset, Abort, Data Abort, Prefetch Abort, Undefined Instruction, Interrupt, and Fast Interrupt) are mapped from address 0x0 to address 0x20, the Remap Command allows the user to redefine dynamically these vectors under software control. The Remap Command is accessible through the Memory Controller User Interface by writing the MC_RCR (Remap Control Register) RCB field to one. The Remap Command can be cancelled by writing the MC_RCR RCB field to one, which acts as a toggling command. This allows easy debug of the user-defined boot sequence by offering a simple way to put the chip in the same configuration as after a reset. 123 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 19.3.4 Abort Status There are two reasons for an abort to occur: • access to an undefined address • an access to a misaligned address. When an abort occurs, a signal is sent back to all the masters, regardless of which one has generated the access. However, only the ARM7TDMI can take an abort signal into account, and only under the condition that it was generating an access. The Peripheral DMA Controller and the EMAC do not handle the abort input signal. Note that the connections are not represented in Figure 19-1. To facilitate debug or for fault analysis by an operating system, the Memory Controller integrates an Abort Status register set. The full 32-bit wide abort address is saved in MC_AASR. Parameters of the access are saved in MC_ASR and include: • the size of the request (field ABTSZ) • the type of the access, whether it is a data read or write, or a code fetch (field ABTTYP) • whether the access is due to accessing an undefined address (bit UNDADD) or a misaligned address (bit MISADD) • the source of the access leading to the last abort (bits MST_EMAC, MST_PDC and MST_ARM) • whether or not an abort occurred for each master since the last read of the register (bits SVMST_EMAC, SVMST_PDC and SVMST_ARM) unless this information is loaded in MST bits In the case of a Data Abort from the processor, the address of the data access is stored. This is useful, as searching for which address generated the abort would require disassembling the instructions and full knowledge of the processor context. In the case of a Prefetch Abort, the address may have changed, as the prefetch abort is pipelined in the ARM processor. The ARM processor takes the prefetch abort into account only if the read instruction is executed and it is probable that several aborts have occurred during this time. Thus, in this case, it is preferable to use the content of the Abort Link register of the ARM processor. 19.3.5 Embedded Flash Controller The Embedded Flash Controller is added to the Memory Controller and ensures the interface of the flash block with the 32-bit internal bus. It allows an increase of performance in Thumb Mode for Code Fetch with its system of 32-bit buffers. It also manages with the programming, erasing, locking and unlocking sequences thanks to a full set of commands. 19.3.6 Misalignment Detector The Memory Controller features a Misalignment Detector that checks the consistency of the accesses. For each access, regardless of the master, the size of the access and the bits 0 and 1 of the address bus are checked. If the type of access is a word (32-bit) and the bits 0 and 1 are not 0, or if the type of the access is a half-word (16-bit) and the bit 0 is not 0, an abort is returned to the master and the access is cancelled. Note that the accesses of the ARM processor when it is fetching instructions are not checked. 124 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The misalignments are generally due to software bugs leading to wrong pointer handling. These bugs are particularly difficult to detect in the debug phase. As the requested address is saved in the Abort Status Register and the address of the instruction generating the misalignment is saved in the Abort Link Register of the processor, detection and fix of this kind of software bugs is simplified. 125 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 19.4 Memory Controller (MC) User Interface Base Address: 0xFFFFFF00 Table 19-1. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access 0x00 MC Remap Control Register MC_RCR Write-only 0x04 MC Abort Status Register MC_ASR Read-only 0x0 0x08 MC Abort Address Status Register MC_AASR Read-only 0x0 0x10-0x5C Reserved 0x60 EFC0 Configuration Registers 0x70 EFC1(1) Configuration Registers Note: 126 Reset See the Embedded Flash Controller Section 1. EFC1 pertains to AT91SAM7XC512 only. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 19.4.1 MC Remap Control Register Register Name: MC_RCR Access Type: Write-only Offset: 0x0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – RCB • RCB: Remap Command Bit 0: No effect. 1: This Command Bit acts on a toggle basis: writing a 1 alternatively cancels and restores the remapping of the page zero memory devices. 127 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 19.4.2 MC Abort Status Register Register Name: MC_ASR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0x0 Offset: 0x04 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – SVMST_ARM SVMST_PDC SVMST_EMAC 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – MST_ARM MST_PDC MST_EMAC 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – MISADD UNDADD ABTTYP 8 ABTSZ • UNDADD: Undefined Address Abort Status 0: The last abort was not due to the access of an undefined address in the address space. 1: The last abort was due to the access of an undefined address in the address space. • MISADD: Misaligned Address Abort Status 0: The last aborted access was not due to an address misalignment. 1: The last aborted access was due to an address misalignment. • ABTSZ: Abort Size Status ABTSZ Abort Size 0 0 Byte 0 1 Half-word 1 0 Word 1 1 Reserved • ABTTYP: Abort Type Status ABTTYP Abort Type 0 0 Data Read 0 1 Data Write 1 0 Code Fetch 1 1 Reserved • MST_EMAC: EMAC Abort Source 0: The last aborted access was not due to the EMAC. 1: The last aborted access was due to the EMAC. 128 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • MST_PDC: PDC Abort Source 0: The last aborted access was not due to the PDC. 1: The last aborted access was due to the PDC. • MST_ARM: ARM Abort Source 0: The last aborted access was not due to the ARM. 1: The last aborted access was due to the ARM. • SVMST_EMAC: Saved EMAC Abort Source 0: No abort due to the EMAC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR or it is notified in the bit MST_EMAC. 1: At least one abort due to the EMAC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR. • SVMST_PDC: Saved PDC Abort Source 0: No abort due to the PDC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR or it is notified in the bit MST_PDC. 1: At least one abort due to the PDC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR. • SVMST_ARM: Saved ARM Abort Source 0: No abort due to the ARM occurred since the last read of MC_ASR or it is notified in the bit MST_ARM. 1: At least one abort due to the ARM occurred since the last read of MC_ASR. 129 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 19.4.3 MC Abort Address Status Register Register Name: MC_AASR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0x0 Offset: 0x08 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ABTADD 23 22 21 20 ABTADD 15 14 13 12 ABTADD 7 6 5 4 ABTADD • ABTADD: Abort Address This field contains the address of the last aborted access. 130 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 20. Embedded Flash Controller (EFC) 20.1 Overview The Embedded Flash Controller (EFC ) is a part of the Memory Controller and ensures the interface of the Flash block with the 32-bit internal bus. It increases performance in Thumb Mode for Code Fetch with its system of 32-bit buffers. It also manages the programming, erasing, locking and unlocking sequences using a full set of commands. The AT91SAM7XC512 is equipped with two EFCs, EFC0 and EFC1. EFC1 does not feature the Security bit and GPNVM bits. The Security and GPNVM bits embedded only on EFC0 apply to the two blocks in the AT91SAM7XC512. 20.2 20.2.1 Functional Description Embedded Flash Organization The Embedded Flash interfaces directly to the 32-bit internal bus. It is composed of several interfaces: • One memory plane organized in several pages of the same size • Two 32-bit read buffers used for code read optimization (see “Read Operations” on page 132). • One write buffer that manages page programming. The write buffer size is equal to the page size. This buffer is write-only and accessible all along the 1 MByte address space, so that each word can be written to its final address (see “Write Operations” on page 134). • Several lock bits used to protect write and erase operations on lock regions. A lock region is composed of several consecutive pages, and each lock region has its associated lock bit. • Several general-purpose NVM bits. Each bit controls a specific feature in the device. Refer to the product definition section to get the GPNVM assignment. The Embedded Flash size, the page size and the lock region organization are described in the product definition section. Table 20-1. Product Specific Lock and General-purpose NVM Bits AT91SAM7XC512 AT91SAM7XC256 AT91SAM7XC128 Denomination 3 3 3 Number of General-purpose NVM bits 32 16 8 Number of Lock Bits 131 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 20-1. Embedded Flash Memory Mapping Page 0 Flash Memory Start Address Lock Region 0 Lock Bit 0 Lock Region 1 Lock Bit 1 Lock Region (n-1) Lock Bit n-1 Page (m-1) Page ( (n-1)*m ) 32-bit wide Page (n*m-1) 20.2.2 Read Operations An optimized controller manages embedded Flash reads. A system of 2 x 32-bit buffers is added in order to start access at following address during the second read, thus increasing performance when the processor is running in Thumb mode (16-bit instruction set). See Figure 20-2, Figure 20-3 and Figure 20-4. This optimization concerns only Code Fetch and not Data. The read operations can be performed with or without wait state. Up to 3 wait states can be programmed in the field FWS (Flash Wait State) in the Flash Mode Register MC_FMR (see “MC Flash Mode Register” on page 142). Defining FWS to be 0 enables the single-cycle access of the embedded Flash. The Flash memory is accessible through 8-, 16- and 32-bit reads. As the Flash block size is smaller than the address space reserved for the internal memory area, the embedded Flash wraps around the address space and appears to be repeated within it. 132 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 20-2. Code Read Optimization in Thumb Mode for FWS = 0 Master Clock ARM Request (16-bit) Code Fetch @Byte 0 Flash Access @Byte 2 @Byte 4 Bytes 0-3 Bytes 4-7 Buffer (32 bits) Bytes 0-1 @Byte 10 @Byte 8 Bytes 4-7 Bytes 2-3 Bytes 4-5 @Byte 12 Bytes 8-9 @Byte 16 Bytes 16-19 Bytes 12-15 Bytes 8-11 Bytes 6-7 @Byte 14 Bytes 12-15 Bytes 8-11 Bytes 0-3 Data To ARM Note: @Byte 6 Bytes 10-11 Bytes 12-13 Bytes 14-15 When FWS is equal to 0, all accesses are performed in a single-cycle access. Figure 20-3. Code Read Optimization in Thumb Mode for FWS = 1 1 Wait State Cycle 1 Wait State Cycle 1 Wait State Cycle 1 Wait State Cycle Master Clock ARM Request (16-bit) Code Fetch @Byte 0 Flash Access @Byte 2 Bytes 0-3 Buffer (32 bits) Data To ARM Note: Bytes 0-1 @Byte 4 @Byte 6 @Byte 8 @Byte 10 @Byte 12 @Byte 14 Bytes 4-7 Bytes 8-11 Bytes 12-15 Bytes 0-3 Bytes 4-7 Bytes 8-11 Bytes 2-3 Bytes 4-5 Bytes 6-7 Bytes 8-9 Bytes 10-11 Bytes 12-13 When FWS is equal to 1, in case of sequential reads, all the accesses are performed in a single-cycle access (except for the first one). 133 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 20-4. Code Read Optimization in Thumb Mode for FWS = 3 3 Wait State Cycles 3 Wait State Cycles 3 Wait State Cycles 3 Wait State Cycles Master Clock ARM Request (16-bit) Code Fetch @2 @Byte 0 Flash Access Bytes 0-3 Buffer (32 bits) Data To ARM Note: 20.2.3 0-1 @6 @4 @10 @8 @12 Bytes 4-7 Bytes 8-11 Bytes 12-15 Bytes 0-3 Bytes 4-7 Bytes 8-11 2-3 4-5 8-9 10-11 6-7 12-13 When FWS is equal to 2 or 3, in case of sequential reads, the first access takes FWS cycles, the second access one cycle, the third access FWS cycles, the fourth access one cycle, etc. Write Operations The internal memory area reserved for the embedded Flash can also be written through a writeonly latch buffer. Write operations take into account only the 8 lowest address bits and thus wrap around within the internal memory area address space and appear to be repeated 1024 times within it. Write operations can be prevented by programming the Memory Protection Unit of the product. Writing 8-bit and 16-bit data is not allowed and may lead to unpredictable data corruption. Write operations are performed in the number of wait states equal to the number of wait states for read operations + 1, except for FWS = 3 (see “MC Flash Mode Register” on page 142). 20.2.4 Flash Commands The EFC offers a command set to manage programming the memory flash, locking and unlocking lock sectors, consecutive programming and locking, and full Flash erasing. Table 20-2. 134 Set of Commands Command Value Mnemonic Write page 0x01 WP Set Lock Bit 0x02 SLB Write Page and Lock 0x03 WPL Clear Lock Bit 0x04 CLB Erase all 0x08 EA Set General-purpose NVM Bit 0x0B SGPB Clear General-purpose NVM Bit 0x0D CGPB Set Security Bit 0x0F SSB AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary To run one of these commands, the field FCMD of the MC_FCR register has to be written with the command number. As soon as the MC_FCR register is written, the FRDY flag is automatically cleared. Once the current command is achieved, then the FRDY flag is automatically set. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. All the commands are protected by the same keyword, which has to be written in the eight highest bits of the MC_FCR register. Writing MC_FCR with data that does not contain the correct key and/or with an invalid command has no effect on the memory plane; however, the PROGE flag is set in the MC_FSR register. This flag is automatically cleared by a read access to the MC_FSR register. When the current command writes or erases a page in a locked region, the command has no effect on the whole memory plane; however, the LOCKE flag is set in the MC_FSR register. This flag is automatically cleared by a read access to the MC_FSR register. 135 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 20-5. Command State Chart Read Status: MC_FSR No Check if FRDY flag set Yes Write FCMD and PAGENB in MC_FCR Read Status: MC_FSR No Check if FRDY flag set Yes Check if LOCKE flag set Yes Locking region violation No Check if PROGE flag set Yes Bad keyword violation and/or Invalid command No Command Successful In order to guarantee valid operations on the Flash memory, the field Flash Microsecond Cycle Number (FMCN) in the Flash Mode Register MC_FMR must be correctly programmed (see “MC Flash Mode Register” on page 142). 20.2.4.1 Flash Programming Several commands can be used to program the Flash. The Flash technology requires that an erase must be done before programming. The entire memory plane can be erased at the same time, or a page can be automatically erased by clearing the NEBP bit in the MC_FMR register before writing the command in the MC_FCR register. By setting the NEBP bit in the MC_FMR register, a page can be programmed in several steps if it has been erased before (see Figure 20-6). 136 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 20-6. Example of Partial Page Programming: 32 bits wide 32 bits wide 16 words 16 words FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF 16 words FF FF FF 16 words FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF ... FF FF FF FF FF CA FE FF FF CA CA FE FE FF FF ... FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF ... FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF ... Step 1. Erase All Flash Page 7 erased ... ... ... ... 32 bits wide FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF CA FE CA FE CA CA FE FE CA CA FE FE FF FF DE CA FF FF FF FF DE DE CA CA FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF Step 2. Programming of the second part of Page 7 (NEBP = 1) FF ... FF FF FF CA FE CA CA FE FE DE CA DE DE CA CA FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF ... ... ... Step 3. Programming of the third part of Page 7 (NEBP = 1) After programming, the page (the whole lock region) can be locked to prevent miscellaneous write or erase sequences. The lock bit can be automatically set after page programming using WPL. Data to be written are stored in an internal latch buffer. The size of the latch buffer corresponds to the page size. The latch buffer wraps around within the internal memory area address space and appears to be repeated by the number of pages in it. Note: Writing of 8-bit and 16-bit data is not allowed and may lead to unpredictable data corruption. Data are written to the latch buffer before the programming command is written to the Flash Command Register MC_FCR. The sequence is as follows: • Write the full page, at any page address, within the internal memory area address space using only 32-bit access. • Programming starts as soon as the page number and the programming command are written to the Flash Command Register. The FRDY bit in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) is automatically cleared. • When programming is completed, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt was enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence: • Programming Error: A bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the MC_FCR register. • Lock Error: The page to be programmed belongs to a locked region. A command must be previously run to unlock the corresponding region. 20.2.4.2 Erase All Command The entire memory can be erased if the Erase All Command (EA) in the Flash Command Register MC_FCR is written. 137 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Erase All operation is allowed only if there are no lock bits set. Thus, if at least one lock region is locked, the bit LOCKE in MC_FSR rises and the command is cancelled. If the bit LOCKE has been written at 1 in MC_FMR, the interrupt line rises. When programming is complete, the bit FRDY bit in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence: • Programming Error: A bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the MC_FCR register. • Lock Error: At least one lock region to be erased is protected. The erase command has been refused and no page has been erased. A Clear Lock Bit command must be executed previously to unlock the corresponding lock regions. 20.2.4.3 Lock Bit Protection Lock bits are associated with several pages in the embedded Flash memory plane. This defines lock regions in the embedded Flash memory plane. They prevent writing/erasing protected pages. After production, the device may have some embedded Flash lock regions locked. These locked regions are reserved for a default application. Refer to the product definition section for the default embedded Flash mapping. Locked sectors can be unlocked to be erased and then programmed with another application or other data. The lock sequence is: • The Flash Command register must be written with the following value: (0x5A << 24) | (lockPageNumber << 8 & PAGEN) | SLB lockPageNumber is a page of the corresponding lock region. • When locking completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. A programming error, where a bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the MC_FCR register, may be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence. It is possible to clear lock bits that were set previously. Then the locked region can be erased or programmed. The unlock sequence is: • The Flash Command register must be written with the following value: (0x5A << 24) | (lockPageNumber << 8 & PAGEN) | CLB lockPageNumber is a page of the corresponding lock region. • When the unlock completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. A programming error, where a bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the MC_FCR register, may be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence. The Unlock command programs the lock bit to 1; the corresponding bit LOCKSx in MC_FSR reads 0. The Lock command programs the lock bit to 0; the corresponding bit LOCKSx in MC_FSR reads 1. Note: 138 Access to the Flash in Read Mode is permitted when a Lock or Unlock command is performed. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 20.2.4.4 General-purpose NVM Bits General-purpose NVM bits do not interfere with the embedded Flash memory plane. (Does not apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.) These general-purpose bits are dedicated to protect other parts of the product. They can be set (activated) or cleared individually. Refer to the product definition section for the general-purpose NVM bit action. The activation sequence is: • Start the Set General Purpose Bit command (SGPB) by writing the Flash Command Register with the SEL command and the number of the general-purpose bit to be set in the PAGEN field. • When the bit is set, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence: • Programming Error: A bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the MC_FCR register • If the general-purpose bit number is greater than the total number of general-purpose bits, then the command has no effect. It is possible to deactivate a general-purpose NVM bit set previously. The clear sequence is: • Start the Clear General-purpose Bit command (CGPB) by writing the Flash Command Register with CGPB and the number of the general-purpose bit to be cleared in the PAGEN field. • When the clear completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence: • Programming Error: a bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the MC_FCR register • If the number of the general-purpose bit set in the PAGEN field is greater than the total number of general-purpose bits, then the command has no effect. The Clear General-purpose Bit command programs the general-purpose NVM bit to 1; the corresponding bit GPNVM0 to GPNVMx in MC_FSR reads 0. The Set General-purpose Bit command programs the general-purpose NVM bit to 0; the corresponding bit GPNVMx in MC_FSR reads 1. Note: 20.2.4.5 Access to the Flash in read mode is permitted when a Set, Clear or Get General-purpose NVM Bit command is performed. Security Bit The goal of the security bit is to prevent external access to the internal bus system. (Does not apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.) JTAG, Fast Flash Programming and Flash Serial Test Interface features are disabled. Once set, this bit can be reset only by an external hardware ERASE request to the chip. Refer to the product definition section for the pin name that controls the ERASE. In this case, the full memory plane is erased and all lock and general-purpose NVM bits are cleared. The security bit in the MC_FSR is cleared only after these operations. The activation sequence is: • Start the Set Security Bit command (SSB) by writing the Flash Command Register. 139 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • When the locking completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated. When the security bit is active, the SECURITY bit in the MC_FSR is set. 140 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 20.3 Embedded Flash Controller (EFC ) User Interface The User Interface of the EFC is integrated within the Memory Controller with Base Address: 0xFFFF FF00. The AT91SAM7XC512 is equipped with two EFCs, EFC0 and EFC1, as described in the Register Mapping tables and Register descriptions that follow. Table 20-3. Embedded Flash Controller (EFC0) Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset State 0x60 MC Flash Mode Register MC_FMR Read/Write 0x0 0x64 MC Flash Command Register MC_FCR Write-only – 0x68 MC Flash Status Register MC_FSR Read-only – 0x6C Reserved – – – Name Access Reset State Table 20-4. Embedded Flash Controller (EFC1) Register Mapping Offset Register 0x70 MC Flash Mode Register MC_FMR Read/Write 0x0 0x74 MC Flash Command Register MC_FCR Write-only – 0x78 MC Flash Status Register MC_FSR Read-only – 0x7C Reserved – – – 141 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 20.3.1 MC Flash Mode Register Register Name: MC_FMR Access Type: Read/Write Offset: (EFC0) 0x60 Offset: (EFC1) 0x70 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 23 22 21 20 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 19 18 17 16 FMCN 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 7 NEBP 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 PROGE 2 LOCKE 1 – 8 FWS 0 FRDY • FRDY: Flash Ready Interrupt Enable 0: Flash Ready does not generate an interrupt. 1: Flash Ready generates an interrupt. • LOCKE: Lock Error Interrupt Enable 0: Lock Error does not generate an interrupt. 1: Lock Error generates an interrupt. • PROGE: Programming Error Interrupt Enable 0: Programming Error does not generate an interrupt. 1: Programming Error generates an interrupt. • NEBP: No Erase Before Programming 0: A page erase is performed before programming. 1: No erase is performed before programming. • FWS: Flash Wait State This field defines the number of wait states for read and write operations: 142 FWS Read Operations Write Operations 0 1 cycle 2 cycles 1 2 cycles 3 cycles 2 3 cycles 4 cycles 3 4 cycles 4 cycles AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • FMCN: Flash Microsecond Cycle Number Before writing Non Volatile Memory bits (Lock bits, General Purpose NVM bit and Security bits), this field must be set to the number of Master Clock cycles in one microsecond. When writing the rest of the Flash, this field defines the number of Master Clock cycles in 1.5 microseconds. This number must be rounded up. Warning: The value 0 is only allowed for a master clock period superior to 30 microseconds. Warning: In order to guarantee valid operations on the flash memory, the field Flash Microsecond Cycle Number (FMCN) must be correctly programmed. 143 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 20.3.2 MC Flash Command Register Register Name: MC_FCR Access Type: Write-only Offset: (EFC0) 0x64 Offset: (EFC1) 0x74 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 – 18 – 17 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 KEY 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 15 14 13 12 16 PAGEN PAGEN 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – FCMD • FCMD: Flash Command This field defines the Flash commands: FCMD 0000 No command. Does not raise the Programming Error Status flag in the Flash Status Register MC_FSR. 0001 Write Page Command (WP): Starts the programming of the page specified in the PAGEN field. 0010 Set Lock Bit Command (SLB): Starts a set lock bit sequence of the lock region specified in the PAGEN field. 0011 Write Page and Lock Command (WPL): The lock sequence of the lock region associated with the page specified in the field PAGEN occurs automatically after completion of the programming sequence. 0100 Clear Lock Bit Command (CLB): Starts a clear lock bit sequence of the lock region specified in the PAGEN field. 1000 Erase All Command (EA): Starts the erase of the entire Flash. If at least one page is locked, the command is cancelled. 1011 Set General-purpose NVM Bit (SGPB): Activates the general-purpose NVM bit corresponding to the number specified in the PAGEN field. 1101 Clear General Purpose NVM Bit (CGPB): Deactivates the general-purpose NVM bit corresponding to the number specified in the PAGEN field. 1111 Set Security Bit Command (SSB): Sets security bit. Others 144 Operations Reserved. Raises the Programming Error Status flag in the Flash Status Register MC_FSR. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • PAGEN: Page Number Command PAGEN Description Write Page Command PAGEN defines the page number to be written. Write Page and Lock Command PAGEN defines the page number to be written and its associated lock region. Erase All Command This field is meaningless Set/Clear Lock Bit Command PAGEN defines one page number of the lock region to be locked or unlocked. Set/Clear General Purpose NVM Bit Command PAGEN defines the general-purpose bit number. Set Security Bit Command This field is meaningless Note: Depending on the command, all the possible unused bits of PAGEN are meaningless. • KEY: Write Protection Key This field should be written with the value 0x5A to enable the command defined by the bits of the register. If the field is written with a different value, the write is not performed and no action is started. 145 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 20.3.3 MC Flash Status Register Register Name: MC_FSR Access Type: Read-only Offset: (EFC0) 0x68 Offset: (EFC1) 0x78 31 LOCKS15 30 LOCKS14 29 LOCKS13 28 LOCKS12 27 LOCKS11 26 LOCKS10 25 LOCKS9 24 LOCKS8 23 LOCKS7 22 LOCKS6 21 LOCKS5 20 LOCKS4 19 LOCKS3 18 LOCKS2 17 LOCKS1 16 LOCKS0 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 GPNVM2 9 GPNVM1 8 GPNVM0 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 SECURITY 3 PROGE 2 LOCKE 1 – 0 FRDY • FRDY: Flash Ready Status 0: The EFC is busy and the application must wait before running a new command. 1: The EFC is ready to run a new command. • LOCKE: Lock Error Status 0: No programming of at least one locked lock region has happened since the last read of MC_FSR. 1: Programming of at least one locked lock region has happened since the last read of MC_FSR. • PROGE: Programming Error Status 0: No invalid commands and no bad keywords were written in the Flash Command Register MC_FCR. 1: An invalid command and/or a bad keyword was/were written in the Flash Command Register MC_FCR. • SECURITY: Security Bit Status (Does not apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.) 0: The security bit is inactive. 1: The security bit is active. • GPNVMx: General-purpose NVM Bit Status (Does not apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.) 0: The corresponding general-purpose NVM bit is inactive. 1: The corresponding general-purpose NVM bit is active. • EFC LOCKSx: Lock Region x Lock Status 0: The corresponding lock region is not locked. 1: The corresponding lock region is locked. 146 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 21. Fast Flash Programming Interface (FFPI) 21.1 Overview The Fast Flash Programming Interface provides two solutions - parallel or serial - for high-volume programming using a standard gang programmer. The parallel interface is fully handshaked and the device is considered to be a standard EEPROM. Additionally, the parallel protocol offers an optimized access to all the embedded Flash functionalities. The serial interface uses the standard IEEE 1149.1 JTAG protocol. It offers an optimized access to all the embedded Flash functionalities. Although the Fast Flash Programming Mode is a dedicated mode for high volume programming, this mode not designed for in-situ programming. 21.2 21.2.1 Parallel Fast Flash Programming Device Configuration In Fast Flash Programming Mode, the device is in a specific test mode. Only a certain set of pins is significant, the rest of the PIOs are used as inputs with a pull-up. The crystal oscillator is in bypass mode. Other pins must be left unconnected. Figure 21-1. Parallel Programming Interface VDDIO VDDIO VDDIO TST PGMEN0 PGMEN1 VDDCORE NCMD VDDIO RDY PGMNCMD PGMRDY NOE PGMNOE VDDFLASH PGMNVALID GND NVALID MODE[3:0] PGMM[3:0] DATA[15:0] PGMD[15:0] 0 - 50MHz XIN VDDPLL 147 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 21-1. Signal Name Signal Description List Function Active Level Type Comments Power VDDFLASH Flash Power Supply Power VDDIO I/O Lines Power Supply Power VDDCORE Core Power Supply Power VDDPLL PLL Power Supply Power GND Ground Ground Clocks Main Clock Input. This input can be tied to GND. In this case, the device is clocked by the internal RC oscillator. XIN Input 32KHz to 50MHz Test TST Test Mode Select Input High Must be connected to VDDIO PGMEN0 Test Mode Select Input High Must be connected to VDDIO PGMEN1 Test Mode Select Input High Must be connected to VDDIO Input Low Pulled-up input at reset Output High Pulled-up input at reset Input Low Pulled-up input at reset Output Low Pulled-up input at reset PIO PGMNCMD Valid command available PGMRDY 0: Device is busy 1: Device is ready for a new command PGMNOE Output Enable (active high) PGMNVALID 0: DATA[15:0] is in input mode 1: DATA[15:0] is in output mode PGMM[3:0] Specifies DATA type (See Table 21-2) PGMD[15:0] Bi-directional data bus 21.2.2 Input Pulled-up input at reset Input/Output Pulled-up input at reset Signal Names Depending on the MODE settings, DATA is latched in different internal registers. Table 21-2. Mode Coding MODE[3:0] Symbol Data 0000 CMDE Command Register 0001 ADDR0 Address Register LSBs 0010 ADDR1 0101 DATA Data Register Default IDLE No register When MODE is equal to CMDE, then a new command (strobed on DATA[15:0] signals) is stored in the command register. 148 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 21-3. DATA[15:0] Symbol Command Executed 0x0011 READ Read Flash 0x0012 WP Write Page Flash 0x0022 WPL Write Page and Lock Flash 0x0032 EWP Erase Page and Write Page 0x0042 EWPL Erase Page and Write Page then Lock 0x0013 EA Erase All 0x0014 SLB Set Lock Bit 0x0024 CLB Clear Lock Bit 0x0015 GLB Get Lock Bit 0x0034 SGPB Set General Purpose NVM bit 0x0044 CGPB Clear General Purpose NVM bit 0x0025 GGPB Get General Purpose NVM bit 0x0054 SSE Set Security Bit 0x0035 GSE Get Security Bit 0x001F WRAM Write Memory 0x0016 SEFC Select EFC Controller(1) 0x001E GVE Get Version Note: 21.2.3 Command Bit Coding 1. Applies to AT91SAM7XC512. Entering Programming Mode The following algorithm puts the device in Parallel Programming Mode: • Apply GND, VDDIO, VDDCORE, VDDFLASH and VDDPLL. • Apply XIN clock within TPOR_RESET if an external clock is available. • Wait for TPOR_RESET • Start a read or write handshaking. Note: 21.2.4 21.2.4.1 After reset, the device is clocked by the internal RC oscillator. Before clearing RDY signal, if an external clock ( > 32 kHz) is connected to XIN, then the device switches on the external clock. Else, XIN input is not considered. A higher frequency on XIN speeds up the programmer handshake. Programmer Handshaking An handshake is defined for read and write operations. When the device is ready to start a new operation (RDY signal set), the programmer starts the handshake by clearing the NCMD signal. The handshaking is achieved once NCMD signal is high and RDY is high. Write Handshaking For details on the write handshaking sequence, refer to Figure 21-2and Table 21-4. 149 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 21-2. Parallel Programming Timing, Write Sequence NCMD 2 4 3 RDY 5 NOE NVALID DATA[15:0] 1 MODE[3:0] Table 21-4. Write Handshake Step Programmer Action Device Action Data I/O 1 Sets MODE and DATA signals Waits for NCMD low Input 2 Clears NCMD signal Latches MODE and DATA Input 3 Waits for RDY low Clears RDY signal Input 4 Releases MODE and DATA signals Executes command and polls NCMD high Input 5 Sets NCMD signal Executes command and polls NCMD high Input 6 Waits for RDY high Sets RDY Input 21.2.4.2 Read Handshaking For details on the read handshaking sequence, refer to Figure 21-3 and Table 21-5. Figure 21-3. Parallel Programming Timing, Read Sequence NCMD 12 2 3 RDY 13 NOE 9 5 NVALID 11 7 6 4 DATA[15:0] Adress IN Z 8 Data OUT 10 X IN 1 MODE[3:0] 150 ADDR AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 21-5. Read Handshake Step Programmer Action Device Action DATA I/O 1 Sets MODE and DATA signals Waits for NCMD low Input 2 Clears NCMD signal Latch MODE and DATA Input 3 Waits for RDY low Clears RDY signal Input 4 Sets DATA signal in tristate Waits for NOE Low Input 5 Clears NOE signal 6 Waits for NVALID low Tristate 7 Sets DATA bus in output mode and outputs the flash contents. Output Clears NVALID signal Output Waits for NOE high Output 8 Reads value on DATA Bus 9 Sets NOE signal 10 Waits for NVALID high Sets DATA bus in input mode X 11 Sets DATA in output mode Sets NVALID signal Input 12 Sets NCMD signal Waits for NCMD high Input 13 Waits for RDY high Sets RDY signal Input 21.2.5 Output Device Operations Several commands on the Flash memory are available. These commands are summarized in Table 21-3 on page 149. Each command is driven by the programmer through the parallel interface running several read/write handshaking sequences. When a new command is executed, the previous one is automatically achieved. Thus, chaining a read command after a write automatically flushes the load buffer in the Flash. 21.2.5.1 Flash Read Command This command is used to read the contents of the Flash memory. The read command can start at any valid address in the memory plane and is optimized for consecutive reads. Read handshaking can be chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased. Table 21-6. Read Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE READ 2 Write handshaking ADDR0 Memory Address LSB 3 Write handshaking ADDR1 Memory Address 4 Read handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ 5 Read handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ ... ... ... ... n Write handshaking ADDR0 Memory Address LSB n+1 Write handshaking ADDR1 Memory Address n+2 Read handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ n+3 Read handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ ... ... ... ... 151 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 21.2.5.2 Flash Write Command This command is used to write the Flash contents. The Flash memory plane is organized into several pages. Data to be written are stored in a load buffer that corresponds to a Flash memory page. The load buffer is automatically flushed to the Flash: • before access to any page other than the current one • when a new command is validated (MODE = CMDE) The Write Page command (WP) is optimized for consecutive writes. Write handshaking can be chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased. Table 21-7. Write Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE WP or WPL or EWP or EWPL 2 Write handshaking ADDR0 Memory Address LSB 3 Write handshaking ADDR1 Memory Address 4 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ 5 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ ... ... ... ... n Write handshaking ADDR0 Memory Address LSB n+1 Write handshaking ADDR1 Memory Address n+2 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ n+3 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ The Flash command Write Page and Lock (WPL) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command. However, the lock bit is automatically set at the end of the Flash write operation. As a lock region is composed of several pages, the programmer writes to the first pages of the lock region using Flash write commands and writes to the last page of the lock region using a Flash write and lock command. The Flash command Erase Page and Write (EWP) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command. However, before programming the load buffer, the page is erased. The Flash command Erase Page and Write the Lock (EWPL) combines EWP and WPL commands. 21.2.5.3 Flash Full Erase Command This command is used to erase the Flash memory planes. All lock regions must be unlocked before the Full Erase command by using the CLB command. Otherwise, the erase command is aborted and no page is erased. Table 21-8. 152 Full Erase Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE EA 2 Write handshaking DATA 0 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 21.2.5.4 Flash Lock Commands Lock bits can be set using WPL or EWPL commands. They can also be set by using the Set Lock command (SLB). With this command, several lock bits can be activated. A Bit Mask is provided as argument to the command. When bit 0 of the bit mask is set, then the first lock bit is activated. In the same way, the Clear Lock command (CLB) is used to clear lock bits. All the lock bits are also cleared by the EA command. Table 21-9. Set and Clear Lock Bit Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE SLB or CLB 2 Write handshaking DATA Bit Mask Lock bits can be read using Get Lock Bit command (GLB). The nth lock bit is active when the bit n of the bit mask is set.. Table 21-10. Get Lock Bit Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE GLB DATA Lock Bit Mask Status 0 = Lock bit is cleared 1 = Lock bit is set 2 21.2.5.5 Read handshaking Flash General-purpose NVM Commands General-purpose NVM bits (GP NVM bits) can be set using the Set GPNVM command (SGPB). This command also activates GP NVM bits. A bit mask is provided as argument to the command. When bit 0 of the bit mask is set, then the first GP NVM bit is activated. In the same way, the Clear GPNVM command (CGPB) is used to clear general-purpose NVM bits. All the general-purpose NVM bits are also cleared by the EA command. The general-purpose NVM bit is deactivated when the corresponding bit in the pattern value is set to 1. Table 21-11. Set/Clear GP NVM Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE SGPB or CGPB 2 Write handshaking DATA GP NVM bit pattern value General-purpose NVM bits can be read using the Get GPNVM Bit command (GGPB). The nth GP NVM bit is active when bit n of the bit mask is set.. Table 21-12. Get GP NVM Bit Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE GGPB 2 Read handshaking DATA GP NVM Bit Mask Status 0 = GP NVM bit is cleared 1 = GP NVM bit is set 153 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 21.2.5.6 Flash Security Bit Command A security bit can be set using the Set Security Bit command (SSE). Once the security bit is active, the Fast Flash programming is disabled. No other command can be run. An event on the Erase pin can erase the security bit once the contents of the Flash have been erased. The AT91SAM7XC512 security bit is controlled by the EFC0. To use the Set Security Bit command, the EFC0 must be selected using the Select EFC command Table 21-13. Set Security Bit Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE SSE 2 Write handshaking DATA 0 Once the security bit is set, it is not possible to access FFPI. The only way to erase the security bit is to erase the Flash. In order to erase the Flash, the user must perform the following: • Power-off the chip • Power-on the chip with TST = 0 • Assert Erase during a period of more than 220 ms • Power-of the chip Then it i possible to return to FFPI mode and check that Flash is erased. 21.2.5.7 AT91SAM7XC512 Select EFC Command The commands WPx, EA, xLB, xFB are executed using the current EFC controller. The default EFC controller is EFC0. The Select EFC command (SEFC) allows selection of the current EFC controller. Table 21-14. Select EFC Command 21.2.5.8 Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE SEFC 2 Write handshaking DATA 0 = Select EFC0 1 = Select EFC1 Memory Write Command This command is used to perform a write access to any memory location. The Memory Write command (WRAM) is optimized for consecutive writes. Write handshaking can be chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased. Table 21-15. Write Command 154 Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE WRAM 2 Write handshaking ADDR0 Memory Address LSB 3 Write handshaking ADDR1 Memory Address 4 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ 5 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 21-15. Write Command (Continued) 21.2.5.9 Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] ... ... ... ... n Write handshaking ADDR0 Memory Address LSB n+1 Write handshaking ADDR1 Memory Address n+2 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ n+3 Write handshaking DATA *Memory Address++ ... ... ... ... Get Version Command The Get Version (GVE) command retrieves the version of the FFPI interface. Table 21-16. Get Version Command Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE GVE 2 Write handshaking DATA Version 155 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 21.3 Serial Fast Flash Programming The Serial Fast Flash programming interface is based on IEEE Std. 1149.1 “Standard Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture”. Refer to this standard for an explanation of terms used in this chapter and for a description of the TAP controller states. In this mode, data read/written from/to the embedded Flash of the device are transmitted through the JTAG interface of the device. 21.3.1 Device Configuration In Serial Fast Flash Programming Mode, the device is in a specific test mode.Only a certain set of pins is significant, the rest of the PIOs are used as inputs with a pull-up. The crystal oscillator is in bypass mode. Other pins must be left unconnected. Figure 21-4. Serial Programing VDDIO VDDIO VDDIO TST PGMEN0 PGMEN1 VDDCORE VDDIO TDI TDO VDDPLL TMS VDDFLASH TCK GND 0-50MHz XIN Table 21-17. Signal Description List Signal Name Function Type Active Level Comments Power VDDFLASH Flash Power Supply Power VDDIO I/O Lines Power Supply Power VDDCORE Core Power Supply Power VDDPLL PLL Power Supply Power GND Ground Ground Clocks XIN 156 Main Clock Input. This input can be tied to GND. In this case, the device is clocked by the internal RC oscillator. Input 32 kHz to 50 MHz AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 21-17. Signal Description List (Continued) Signal Name Function Type Active Level Comments Test TST Test Mode Select Input High Must be connected to VDDIO. PGMEN0 Test Mode Select Input High Must be connected to VDDIO PGMEN1 Test Mode Select Input High Must be connected to VDDIO JTAG TCK JTAG TCK Input - Pulled-up input at reset TDI JTAG Test Data In Input - Pulled-up input at reset TDO JTAG Test Data Out Output - TMS JTAG Test Mode Select Input - 21.3.2 Pulled-up input at reset Entering Serial Programming Mode The following algorithm puts the device in Serial Programming Mode: • Apply GND, VDDIO, VDDCORE, VDDFLASH and VDDPLL. • Apply XIN clock within TPOR_RESET + 32(TSCLK) if an external clock is available. • Wait for TPOR_RESET. • Reset the TAP controller clocking 5 TCK pulses with TMS set. • Shift 0x2 into the IR register (IR is 4 bits long, LSB first) without going through the Run-TestIdle state. • Shift 0x2 into the DR register (DR is 4 bits long, LSB first) without going through the RunTest-Idle state. • Shift 0xC into the IR register (IR is 4 bits long, LSB first) without going through the Run-TestIdle state. Note: After reset, the device is clocked by the internal RC oscillator. Before clearing RDY signal, if an external clock ( > 32 kHz) is connected to XIN, then the device will switch on the external clock. Else, XIN input is not considered. An higher frequency on XIN speeds up the programmer handshake. Table 21-18. Reset TAP Controller and Go to Select-DR-Scan 21.3.3 TDI TMS TAP Controller State X 1 X 1 X 1 X 1 X 1 Test-Logic Reset X 0 Run-Test/Idle Xt 1 Select-DR-Scan Read/Write Handshake The read/write handshake is done by carrying out read/write operations on two registers of the device that are accessible through the JTAG: 157 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Debug Comms Control Register: DCCR • Debug Comms Data Register: DCDR Access to these registers is done through the TAP 38-bit DR register comprising a 32-bit data field, a 5-bit address field and a read/write bit. The data to be written is scanned into the 32-bit data field with the address of the register to the 5-bit address field and 1 to the read/write bit. A register is read by scanning its address into the address field and 0 into the read/write bit, going through the UPDATE-DR TAP state, then scanning out the data. Refer to the ARM7TDMI reference manuel for more information on Comm channel operations. Figure 21-5. TAP 8-bit DR Register TDI r/w 4 Address 0 31 Data 5 Address Decoder 0 TDO 32 Debug Comms Control Register Debug Comms Data Register A read or write takes place when the TAP controller enters UPDATE-DR state. Refer to the IEEE 1149.1 for more details on JTAG operations. • The address of the Debug Comms Control Register is 0x04. • The address of the Debug Comms Data Register is 0x05. The Debug Comms Control Register is read-only and allows synchronized handshaking between the processor and the debugger. – Bit 1 (W): Denotes whether the programmer can read a data through the Debug Comms Data Register. If the device is busy W = 0, then the programmer must poll until W = 1. – Bit 0 (R): Denotes whether the programmer can send data from the Debug Comms Data Register. If R = 1, data previously placed there through the scan chain has not been collected by the device and so the programmer must wait. The write handshake is done by polling the Debug Comms Control Register until the R bit is cleared. Once cleared, data can be written to the Debug Comms Data Register. The read handshake is done by polling the Debug Comms Control Register until the W bit is set. Once set, data can be read in the Debug Comms Data Register. 21.3.4 21.3.4.1 158 Device Operations Several commands on the Flash memory are available. These commands are summarized in Table 21-3 on page 149. Commands are run by the programmer through the serial interface that is reading and writing the Debug Comms Registers. Flash Read Command This command is used to read the Flash contents. The memory map is accessible through this command. Memory is seen as an array of words (32-bit wide). The read command can start at AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary any valid address in the memory plane. This address must be word-aligned. The address is automatically incremented. Table 21-19. Read Command 21.3.4.2 Read/Write DR Data Write (Number of Words to Read) << 16 | READ Write Address Read Memory [address] Read Memory [address+4] ... ... Read Memory [address+(Number of Words to Read - 1)* 4] Flash Write Command This command is used to write the Flash contents. The address transmitted must be a valid Flash address in the memory plane. The Flash memory plane is organized into several pages. Data to be written is stored in a load buffer that corresponds to a Flash memory page. The load buffer is automatically flushed to the Flash: • before access to any page than the current one • at the end of the number of words transmitted The Write Page command (WP) is optimized for consecutive writes. Write handshaking can be chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased. Table 21-20. Write Command Read/Write DR Data Write (Number of Words to Write) << 16 | (WP or WPL or EWP or EWPL) Write Address Write Memory [address] Write Memory [address+4] Write Memory [address+8] Write Memory [address+(Number of Words to Write - 1)* 4] Flash Write Page and Lock command (WPL) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command. However, the lock bit is automatically set at the end of the Flash write operation. As a lock region is composed of several pages, the programmer writes to the first pages of the lock region using Flash write commands and writes to the last page of the lock region using a Flash write and lock command. Flash Erase Page and Write command (EWP) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command. However, before programming the load buffer, the page is erased. Flash Erase Page and Write the Lock command (EWPL) combines EWP and WPL commands. 21.3.4.3 Flash Full Erase Command This command is used to erase the Flash memory planes. 159 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 All lock bits must be deactivated before using the Full Erase command. This can be done by using the CLB command. Table 21-21. Full Erase Command 21.3.4.4 Read/Write DR Data Write EA Flash Lock Commands Lock bits can be set using WPL or EWPL commands. They can also be set by using the Set Lock command (SLB). With this command, several lock bits can be activated at the same time. Bit 0 of Bit Mask corresponds to the first lock bit and so on. In the same way, the Clear Lock command (CLB) is used to clear lock bits. All the lock bits can also be cleared by the EA command. Table 21-22. Set and Clear Lock Bit Command Read/Write DR Data Write SLB or CLB Write Bit Mask Lock bits can be read using Get Lock Bit command (GLB). When a bit set in the Bit Mask is returned, then the corresponding lock bit is active. Table 21-23. Get Lock Bit Command 21.3.4.5 Read/Write DR Data Write GLB Read Bit Mask Flash General-purpose NVM Commands General-purpose NVM bits (GP NVM) can be set with the Set GPNVM command (SGPB). Using this command, several GP NVM bits can be activated at the same time. Bit 0 of Bit Mask corresponds to the first GPNVM bit and so on. In the same way, the Clear GPNVM command (CGPB) is used to clear GP NVM bits. All the general-purpose NVM bits are also cleared by the EA command. Table 21-24. Set and Clear General-purpose NVM Bit Command Read/Write DR Data Write SGPB or CGPB Write Bit Mask GP NVM bits can be read using Get GPNVM Bit command (GGPB). When a bit set in the Bit Mask is returned, then the corresponding GPNVM bit is set. Table 21-25. Get General-purpose NVM Bit Command 160 Read/Write DR Data Write GGPB Read Bit Mask AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 21.3.4.6 Flash Security Bit Command Security bits can be set using Set Security Bit command (SSE). Once the security bit is active, the Fast Flash programming is disabled. No other command can be run. Only an event on the Erase pin can erase the security bit once the contents of the Flash have been erased. The AT91SAM7XC512 security bit is controlled by the EFC0. To use the Set Security Bit command, the EFC0 must be selected using the Select EFC command. Table 21-26. Set Security Bit Command Read/Write DR Data Write SSE Once the security bit is set, it is not possible to access FFPI. The only way to erase the security bit is to erase the Flash. In order to erase the Flash, the user must perform the following: • Power-off the chip • Power-on the chip with TST = 0 • Assert Erase during a period of more than 220 ms • Power-off the chip Then it is possible to return to FFPI mode and check that Flash is erased. 21.3.4.7 AT91SAM7XC512 Select EFC Command The commands WPx, EA, xLB, xFB are executed using the current EFC controller. The default EFC controller is EFC0. The Select EFC command (SEFC) allows selection of the current EFC controller. Table 21-27. Select EFC Command 21.3.4.8 Step Handshake Sequence MODE[3:0] DATA[15:0] 1 Write handshaking CMDE SEFC 2 Write handshaking DATA 0 = Select EFC0 1 = Select EFC1 Memory Write Command This command is used to perform a write access to any memory location. The Memory Write command (WRAM) is optimized for consecutive writes. An internal address buffer is automatically increased. Table 21-28. Write Command Read/Write DR Data Write (Number of Words to Write) << 16 | (WRAM) Write Address Write Memory [address] Write Memory [address+4] Write Memory [address+8] Write Memory [address+(Number of Words to Write - 1)* 4] 161 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 21.3.4.9 Get Version Command The Get Version (GVE) command retrieves the version of the FFPI interface. Table 21-29. Get Version Command 162 Read/Write DR Data Write GVE Read Version AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 22. AT91SAM Boot Program 22.1 Overview The Boot Program integrates different programs permitting download and/or upload into the different memories of the product. First, it initializes the Debug Unit serial port (DBGU) and the USB Device Port. SAM-BA® Boot is then executed. It waits for transactions either on the USB device, or on the DBGU serial port. 22.2 Flow Diagram The Boot Program implements the algorithm in Figure 22-1. Figure 22-1. Boot Program Algorithm Flow Diagram No Device Setup USB Enumeration Successful ? No AutoBaudrate Sequence Successful ? Yes Run SAM-BA Boot 22.3 Yes Run SAM-BA Boot Device Initialization Initialization follows the steps described below: 1. FIQ initialization 1. Stack setup for ARM supervisor mode 2. Setup the Embedded Flash Controller 3. External Clock detection 4. Main oscillator frequency detection if no external clock detected 5. Switch Master Clock on Main Oscillator 6. Copy code into SRAM 7. C variable initialization 8. PLL setup: PLL is initialized to generate a 48 MHz clock necessary to use the USB Device 9. Disable of the Watchdog and enable of the user reset 10. Initialization of the USB Device Port 11. Jump to SAM-BA Boot sequence (see “SAM-BA Boot” on page 164) 163 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 22.4 SAM-BA Boot The SAM-BA boot principle is to: – Check if USB Device enumeration has occurred – Check if the AutoBaudrate sequence has succeeded (see Figure 22-2) Figure 22-2. AutoBaudrate Flow Diagram Device Setup Character '0x80' received ? No 1st measurement Yes Character '0x80' received ? No 2nd measurement No Test Communication Yes Character '#' received ? Yes Send Character '>' UART operational Run SAM-BA Boot – Once the communication interface is identified, the application runs in an infinite loop waiting for different commands as in Table 22-1. 164 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 22-1. Commands Available through the SAM-BA Boot Command Action Argument(s) Example O write a byte Address, Value# O200001,CA# o read a byte Address,# o200001,# H write a half word Address, Value# H200002,CAFE# h read a half word Address,# h200002,# W write a word Address, Value# W200000,CAFEDECA# w read a word Address,# w200000,# S send a file Address,# S200000,# R receive a file Address, NbOfBytes# R200000,1234# G go Address# G200200# V display version No argument V# • Write commands: Write a byte (O), a halfword (H) or a word (W) to the target. – Address: Address in hexadecimal. – Value: Byte, halfword or word to write in hexadecimal. – Output: ‘>’. • Read commands: Read a byte (o), a halfword (h) or a word (w) from the target. – Address: Address in hexadecimal – Output: The byte, halfword or word read in hexadecimal following by ‘>’ • Send a file (S): Send a file to a specified address – Address: Address in hexadecimal – Output: ‘>’. Note: There is a time-out on this command which is reached when the prompt ‘>’ appears before the end of the command execution. • Receive a file (R): Receive data into a file from a specified address – Address: Address in hexadecimal – NbOfBytes: Number of bytes in hexadecimal to receive – Output: ‘>’ • Go (G): Jump to a specified address and execute the code – Address: Address to jump in hexadecimal – Output: ‘>’ • Get Version (V): Return the SAM-BA boot version – Output: ‘>’ 22.4.1 DBGU Serial Port Communication is performed through the DBGU serial port initialized to 115200 Baud, 8, n, 1. The Send and Receive File commands use the Xmodem protocol to communicate. Any terminal performing this protocol can be used to send the application file to the target. The size of the binary file to send depends on the SRAM size embedded in the product. In all cases, the size of 165 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 the binary file must be lower than the SRAM size because the Xmodem protocol requires some SRAM memory to work. 22.4.2 Xmodem Protocol The Xmodem protocol supported is the 128-byte length block. This protocol uses a two-character CRC-16 to guarantee detection of a maximum bit error. Xmodem protocol with CRC is accurate provided both sender and receiver report successful transmission. Each block of the transfer looks like: <SOH><blk #><255-blk #><--128 data bytes--><checksum> in which: – <SOH> = 01 hex – <blk #> = binary number, starts at 01, increments by 1, and wraps 0FFH to 00H (not to 01) – <255-blk #> = 1’s complement of the blk#. – <checksum> = 2 bytes CRC16 Figure 22-3 shows a transmission using this protocol. Figure 22-3. Xmodem Transfer Example Host Device C SOH 01 FE Data[128] CRC CRC ACK SOH 02 FD Data[128] CRC CRC ACK SOH 03 FC Data[100] CRC CRC ACK EOT ACK 22.4.3 USB Device Port A 48 MHz USB clock is necessary to use the USB Device port. It has been programmed earlier in the device initialization procedure with PLLB configuration. The device uses the USB communication device class (CDC) drivers to take advantage of the installed PC RS-232 software to talk over the USB. The CDC class is implemented in all releases of Windows®, from Windows 98SE to Windows XP. The CDC document, available at www.usb.org, describes a way to implement devices such as ISDN modems and virtual COM ports. The Vendor ID is Atmel’s vendor ID 0x03EB. The product ID is 0x6124. These references are used by the host operating system to mount the correct driver. On Windows systems, the INF files contain the correspondence between vendor ID and product ID. 166 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Atmel provides an INF example to see the device as a new serial port and also provides another custom driver used by the SAM-BA application: atm6124.sys. Refer to the document “USB Basic Application”, literature number 6123, for more details. 22.4.3.1 Enumeration Process The USB protocol is a master/slave protocol. This is the host that starts the enumeration sending requests to the device through the control endpoint. The device handles standard requests as defined in the USB Specification. Table 22-2. Handled Standard Requests Request Definition GET_DESCRIPTOR Returns the current device configuration value. SET_ADDRESS Sets the device address for all future device access. SET_CONFIGURATION Sets the device configuration. GET_CONFIGURATION Returns the current device configuration value. GET_STATUS Returns status for the specified recipient. SET_FEATURE Used to set or enable a specific feature. CLEAR_FEATURE Used to clear or disable a specific feature. The device also handles some class requests defined in the CDC class. Table 22-3. Handled Class Requests Request Definition SET_LINE_CODING Configures DTE rate, stop bits, parity and number of character bits. GET_LINE_CODING Requests current DTE rate, stop bits, parity and number of character bits. SET_CONTROL_LINE_STATE RS-232 signal used to tell the DCE device the DTE device is now present. Unhandled requests are STALLed. 22.4.3.2 Communication Endpoints There are two communication endpoints and endpoint 0 is used for the enumeration process. Endpoint 1 is a 64-byte Bulk OUT endpoint and endpoint 2 is a 64-byte Bulk IN endpoint. SAMBA Boot commands are sent by the host through the endpoint 1. If required, the message is split by the host into several data payloads by the host driver. If the command requires a response, the host can send IN transactions to pick up the response. 167 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 22.5 Hardware and Software Constraints • SAM-BA boot copies itself in the SRAM and uses a block of internal SRAM for variables and stacks. The remaining available size for the user code is 122880 bytes for AT91SAM7XC512, 57344 bytes for AT91SAM7XC256 and 24576 bytes for AT91SAM7XC128. • USB requirements: – pull-up on DDP – 18.432 MHz Quartz Table 22-4. Device Start Address End Address Size (bytes) AT91SAM7XC512 0x202000 0x220000 122880 AT91SAM7XC256 0x202000 0x210000 57344 AT91SAM7XC128 0x202000 0x208000 24576 Table 22-5. 168 User Area Addresses Pins Driven during Boot Program Execution Peripheral Pin PIO Line DBGU DRXD PA27 DBGU DTXD PA28 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 23. Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) 23.1 Overview The Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) transfers data between on-chip serial peripherals such as the UART, USART, SSC, SPI, MCI and the on- and off-chip memories. Using the Peripheral DMA Controller avoids processor intervention and removes the processor interrupt-handling overhead. This significantly reduces the number of clock cycles required for a data transfer and, as a result, improves the performance of the microcontroller and makes it more power efficient. The PDC channels are implemented in pairs, each pair being dedicated to a particular peripheral. One channel in the pair is dedicated to the receiving channel and one to the transmitting channel of each UART, USART, SSC and SPI. The user interface of a PDC channel is integrated in the memory space of each peripheral. It contains: • A 32-bit memory pointer register • A 16-bit transfer count register • A 32-bit register for next memory pointer • A 16-bit register for next transfer count The peripheral triggers PDC transfers using transmit and receive signals. When the programmed data is transferred, an end of transfer interrupt is generated by the corresponding peripheral. 23.2 Block Diagram Figure 23-1. Block Diagram Peripheral Peripheral DMA Controller THR PDC Channel 0 RHR PDC Channel 1 Control Control Memory Controller Status & Control 169 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 23.3 23.3.1 Functional Description Configuration The PDC channels user interface enables the user to configure and control the data transfers for each channel. The user interface of a PDC channel is integrated into the user interface of the peripheral (offset 0x100), which it is related to. Per peripheral, it contains four 32-bit Pointer Registers (RPR, RNPR, TPR, and TNPR) and four 16-bit Counter Registers (RCR, RNCR, TCR, and TNCR). The size of the buffer (number of transfers) is configured in an internal 16-bit transfer counter register, and it is possible, at any moment, to read the number of transfers left for each channel. The memory base address is configured in a 32-bit memory pointer by defining the location of the first address to access in the memory. It is possible, at any moment, to read the location in memory of the next transfer and the number of remaining transfers. The PDC has dedicated status registers which indicate if the transfer is enabled or disabled for each channel. The status for each channel is located in the peripheral status register. Transfers can be enabled and/or disabled by setting TXTEN/TXTDIS and RXTEN/RXTDIS in PDC Transfer Control Register. These control bits enable reading the pointer and counter registers safely without any risk of their changing between both reads. The PDC sends status flags to the peripheral visible in its status-register (ENDRX, ENDTX, RXBUFF, and TXBUFE). ENDRX flag is set when the PERIPH_RCR register reaches zero. RXBUFF flag is set when both PERIPH_RCR and PERIPH_RNCR reach zero. ENDTX flag is set when the PERIPH_TCR register reaches zero. TXBUFE flag is set when both PERIPH_TCR and PERIPH_TNCR reach zero. These status flags are described in the peripheral status register. 23.3.2 Memory Pointers Each peripheral is connected to the PDC by a receiver data channel and a transmitter data channel. Each channel has an internal 32-bit memory pointer. Each memory pointer points to a location anywhere in the memory space (on-chip memory or external bus interface memory). Depending on the type of transfer (byte, half-word or word), the memory pointer is incremented by 1, 2 or 4, respectively for peripheral transfers. If a memory pointer is reprogrammed while the PDC is in operation, the transfer address is changed, and the PDC performs transfers using the new address. 23.3.3 Transfer Counters There is one internal 16-bit transfer counter for each channel used to count the size of the block already transferred by its associated channel. These counters are decremented after each data transfer. When the counter reaches zero, the transfer is complete and the PDC stops transferring data. If the Next Counter Register is equal to zero, the PDC disables the trigger while activating the related peripheral end flag. If the counter is reprogrammed while the PDC is operating, the number of transfers is updated and the PDC counts transfers from the new value. 170 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Programming the Next Counter/Pointer registers chains the buffers. The counters are decremented after each data transfer as stated above, but when the transfer counter reaches zero, the values of the Next Counter/Pointer are loaded into the Counter/Pointer registers in order to re-enable the triggers. For each channel, two status bits indicate the end of the current buffer (ENDRX, ENTX) and the end of both current and next buffer (RXBUFF, TXBUFE). These bits are directly mapped to the peripheral status register and can trigger an interrupt request to the AIC. The peripheral end flag is automatically cleared when one of the counter-registers (Counter or Next Counter Register) is written. Note: When the Next Counter Register is loaded into the Counter Register, it is set to zero. 23.3.4 Data Transfers The peripheral triggers PDC transfers using transmit (TXRDY) and receive (RXRDY) signals. When the peripheral receives an external character, it sends a Receive Ready signal to the PDC which then requests access to the system bus. When access is granted, the PDC starts a read of the peripheral Receive Holding Register (RHR) and then triggers a write in the memory. After each transfer, the relevant PDC memory pointer is incremented and the number of transfers left is decremented. When the memory block size is reached, a signal is sent to the peripheral and the transfer stops. The same procedure is followed, in reverse, for transmit transfers. 23.3.5 Priority of PDC Transfer Requests The Peripheral DMA Controller handles transfer requests from the channel according to priorities fixed for each product.These priorities are defined in the product datasheet. If simultaneous requests of the same type (receiver or transmitter) occur on identical peripherals, the priority is determined by the numbering of the peripherals. If transfer requests are not simultaneous, they are treated in the order they occurred. Requests from the receivers are handled first and then followed by transmitter requests. 171 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 23.4 Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) User Interface Table 23-1. Offset Register Mapping Register Name (1) Access Reset 0x100 Receive Pointer Register PERIPH _RPR Read-write 0x0 0x104 Receive Counter Register PERIPH_RCR Read-write 0x0 0x108 Transmit Pointer Register PERIPH_TPR Read-write 0x0 0x10C Transmit Counter Register PERIPH_TCR Read-write 0x0 0x110 Receive Next Pointer Register PERIPH_RNPR Read-write 0x0 0x114 Receive Next Counter Register PERIPH_RNCR Read-write 0x0 0x118 Transmit Next Pointer Register PERIPH_TNPR Read-write 0x0 0x11C Transmit Next Counter Register PERIPH_TNCR Read-write 0x0 0x120 PDC Transfer Control Register PERIPH_PTCR Write-only - 0x124 PDC Transfer Status Register PERIPH_PTSR Read-only 0x0 Note: 172 1. PERIPH: Ten registers are mapped in the peripheral memory space at the same offset. These can be defined by the user according to the function and the peripheral desired (DBGU, USART, SSC, SPI, MCI, etc.). AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 23.4.1 PDC Receive Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_RPR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RXPTR 23 22 21 20 RXPTR 15 14 13 12 RXPTR 7 6 5 4 RXPTR • RXPTR: Receive Pointer Address Address of the next receive transfer. 23.4.2 PDC Receive Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_RCR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 -23 22 21 20 -15 14 13 12 RXCTR 7 6 5 4 RXCTR • RXCTR: Receive Counter Value Number of receive transfers to be performed. 173 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 23.4.3 PDC Transmit Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_TPR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TXPTR 23 22 21 20 TXPTR 15 14 13 12 TXPTR 7 6 5 4 TXPTR • TXPTR: Transmit Pointer Address Address of the transmit buffer. 23.4.4 PDC Transmit Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_TCR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 -23 22 21 20 -15 14 13 12 TXCTR 7 6 5 4 TXCTR • TXCTR: Transmit Counter Value TXCTR is the size of the transmit transfer to be performed. At zero, the peripheral DMA transfer is stopped. 174 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 23.4.5 PDC Receive Next Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_RNPR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RXNPTR 23 22 21 20 RXNPTR 15 14 13 12 RXNPTR 7 6 5 4 RXNPTR • RXNPTR: Receive Next Pointer Address RXNPTR is the address of the next buffer to fill with received data when the current buffer is full. 23.4.6 PDC Receive Next Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_RNCR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 -23 22 21 20 -15 14 13 12 RXNCR 7 6 5 4 RXNCR • RXNCR: Receive Next Counter Value RXNCR is the size of the next buffer to receive. 175 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 23.4.7 PDC Transmit Next Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_TNPR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TXNPTR 23 22 21 20 TXNPTR 15 14 13 12 TXNPTR 7 6 5 4 TXNPTR • TXNPTR: Transmit Next Pointer Address TXNPTR is the address of the next buffer to transmit when the current buffer is empty. 23.4.8 PDC Transmit Next Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_TNCR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 -23 22 21 20 -15 14 13 12 TXNCR 7 6 5 4 TXNCR • TXNCR: Transmit Next Counter Value TXNCR is the size of the next buffer to transmit. 176 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 23.4.9 PDC Transfer Control Register Register Name: PERIPH_PTCR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – TXTDIS TXTEN 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – RXTDIS RXTEN • RXTEN: Receiver Transfer Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the receiver PDC transfer requests if RXTDIS is not set. • RXTDIS: Receiver Transfer Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the receiver PDC transfer requests. • TXTEN: Transmitter Transfer Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the transmitter PDC transfer requests. • TXTDIS: Transmitter Transfer Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the transmitter PDC transfer requests 177 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 23.4.10 PDC Transfer Status Register Register Name: PERIPH_PTSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – TXTEN 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – RXTEN • RXTEN: Receiver Transfer Enable 0 = Receiver PDC transfer requests are disabled. 1 = Receiver PDC transfer requests are enabled. • TXTEN: Transmitter Transfer Enable 0 = Transmitter PDC transfer requests are disabled. 1 = Transmitter PDC transfer requests are enabled. 178 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24. Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) 24.1 Overview The Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) is an 8-level priority, individually maskable, vectored interrupt controller, providing handling of up to thirty-two interrupt sources. It is designed to substantially reduce the software and real-time overhead in handling internal and external interrupts. The AIC drives the nFIQ (fast interrupt request) and the nIRQ (standard interrupt request) inputs of an ARM processor. Inputs of the AIC are either internal peripheral interrupts or external interrupts coming from the product's pins. The 8-level Priority Controller allows the user to define the priority for each interrupt source, thus permitting higher priority interrupts to be serviced even if a lower priority interrupt is being treated. Internal interrupt sources can be programmed to be level sensitive or edge triggered. External interrupt sources can be programmed to be positive-edge or negative-edge triggered or highlevel or low-level sensitive. The fast forcing feature redirects any internal or external interrupt source to provide a fast interrupt rather than a normal interrupt. 24.2 Block Diagram Figure 24-1. Block Diagram FIQ IRQ0-IRQn Embedded PeripheralEE Embedded AIC ARM Processor Up to Thirty-two Sources nFIQ nIRQ Peripheral Embedded Peripheral APB 179 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.3 Application Block Diagram Figure 24-2. Description of the Application Block OS-based Applications Standalone Applications OS Drivers RTOS Drivers Hard Real Time Tasks General OS Interrupt Handler Advanced Interrupt Controller External Peripherals (External Interrupts) Embedded Peripherals 24.4 AIC Detailed Block Diagram Figure 24-3. AIC Detailed Block Diagram Advanced Interrupt Controller FIQ PIO Controller Fast Interrupt Controller External Source Input Stage ARM Processor nFIQ nIRQ IRQ0-IRQn Embedded Peripherals Interrupt Priority Controller Fast Forcing PIOIRQ Internal Source Input Stage Processor Clock Power Management Controller User Interface Wake Up APB 24.5 I/O Line Description Table 24-1. I/O Line Description Pin Name Pin Description Type FIQ Fast Interrupt Input IRQ0 - IRQn Interrupt 0 - Interrupt n Input 180 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.6 24.6.1 Product Dependencies I/O Lines The interrupt signals FIQ and IRQ0 to IRQn are normally multiplexed through the PIO controllers. Depending on the features of the PIO controller used in the product, the pins must be programmed in accordance with their assigned interrupt function. This is not applicable when the PIO controller used in the product is transparent on the input path. 24.6.2 Power Management The Advanced Interrupt Controller is continuously clocked. The Power Management Controller has no effect on the Advanced Interrupt Controller behavior. The assertion of the Advanced Interrupt Controller outputs, either nIRQ or nFIQ, wakes up the ARM processor while it is in Idle Mode. The General Interrupt Mask feature enables the AIC to wake up the processor without asserting the interrupt line of the processor, thus providing synchronization of the processor on an event. 24.6.3 Interrupt Sources The Interrupt Source 0 is always located at FIQ. If the product does not feature an FIQ pin, the Interrupt Source 0 cannot be used. The Interrupt Source 1 is always located at System Interrupt. This is the result of the OR-wiring of the system peripheral interrupt lines, such as the System Timer, the Real Time Clock, the Power Management Controller and the Memory Controller. When a system interrupt occurs, the service routine must first distinguish the cause of the interrupt. This is performed by reading successively the status registers of the above mentioned system peripherals. The interrupt sources 2 to 31 can either be connected to the interrupt outputs of an embedded user peripheral or to external interrupt lines. The external interrupt lines can be connected directly, or through the PIO Controller. The PIO Controllers are considered as user peripherals in the scope of interrupt handling. Accordingly, the PIO Controller interrupt lines are connected to the Interrupt Sources 2 to 31. The peripheral identification defined at the product level corresponds to the interrupt source number (as well as the bit number controlling the clock of the peripheral). Consequently, to simplify the description of the functional operations and the user interface, the interrupt sources are named FIQ, SYS, and PID2 to PID31. 181 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.7 Functional Description 24.7.1 24.7.1.1 Interrupt Source Control Interrupt Source Mode The Advanced Interrupt Controller independently programs each interrupt source. The SRCTYPE field of the corresponding AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register) selects the interrupt condition of each source. The internal interrupt sources wired on the interrupt outputs of the embedded peripherals can be programmed either in level-sensitive mode or in edge-triggered mode. The active level of the internal interrupts is not important for the user. The external interrupt sources can be programmed either in high level-sensitive or low level-sensitive modes, or in positive edge-triggered or negative edge-triggered modes. 24.7.1.2 Interrupt Source Enabling Each interrupt source, including the FIQ in source 0, can be enabled or disabled by using the command registers; AIC_IECR (Interrupt Enable Command Register) and AIC_IDCR (Interrupt Disable Command Register). This set of registers conducts enabling or disabling in one instruction. The interrupt mask can be read in the AIC_IMR register. A disabled interrupt does not affect servicing of other interrupts. 24.7.1.3 Interrupt Clearing and Setting All interrupt sources programmed to be edge-triggered (including the FIQ in source 0) can be individually set or cleared by writing respectively the AIC_ISCR and AIC_ICCR registers. Clearing or setting interrupt sources programmed in level-sensitive mode has no effect. The clear operation is perfunctory, as the software must perform an action to reinitialize the “memorization” circuitry activated when the source is programmed in edge-triggered mode. However, the set operation is available for auto-test or software debug purposes. It can also be used to execute an AIC-implementation of a software interrupt. The AIC features an automatic clear of the current interrupt when the AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register) is read. Only the interrupt source being detected by the AIC as the current interrupt is affected by this operation. (See “Priority Controller” on page 186.) The automatic clear reduces the operations required by the interrupt service routine entry code to reading the AIC_IVR. Note that the automatic interrupt clear is disabled if the interrupt source has the Fast Forcing feature enabled as it is considered uniquely as a FIQ source. (For further details, See “Fast Forcing” on page 190.) The automatic clear of the interrupt source 0 is performed when AIC_FVR is read. 24.7.1.4 Interrupt Status For each interrupt, the AIC operation originates in AIC_IPR (Interrupt Pending Register) and its mask in AIC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register). AIC_IPR enables the actual activity of the sources, whether masked or not. The AIC_ISR register reads the number of the current interrupt (see “Priority Controller” on page 186) and the register AIC_CISR gives an image of the signals nIRQ and nFIQ driven on the processor. Each status referred to above can be used to optimize the interrupt handling of the systems. 182 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.7.1.5 Internal Interrupt Source Input Stage Figure 24-4. Internal Interrupt Source Input Stage AIC_SMRI (SRCTYPE) Level/ Edge Source i AIC_IPR AIC_IMR Fast Interrupt Controller or Priority Controller Edge AIC_IECR Detector Set Clear FF AIC_ISCR AIC_ICCR AIC_IDCR 24.7.1.6 External Interrupt Source Input Stage Figure 24-5. External Interrupt Source Input Stage High/Low AIC_SMRi SRCTYPE Level/ Edge AIC_IPR AIC_IMR Source i Fast Interrupt Controller or Priority Controller AIC_IECR Pos./Neg. Edge Detector Set AIC_ISCR FF Clear AIC_IDCR AIC_ICCR 183 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.7.2 Interrupt Latencies Global interrupt latencies depend on several parameters, including: • The time the software masks the interrupts. • Occurrence, either at the processor level or at the AIC level. • The execution time of the instruction in progress when the interrupt occurs. • The treatment of higher priority interrupts and the resynchronization of the hardware signals. This section addresses only the hardware resynchronizations. It gives details of the latency times between the event on an external interrupt leading in a valid interrupt (edge or level) or the assertion of an internal interrupt source and the assertion of the nIRQ or nFIQ line on the processor. The resynchronization time depends on the programming of the interrupt source and on its type (internal or external). For the standard interrupt, resynchronization times are given assuming there is no higher priority in progress. The PIO Controller multiplexing has no effect on the interrupt latencies of the external interrupt sources. 24.7.2.1 External Interrupt Edge Triggered Source Figure 24-6. External Interrupt Edge Triggered Source MCK IRQ or FIQ (Positive Edge) IRQ or FIQ (Negative Edge) nIRQ Maximum IRQ Latency = 4 Cycles nFIQ Maximum FIQ Latency = 4 Cycles 184 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.7.2.2 External Interrupt Level Sensitive Source Figure 24-7. External Interrupt Level Sensitive Source MCK IRQ or FIQ (High Level) IRQ or FIQ (Low Level) nIRQ Maximum IRQ Latency = 3 Cycles nFIQ Maximum FIQ Latency = 3 cycles 24.7.2.3 Internal Interrupt Edge Triggered Source Figure 24-8. Internal Interrupt Edge Triggered Source MCK nIRQ Maximum IRQ Latency = 4.5 Cycles Peripheral Interrupt Becomes Active 24.7.2.4 Internal Interrupt Level Sensitive Source Figure 24-9. Internal Interrupt Level Sensitive Source MCK nIRQ Maximum IRQ Latency = 3.5 Cycles Peripheral Interrupt Becomes Active 185 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.7.3 24.7.3.1 Normal Interrupt Priority Controller An 8-level priority controller drives the nIRQ line of the processor, depending on the interrupt conditions occurring on the interrupt sources 1 to 31 (except for those programmed in Fast Forcing). Each interrupt source has a programmable priority level of 7 to 0, which is user-definable by writing the PRIOR field of the corresponding AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register). Level 7 is the highest priority and level 0 the lowest. As soon as an interrupt condition occurs, as defined by the SRCTYPE field of the AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register), the nIRQ line is asserted. As a new interrupt condition might have happened on other interrupt sources since the nIRQ has been asserted, the priority controller determines the current interrupt at the time the AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register) is read. The read of AIC_IVR is the entry point of the interrupt handling which allows the AIC to consider that the interrupt has been taken into account by the software. The current priority level is defined as the priority level of the current interrupt. If several interrupt sources of equal priority are pending and enabled when the AIC_IVR is read, the interrupt with the lowest interrupt source number is serviced first. The nIRQ line can be asserted only if an interrupt condition occurs on an interrupt source with a higher priority. If an interrupt condition happens (or is pending) during the interrupt treatment in progress, it is delayed until the software indicates to the AIC the end of the current service by writing the AIC_EOICR (End of Interrupt Command Register). The write of AIC_EOICR is the exit point of the interrupt handling. 24.7.3.2 Interrupt Nesting The priority controller utilizes interrupt nesting in order for the high priority interrupt to be handled during the service of lower priority interrupts. This requires the interrupt service routines of the lower interrupts to re-enable the interrupt at the processor level. When an interrupt of a higher priority happens during an already occurring interrupt service routine, the nIRQ line is re-asserted. If the interrupt is enabled at the core level, the current execution is interrupted and the new interrupt service routine should read the AIC_IVR. At this time, the current interrupt number and its priority level are pushed into an embedded hardware stack, so that they are saved and restored when the higher priority interrupt servicing is finished and the AIC_EOICR is written. The AIC is equipped with an 8-level wide hardware stack in order to support up to eight interrupt nestings pursuant to having eight priority levels. 24.7.3.3 Interrupt Vectoring The interrupt handler addresses corresponding to each interrupt source can be stored in the registers AIC_SVR1 to AIC_SVR31 (Source Vector Register 1 to 31). When the processor reads AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register), the value written into AIC_SVR corresponding to the current interrupt is returned. This feature offers a way to branch in one single instruction to the handler corresponding to the current interrupt, as AIC_IVR is mapped at the absolute address 0xFFFF F100 and thus accessible from the ARM interrupt vector at address 0x0000 0018 through the following instruction: LDR 186 PC,[PC,# -&F20] AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary When the processor executes this instruction, it loads the read value in AIC_IVR in its program counter, thus branching the execution on the correct interrupt handler. This feature is often not used when the application is based on an operating system (either real time or not). Operating systems often have a single entry point for all the interrupts and the first task performed is to discern the source of the interrupt. However, it is strongly recommended to port the operating system on AT91 products by supporting the interrupt vectoring. This can be performed by defining all the AIC_SVR of the interrupt source to be handled by the operating system at the address of its interrupt handler. When doing so, the interrupt vectoring permits a critical interrupt to transfer the execution on a specific very fast handler and not onto the operating system’s general interrupt handler. This facilitates the support of hard real-time tasks (input/outputs of voice/audio buffers and software peripheral handling) to be handled efficiently and independently of the application running under an operating system. 24.7.3.4 Interrupt Handlers This section gives an overview of the fast interrupt handling sequence when using the AIC. It is assumed that the programmer understands the architecture of the ARM processor, and especially the processor interrupt modes and the associated status bits. It is assumed that: 1. The Advanced Interrupt Controller has been programmed, AIC_SVR registers are loaded with corresponding interrupt service routine addresses and interrupts are enabled. 2. The instruction at the ARM interrupt exception vector address is required to work with the vectoring LDR PC, [PC, # -&F20] When nIRQ is asserted, if the bit “I” of CPSR is 0, the sequence is as follows: 1. The CPSR is stored in SPSR_irq, the current value of the Program Counter is loaded in the Interrupt link register (R14_irq) and the Program Counter (R15) is loaded with 0x18. In the following cycle during fetch at address 0x1C, the ARM core adjusts R14_irq, decrementing it by four. 2. The ARM core enters Interrupt mode, if it has not already done so. 3. When the instruction loaded at address 0x18 is executed, the program counter is loaded with the value read in AIC_IVR. Reading the AIC_IVR has the following effects: – Sets the current interrupt to be the pending and enabled interrupt with the highest priority. The current level is the priority level of the current interrupt. – De-asserts the nIRQ line on the processor. Even if vectoring is not used, AIC_IVR must be read in order to de-assert nIRQ. – Automatically clears the interrupt, if it has been programmed to be edge-triggered. – Pushes the current level and the current interrupt number on to the stack. – Returns the value written in the AIC_SVR corresponding to the current interrupt. 4. The previous step has the effect of branching to the corresponding interrupt service routine. This should start by saving the link register (R14_irq) and SPSR_IRQ. The link register must be decremented by four when it is saved if it is to be restored directly into the program counter at the end of the interrupt. For example, the instruction SUB PC, LR, #4 may be used. 187 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 5. Further interrupts can then be unmasked by clearing the “I” bit in CPSR, allowing reassertion of the nIRQ to be taken into account by the core. This can happen if an interrupt with a higher priority than the current interrupt occurs. 6. The interrupt handler can then proceed as required, saving the registers that will be used and restoring them at the end. During this phase, an interrupt of higher priority than the current level will restart the sequence from step 1. Note: If the interrupt is programmed to be level sensitive, the source of the interrupt must be cleared during this phase. 7. The “I” bit in CPSR must be set in order to mask interrupts before exiting to ensure that the interrupt is completed in an orderly manner. 8. The End of Interrupt Command Register (AIC_EOICR) must be written in order to indicate to the AIC that the current interrupt is finished. This causes the current level to be popped from the stack, restoring the previous current level if one exists on the stack. If another interrupt is pending, with lower or equal priority than the old current level but with higher priority than the new current level, the nIRQ line is re-asserted, but the interrupt sequence does not immediately start because the “I” bit is set in the core. SPSR_irq is restored. Finally, the saved value of the link register is restored directly into the PC. This has the effect of returning from the interrupt to whatever was being executed before, and of loading the CPSR with the stored SPSR, masking or unmasking the interrupts depending on the state saved in SPSR_irq. Note: 188 The “I” bit in SPSR is significant. If it is set, it indicates that the ARM core was on the verge of masking an interrupt when the mask instruction was interrupted. Hence, when SPSR is restored, the mask instruction is completed (interrupt is masked). AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.7.4 Fast Interrupt 24.7.4.1 Fast Interrupt Source The interrupt source 0 is the only source which can raise a fast interrupt request to the processor except if fast forcing is used. The interrupt source 0 is generally connected to a FIQ pin of the product, either directly or through a PIO Controller. 24.7.4.2 Fast Interrupt Control The fast interrupt logic of the AIC has no priority controller. The mode of interrupt source 0 is programmed with the AIC_SMR0 and the field PRIOR of this register is not used even if it reads what has been written. The field SRCTYPE of AIC_SMR0 enables programming the fast interrupt source to be positive-edge triggered or negative-edge triggered or high-level sensitive or low-level sensitive Writing 0x1 in the AIC_IECR (Interrupt Enable Command Register) and AIC_IDCR (Interrupt Disable Command Register) respectively enables and disables the fast interrupt. The bit 0 of AIC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register) indicates whether the fast interrupt is enabled or disabled. 24.7.4.3 Fast Interrupt Vectoring The fast interrupt handler address can be stored in AIC_SVR0 (Source Vector Register 0). The value written into this register is returned when the processor reads AIC_FVR (Fast Vector Register). This offers a way to branch in one single instruction to the interrupt handler, as AIC_FVR is mapped at the absolute address 0xFFFF F104 and thus accessible from the ARM fast interrupt vector at address 0x0000 001C through the following instruction: LDR PC,[PC,# -&F20] When the processor executes this instruction it loads the value read in AIC_FVR in its program counter, thus branching the execution on the fast interrupt handler. It also automatically performs the clear of the fast interrupt source if it is programmed in edge-triggered mode. 24.7.4.4 Fast Interrupt Handlers This section gives an overview of the fast interrupt handling sequence when using the AIC. It is assumed that the programmer understands the architecture of the ARM processor, and especially the processor interrupt modes and associated status bits. Assuming that: 1. The Advanced Interrupt Controller has been programmed, AIC_SVR0 is loaded with the fast interrupt service routine address, and the interrupt source 0 is enabled. 2. The Instruction at address 0x1C (FIQ exception vector address) is required to vector the fast interrupt: LDR PC, [PC, # -&F20] 3. The user does not need nested fast interrupts. When nFIQ is asserted, if the bit “F” of CPSR is 0, the sequence is: 1. The CPSR is stored in SPSR_fiq, the current value of the program counter is loaded in the FIQ link register (R14_FIQ) and the program counter (R15) is loaded with 0x1C. In the following cycle, during fetch at address 0x20, the ARM core adjusts R14_fiq, decrementing it by four. 2. The ARM core enters FIQ mode. 3. When the instruction loaded at address 0x1C is executed, the program counter is loaded with the value read in AIC_FVR. Reading the AIC_FVR has effect of automati- 189 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 cally clearing the fast interrupt, if it has been programmed to be edge triggered. In this case only, it de-asserts the nFIQ line on the processor. 4. The previous step enables branching to the corresponding interrupt service routine. It is not necessary to save the link register R14_fiq and SPSR_fiq if nested fast interrupts are not needed. 5. The Interrupt Handler can then proceed as required. It is not necessary to save registers R8 to R13 because FIQ mode has its own dedicated registers and the user R8 to R13 are banked. The other registers, R0 to R7, must be saved before being used, and restored at the end (before the next step). Note that if the fast interrupt is programmed to be level sensitive, the source of the interrupt must be cleared during this phase in order to de-assert the interrupt source 0. 6. Finally, the Link Register R14_fiq is restored into the PC after decrementing it by four (with instruction SUB PC, LR, #4 for example). This has the effect of returning from the interrupt to whatever was being executed before, loading the CPSR with the SPSR and masking or unmasking the fast interrupt depending on the state saved in the SPSR. Note: The “F” bit in SPSR is significant. If it is set, it indicates that the ARM core was just about to mask FIQ interrupts when the mask instruction was interrupted. Hence when the SPSR is restored, the interrupted instruction is completed (FIQ is masked). Another way to handle the fast interrupt is to map the interrupt service routine at the address of the ARM vector 0x1C. This method does not use the vectoring, so that reading AIC_FVR must be performed at the very beginning of the handler operation. However, this method saves the execution of a branch instruction. 24.7.4.5 Fast Forcing The Fast Forcing feature of the advanced interrupt controller provides redirection of any normal Interrupt source on the fast interrupt controller. Fast Forcing is enabled or disabled by writing to the Fast Forcing Enable Register (AIC_FFER) and the Fast Forcing Disable Register (AIC_FFDR). Writing to these registers results in an update of the Fast Forcing Status Register (AIC_FFSR) that controls the feature for each internal or external interrupt source. When Fast Forcing is disabled, the interrupt sources are handled as described in the previous pages. When Fast Forcing is enabled, the edge/level programming and, in certain cases, edge detection of the interrupt source is still active but the source cannot trigger a normal interrupt to the processor and is not seen by the priority handler. If the interrupt source is programmed in level-sensitive mode and an active level is sampled, Fast Forcing results in the assertion of the nFIQ line to the core. If the interrupt source is programmed in edge-triggered mode and an active edge is detected, Fast Forcing results in the assertion of the nFIQ line to the core. The Fast Forcing feature does not affect the Source 0 pending bit in the Interrupt Pending Register (AIC_IPR). The FIQ Vector Register (AIC_FVR) reads the contents of the Source Vector Register 0 (AIC_SVR0), whatever the source of the fast interrupt may be. The read of the FVR does not clear the Source 0 when the fast forcing feature is used and the interrupt source should be cleared by writing to the Interrupt Clear Command Register (AIC_ICCR). 190 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary All enabled and pending interrupt sources that have the fast forcing feature enabled and that are programmed in edge-triggered mode must be cleared by writing to the Interrupt Clear Command Register. In doing so, they are cleared independently and thus lost interrupts are prevented. The read of AIC_IVR does not clear the source that has the fast forcing feature enabled. The source 0, reserved to the fast interrupt, continues operating normally and becomes one of the Fast Interrupt sources. Figure 24-10. Fast Forcing Source 0 _ FIQ AIC_IPR Input Stage Automatic Clear AIC_IMR nFIQ Read FVR if Fast Forcing is disabled on Sources 1 to 31. AIC_FFSR Source n AIC_IPR Input Stage Priority Manager Automatic Clear AIC_IMR nIRQ Read IVR if Source n is the current interrupt and if Fast Forcing is disabled on Source n. 191 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.7.5 Protect Mode The Protect Mode permits reading the Interrupt Vector Register without performing the associated automatic operations. This is necessary when working with a debug system. When a debugger, working either with a Debug Monitor or the ARM processor's ICE, stops the applications and updates the opened windows, it might read the AIC User Interface and thus the IVR. This has undesirable consequences: • If an enabled interrupt with a higher priority than the current one is pending, it is stacked. • If there is no enabled pending interrupt, the spurious vector is returned. In either case, an End of Interrupt command is necessary to acknowledge and to restore the context of the AIC. This operation is generally not performed by the debug system as the debug system would become strongly intrusive and cause the application to enter an undesired state. This is avoided by using the Protect Mode. Writing PROT in AIC_DCR (Debug Control Register) at 0x1 enables the Protect Mode. When the Protect Mode is enabled, the AIC performs interrupt stacking only when a write access is performed on the AIC_IVR. Therefore, the Interrupt Service Routines must write (arbitrary data) to the AIC_IVR just after reading it. The new context of the AIC, including the value of the Interrupt Status Register (AIC_ISR), is updated with the current interrupt only when AIC_IVR is written. An AIC_IVR read on its own (e.g., by a debugger), modifies neither the AIC context nor the AIC_ISR. Extra AIC_IVR reads perform the same operations. However, it is recommended to not stop the processor between the read and the write of AIC_IVR of the interrupt service routine to make sure the debugger does not modify the AIC context. To summarize, in normal operating mode, the read of AIC_IVR performs the following operations within the AIC: 1. Calculates active interrupt (higher than current or spurious). 2. Determines and returns the vector of the active interrupt. 3. Memorizes the interrupt. 4. Pushes the current priority level onto the internal stack. 5. Acknowledges the interrupt. However, while the Protect Mode is activated, only operations 1 to 3 are performed when AIC_IVR is read. Operations 4 and 5 are only performed by the AIC when AIC_IVR is written. Software that has been written and debugged using the Protect Mode runs correctly in Normal Mode without modification. However, in Normal Mode the AIC_IVR write has no effect and can be removed to optimize the code. 24.7.6 Spurious Interrupt The Advanced Interrupt Controller features protection against spurious interrupts. A spurious interrupt is defined as being the assertion of an interrupt source long enough for the AIC to assert the nIRQ, but no longer present when AIC_IVR is read. This is most prone to occur when: • An external interrupt source is programmed in level-sensitive mode and an active level occurs for only a short time. 192 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • An internal interrupt source is programmed in level sensitive and the output signal of the corresponding embedded peripheral is activated for a short time. (As in the case for the Watchdog.) • An interrupt occurs just a few cycles before the software begins to mask it, thus resulting in a pulse on the interrupt source. The AIC detects a spurious interrupt at the time the AIC_IVR is read while no enabled interrupt source is pending. When this happens, the AIC returns the value stored by the programmer in AIC_SPU (Spurious Vector Register). The programmer must store the address of a spurious interrupt handler in AIC_SPU as part of the application, to enable an as fast as possible return to the normal execution flow. This handler writes in AIC_EOICR and performs a return from interrupt. 24.7.7 General Interrupt Mask The AIC features a General Interrupt Mask bit to prevent interrupts from reaching the processor. Both the nIRQ and the nFIQ lines are driven to their inactive state if the bit GMSK in AIC_DCR (Debug Control Register) is set. However, this mask does not prevent waking up the processor if it has entered Idle Mode. This function facilitates synchronizing the processor on a next event and, as soon as the event occurs, performs subsequent operations without having to handle an interrupt. It is strongly recommended to use this mask with caution. 193 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.8 Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface 24.8.1 Base Address The AIC is mapped at the address 0xFFFF F000. It has a total 4-Kbyte addressing space. This permits the vectoring feature, as the PC-relative load/store instructions of the ARM processor support only an ± 4-Kbyte offset. 24.8.2 Register Mapping Table 24-2. Offset Register Mapping Register Name Access Reset 0000 Source Mode Register 0 AIC_SMR0 Read-write 0x0 0x04 Source Mode Register 1 AIC_SMR1 Read-write 0x0 --- --- --- 0x7C --- --Source Mode Register 31 AIC_SMR31 Read-write 0x0 0x80 Source Vector Register 0 AIC_SVR0 Read-write 0x0 0x84 Source Vector Register 1 AIC_SVR1 Read-write 0x0 --- --- --- --- --- AIC_SVR31 Read-write 0x0 Interrupt Vector Register AIC_IVR Read-only 0x0 0x104 FIQ Interrupt Vector Register AIC_FVR Read-only 0x0 0xFC Source Vector Register 31 0x100 0x108 Interrupt Status Register AIC_ISR Read-only 0x0 0x10C Interrupt Pending Register(2) AIC_IPR Read-only 0x0(1) 0x110 Interrupt Mask Register(2) AIC_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x114 Core Interrupt Status Register AIC_CISR Read-only 0x0 0x118 Reserved --- --- --- 0x11C Reserved --- --- --- 0x120 Interrupt Enable Command Register(2) AIC_IECR Write-only --- 0x124 Interrupt Disable Command Register (2) AIC_IDCR Write-only --- 0x128 (2) Interrupt Clear Command Register AIC_ICCR Write-only --- 0x12C (2) Interrupt Set Command Register AIC_ISCR Write-only --- 0x130 End of Interrupt Command Register AIC_EOICR Write-only --- 0x134 Spurious Interrupt Vector Register AIC_SPU Read-write 0x0 0x138 Debug Control Register AIC_DCR Read-write 0x0 0x13C Reserved --- --- --- (2) AIC_FFER Write-only --- (2) AIC_FFDR Write-only --- AIC_FFSR Read-only 0x0 0x140 0x144 0x148 Notes: Fast Forcing Enable Register Fast Forcing Disable Register Fast Forcing Status Register (2) 1. The reset value of this register depends on the level of the external interrupt source. All other sources are cleared at reset, thus not pending. 2. PID2...PID31 bit fields refer to the identifiers as defined in the Peripheral Identifiers Section of the product datasheet. 194 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.8.3 AIC Source Mode Register Register Name: AIC_SMR0..AIC_SMR31 Access Type: Read-write Reset Value: 0x0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – SRCTYPE PRIOR • PRIOR: Priority Level Programs the priority level for all sources except FIQ source (source 0). The priority level can be between 0 (lowest) and 7 (highest). The priority level is not used for the FIQ in the related SMR register AIC_SMRx. • SRCTYPE: Interrupt Source Type The active level or edge is not programmable for the internal interrupt sources. SRCTYPE Internal Interrupt Sources External Interrupt Sources 0 0 High level Sensitive Low level Sensitive 0 1 Positive edge triggered Negative edge triggered 1 0 High level Sensitive High level Sensitive 1 1 Positive edge triggered Positive edge triggered 195 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.8.4 AIC Source Vector Register Register Name: AIC_SVR0..AIC_SVR31 Access Type: Read-write Reset Value: 0x0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 VECTOR 23 22 21 20 VECTOR 15 14 13 12 VECTOR 7 6 5 4 VECTOR • VECTOR: Source Vector The user may store in these registers the addresses of the corresponding handler for each interrupt source. 24.8.5 AIC Interrupt Vector Register Register Name: AIC_IVR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 IRQV 23 22 21 20 IRQV 15 14 13 12 IRQV 7 6 5 4 IRQV • IRQV: Interrupt Vector Register The Interrupt Vector Register contains the vector programmed by the user in the Source Vector Register corresponding to the current interrupt. The Source Vector Register is indexed using the current interrupt number when the Interrupt Vector Register is read. When there is no current interrupt, the Interrupt Vector Register reads the value stored in AIC_SPU. 196 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.8.6 AIC FIQ Vector Register Register Name: AIC_FVR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 FIQV 23 22 21 20 FIQV 15 14 13 12 FIQV 7 6 5 4 FIQV • FIQV: FIQ Vector Register The FIQ Vector Register contains the vector programmed by the user in the Source Vector Register 0. When there is no fast interrupt, the FIQ Vector Register reads the value stored in AIC_SPU. 24.8.7 AIC Interrupt Status Register Register Name: AIC_ISR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – IRQID • IRQID: Current Interrupt Identifier The Interrupt Status Register returns the current interrupt source number. 197 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.8.8 AIC Interrupt Pending Register Register Name: AIC_IPR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS FIQ • FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Pending 0 = Corresponding interrupt is not pending. 1 = Corresponding interrupt is pending. 24.8.9 AIC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: AIC_IMR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS FIQ • FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Mask 0 = Corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = Corresponding interrupt is enabled. 198 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.8.10 AIC Core Interrupt Status Register Register Name: AIC_CISR Access Type: Read-only Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – NIRQ NIFQ • NFIQ: NFIQ Status 0 = nFIQ line is deactivated. 1 = nFIQ line is active. • NIRQ: NIRQ Status 0 = nIRQ line is deactivated. 1 = nIRQ line is active. 24.8.11 AIC Interrupt Enable Command Register Register Name: AIC_IECR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS FIQ • FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID3: Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables corresponding interrupt. 199 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.8.12 AIC Interrupt Disable Command Register Register Name: AIC_IDCR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS FIQ • FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables corresponding interrupt. 24.8.13 AIC Interrupt Clear Command Register Register Name: AIC_ICCR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS FIQ • FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding interrupt. 200 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.8.14 AIC Interrupt Set Command Register Register Name: AIC_ISCR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS FIQ • FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Set 0 = No effect. 1 = Sets corresponding interrupt. 24.8.15 AIC End of Interrupt Command Register Register Name: AIC_EOICR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – – The End of Interrupt Command Register is used by the interrupt routine to indicate that the interrupt treatment is complete. Any value can be written because it is only necessary to make a write to this register location to signal the end of interrupt treatment. 201 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.8.16 AIC Spurious Interrupt Vector Register Register Name: AIC_SPU Access Type: Read-write Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 SIVR 23 22 21 20 SIVR 15 14 13 12 SIVR 7 6 5 4 SIVR • SIVR: Spurious Interrupt Vector Register The user may store the address of a spurious interrupt handler in this register. The written value is returned in AIC_IVR in case of a spurious interrupt and in AIC_FVR in case of a spurious fast interrupt. 24.8.17 AIC Debug Control Register Register Name: AIC_DEBUG Access Type: Read-write Reset Value: 0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – GMSK PROT • PROT: Protection Mode 0 = The Protection Mode is disabled. 1 = The Protection Mode is enabled. • GMSK: General Mask 0 = The nIRQ and nFIQ lines are normally controlled by the AIC. 1 = The nIRQ and nFIQ lines are tied to their inactive state. 202 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 24.8.18 AIC Fast Forcing Enable Register Register Name: AIC_FFER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS – • SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the fast forcing feature on the corresponding interrupt. 24.8.19 AIC Fast Forcing Disable Register Register Name: AIC_FFDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS – • SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Fast Forcing feature on the corresponding interrupt. 203 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 24.8.20 AIC Fast Forcing Status Register Register Name: AIC_FFSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 SYS – • SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Status 0 = The Fast Forcing feature is disabled on the corresponding interrupt. 1 = The Fast Forcing feature is enabled on the corresponding interrupt. 204 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 25. Clock Generator 25.1 Overview The Clock Generator is made up of 1 PLL, a Main Oscillator, as well as an RC Oscillator . It provides the following clocks: • SLCK, the Slow Clock, which is the only permanent clock within the system • MAINCK is the output of the Main Oscillator • PLLCK is the output of the Divider and PLL block The Clock Generator User Interface is embedded within the Power Management Controller one and is described in Section 26.9. However, the Clock Generator registers are named CKGR_. 25.2 Slow Clock RC Oscillator The user has to take into account the possible drifts of the RC Oscillator. More details are given in the section “DC Characteristics” of the product datasheet. 25.3 Main Oscillator Figure 25-1 shows the Main Oscillator block diagram. Figure 25-1. Main Oscillator Block Diagram MOSCEN XIN Main Oscillator XOUT MAINCK Main Clock OSCOUNT SLCK Slow Clock Main Oscillator Counter Main Clock Frequency Counter 25.3.1 MOSCS MAINF MAINRDY Main Oscillator Connections The Clock Generator integrates a Main Oscillator that is designed for a 3 to 20 MHz fundamental crystal. The typical crystal connection is illustrated in Figure 25-2. For further details on the electrical characteristics of the Main Oscillator, see the section “DC Characteristics” of the product datasheet. 205 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 25-2. Typical Crystal Connection AT91SAM7XC Microcontroller XIN XOUT GND 1K 25.3.2 Main Oscillator Startup Time The startup time of the Main Oscillator is given in the DC Characteristics section of the product datasheet. The startup time depends on the crystal frequency and decreases when the frequency rises. 25.3.3 Main Oscillator Control To minimize the power required to start up the system, the main oscillator is disabled after reset and slow clock is selected. The software enables or disables the main oscillator so as to reduce power consumption by clearing the MOSCEN bit in the Main Oscillator Register (CKGR_MOR). When disabling the main oscillator by clearing the MOSCEN bit in CKGR_MOR, the MOSCS bit in PMC_SR is automatically cleared, indicating the main clock is off. When enabling the main oscillator, the user must initiate the main oscillator counter with a value corresponding to the startup time of the oscillator. This startup time depends on the crystal frequency connected to the main oscillator. When the MOSCEN bit and the OSCOUNT are written in CKGR_MOR to enable the main oscillator, the MOSCS bit in PMC_SR (Status Register) is cleared and the counter starts counting down on the slow clock divided by 8 from the OSCOUNT value. Since the OSCOUNT value is coded with 8 bits, the maximum startup time is about 62 ms. When the counter reaches 0, the MOSCS bit is set, indicating that the main clock is valid. Setting the MOSCS bit in PMC_IMR can trigger an interrupt to the processor. 25.3.4 Main Clock Frequency Counter The Main Oscillator features a Main Clock frequency counter that provides the quartz frequency connected to the Main Oscillator. Generally, this value is known by the system designer; however, it is useful for the boot program to configure the device with the correct clock speed, independently of the application. The Main Clock frequency counter starts incrementing at the Main Clock speed after the next rising edge of the Slow Clock as soon as the Main Oscillator is stable, i.e., as soon as the MOSCS bit is set. Then, at the 16th falling edge of Slow Clock, the MAINRDY bit in CKGR_MCFR (Main Clock Frequency Register) is set and the counter stops counting. Its value can be read in the MAINF field of CKGR_MCFR and gives the number of Main Clock cycles during 16 periods of 206 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Slow Clock, so that the frequency of the crystal connected on the Main Oscillator can be determined. 25.3.5 25.4 Main Oscillator Bypass The user can input a clock on the device instead of connecting a crystal. In this case, the user has to provide the external clock signal on the XIN pin. The input characteristics of the XIN pin under these conditions are given in the product electrical characteristics section. The programmer has to be sure to set the OSCBYPASS bit to 1 and the MOSCEN bit to 0 in the Main OSC register (CKGR_MOR) for the external clock to operate properly. Divider and PLL Block The PLL embeds an input divider to increase the accuracy of the resulting clock signals. However, the user must respect the PLL minimum input frequency when programming the divider. Figure 25-3 shows the block diagram of the divider and PLL block. Figure 25-3. Divider and PLL Block Diagram DIV Divider MAINCK OUT MUL PLLCK PLL PLLRC PLLCOUNT PLL Counter SLCK 25.4.1 LOCK PLL Filter The PLL requires connection to an external second-order filter through the PLLRC pin. Figure 25-4 shows a schematic of these filters. Figure 25-4. PLL Capacitors and Resistors PLLRC PLL R C2 C1 GND Values of R, C1 and C2 to be connected to the PLLRC pin must be calculated as a function of the PLL input frequency, the PLL output frequency and the phase margin. A trade-off has to be found between output signal overshoot and startup time. 207 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 25.4.2 Divider and Phase Lock Loop Programming The divider can be set between 1 and 255 in steps of 1. When a divider field (DIV) is set to 0, the output of the corresponding divider and the PLL output is a continuous signal at level 0. On reset, each DIV field is set to 0, thus the corresponding PLL input clock is set to 0. The PLL allows multiplication of the divider’s outputs. The PLL clock signal has a frequency that depends on the respective source signal frequency and on the parameters DIV and MUL. The factor applied to the source signal frequency is (MUL + 1)/DIV. When MUL is written to 0, the corresponding PLL is disabled and its power consumption is saved. Re-enabling the PLL can be performed by writing a value higher than 0 in the MUL field. Whenever the PLL is re-enabled or one of its parameters is changed, the LOCK bit in PMC_SR is automatically cleared. The values written in the PLLCOUNT field in CKGR_PLLR are loaded in the PLL counter. The PLL counter then decrements at the speed of the Slow Clock until it reaches 0. At this time, the LOCK bit is set in PMC_SR and can trigger an interrupt to the processor. The user has to load the number of Slow Clock cycles required to cover the PLL transient time into the PLLCOUNT field. The transient time depends on the PLL filter. The initial state of the PLL and its target frequency can be calculated using a specific tool provided by Atmel. 208 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26. Power Management Controller (PMC) 26.1 Overview The Power Management Controller (PMC) optimizes power consumption by controlling all system and user peripheral clocks. The PMC enables/disables the clock inputs to many of the peripherals and the ARM Processor. The Power Management Controller provides the following clocks: • MCK, the Master Clock, programmable from a few hundred Hz to the maximum operating frequency of the device. It is available to the modules running permanently, such as the AIC and the Memory Controller. • Processor Clock (PCK), switched off when entering processor in idle mode. • Peripheral Clocks, typically MCK, provided to the embedded peripherals (USART, SSC, SPI, TWI, TC, MCI, etc.) and independently controllable. In order to reduce the number of clock names in a product, the Peripheral Clocks are named MCK in the product datasheet. • UDP Clock (UDPCK), required by USB Device Port operations. • Programmable Clock Outputs can be selected from the clocks provided by the clock generator and driven on the PCKx pins. 26.2 Master Clock Controller The Master Clock Controller provides selection and division of the Master Clock (MCK). MCK is the clock provided to all the peripherals and the memory controller. The Master Clock is selected from one of the clocks provided by the Clock Generator. Selecting the Slow Clock provides a Slow Clock signal to the whole device. Selecting the Main Clock saves power consumption of the PLL. The Master Clock Controller is made up of a clock selector and a prescaler. The Master Clock selection is made by writing the CSS field (Clock Source Selection) in PMC_MCKR (Master Clock Register). The prescaler supports the division by a power of 2 of the selected clock between 1 and 64. The PRES field in PMC_MCKR programs the prescaler. Each time PMC_MCKR is written to define a new Master Clock, the MCKRDY bit is cleared in PMC_SR. It reads 0 until the Master Clock is established. Then, the MCKRDY bit is set and can trigger an interrupt to the processor. This feature is useful when switching from a high-speed clock to a lower one to inform the software when the change is actually done. Figure 26-1. Master Clock Controller PMC_MCKR CSS PMC_MCKR PRES SLCK MAINCK Master Clock Prescaler MCK PLLCK To the Processor Clock Controller (PCK) 209 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.3 Processor Clock Controller The PMC features a Processor Clock Controller (PCK) that implements the Processor Idle Mode. The Processor Clock can be disabled by writing the System Clock Disable Register (PMC_SCDR). The status o this clock (at least for debug purpose) can be read in the System Clock Status Register (PMC_SCSR). The Processor Clock PCK is enabled after a reset and is automatically re-enabled by any enabled interrupt. The Processor Idle Mode is achieved by disabling the Processor Clock, which is automatically re-enabled by any enabled fast or normal interrupt, or by the reset of the product. When the Processor Clock is disabled, the current instruction is finished before the clock is stopped, but this does not prevent data transfers from other masters of the system bus. 26.4 USB Clock Controller The USB Source Clock is the PLL output. If using the USB, the user must program the PLL to generate a 48 MHz, a 96 MHz or a 192 MHz signal with an accuracy of ± 0.25% depending on the USBDIV bit in CKGR_PLLR. When the PLL output is stable, i.e., the LOCK bit is set: • The USB device clock can be enabled by setting the UDP bit in PMC_SCER. To save power on this peripheral when it is not used, the user can set the UDP bit in PMC_SCDR. The UDP bit in PMC_SCSR gives the activity of this clock. The USB device port require both the 48 MHz signal and the Master Clock. The Master Clock may be controlled via the Master Clock Controller. Figure 26-2. USB Clock Controller USBDIV USB Source Clock 26.5 Divider /1,/2,/4 UDP Clock (UDPCK) UDP Peripheral Clock Controller The Power Management Controller controls the clocks of each embedded peripheral by the way of the Peripheral Clock Controller. The user can individually enable and disable the Master Clock on the peripherals by writing into the Peripheral Clock Enable (PMC_PCER) and Peripheral Clock Disable (PMC_PCDR) registers. The status of the peripheral clock activity can be read in the Peripheral Clock Status Register (PMC_PCSR). When a peripheral clock is disabled, the clock is immediately stopped. The peripheral clocks are automatically disabled after a reset. In order to stop a peripheral, it is recommended that the system software wait until the peripheral has executed its last programmed operation before disabling the clock. This is to avoid data corruption or erroneous behavior of the system. 210 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The bit number within the Peripheral Clock Control registers (PMC_PCER, PMC_PCDR, and PMC_PCSR) is the Peripheral Identifier defined at the product level. Generally, the bit number corresponds to the interrupt source number assigned to the peripheral. 26.6 Programmable Clock Output Controller The PMC controls 4 signals to be output on external pins PCKx. Each signal can be independently programmed via the PMC_PCKx registers. PCKx can be independently selected between the Slow clock, the PLL output and the main clock by writing the CSS field in PMC_PCKx. Each output signal can also be divided by a power of 2 between 1 and 64 by writing the PRES (Prescaler) field in PMC_PCKx. Each output signal can be enabled and disabled by writing 1 in the corresponding bit, PCKx of PMC_SCER and PMC_SCDR, respectively. Status of the active programmable output clocks are given in the PCKx bits of PMC_SCSR (System Clock Status Register). Moreover, like the PCK, a status bitin PMC_SR indicates that the Programmable Clock is actually what has been programmed in the Programmable Clock registers. As the Programmable Clock Controller does not manage with glitch prevention when switching clocks, it is strongly recommended to disable the Programmable Clock before any configuration change and to re-enable it after the change is actually performed. 26.7 Programming Sequence 1. Enabling the Main Oscillator: The main oscillator is enabled by setting the MOSCEN field in the CKGR_MOR register. In some cases it may be advantageous to define a start-up time. This can be achieved by writing a value in the OSCOUNT field in the CKGR_MOR register. Once this register has been correctly configured, the user must wait for MOSCS field in the PMC_SR register to be set. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to MOSCS has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. Code Example: write_register(CKGR_MOR,0x00000701) Start Up Time = 8 * OSCOUNT / SLCK = 56 Slow Clock Cycles. So, the main oscillator will be enabled (MOSCS bit set) after 56 Slow Clock Cycles. 2. Checking the Main Oscillator Frequency (Optional): In some situations the user may need an accurate measure of the main oscillator frequency. This measure can be accomplished via the CKGR_MCFR register. Once the MAINRDY field is set in CKGR_MCFR register, the user may read the MAINF field in CKGR_MCFR register. This provides the number of main clock cycles within sixteen slow clock cycles. 211 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 3. Setting PLL and divider: All parameters needed to configure PLL and the divider are located in the CKGR_PLLR register. The DIV field is used to control divider itself. A value between 0 and 255 can be programmed. Divider output is divider input divided by DIV parameter. By default DIV parameter is set to 0 which means that divider is turned off. The OUT field is used to select the PLL B output frequency range. The MUL field is the PLL multiplier factor. This parameter can be programmed between 0 and 2047. If MUL is set to 0, PLL will be turned off, otherwise the PLL output frequency is PLL input frequency multiplied by (MUL + 1). The PLLCOUNT field specifies the number of slow clock cycles before LOCK bit is set in the PMC_SR register after CKGR_PLLR register has been written. Once the PMC_PLL register has been written, the user must wait for the LOCK bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to LOCK has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. All parameters in CKGR_PLLR can be programmed in a single write operation. If at some stage one of the following parameters, MUL, DIV is modified, LOCK bit will go low to indicate that PLL is not ready yet. When PLL is locked, LOCK will be set again. The user is constrained to wait for LOCK bit to be set before using the PLL output clock. The USBDIV field is used to control the additional divider by 1, 2 or 4, which generates the USB clock(s). Code Example: write_register(CKGR_PLLR,0x00040805) If PLL and divider are enabled, the PLL input clock is the main clock. PLL output clock is PLL input clock multiplied by 5. Once CKGR_PLLR has been written, LOCK bit will be set after eight slow clock cycles. 4. Selection of Master Clock and Processor Clock The Master Clock and the Processor Clock are configurable via the PMC_MCKR register. The CSS field is used to select the Master Clock divider source. By default, the selected clock source is slow clock. The PRES field is used to control the Master Clock prescaler. The user can choose between different values (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64). Master Clock output is prescaler input divided by PRES parameter. By default, PRES parameter is set to 1 which means that master clock is equal to slow clock. Once the PMC_MCKR register has been written, the user must wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting for the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to MCKRDY has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. The PMC_MCKR register must not be programmed in a single write operation. The preferred programming sequence for the PMC_MCKR register is as follows: 212 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • If a new value for CSS field corresponds to PLL Clock, – Program the PRES field in the PMC_MCKR register. – Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. – Program the CSS field in the PMC_MCKR register. – Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. • If a new value for CSS field corresponds to Main Clock or Slow Clock, – Program the CSS field in the PMC_MCKR register. – Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. – Program the PRES field in the PMC_MCKR register. – Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. If at some stage one of the following parameters, CSS or PRES, is modified, the MCKRDY bit will go low to indicate that the Master Clock and the Processor Clock are not ready yet. The user must wait for MCKRDY bit to be set again before using the Master and Processor Clocks. Note: IF PLLx clock was selected as the Master Clock and the user decides to modify it by writing in CKGR_PLLR, the MCKRDY flag will go low while PLL is unlocked. Once PLL is locked again, LOCK goes high and MCKRDY is set. While PLL is unlocked, the Master Clock selection is automatically changed to Main Clock. For further information, see Section 26.8.2. “Clock Switching Waveforms” on page 215. Code Example: write_register(PMC_MCKR,0x00000001) wait (MCKRDY=1) write_register(PMC_MCKR,0x00000011) wait (MCKRDY=1) The Master Clock is main clock divided by 16. The Processor Clock is the Master Clock. 5. Selection of Programmable clocks Programmable clocks are controlled via registers; PMC_SCER, PMC_SCDR and PMC_SCSR. Programmable clocks can be enabled and/or disabled via the PMC_SCER and PMC_SCDR registers. Depending on the system used, 4 Programmable clocks can be enabled or disabled. The PMC_SCSR provides a clear indication as to which Programmable clock is enabled. By default all Programmable clocks are disabled. PMC_PCKx registers are used to configure Programmable clocks. The CSS field is used to select the Programmable clock divider source. Four clock options are available: main clock, slow clock, PLLCK. By default, the clock source selected is slow clock. The PRES field is used to control the Programmable clock prescaler. It is possible to choose between different values (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64). Programmable clock output is prescaler 213 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 input divided by PRES parameter. By default, the PRES parameter is set to 1 which means that master clock is equal to slow clock. Once the PMC_PCKx register has been programmed, The corresponding Programmable clock must be enabled and the user is constrained to wait for the PCKRDYx bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to PCKRDYx has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. All parameters in PMC_PCKx can be programmed in a single write operation. If the CSS and PRES parameters are to be modified, the corresponding Programmable clock must be disabled first. The parameters can then be modified. Once this has been done, the user must re-enable the Programmable clock and wait for the PCKRDYx bit to be set. Code Example: write_register(PMC_PCK0,0x00000015) Programmable clock 0 is main clock divided by 32. 6. Enabling Peripheral Clocks Once all of the previous steps have been completed, the peripheral clocks can be enabled and/or disabled via registers PMC_PCER and PMC_PCDR. Depending on the system used, 15 peripheral clocks can be enabled or disabled. The PMC_PCSR provides a clear view as to which peripheral clock is enabled. Note: Each enabled peripheral clock corresponds to Master Clock. Code Examples: write_register(PMC_PCER,0x00000110) Peripheral clocks 4 and 8 are enabled. write_register(PMC_PCDR,0x00000010) Peripheral clock 4 is disabled. 214 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.8 26.8.1 Clock Switching Details Master Clock Switching Timings Table 26-1 gives the worst case timings required for the Master Clock to switch from one selected clock to another one. This is in the event that the prescaler is de-activated. When the prescaler is activated, an additional time of 64 clock cycles of the new selected clock has to be added. Table 26-1. Clock Switching Timings (Worst Case) From Main Clock SLCK PLL Clock – 4 x SLCK + 2.5 x Main Clock 3 x PLL Clock + 4 x SLCK + 1 x Main Clock 0.5 x Main Clock + 4.5 x SLCK – 3 x PLL Clock + 5 x SLCK 0.5 x Main Clock + 4 x SLCK + PLLCOUNT x SLCK + 2.5 x PLLx Clock 2.5 x PLL Clock + 5 x SLCK + PLLCOUNT x SLCK 2.5 x PLL Clock + 4 x SLCK + PLLCOUNT x SLCK To Main Clock SLCK PLL Clock 26.8.2 Clock Switching Waveforms Figure 26-3. Switch Master Clock from Slow Clock to PLL Clock Slow Clock PLL Clock LOCK MCKRDY Master Clock Write PMC_MCKR 215 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 26-4. Switch Master Clock from Main Clock to Slow Clock Slow Clock Main Clock MCKRDY Master Clock Write PMC_MCKR Figure 26-5. Change PLL Programming Main Clock PLL Clock LOCK MCKRDY Master Clock Main Clock Write CKGR_PLLR 216 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 26-6. Programmable Clock Output Programming PLL Clock PCKRDY PCKx Output Write PMC_PCKx Write PMC_SCER Write PMC_SCDR PLL Clock is selected PCKx is enabled PCKx is disabled 217 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9 Power Management Controller (PMC) User Interface Table 26-2. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x0000 System Clock Enable Register PMC_SCER Write-only – 0x0004 System Clock Disable Register PMC_SCDR Write-only – 0x0008 System Clock Status Register PMC _SCSR Read-only 0x01 0x000C Reserved – – 0x0010 Peripheral Clock Enable Register PMC _PCER Write-only – 0x0014 Peripheral Clock Disable Register PMC_PCDR Write-only – 0x0018 Peripheral Clock Status Register PMC_PCSR Read-only 0x0 0x001C Reserved – – 0x0020 Main Oscillator Register CKGR_MOR Read-write 0x0 0x0024 Main Clock Frequency Register CKGR_MCFR Read-only 0x0 0x0028 Reserved – – 0x002C PLL Register CKGR_PLLR Read-write 0x3F00 0x0030 Master Clock Register PMC_MCKR Read-write 0x0 0x0038 Reserved – – – 0x003C Reserved – – – 0x0040 Programmable Clock 0 Register PMC_PCK0 Read-write 0x0 0x0044 Programmable Clock 1 Register PMC_PCK1 Read-write 0x0 ... ... 0x0060 Interrupt Enable Register PMC_IER Write-only -- 0x0064 Interrupt Disable Register PMC_IDR Write-only -- 0x0068 Status Register PMC_SR Read-only 0x08 0x006C Interrupt Mask Register PMC_IMR Read-only 0x0 – – ... 0x0070 - 0x007C 218 Reserved – – – ... – ... AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.1 PMC System Clock Enable Register Register Name: PMC_SCER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – PCK3 PCK2 PCK1 PCK0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UDP – – – – – – – • UDP: USB Device Port Clock Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the 48 MHz clock of the USB Device Port. • PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding Programmable Clock output. 219 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.2 PMC System Clock Disable Register Register Name: PMC_SCDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – PCK3 PCK2 PCK1 PCK0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UDP – – – – – – PCK • PCK: Processor Clock Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Processor clock. This is used to enter the processor in Idle Mode. • UDP: USB Device Port Clock Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the 48 MHz clock of the USB Device Port. • PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding Programmable Clock output. 220 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.3 PMC System Clock Status Register Register Name: PMC_SCSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – PCK3 PCK2 PCK1 PCK0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UDP – – – – – – PCK • PCK: Processor Clock Status 0 = The Processor clock is disabled. 1 = The Processor clock is enabled. • UDP: USB Device Port Clock Status 0 = The 48 MHz clock (UDPCK) of the USB Device Port is disabled. 1 = The 48 MHz clock (UDPCK) of the USB Device Port is enabled. • PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Status 0 = The corresponding Programmable Clock output is disabled. 1 = The corresponding Programmable Clock output is enabled. 221 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.4 PMC Peripheral Clock Enable Register Register Name: PMC_PCER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 - - • PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding peripheral clock. Note: PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section “Peripheral Identifiers” in the product datasheet. Note: Programming the control bits of the Peripheral ID that are not implemented has no effect on the behavior of the PMC. 26.9.5 PMC Peripheral Clock Disable Register Register Name: PMC_PCDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 - - • PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding peripheral clock. Note: 222 PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section “Peripheral Identifiers” in the product datasheet. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.6 PMC Peripheral Clock Status Register Register Name: PMC_PCSR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 PID31 PID30 PID29 PID28 PID27 PID26 PID25 PID24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PID23 PID22 PID21 PID20 PID19 PID18 PID17 PID16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PID15 PID14 PID13 PID12 PID11 PID10 PID9 PID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PID7 PID6 PID5 PID4 PID3 PID2 – – • PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Status 0 = The corresponding peripheral clock is disabled. 1 = The corresponding peripheral clock is enabled. Note: PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section “Peripheral Identifiers” in the product datasheet. 223 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.7 PMC Clock Generator Main Oscillator Register Register Name: CKGR_MOR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 – 2 – 1 OSCBYPASS 0 MOSCEN OSCOUNT 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – • MOSCEN: Main Oscillator Enable A crystal must be connected between XIN and XOUT. 0 = The Main Oscillator is disabled. 1 = The Main Oscillator is enabled. OSCBYPASS must be set to 0. When MOSCEN is set, the MOSCS flag is set once the Main Oscillator startup time is achieved. • OSCBYPASS: Oscillator Bypass 0 = No effect. 1 = The Main Oscillator is bypassed. MOSCEN must be set to 0. An external clock must be connected on XIN. When OSCBYPASS is set, the MOSCS flag in PMC_SR is automatically set. Clearing MOSCEN and OSCBYPASS bits allows resetting the MOSCS flag. • OSCOUNT: Main Oscillator Start-up Time Specifies the number of Slow Clock cycles multiplied by 8 for the Main Oscillator start-up time. 224 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.8 PMC Clock Generator Main Clock Frequency Register Register Name: CKGR_MCFR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 MAINRDY 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MAINF 7 6 5 4 MAINF • MAINF: Main Clock Frequency Gives the number of Main Clock cycles within 16 Slow Clock periods. • MAINRDY: Main Clock Ready 0 = MAINF value is not valid or the Main Oscillator is disabled. 1 = The Main Oscillator has been enabled previously and MAINF value is available. 225 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.9 PMC Clock Generator PLL Register Register Name: CKGR_PLLR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 23 22 21 28 27 – 26 25 MUL 24 20 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 2 1 0 USBDIV MUL 15 14 13 12 OUT 7 PLLCOUNT 6 5 4 3 DIV Possible limitations on PLL input frequencies and multiplier factors should be checked before using the PMC. • DIV: Divider DIV Divider Selected 0 Divider output is 0 1 Divider is bypassed 2 - 255 Divider output is the selected clock divided by DIV. • PLLCOUNT: PLL Counter Specifies the number of slow clock cycles before the LOCK bit is set in PMC_SR after CKGR_PLLR is written. • OUT: PLL Clock Frequency Range To optimize clock performance, this field must be programmed as specified in “PLL Characteristics” in the Electrical Characteristics section of the product datasheet. • MUL: PLL Multiplier 0 = The PLL is deactivated. 1 up to 2047 = The PLL Clock frequency is the PLL input frequency multiplied by MUL+ 1. • USBDIV: Divider for USB Clock USBDIV 226 Divider for USB Clock(s) 0 0 Divider output is PLL clock output. 0 1 Divider output is PLL clock output divided by 2. 1 0 Divider output is PLL clock output divided by 4. 1 1 Reserved. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.10 PMC Master Clock Register Register Name: PMC_MCKR Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 – – – PRES 0 CSS • CSS: Master Clock Selection CSS Clock Source Selection 0 0 Slow Clock is selected 0 1 Main Clock is selected 1 0 Reserved 1 1 PLL Clock is selected. • PRES: Processor Clock Prescaler PRES Processor Clock 0 0 0 Selected clock 0 0 1 Selected clock divided by 2 0 1 0 Selected clock divided by 4 0 1 1 Selected clock divided by 8 1 0 0 Selected clock divided by 16 1 0 1 Selected clock divided by 32 1 1 0 Selected clock divided by 64 1 1 1 Reserved 227 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.11 PMC Programmable Clock Register Register Name: PMC_PCKx Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 – – – PRES 0 CSS • CSS: Master Clock Selection CSS Clock Source Selection 0 0 Slow Clock is selected 0 1 Main Clock is selected 1 0 Reserved 1 1 PLL Clock is selected • PRES: Programmable Clock Prescaler PRES 228 Programmable Clock 0 0 0 Selected clock 0 0 1 Selected clock divided by 2 0 1 0 Selected clock divided by 4 0 1 1 Selected clock divided by 8 1 0 0 Selected clock divided by 16 1 0 1 Selected clock divided by 32 1 1 0 Selected clock divided by 64 1 1 1 Reserved AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.12 PMC Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: PMC_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – PCKRDY2 PCKRDY1 PCKRDY0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – MCKRDY LOCK – MOSCS • MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Enable • LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Enable • MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Enable • PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 229 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.13 PMC Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: PMC_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – PCKRDY2 PCKRDY1 PCKRDY0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – MCKRDY LOCK – MOSCS • MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Disable • LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Disable • MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Disable • PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 230 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 26.9.14 PMC Status Register Register Name: PMC_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – PCKRDY2 PCKRDY1 PCKRDY0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – MCKRDY LOCK – MOSCS • MOSCS: MOSCS Flag Status 0 = Main oscillator is not stabilized. 1 = Main oscillator is stabilized. • LOCK: PLL Lock Status 0 = PLL is not locked 1 = PLL is locked. • MCKRDY: Master Clock Status 0 = Master Clock is not ready. 1 = Master Clock is ready. • PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready Status 0 = Programmable Clock x is not ready. 1 = Programmable Clock x is ready. 231 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 26.9.15 PMC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: PMC_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – PCKRDY2 PCKRDY1 PCKRDY0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – MCKRDY LOCK – MOSCS • MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Mask • LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Mask • MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Mask • PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 232 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27. Debug Unit (DBGU) 27.1 Overview The Debug Unit provides a single entry point from the processor for access to all the debug capabilities of Atmel’s ARM-based systems. The Debug Unit features a two-pin UART that can be used for several debug and trace purposes and offers an ideal medium for in-situ programming solutions and debug monitor communications. The Debug Unit two-pin UART can be used standalone for general purpose serial communication. Moreover, the association with two peripheral data controller channels permits packet handling for these tasks with processor time reduced to a minimum. The Debug Unit also makes the Debug Communication Channel (DCC) signals provided by the In-circuit Emulator of the ARM processor visible to the software. These signals indicate the status of the DCC read and write registers and generate an interrupt to the ARM processor, making possible the handling of the DCC under interrupt control. Chip Identifier registers permit recognition of the device and its revision. These registers inform as to the sizes and types of the on-chip memories, as well as the set of embedded peripherals. Finally, the Debug Unit features a Force NTRST capability that enables the software to decide whether to prevent access to the system via the In-circuit Emulator. This permits protection of the code, stored in ROM. 233 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.2 Block Diagram Figure 27-1. Debug Unit Functional Block Diagram Peripheral Bridge Peripheral DMA Controller APB Debug Unit DTXD Transmit Power Management Controller MCK Parallel Input/ Output Baud Rate Generator Receive DRXD COMMRX R ARM Processor COMMTX DCC Handler Chip ID nTRST ICE Access Handler Interrupt Control dbgu_irq Power-on Reset force_ntrst Table 27-1. Debug Unit Pin Description Pin Name Description Type DRXD Debug Receive Data Input DTXD Debug Transmit Data Output Debug Unit Application Example Boot Program Debug Monitor Trace Manager Debug Unit RS232 Drivers Programming Tool 234 Debug Console Trace Console AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27.3 27.3.1 Product Dependencies I/O Lines Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit pins may be multiplexed with PIO lines. In this case, the programmer must first configure the corresponding PIO Controller to enable I/O lines operations of the Debug Unit. 27.3.2 Power Management Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit clock may be controllable through the Power Management Controller. In this case, the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the Debug Unit clock. Usually, the peripheral identifier used for this purpose is 1. 27.3.3 Interrupt Source Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit interrupt line is connected to one of the interrupt sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Interrupt handling requires programming of the AIC before configuring the Debug Unit. Usually, the Debug Unit interrupt line connects to the interrupt source 1 of the AIC, which may be shared with the real-time clock, the system timer interrupt lines and other system peripheral interrupts, as shown in Figure 27-1. This sharing requires the programmer to determine the source of the interrupt when the source 1 is triggered. 27.4 UART Operations The Debug Unit operates as a UART, (asynchronous mode only) and supports only 8-bit character handling (with parity). It has no clock pin. The Debug Unit's UART is made up of a receiver and a transmitter that operate independently, and a common baud rate generator. Receiver timeout and transmitter time guard are not implemented. However, all the implemented features are compatible with those of a standard USART. 27.4.1 Baud Rate Generator The baud rate generator provides the bit period clock named baud rate clock to both the receiver and the transmitter. The baud rate clock is the master clock divided by 16 times the value (CD) written in DBGU_BRGR (Baud Rate Generator Register). If DBGU_BRGR is set to 0, the baud rate clock is disabled and the Debug Unit's UART remains inactive. The maximum allowable baud rate is Master Clock divided by 16. The minimum allowable baud rate is Master Clock divided by (16 x 65536). MCK Baud Rate = ---------------------16 × CD 235 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 27-2. Baud Rate Generator CD CD MCK 16-bit Counter OUT >1 1 0 Divide by 16 Baud Rate Clock 0 Receiver Sampling Clock 27.4.2 27.4.2.1 Receiver Receiver Reset, Enable and Disable After device reset, the Debug Unit receiver is disabled and must be enabled before being used. The receiver can be enabled by writing the control register DBGU_CR with the bit RXEN at 1. At this command, the receiver starts looking for a start bit. The programmer can disable the receiver by writing DBGU_CR with the bit RXDIS at 1. If the receiver is waiting for a start bit, it is immediately stopped. However, if the receiver has already detected a start bit and is receiving the data, it waits for the stop bit before actually stopping its operation. The programmer can also put the receiver in its reset state by writing DBGU_CR with the bit RSTRX at 1. In doing so, the receiver immediately stops its current operations and is disabled, whatever its current state. If RSTRX is applied when data is being processed, this data is lost. 27.4.2.2 Start Detection and Data Sampling The Debug Unit only supports asynchronous operations, and this affects only its receiver. The Debug Unit receiver detects the start of a received character by sampling the DRXD signal until it detects a valid start bit. A low level (space) on DRXD is interpreted as a valid start bit if it is detected for more than 7 cycles of the sampling clock, which is 16 times the baud rate. Hence, a space that is longer than 7/16 of the bit period is detected as a valid start bit. A space which is 7/16 of a bit period or shorter is ignored and the receiver continues to wait for a valid start bit. When a valid start bit has been detected, the receiver samples the DRXD at the theoretical midpoint of each bit. It is assumed that each bit lasts 16 cycles of the sampling clock (1-bit period) so the bit sampling point is eight cycles (0.5-bit period) after the start of the bit. The first sampling point is therefore 24 cycles (1.5-bit periods) after the falling edge of the start bit was detected. Each subsequent bit is sampled 16 cycles (1-bit period) after the previous one. 236 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 27-3. Start Bit Detection Sampling Clock DRXD True Start Detection D0 Baud Rate Clock Figure 27-4. Character Reception Example: 8-bit, parity enabled 1 stop 0.5 bit period 1 bit period DRXD D0 D1 True Start Detection Sampling 27.4.2.3 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Stop Bit Parity Bit Receiver Ready When a complete character is received, it is transferred to the DBGU_RHR and the RXRDY status bit in DBGU_SR (Status Register) is set. The bit RXRDY is automatically cleared when the receive holding register DBGU_RHR is read. Figure 27-5. Receiver Ready DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 S P D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P RXRDY Read DBGU_RHR 27.4.2.4 Receiver Overrun If DBGU_RHR has not been read by the software (or the Peripheral Data Controller) since the last transfer, the RXRDY bit is still set and a new character is received, the OVRE status bit in DBGU_SR is set. OVRE is cleared when the software writes the control register DBGU_CR with the bit RSTSTA (Reset Status) at 1. Figure 27-6. Receiver Overrun DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop RXRDY OVRE RSTSTA 27.4.2.5 Parity Error Each time a character is received, the receiver calculates the parity of the received data bits, in accordance with the field PAR in DBGU_MR. It then compares the result with the received parity 237 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 bit. If different, the parity error bit PARE in DBGU_SR is set at the same time the RXRDY is set. The parity bit is cleared when the control register DBGU_CR is written with the bit RSTSTA (Reset Status) at 1. If a new character is received before the reset status command is written, the PARE bit remains at 1. Figure 27-7. Parity Error DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop RXRDY PARE Wrong Parity Bit 27.4.2.6 RSTSTA Receiver Framing Error When a start bit is detected, it generates a character reception when all the data bits have been sampled. The stop bit is also sampled and when it is detected at 0, the FRAME (Framing Error) bit in DBGU_SR is set at the same time the RXRDY bit is set. The bit FRAME remains high until the control register DBGU_CR is written with the bit RSTSTA at 1. Figure 27-8. Receiver Framing Error DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop RXRDY FRAME Stop Bit Detected at 0 27.4.3 27.4.3.1 RSTSTA Transmitter Transmitter Reset, Enable and Disable After device reset, the Debug Unit transmitter is disabled and it must be enabled before being used. The transmitter is enabled by writing the control register DBGU_CR with the bit TXEN at 1. From this command, the transmitter waits for a character to be written in the Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR before actually starting the transmission. The programmer can disable the transmitter by writing DBGU_CR with the bit TXDIS at 1. If the transmitter is not operating, it is immediately stopped. However, if a character is being processed into the Shift Register and/or a character has been written in the Transmit Holding Register, the characters are completed before the transmitter is actually stopped. The programmer can also put the transmitter in its reset state by writing the DBGU_CR with the bit RSTTX at 1. This immediately stops the transmitter, whether or not it is processing characters. 27.4.3.2 238 Transmit Format The Debug Unit transmitter drives the pin DTXD at the baud rate clock speed. The line is driven depending on the format defined in the Mode Register and the data stored in the Shift Register. One start bit at level 0, then the 8 data bits, from the lowest to the highest bit, one optional parity bit and one stop bit at 1 are consecutively shifted out as shown on the following figure. The field AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary PARE in the mode register DBGU_MR defines whether or not a parity bit is shifted out. When a parity bit is enabled, it can be selected between an odd parity, an even parity, or a fixed space or mark bit. Figure 27-9. Character Transmission Example: Parity enabled Baud Rate Clock DTXD Start Bit 27.4.3.3 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Bit Stop Bit Transmitter Control When the transmitter is enabled, the bit TXRDY (Transmitter Ready) is set in the status register DBGU_SR. The transmission starts when the programmer writes in the Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR, and after the written character is transferred from DBGU_THR to the Shift Register. The bit TXRDY remains high until a second character is written in DBGU_THR. As soon as the first character is completed, the last character written in DBGU_THR is transferred into the shift register and TXRDY rises again, showing that the holding register is empty. When both the Shift Register and the DBGU_THR are empty, i.e., all the characters written in DBGU_THR have been processed, the bit TXEMPTY rises after the last stop bit has been completed. Figure 27-10. Transmitter Control DBGU_THR Data 0 Data 1 Shift Register DTXD Data 0 S Data 0 Data 1 P stop S Data 1 P stop TXRDY TXEMPTY Write Data 0 in DBGU_THR 27.4.4 Write Data 1 in DBGU_THR Peripheral Data Controller Both the receiver and the transmitter of the Debug Unit's UART are generally connected to a Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) channel. The peripheral data controller channels are programmed via registers that are mapped within the Debug Unit user interface from the offset 0x100. The status bits are reported in the Debug Unit status register DBGU_SR and can generate an interrupt. 239 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 The RXRDY bit triggers the PDC channel data transfer of the receiver. This results in a read of the data in DBGU_RHR. The TXRDY bit triggers the PDC channel data transfer of the transmitter. This results in a write of a data in DBGU_THR. 27.4.5 Test Modes The Debug Unit supports three tests modes. These modes of operation are programmed by using the field CHMODE (Channel Mode) in the mode register DBGU_MR. The Automatic Echo mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. When a bit is received on the DRXD line, it is sent to the DTXD line. The transmitter operates normally, but has no effect on the DTXD line. The Local Loopback mode allows the transmitted characters to be received. DTXD and DRXD pins are not used and the output of the transmitter is internally connected to the input of the receiver. The DRXD pin level has no effect and the DTXD line is held high, as in idle state. The Remote Loopback mode directly connects the DRXD pin to the DTXD line. The transmitter and the receiver are disabled and have no effect. This mode allows a bit-by-bit retransmission. Figure 27-11. Test Modes Automatic Echo RXD Receiver Transmitter Disabled TXD Local Loopback Disabled Receiver RXD VDD Disabled Transmitter Remote Loopback Receiver Transmitter 27.4.6 240 TXD VDD Disabled Disabled RXD TXD Debug Communication Channel Support The Debug Unit handles the signals COMMRX and COMMTX that come from the Debug Communication Channel of the ARM Processor and are driven by the In-circuit Emulator. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The Debug Communication Channel contains two registers that are accessible through the ICE Breaker on the JTAG side and through the coprocessor 0 on the ARM Processor side. As a reminder, the following instructions are used to read and write the Debug Communication Channel: MRC p14, 0, Rd, c1, c0, 0 Returns the debug communication data read register into Rd MCR p14, 0, Rd, c1, c0, 0 Writes the value in Rd to the debug communication data write register. The bits COMMRX and COMMTX, which indicate, respectively, that the read register has been written by the debugger but not yet read by the processor, and that the write register has been written by the processor and not yet read by the debugger, are wired on the two highest bits of the status register DBGU_SR. These bits can generate an interrupt. This feature permits handling under interrupt a debug link between a debug monitor running on the target system and a debugger. 27.4.7 Chip Identifier The Debug Unit features two chip identifier registers, DBGU_CIDR (Chip ID Register) and DBGU_EXID (Extension ID). Both registers contain a hard-wired value that is read-only. The first register contains the following fields: • EXT - shows the use of the extension identifier register • NVPTYP and NVPSIZ - identifies the type of embedded non-volatile memory and its size • ARCH - identifies the set of embedded peripheral • SRAMSIZ - indicates the size of the embedded SRAM • EPROC - indicates the embedded ARM processor • VERSION - gives the revision of the silicon The second register is device-dependent and reads 0 if the bit EXT is 0. 27.4.8 ICE Access Prevention The Debug Unit allows blockage of access to the system through the ARM processor's ICE interface. This feature is implemented via the register Force NTRST (DBGU_FNR), that allows assertion of the NTRST signal of the ICE Interface. Writing the bit FNTRST (Force NTRST) to 1 in this register prevents any activity on the TAP controller. On standard devices, the FNTRST bit resets to 0 and thus does not prevent ICE access. This feature is especially useful on custom ROM devices for customers who do not want their on-chip code to be visible. 241 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5 Debug Unit User Interface Table 27-2. Debug Unit Memory Map Offset Register Name Access Reset Value 0x0000 Control Register DBGU_CR Write-only – 0x0004 Mode Register DBGU_MR Read/Write 0x0 0x0008 Interrupt Enable Register DBGU_IER Write-only – 0x000C Interrupt Disable Register DBGU_IDR Write-only – 0x0010 Interrupt Mask Register DBGU_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x0014 Status Register DBGU_SR Read-only – 0x0018 Receive Holding Register DBGU_RHR Read-only 0x0 0x001C Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR Write-only – 0x0020 Baud Rate Generator Register DBGU_BRGR Read/Write 0x0 – – – 0x0024 - 0x003C Reserved 0x0040 Chip ID Register DBGU_CIDR Read-only – 0x0044 Chip ID Extension Register DBGU_EXID Read-only – 0x0048 Force NTRST Register DBGU_FNR Read/Write 0x0 0x004C - 0x00FC Reserved – – – 0x0100 - 0x0124 PDC Area – – – 242 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27.5.1 Name: Debug Unit Control Register DBGU_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – RSTSTA 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXDIS TXEN RXDIS RXEN RSTTX RSTRX – – • RSTRX: Reset Receiver 0 = No effect. 1 = The receiver logic is reset and disabled. If a character is being received, the reception is aborted. • RSTTX: Reset Transmitter 0 = No effect. 1 = The transmitter logic is reset and disabled. If a character is being transmitted, the transmission is aborted. • RXEN: Receiver Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The receiver is enabled if RXDIS is 0. • RXDIS: Receiver Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The receiver is disabled. If a character is being processed and RSTRX is not set, the character is completed before the receiver is stopped. • TXEN: Transmitter Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The transmitter is enabled if TXDIS is 0. • TXDIS: Transmitter Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The transmitter is disabled. If a character is being processed and a character has been written the DBGU_THR and RSTTX is not set, both characters are completed before the transmitter is stopped. • RSTSTA: Reset Status Bits 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the status bits PARE, FRAME and OVRE in the DBGU_SR. 243 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5.2 Name: Debug Unit Mode Register DBGU_MR Access Type: Read/Write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 14 13 12 11 10 9 – – 15 CHMODE 8 – PAR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – – • PAR: Parity Type PAR Parity Type 0 0 0 Even parity 0 0 1 Odd parity 0 1 0 Space: parity forced to 0 0 1 1 Mark: parity forced to 1 1 x x No parity • CHMODE: Channel Mode CHMODE 244 Mode Description 0 0 Normal Mode 0 1 Automatic Echo 1 0 Local Loopback 1 1 Remote Loopback AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27.5.3 Name: Debug Unit Interrupt Enable Register DBGU_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 COMMRX COMMTX – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – RXBUFF TXBUFE – TXEMPTY – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PARE FRAME OVRE ENDTX ENDRX – TXRDY RXRDY • RXRDY: Enable RXRDY Interrupt • TXRDY: Enable TXRDY Interrupt • ENDRX: Enable End of Receive Transfer Interrupt • ENDTX: Enable End of Transmit Interrupt • OVRE: Enable Overrun Error Interrupt • FRAME: Enable Framing Error Interrupt • PARE: Enable Parity Error Interrupt • TXEMPTY: Enable TXEMPTY Interrupt • TXBUFE: Enable Buffer Empty Interrupt • RXBUFF: Enable Buffer Full Interrupt • COMMTX: Enable COMMTX (from ARM) Interrupt • COMMRX: Enable COMMRX (from ARM) Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 245 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5.4 Name: Debug Unit Interrupt Disable Register DBGU_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 COMMRX COMMTX – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – RXBUFF TXBUFE – TXEMPTY – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PARE FRAME OVRE ENDTX ENDRX – TXRDY RXRDY • RXRDY: Disable RXRDY Interrupt • TXRDY: Disable TXRDY Interrupt • ENDRX: Disable End of Receive Transfer Interrupt • ENDTX: Disable End of Transmit Interrupt • OVRE: Disable Overrun Error Interrupt • FRAME: Disable Framing Error Interrupt • PARE: Disable Parity Error Interrupt • TXEMPTY: Disable TXEMPTY Interrupt • TXBUFE: Disable Buffer Empty Interrupt • RXBUFF: Disable Buffer Full Interrupt • COMMTX: Disable COMMTX (from ARM) Interrupt • COMMRX: Disable COMMRX (from ARM) Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 246 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27.5.5 Name: Debug Unit Interrupt Mask Register DBGU_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 COMMRX COMMTX – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – RXBUFF TXBUFE – TXEMPTY – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PARE FRAME OVRE ENDTX ENDRX – TXRDY RXRDY • RXRDY: Mask RXRDY Interrupt • TXRDY: Disable TXRDY Interrupt • ENDRX: Mask End of Receive Transfer Interrupt • ENDTX: Mask End of Transmit Interrupt • OVRE: Mask Overrun Error Interrupt • FRAME: Mask Framing Error Interrupt • PARE: Mask Parity Error Interrupt • TXEMPTY: Mask TXEMPTY Interrupt • TXBUFE: Mask TXBUFE Interrupt • RXBUFF: Mask RXBUFF Interrupt • COMMTX: Mask COMMTX Interrupt • COMMRX: Mask COMMRX Interrupt 0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 247 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5.6 Name: Debug Unit Status Register DBGU_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 COMMRX COMMTX – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – RXBUFF TXBUFE – TXEMPTY – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PARE FRAME OVRE ENDTX ENDRX – TXRDY RXRDY • RXRDY: Receiver Ready 0 = No character has been received since the last read of the DBGU_RHR or the receiver is disabled. 1 = At least one complete character has been received, transferred to DBGU_RHR and not yet read. • TXRDY: Transmitter Ready 0 = A character has been written to DBGU_THR and not yet transferred to the Shift Register, or the transmitter is disabled. 1 = There is no character written to DBGU_THR not yet transferred to the Shift Register. • ENDRX: End of Receiver Transfer 0 = The End of Transfer signal from the receiver Peripheral Data Controller channel is inactive. 1 = The End of Transfer signal from the receiver Peripheral Data Controller channel is active. • ENDTX: End of Transmitter Transfer 0 = The End of Transfer signal from the transmitter Peripheral Data Controller channel is inactive. 1 = The End of Transfer signal from the transmitter Peripheral Data Controller channel is active. • OVRE: Overrun Error 0 = No overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1 = At least one overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. • FRAME: Framing Error 0 = No framing error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1 = At least one framing error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. • PARE: Parity Error 0 = No parity error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1 = At least one parity error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. • TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty 0 = There are characters in DBGU_THR, or characters being processed by the transmitter, or the transmitter is disabled. 1 = There are no characters in DBGU_THR and there are no characters being processed by the transmitter. 248 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • TXBUFE: Transmission Buffer Empty 0 = The buffer empty signal from the transmitter PDC channel is inactive. 1 = The buffer empty signal from the transmitter PDC channel is active. • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full 0 = The buffer full signal from the receiver PDC channel is inactive. 1 = The buffer full signal from the receiver PDC channel is active. • COMMTX: Debug Communication Channel Write Status 0 = COMMTX from the ARM processor is inactive. 1 = COMMTX from the ARM processor is active. • COMMRX: Debug Communication Channel Read Status 0 = COMMRX from the ARM processor is inactive. 1 = COMMRX from the ARM processor is active. 249 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5.7 Name: Debug Unit Receiver Holding Register DBGU_RHR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RXCHR • RXCHR: Received Character Last received character if RXRDY is set. 250 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27.5.8 Name: Debug Unit Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXCHR • TXCHR: Character to be Transmitted Next character to be transmitted after the current character if TXRDY is not set. 251 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5.9 Name: Debug Unit Baud Rate Generator Register DBGU_BRGR Access Type: Read/Write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CD 7 6 5 4 CD • CD: Clock Divisor CD 0 Disabled 1 MCK 2 to 65535 252 Baud Rate Clock MCK / (CD x 16) AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 27.5.10 Name: Debug Unit Chip ID Register DBGU_CIDR Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 EXT 23 28 27 26 NVPTYP 22 21 20 19 18 ARCH 15 14 13 6 24 17 16 9 8 1 0 SRAMSIZ 12 11 10 NVPSIZ2 7 25 ARCH NVPSIZ 5 4 3 EPROC 2 VERSION • VERSION: Version of the Device • EPROC: Embedded Processor EPROC Processor 0 0 1 ARM946ES™ 0 1 0 ARM7TDMI® 1 0 0 ARM920T™ 1 0 1 ARM926EJS™ • NVPSIZ: Nonvolatile Program Memory Size NVPSIZ Size 0 0 0 0 None 0 0 0 1 8K bytes 0 0 1 0 16K bytes 0 0 1 1 32K bytes 0 1 0 0 Reserved 0 1 0 1 64K bytes 0 1 1 0 Reserved 0 1 1 1 128K bytes 1 0 0 0 Reserved 1 0 0 1 256K bytes 1 0 1 0 512K bytes 1 0 1 1 Reserved 1 1 0 0 1024K bytes 1 1 0 1 Reserved 1 1 1 0 2048K bytes 1 1 1 1 Reserved 253 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • NVPSIZ2 Second Nonvolatile Program Memory Size NVPSIZ2 Size 0 0 0 0 None 0 0 0 1 8K bytes 0 0 1 0 16K bytes 0 0 1 1 32K bytes 0 1 0 0 Reserved 0 1 0 1 64K bytes 0 1 1 0 Reserved 0 1 1 1 128K bytes 1 0 0 0 Reserved 1 0 0 1 256K bytes 1 0 1 0 512K bytes 1 0 1 1 Reserved 1 1 0 0 1024K bytes 1 1 0 1 Reserved 1 1 1 0 2048K bytes 1 1 1 1 Reserved • SRAMSIZ: Internal SRAM Size SRAMSIZ 254 Size 0 0 0 0 Reserved 0 0 0 1 1K bytes 0 0 1 0 2K bytes 0 0 1 1 6K bytes 0 1 0 0 112K bytes 0 1 0 1 4K bytes 0 1 1 0 80K bytes 0 1 1 1 160K bytes 1 0 0 0 8K bytes 1 0 0 1 16K bytes 1 0 1 0 32K bytes 1 0 1 1 64K bytes 1 1 0 0 128K bytes 1 1 0 1 256K bytes 1 1 1 0 96K bytes 1 1 1 1 512K bytes AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • ARCH: Architecture Identifier ARCH Hex Bin Architecture 0x19 0001 1001 AT91SAM9xx Series 0x29 0010 1001 AT91SAM9XExx Series 0x34 0011 0100 AT91x34 Series 0x37 0011 0111 CAP7Series 0x39 0011 1001 CAP9 Series 0x3B 0011 1011 CAP11 Series 0x40 0100 0000 AT91x40 Series 0x42 0100 0010 AT91x42 Series 0x55 0101 0101 AT91x55 Series 0x60 0110 0000 AT91SAM7Axx Series 0x61 0110 0001 AT91SAM7AQxx Series 0x63 0110 0011 AT91x63 Series 0x70 0111 0000 AT91SAM7Sxx Series 0x71 0111 0001 AT91SAM7XCxx Series 0x72 0111 0010 AT91SAM7SExx Series 0x73 0111 0011 AT91SAM7Lxx Series 0x75 0111 0101 AT91SAM7Xxx Series 0x92 1001 0010 AT91x92 Series 0xF0 1111 0000 AT75Cxx Series • NVPTYP: Nonvolatile Program Memory Type NVPTYP Memory 0 0 0 ROM 0 0 1 ROMless or on-chip Flash 1 0 0 SRAM emulating ROM 0 1 0 Embedded Flash Memory 0 1 1 ROM and Embedded Flash Memory NVPSIZ is ROM size NVPSIZ2 is Flash size • EXT: Extension Flag 0 = Chip ID has a single register definition without extension 1 = An extended Chip ID exists. 255 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 27.5.11 Name: Debug Unit Chip ID Extension Register DBGU_EXID Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 EXID 23 22 21 20 EXID 15 14 13 12 EXID 7 6 5 4 EXID • EXID: Chip ID Extension Reads 0 if the bit EXT in DBGU_CIDR is 0. 27.5.12 Name: Debug Unit Force NTRST Register DBGU_FNR Access Type: Read/Write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – FNTRST • FNTRST: Force NTRST 0 = NTRST of the ARM processor’s TAP controller is driven by the power_on_reset signal. 1 = NTRST of the ARM processor’s TAP controller is held low. 256 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28. Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) 28.1 Overview The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) circuit is a synchronous serial data link that provides communication with external devices in Master or Slave Mode. It also enables communication between processors if an external processor is connected to the system. The Serial Peripheral Interface is essentially a shift register that serially transmits data bits to other SPIs. During a data transfer, one SPI system acts as the “master”' which controls the data flow, while the other devices act as “slaves” which have data shifted into and out by the master. Different CPUs can take turn being masters (Multiple Master Protocol opposite to Single Master Protocol where one CPU is always the master while all of the others are always slaves) and one master may simultaneously shift data into multiple slaves. However, only one slave may drive its output to write data back to the master at any given time. A slave device is selected when the master asserts its NSS signal. If multiple slave devices exist, the master generates a separate slave select signal for each slave (NPCS). The SPI system consists of two data lines and two control lines: • Master Out Slave In (MOSI): This data line supplies the output data from the master shifted into the input(s) of the slave(s). • Master In Slave Out (MISO): This data line supplies the output data from a slave to the input of the master. There may be no more than one slave transmitting data during any particular transfer. • Serial Clock (SPCK): This control line is driven by the master and regulates the flow of the data bits. The master may transmit data at a variety of baud rates; the SPCK line cycles once for each bit that is transmitted. • Slave Select (NSS): This control line allows slaves to be turned on and off by hardware. 257 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.2 Block Diagram Figure 28-1. Block Diagram PDC APB SPCK MISO PMC MOSI MCK SPI Interface PIO NPCS0/NSS NPCS1 NPCS2 Interrupt Control NPCS3 SPI Interrupt 28.3 Application Block Diagram Figure 28-2. Application Block Diagram: Single Master/Multiple Slave Implementation SPI Master SPCK SPCK MISO MISO MOSI MOSI NPCS0 NSS Slave 0 SPCK NPCS1 NPCS2 NC NPCS3 MISO Slave 1 MOSI NSS SPCK MISO Slave 2 MOSI NSS 258 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.4 Signal Description Table 28-1. Signal Description Type Pin Name Pin Description Master Slave MISO Master In Slave Out Input Output MOSI Master Out Slave In Output Input SPCK Serial Clock Output Input NPCS1-NPCS3 Peripheral Chip Selects Output Unused NPCS0/NSS Peripheral Chip Select/Slave Select Output Input 28.5 28.5.1 Product Dependencies I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the SPI pins to their peripheral functions. 28.5.2 Power Management The SPI may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the SPI clock. 28.5.3 Interrupt The SPI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the SPI interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the SPI. 259 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.6 28.6.1 Functional Description Modes of Operation The SPI operates in Master Mode or in Slave Mode. Operation in Master Mode is programmed by writing at 1 the MSTR bit in the Mode Register. The pins NPCS0 to NPCS3 are all configured as outputs, the SPCK pin is driven, the MISO line is wired on the receiver input and the MOSI line driven as an output by the transmitter. If the MSTR bit is written at 0, the SPI operates in Slave Mode. The MISO line is driven by the transmitter output, the MOSI line is wired on the receiver input, the SPCK pin is driven by the transmitter to synchronize the receiver. The NPCS0 pin becomes an input, and is used as a Slave Select signal (NSS). The pins NPCS1 to NPCS3 are not driven and can be used for other purposes. The data transfers are identically programmable for both modes of operations. The baud rate generator is activated only in Master Mode. 28.6.2 Data Transfer Four combinations of polarity and phase are available for data transfers. The clock polarity is programmed with the CPOL bit in the Chip Select Register. The clock phase is programmed with the NCPHA bit. These two parameters determine the edges of the clock signal on which data is driven and sampled. Each of the two parameters has two possible states, resulting in four possible combinations that are incompatible with one another. Thus, a master/slave pair must use the same parameter pair values to communicate. If multiple slaves are used and fixed in different configurations, the master must reconfigure itself each time it needs to communicate with a different slave. Table 28-2 shows the four modes and corresponding parameter settings. Table 28-2. SPI Bus Protocol Mode SPI Mode CPOL NCPHA 0 0 1 1 0 0 2 1 1 3 1 0 Figure 28-3 and Figure 28-4 show examples of data transfers. 260 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 28-3. SPI Transfer Format (NCPHA = 1, 8 bits per transfer) 1 SPCK cycle (for reference) 2 3 4 6 5 7 8 SPCK (CPOL = 0) SPCK (CPOL = 1) MOSI (from master) MSB MISO (from slave) MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 LSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 LSB * NSS (to slave) * Not defined, but normally MSB of previous character received. Figure 28-4. SPI Transfer Format (NCPHA = 0, 8 bits per transfer) 1 SPCK cycle (for reference) 2 3 4 5 7 6 8 SPCK (CPOL = 0) SPCK (CPOL = 1) MOSI (from master) MISO (from slave) * MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 LSB LSB NSS (to slave) * Not defined but normally LSB of previous character transmitted. 261 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.6.3 Master Mode Operations When configured in Master Mode, the SPI operates on the clock generated by the internal programmable baud rate generator. It fully controls the data transfers to and from the slave(s) connected to the SPI bus. The SPI drives the chip select line to the slave and the serial clock signal (SPCK). The SPI features two holding registers, the Transmit Data Register and the Receive Data Register, and a single Shift Register. The holding registers maintain the data flow at a constant rate. After enabling the SPI, a data transfer begins when the processor writes to the SPI_TDR (Transmit Data Register). The written data is immediately transferred in the Shift Register and transfer on the SPI bus starts. While the data in the Shift Register is shifted on the MOSI line, the MISO line is sampled and shifted in the Shift Register. Transmission cannot occur without reception. Before writing the TDR, the PCS field must be set in order to select a slave. If new data is written in SPI_TDR during the transfer, it stays in it until the current transfer is completed. Then, the received data is transferred from the Shift Register to SPI_RDR, the data in SPI_TDR is loaded in the Shift Register and a new transfer starts. The transfer of a data written in SPI_TDR in the Shift Register is indicated by the TDRE bit (Transmit Data Register Empty) in the Status Register (SPI_SR). When new data is written in SPI_TDR, this bit is cleared. The TDRE bit is used to trigger the Transmit PDC channel. The end of transfer is indicated by the TXEMPTY flag in the SPI_SR register. If a transfer delay (DLYBCT) is greater than 0 for the last transfer, TXEMPTY is set after the completion of said delay. The master clock (MCK) can be switched off at this time. The transfer of received data from the Shift Register in SPI_RDR is indicated by the RDRF bit (Receive Data Register Full) in the Status Register (SPI_SR). When the received data is read, the RDRF bit is cleared. If the SPI_RDR (Receive Data Register) has not been read before new data is received, the Overrun Error bit (OVRES) in SPI_SR is set. As long as this flag is set, data is loaded in SPI_RDR. The user has to read the status register to clear the OVRES bit. Figure 28-5 on page 263 shows a block diagram of the SPI when operating in Master Mode. Figure 28-6 on page 264 shows a flow chart describing how transfers are handled. 262 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.6.3.1 Master Mode Block Diagram Figure 28-5. Master Mode Block Diagram SPI_CSR0..3 SCBR Baud Rate Generator MCK SPCK SPI Clock SPI_CSR0..3 BITS NCPHA CPOL LSB MISO SPI_RDR RDRF OVRES RD MSB Shift Register MOSI SPI_TDR TD SPI_CSR0..3 CSAAT TDRE SPI_RDR PCS PS NPCS3 PCSDEC SPI_MR PCS 0 NPCS2 Current Peripheral NPCS1 SPI_TDR NPCS0 PCS 1 MSTR MODF NPCS0 MODFDIS 263 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.6.3.2 Master Mode Flow Diagram Figure 28-6. Master Mode Flow Diagram S SPI Enable - NPCS defines the current Chip Select - CSAAT, DLYBS, DLYBCT refer to the fields of the Chip Select Register corresponding to the Current Chip Select - When NPCS is 0xF, CSAAT is 0. 1 TDRE ? 0 1 CSAAT ? PS ? 0 1 0 Fixed peripheral PS ? 1 Fixed peripheral 0 Variable peripheral Variable peripheral SPI_TDR(PCS) = NPCS ? no NPCS = SPI_TDR(PCS) NPCS = SPI_MR(PCS) yes SPI_MR(PCS) = NPCS ? no NPCS = 0xF NPCS = 0xF Delay DLYBCS Delay DLYBCS NPCS = SPI_TDR(PCS) NPCS = SPI_MR(PCS), SPI_TDR(PCS) Delay DLYBS Serializer = SPI_TDR(TD) TDRE = 1 Data Transfer SPI_RDR(RD) = Serializer RDRF = 1 Delay DLYBCT 0 TDRE ? 1 1 CSAAT ? 0 NPCS = 0xF Delay DLYBCS 264 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.6.3.3 Clock Generation The SPI Baud rate clock is generated by dividing the Master Clock (MCK), by a value between 1 and 255. This allows a maximum operating baud rate at up to Master Clock and a minimum operating baud rate of MCK divided by 255. Programming the SCBR field at 0 is forbidden. Triggering a transfer while SCBR is at 0 can lead to unpredictable results. At reset, SCBR is 0 and the user has to program it at a valid value before performing the first transfer. The divisor can be defined independently for each chip select, as it has to be programmed in the SCBR field of the Chip Select Registers. This allows the SPI to automatically adapt the baud rate for each interfaced peripheral without reprogramming. 28.6.3.4 Transfer Delays Figure 28-7 shows a chip select transfer change and consecutive transfers on the same chip select. Three delays can be programmed to modify the transfer waveforms: • The delay between chip selects, programmable only once for all the chip selects by writing the DLYBCS field in the Mode Register. Allows insertion of a delay between release of one chip select and before assertion of a new one. • The delay before SPCK, independently programmable for each chip select by writing the field DLYBS. Allows the start of SPCK to be delayed after the chip select has been asserted. • The delay between consecutive transfers, independently programmable for each chip select by writing the DLYBCT field. Allows insertion of a delay between two transfers occurring on the same chip select These delays allow the SPI to be adapted to the interfaced peripherals and their speed and bus release time. Figure 28-7. Programmable Delays Chip Select 1 Chip Select 2 SPCK DLYBCS 28.6.3.5 DLYBS DLYBCT DLYBCT Peripheral Selection The serial peripherals are selected through the assertion of the NPCS0 to NPCS3 signals. By default, all the NPCS signals are high before and after each transfer. The peripheral selection can be performed in two different ways: • Fixed Peripheral Select: SPI exchanges data with only one peripheral 265 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Variable Peripheral Select: Data can be exchanged with more than one peripheral Fixed Peripheral Select is activated by writing the PS bit to zero in SPI_MR (Mode Register). In this case, the current peripheral is defined by the PCS field in SPI_MR and the PCS field in the SPI_TDR has no effect. Variable Peripheral Select is activated by setting PS bit to one. The PCS field in SPI_TDR is used to select the current peripheral. This means that the peripheral selection can be defined for each new data. The Fixed Peripheral Selection allows buffer transfers with a single peripheral. Using the PDC is an optimal means, as the size of the data transfer between the memory and the SPI is either 8 bits or 16 bits. However, changing the peripheral selection requires the Mode Register to be reprogrammed. The Variable Peripheral Selection allows buffer transfers with multiple peripherals without reprogramming the Mode Register. Data written in SPI_TDR is 32 bits wide and defines the real data to be transmitted and the peripheral it is destined to. Using the PDC in this mode requires 32-bit wide buffers, with the data in the LSBs and the PCS and LASTXFER fields in the MSBs, however the SPI still controls the number of bits (8 to16) to be transferred through MISO and MOSI lines with the chip select configuration registers. This is not the optimal means in term of memory size for the buffers, but it provides a very effective means to exchange data with several peripherals without any intervention of the processor. 28.6.3.6 Peripheral Chip Select Decoding The user can program the SPI to operate with up to 15 peripherals by decoding the four Chip Select lines, NPCS0 to NPCS3 with an external logic. This can be enabled by writing the PCSDEC bit at 1 in the Mode Register (SPI_MR). When operating without decoding, the SPI makes sure that in any case only one chip select line is activated, i.e. driven low at a time. If two bits are defined low in a PCS field, only the lowest numbered chip select is driven low. When operating with decoding, the SPI directly outputs the value defined by the PCS field of either the Mode Register or the Transmit Data Register (depending on PS). As the SPI sets a default value of 0xF on the chip select lines (i.e. all chip select lines at 1) when not processing any transfer, only 15 peripherals can be decoded. The SPI has only four Chip Select Registers, not 15. As a result, when decoding is activated, each chip select defines the characteristics of up to four peripherals. As an example, SPI_CRS0 defines the characteristics of the externally decoded peripherals 0 to 3, corresponding to the PCS values 0x0 to 0x3. Thus, the user has to make sure to connect compatible peripherals on the decoded chip select lines 0 to 3, 4 to 7, 8 to 11 and 12 to 14. 28.6.3.7 Peripheral Deselection When operating normally, as soon as the transfer of the last data written in SPI_TDR is completed, the NPCS lines all rise. This might lead to runtime error if the processor is too long in responding to an interrupt, and thus might lead to difficulties for interfacing with some serial peripherals requiring the chip select line to remain active during a full set of transfers. To facilitate interfacing with such devices, the Chip Select Register can be programmed with the CSAAT bit (Chip Select Active After Transfer) at 1. This allows the chip select lines to remain in their current state (low = active) until transfer to another peripheral is required. 266 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 28-8 shows different peripheral deselection cases and the effect of the CSAAT bit. Figure 28-8. Peripheral Deselection CSAAT = 0 TDRE NPCS[0..3] CSAAT = 1 DLYBCT DLYBCT A A A A DLYBCS A DLYBCS PCS = A PCS = A Write SPI_TDR TDRE NPCS[0..3] DLYBCT DLYBCT A A A A DLYBCS A DLYBCS PCS=A PCS = A Write SPI_TDR TDRE NPCS[0..3] DLYBCT DLYBCT A B A B DLYBCS PCS = B DLYBCS PCS = B Write SPI_TDR 28.6.3.8 Mode Fault Detection A mode fault is detected when the SPI is programmed in Master Mode and a low level is driven by an external master on the NPCS0/NSS signal. NPCS0, MOSI, MISO and SPCK must be configured in open drain through the PIO controller, so that external pull up resistors are needed to guarantee high level. When a mode fault is detected, the MODF bit in the SPI_SR is set until the SPI_SR is read and the SPI is automatically disabled until re-enabled by writing the SPIEN bit in the SPI_CR (Control Register) at 1. By default, the Mode Fault detection circuitry is enabled. The user can disable Mode Fault detection by setting the MODFDIS bit in the SPI Mode Register (SPI_MR). 28.6.4 SPI Slave Mode When operating in Slave Mode, the SPI processes data bits on the clock provided on the SPI clock pin (SPCK). The SPI waits for NSS to go active before receiving the serial clock from an external master. When NSS falls, the clock is validated on the serializer, which processes the number of bits 267 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 defined by the BITS field of the Chip Select Register 0 (SPI_CSR0). These bits are processed following a phase and a polarity defined respectively by the NCPHA and CPOL bits of the SPI_CSR0. Note that BITS, CPOL and NCPHA of the other Chip Select Registers have no effect when the SPI is programmed in Slave Mode. The bits are shifted out on the MISO line and sampled on the MOSI line. When all the bits are processed, the received data is transferred in the Receive Data Register and the RDRF bit rises. If the SPI_RDR (Receive Data Register) has not been read before new data is received, the Overrun Error bit (OVRES) in SPI_SR is set. As long as this flag is set, data is loaded in SPI_RDR. The user has to read the status register to clear the OVRES bit. When a transfer starts, the data shifted out is the data present in the Shift Register. If no data has been written in the Transmit Data Register (SPI_TDR), the last data received is transferred. If no data has been received since the last reset, all bits are transmitted low, as the Shift Register resets at 0. When a first data is written in SPI_TDR, it is transferred immediately in the Shift Register and the TDRE bit rises. If new data is written, it remains in SPI_TDR until a transfer occurs, i.e. NSS falls and there is a valid clock on the SPCK pin. When the transfer occurs, the last data written in SPI_TDR is transferred in the Shift Register and the TDRE bit rises. This enables frequent updates of critical variables with single transfers. Then, a new data is loaded in the Shift Register from the Transmit Data Register. In case no character is ready to be transmitted, i.e. no character has been written in SPI_TDR since the last load from SPI_TDR to the Shift Register, the Shift Register is not modified and the last received character is retransmitted. Figure 28-9 shows a block diagram of the SPI when operating in Slave Mode. Figure 28-9. Slave Mode Functional Block Diagram SPCK NSS SPI Clock SPIEN SPIENS SPIDIS SPI_CSR0 BITS NCPHA CPOL MOSI LSB SPI_RDR RDRF OVRES RD MSB Shift Register MISO SPI_TDR TD 268 TDRE AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.7 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) User Interface Table 28-3. SPI Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Control Register SPI_CR Write-only --- 0x04 Mode Register SPI_MR Read/Write 0x0 0x08 Receive Data Register SPI_RDR Read-only 0x0 0x0C Transmit Data Register SPI_TDR Write-only --- 0x10 Status Register SPI_SR Read-only 0x000000F0 0x14 Interrupt Enable Register SPI_IER Write-only --- 0x18 Interrupt Disable Register SPI_IDR Write-only --- 0x1C Interrupt Mask Register SPI_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x20 - 0x2C Reserved 0x30 Chip Select Register 0 SPI_CSR0 Read/Write 0x0 0x34 Chip Select Register 1 SPI_CSR1 Read/Write 0x0 0x38 Chip Select Register 2 SPI_CSR2 Read/Write 0x0 0x3C Chip Select Register 3 SPI_CSR3 Read/Write 0x0 0x004C - 0x00F8 Reserved – – – 0x004C - 0x00FC Reserved – – – 0x100 - 0x124 Reserved for the PDC 269 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.7.1 Name: SPI Control Register SPI_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – LASTXFER 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SWRST – – – – – SPIDIS SPIEN • SPIEN: SPI Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the SPI to transfer and receive data. • SPIDIS: SPI Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the SPI. As soon as SPIDIS is set, SPI finishes its transfer. All pins are set in input mode and no data is received or transmitted. If a transfer is in progress, the transfer is finished before the SPI is disabled. If both SPIEN and SPIDIS are equal to one when the control register is written, the SPI is disabled. • SWRST: SPI Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Reset the SPI. A software-triggered hardware reset of the SPI interface is performed. The SPI is in slave mode after software reset. PDC channels are not affected by software reset. • LASTXFER: Last Transfer 0 = No effect. 1 = The current NPCS will be deasserted after the character written in TD has been transferred. When CSAAT is set, this allows to close the communication with the current serial peripheral by raising the corresponding NPCS line as soon as TD transfer has completed. 270 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.7.2 Name: SPI Mode Register SPI_MR Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 19 18 25 24 17 16 DLYBCS 23 22 21 20 – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 3 7 6 5 4 LLB – – MODFDIS PCS 2 1 0 PCSDEC PS MSTR • MSTR: Master/Slave Mode 0 = SPI is in Slave mode. 1 = SPI is in Master mode. • PS: Peripheral Select 0 = Fixed Peripheral Select. 1 = Variable Peripheral Select. • PCSDEC: Chip Select Decode 0 = The chip selects are directly connected to a peripheral device. 1 = The four chip select lines are connected to a 4- to 16-bit decoder. When PCSDEC equals one, up to 15 Chip Select signals can be generated with the four lines using an external 4- to 16-bit decoder. The Chip Select Registers define the characteristics of the 15 chip selects according to the following rules: SPI_CSR0 defines peripheral chip select signals 0 to 3. SPI_CSR1 defines peripheral chip select signals 4 to 7. SPI_CSR2 defines peripheral chip select signals 8 to 11. SPI_CSR3 defines peripheral chip select signals 12 to 14. • MODFDIS: Mode Fault Detection 0 = Mode fault detection is enabled. 1 = Mode fault detection is disabled. • LLB: Local Loopback Enable 0 = Local loopback path disabled. 1 = Local loopback path enabled. LLB controls the local loopback on the data serializer for testing in Master Mode only. (MISO is internally connected on MOSI.) • PCS: Peripheral Chip Select This field is only used if Fixed Peripheral Select is active (PS = 0). 271 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 If PCSDEC = 0: PCS = xxx0 NPCS[3:0] = 1110 PCS = xx01 NPCS[3:0] = 1101 PCS = x011 NPCS[3:0] = 1011 PCS = 0111 NPCS[3:0] = 0111 PCS = 1111 forbidden (no peripheral is selected) (x = don’t care) If PCSDEC = 1: NPCS[3:0] output signals = PCS. • DLYBCS: Delay Between Chip Selects This field defines the delay from NPCS inactive to the activation of another NPCS. The DLYBCS time guarantees non-overlapping chip selects and solves bus contentions in case of peripherals having long data float times. If DLYBCS is less than or equal to six, six MCK periods will be inserted by default. Otherwise, the following equation determines the delay: Delay Between Chip Selects = DLYBCS ------------------------MCK 272 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.7.3 Name: SPI Receive Data Register SPI_RDR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – 15 14 13 12 PCS 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RD 7 6 5 4 RD • RD: Receive Data Data received by the SPI Interface is stored in this register right-justified. Unused bits read zero. • PCS: Peripheral Chip Select In Master Mode only, these bits indicate the value on the NPCS pins at the end of a transfer. Otherwise, these bits read zero. 273 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.7.4 Name: SPI Transmit Data Register SPI_TDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – LASTXFER 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – 15 14 13 12 PCS 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TD 7 6 5 4 TD • TD: Transmit Data Data to be transmitted by the SPI Interface is stored in this register. Information to be transmitted must be written to the transmit data register in a right-justified format. PCS: Peripheral Chip Select This field is only used if Variable Peripheral Select is active (PS = 1). If PCSDEC = 0: PCS = xxx0 NPCS[3:0] = 1110 PCS = xx01 NPCS[3:0] = 1101 PCS = x011 NPCS[3:0] = 1011 PCS = 0111 NPCS[3:0] = 0111 PCS = 1111 forbidden (no peripheral is selected) (x = don’t care) If PCSDEC = 1: NPCS[3:0] output signals = PCS • LASTXFER: Last Transfer 0 = No effect. 1 = The current NPCS will be deasserted after the character written in TD has been transferred. When CSAAT is set, this allows to close the communication with the current serial peripheral by raising the corresponding NPCS line as soon as TD transfer has completed. This field is only used if Variable Peripheral Select is active (PS = 1). 274 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.7.5 Name: SPI Status Register SPI_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – SPIENS 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – TXEMPTY NSSR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX OVRES MODF TDRE RDRF • RDRF: Receive Data Register Full 0 = No data has been received since the last read of SPI_RDR 1 = Data has been received and the received data has been transferred from the serializer to SPI_RDR since the last read of SPI_RDR. • TDRE: Transmit Data Register Empty 0 = Data has been written to SPI_TDR and not yet transferred to the serializer. 1 = The last data written in the Transmit Data Register has been transferred to the serializer. TDRE equals zero when the SPI is disabled or at reset. The SPI enable command sets this bit to one. • MODF: Mode Fault Error 0 = No Mode Fault has been detected since the last read of SPI_SR. 1 = A Mode Fault occurred since the last read of the SPI_SR. • OVRES: Overrun Error Status 0 = No overrun has been detected since the last read of SPI_SR. 1 = An overrun has occurred since the last read of SPI_SR. An overrun occurs when SPI_RDR is loaded at least twice from the serializer since the last read of the SPI_RDR. • ENDRX: End of RX buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1). 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1). • ENDTX: End of TX buffer 0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1). 1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1). • RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1) has a value other than 0. 1 = Both SPI_RCR(1) and SPI_RNCR(1) have a value of 0. 275 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty 0 = SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1) has a value other than 0. 1 = Both SPI_TCR(1) and SPI_TNCR(1) have a value of 0. • NSSR: NSS Rising 0 = No rising edge detected on NSS pin since last read. 1 = A rising edge occurred on NSS pin since last read. • TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty 0 = As soon as data is written in SPI_TDR. 1 = SPI_TDR and internal shifter are empty. If a transfer delay has been defined, TXEMPTY is set after the completion of such delay. • SPIENS: SPI Enable Status 0 = SPI is disabled. 1 = SPI is enabled. Note: 1. 276 SPI_RCR, SPI_RNCR, SPI_TCR, SPI_TNCR are physically located in the PDC. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.7.6 Name: SPI Interrupt Enable Register SPI_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – TXEMPTY NSSR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX OVRES MODF TDRE RDRF • RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Enable • TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable • MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Enable • OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable • TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Enable • NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 277 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.7.7 Name: SPI Interrupt Disable Register SPI_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – TXEMPTY NSSR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX OVRES MODF TDRE RDRF • RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Disable • TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Disable • MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Disable • OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable • TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Disable • NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 278 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 28.7.8 Name: SPI Interrupt Mask Register SPI_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – TXEMPTY NSSR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX OVRES MODF TDRE RDRF • RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Mask • TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Mask • MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Mask • OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask • TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Mask • NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 279 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 28.7.9 Name: SPI Chip Select Register SPI_CSR0... SPI_CSR3 Access Type: 31 Read/Write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 DLYBCT 23 22 21 20 DLYBS 15 14 13 12 SCBR 7 6 5 4 BITS 3 2 1 0 CSAAT – NCPHA CPOL • CPOL: Clock Polarity 0 = The inactive state value of SPCK is logic level zero. 1 = The inactive state value of SPCK is logic level one. CPOL is used to determine the inactive state value of the serial clock (SPCK). It is used with NCPHA to produce the required clock/data relationship between master and slave devices. • NCPHA: Clock Phase 0 = Data is changed on the leading edge of SPCK and captured on the following edge of SPCK. 1 = Data is captured on the leading edge of SPCK and changed on the following edge of SPCK. NCPHA determines which edge of SPCK causes data to change and which edge causes data to be captured. NCPHA is used with CPOL to produce the required clock/data relationship between master and slave devices. • CSAAT: Chip Select Active After Transfer 0 = The Peripheral Chip Select Line rises as soon as the last transfer is achieved. 1 = The Peripheral Chip Select does not rise after the last transfer is achieved. It remains active until a new transfer is requested on a different chip select. 280 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • BITS: Bits Per Transfer The BITS field determines the number of data bits transferred. Reserved values should not be used. BITS 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Bits Per Transfer 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved • SCBR: Serial Clock Baud Rate In Master Mode, the SPI Interface uses a modulus counter to derive the SPCK baud rate from the Master Clock MCK. The Baud rate is selected by writing a value from 1 to 255 in the SCBR field. The following equations determine the SPCK baud rate: MCKSPCK Baudrate = ---------------SCBR Programming the SCBR field at 0 is forbidden. Triggering a transfer while SCBR is at 0 can lead to unpredictable results. At reset, SCBR is 0 and the user has to program it at a valid value before performing the first transfer. • DLYBS: Delay Before SPCK This field defines the delay from NPCS valid to the first valid SPCK transition. When DLYBS equals zero, the NPCS valid to SPCK transition is 1/2 the SPCK clock period. Otherwise, the following equations determine the delay: Delay Before SPCK = DLYBS --------------------MCK 281 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • DLYBCT: Delay Between Consecutive Transfers This field defines the delay between two consecutive transfers with the same peripheral without removing the chip select. The delay is always inserted after each transfer and before removing the chip select if needed. When DLYBCT equals zero, no delay between consecutive transfers is inserted and the clock keeps its duty cycle over the character transfers. Otherwise, the following equation determines the delay: 32 × DLYBCT Delay Between Consecutive Transfers = --------------------------------------MCK 282 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 29. Two-wire Interface (TWI) 29.1 Overview The Two-wire Interface (TWI) interconnects components on a unique two-wire bus, made up of one clock line and one data line with speeds of up to 400 Kbits per second, based on a byte-oriented transfer format. It can be used with any Atmel Two-wire Interface bus Serial EEPROM and I²C compatible device such as Real Time Clock (RTC), Dot Matrix/Graphic LCD Controllers and Temperature Sensor, to name but a few. The TWI is programmable as master transmitter or master receiver with sequential or single-byte access. A configurable baud rate generator permits the output data rate to be adapted to a wide range of core clock frequencies. Below, Table 29-1 lists the compatibility level of the Atmel Two-wire Interface and a full I2C compatible device. Table 29-1. Atmel TWI compatibility with i2C Standard I2C Standard Atmel TWI Standard Mode Speed (100 KHz) Supported Fast Mode Speed (400 KHz) Supported 7 or 10 bits Slave Addressing Supported (1) START BYTE Not Supported Repeated Start (Sr) Condition Not Fully Supported(2) ACK and NACK Management Supported Slope control and input filtering (Fast mode) Not Supported Clock stretching Supported Notes: 1. START + b000000001 + Ack + Sr 2. A repeated start condition is only supported in Master Receiver mode. See Section 29.6.5 “Internal Address” on page 288 29.2 List of Abbreviations Table 29-2. Abbreviations Abbreviation Description TWI Two-wire Interface A Acknowledge NA Non Acknowledge P Stop S Start Sr Repeated Start SADR Slave Address ADR Any address except SADR R Read W Write 283 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.3 Block Diagram Figure 29-1. Block Diagram APB Bridge TWCK PIO PMC MCK TWD Two-wire Interface TWI Interrupt 29.4 AIC Application Block Diagram Figure 29-2. Application Block Diagram VDD Rp Host with TWI Interface Rp TWD TWCK Atmel TWI Serial EEPROM Slave 1 I²C RTC I²C LCD Controller I²C Temp. Sensor Slave 2 Slave 3 Slave 4 Rp: Pull up value as given by the I²C Standard 29.4.1 I/O Lines Description Table 29-3. 29.5 29.5.1 I/O Lines Description Pin Name Pin Description Type TWD Two-wire Serial Data Input/Output TWCK Two-wire Serial Clock Input/Output Product Dependencies I/O Lines Both TWD and TWCK are bidirectional lines, connected to a positive supply voltage via a current source or pull-up resistor (see Figure 29-2 on page 284). When the bus is free, both lines are 284 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 high. The output stages of devices connected to the bus must have an open-drain or open-collector to perform the wired-AND function. TWD and TWCK pins may be multiplexed with PIO lines. To enable the TWI, the programmer must perform the following step: • Program the PIO controller to dedicate TWD and TWCK as peripheral lines. The user must not program TWD and TWCK as open-drain. It is already done by the hardware. 29.5.2 Power Management • Enable the peripheral clock. The TWI interface may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the TWI clock. 29.5.3 Interrupt The TWI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). In order to handle interrupts, the AIC must be programmed before configuring the TWI. 29.6 29.6.1 Functional Description Transfer format The data put on the TWD line must be 8 bits long. Data is transferred MSB first; each byte must be followed by an acknowledgement. The number of bytes per transfer is unlimited (see Figure 29-4 on page 285). Each transfer begins with a START condition and terminates with a STOP condition (see Figure 29-3 on page 285). • A high-to-low transition on the TWD line while TWCK is high defines the START condition. • A low-to-high transition on the TWD line while TWCK is high defines a STOP condition. Figure 29-3. START and STOP Conditions TWD TWCK Start Stop Figure 29-4. Transfer Format TWD TWCK Start 29.6.2 285 Address R/W Ack Data Ack Data Ack Stop Modes of Operation The TWI has two modes of operation: AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Master transmitter mode • Master receiver mode The TWI Control Register (TWI_CR) allows configuration of the interface in Master Mode. In this mode, it generates the clock according to the value programmed in the Clock Waveform Generator Register (TWI_CWGR). This register defines the TWCK signal completely, enabling the interface to be adapted to a wide range of clocks. 29.6.3 Master Transmitter Mode After the master initiates a Start condition when writing into the Transmit Holding Register, TWI_THR, it sends a 7-bit slave address, configured in the Master Mode register (DADR in TWI_MMR), to notify the slave device. The bit following the slave address indicates the transfer direction, 0 in this case (MREAD = 0 in TWI_MMR). The TWI transfers require the slave to acknowledge each received byte. During the acknowledge clock pulse (9th pulse), the master releases the data line (HIGH), enabling the slave to pull it down in order to generate the acknowledge. The master polls the data line during this clock pulse and sets the Not Acknowledge bit (NACK) in the status register if the slave does not acknowledge the byte. As with the other status bits, an interrupt can be generated if enabled in the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER). If the slave acknowledges the byte, the data written in the TWI_THR, is then shifted in the internal shifter and transferred. When an acknowledge is detected, the TXRDY bit is set until a new write in the TWI_THR. When no more data is written into the TWI_THR, the master generates a stop condition to end the transfer. The end of the complete transfer is marked by the TWI_TXCOMP bit set to one. See Figure 29-5, Figure 29-6, and Figure 29-7. Figure 29-5. Master Write with One Data Byte TWD S DADR W A DATA A P TXCOMP TXRDY STOP sent automaticaly (ACK received and TXRDY = 1) Write THR (DATA) Figure 29-6. Master Write with Multiple Data Byte TWD S DADR W A DATA n A DATA n+5 A DATA n+x A P TXCOMP TXRDY Write THR (Data n) 286 Write THR (Data n+1) Write THR (Data n+x) Last data sent STOP sent automaticaly (ACK received and TXRDY = 1) AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-7. Master Write with One Byte Internal Address and Multiple Data Bytes TWD S DADR W A IADR(7:0) A DATA n A DATA n+5 A DATA n+x A P TXCOMP TXRDY Write THR (Data n) 29.6.4 Write THR (Data n+1) Write THR (Data n+x) STOP sent automaticaly Last data sent (ACK received and TXRDY = 1) Master Receiver Mode The read sequence begins by setting the START bit. After the start condition has been sent, the master sends a 7-bit slave address to notify the slave device. The bit following the slave address indicates the transfer direction, 1 in this case (MREAD = 1 in TWI_MMR). During the acknowledge clock pulse (9th pulse), the master releases the data line (HIGH), enabling the slave to pull it down in order to generate the acknowledge. The master polls the data line during this clock pulse and sets the NACK bit in the status register if the slave does not acknowledge the byte. If an acknowledge is received, the master is then ready to receive data from the slave. After data has been received, the master sends an acknowledge condition to notify the slave that the data has been received except for the last data, after the stop condition. See Figure 29-9. When the RXRDY bit is set in the status register, a character has been received in the receive-holding register (TWI_RHR). The RXRDY bit is reset when reading the TWI_RHR. When a single data byte read is performed, with or without internal address (IADR), the START and STOP bits must be set at the same time. See Figure 29-8. When a multiple data byte read is performed, with or without internal address (IADR), the STOP bit must be set after the next-tolast data received. See Figure 29-9. For Internal Address usage see Section 29.6.5. Figure 29-8. Master Read with One Data Byte TWD S DADR R A DATA N P TXCOMP Write START & STOP Bit RXRDY Read RHR 287 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-9. Master Read with Multiple Data Bytes TWD S DADR R A DATA n A DATA (n+1) A DATA (n+m)-1 A DATA (n+m) N P TXCOMP Write START Bit RXRDY Read RHR DATA n Read RHR DATA (n+1) Read RHR DATA (n+m)-1 Read RHR DATA (n+m) Write STOP Bit after next-to-last data read 29.6.5 29.6.5.1 Internal Address The TWI interface can perform various transfer formats: Transfers with 7-bit slave address devices and 10-bit slave address devices. 7-bit Slave Addressing When Addressing 7-bit slave devices, the internal address bytes are used to perform random address (read or write) accesses to reach one or more data bytes, within a memory page location in a serial memory, for example. When performing read operations with an internal address, the TWI performs a write operation to set the internal address into the slave device, and then switch to Master Receiver mode. Note that the second start condition (after sending the IADR) is sometimes called “repeated start” (Sr) in I2C fully-compatible devices. See Figure 29-10, Figure 29-11 and Figure 29-12. The three internal address bytes are configurable through the Master Mode register (TWI_MMR). If the slave device supports only a 7-bit address, i.e. no internal address, IADRSZ must be set to 0. In the figures below the following abbreviations are used: 288 •S Start •P Stop •W Write •R Read •A Acknowledge •N Not Acknowledge • DADR Device Address • IADR Internal Address AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-10. Master Write with One, Two or Three Bytes Internal Address and One Data Byte Three bytes internal address S TWD DADR W A IADR(23:16) A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A W A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A DATA A W A IADR(7:0) A DATA A DATA A P Two bytes internal address S TWD DADR P One byte internal address S TWD DADR P Figure 29-11. Master Read with One, Two or Three Bytes Internal Address and One Data Byte Three bytes internal address S TWD DADR W A IADR(23:16) A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A S DADR R A DATA N P Two bytes internal address S TWD DADR W A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A IADR(7:0) A S A S R A DADR R A DATA N P One byte internal address TWD 29.6.5.2 S DADR W DADR DATA N P 10-bit Slave Addressing For a slave address higher than 7 bits, the user must configure the address size (IADRSZ) and set the other slave address bits in the internal address register (TWI_IADR). The two remaining Internal address bytes, IADR[15:8] and IADR[23:16] can be used the same as in 7-bit Slave Addressing. Example: Address a 10-bit device (10-bit device address is b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10) 1. Program IADRSZ = 1, 2. Program DADR with 1 1 1 1 0 b1 b2 (b1 is the MSB of the 10-bit address, b2, etc.) 3. Program TWI_IADR with b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10 (b10 is the LSB of the 10-bit address) Figure 29-12 below shows a byte write to an Atmel AT24LC512 EEPROM. This demonstrates the use of internal addresses to access the device. Figure 29-12. Internal Address Usage S T A R T Device Address W R I T E FIRST WORD ADDRESS SECOND WORD ADDRESS S T O P DATA 0 M S B 289 L R A S / C BW K M S B A C K L A SC BK A C K AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.6.6 Read/Write Flowcharts The following flowcharts shown in Figure 29-13, Figure 29-14 on page 291, Figure 29-15 on page 292, Figure 29-16 on page 293, Figure 29-17 on page 294 and Figure 29-18 on page 295 give examples for read and write operations. A polling or interrupt method can be used to check the status bits. The interrupt method requires that the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER) be configured first. Figure 29-13. TWI Write Operation with Single Data Byte without Internal Address BEGIN Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once) Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address (DADR) - Transfer direction bit Write ==> bit MREAD = 0 Load Transmit register TWI_THR = Data to send Read Status register No TXRDY = 1? Yes Read Status register No TXCOMP = 1? Yes Transfer finished 290 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-14. TWI Write Operation with Single Data Byte and Internal Address BEGIN Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once) Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address (DADR) - Internal address size (IADRSZ) - Transfer direction bit Write ==> bit MREAD = 0 Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address Load transmit register TWI_THR = Data to send Read Status register No TXRDY = 1? Yes Read Status register TXCOMP = 1? No Yes Transfer finished 291 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-15. TWI Write Operation with Multiple Data Bytes with or without Internal Address BEGIN Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once) Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Internal address size (if IADR used) - Transfer direction bit Write ==> bit MREAD = 0 No Internal address size = 0? Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address Yes Load Transmit register TWI_THR = Data to send Read Status register TWI_THR = data to send No TXRDY = 1? Yes Data to send? Yes Read Status register Yes No TXCOMP = 1? END 292 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-16. TWI Read Operation with Single Data Byte without Internal Address BEGIN Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once) Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Transfer direction bit Read ==> bit MREAD = 1 Start the transfer TWI_CR = START | STOP Read status register RXRDY = 1? No Yes Read Receive Holding Register Read Status register No TXCOMP = 1? Yes END 293 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-17. TWI Read Operation with Single Data Byte and Internal Address BEGIN Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once) Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Internal address size (IADRSZ) - Transfer direction bit Read ==> bit MREAD = 1 Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address Start the transfer TWI_CR = START | STOP Read Status register No RXRDY = 1? Yes Read Receive Holding register Read Status register No TXCOMP = 1? Yes END 294 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 29-18. TWI Read Operation with Multiple Data Bytes with or without Internal Address BEGIN Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once) Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Internal address size (if IADR used) - Transfer direction bit Read ==> bit MREAD = 1 Internal address size = 0? Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address Yes Start the transfer TWI_CR = START Read Status register RXRDY = 1? No Yes Read Receive Holding register (TWI_RHR) No Last data to read but one? Yes Stop the transfer TWI_CR = STOP Read Status register No RXRDY = 1? Yes Read Receive Holding register (TWI_RHR) Read status register TXCOMP = 1? No Yes END 295 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7 Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface Table 29-4. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x0000 Control Register TWI_CR Write-only N/A 0x0004 Master Mode Register TWI_MMR Read-write 0x0000 0x0008 Reserved - - - 0x000C Internal Address Register TWI_IADR Read-write 0x0000 0x0010 Clock Waveform Generator Register TWI_CWGR Read-write 0x0000 0x0020 Status Register TWI_SR Read-only 0x0008 0x0024 Interrupt Enable Register TWI_IER Write-only N/A 0x0028 Interrupt Disable Register TWI_IDR Write-only N/A 0x002C Interrupt Mask Register TWI_IMR Read-only 0x0000 0x0030 Receive Holding Register TWI_RHR Read-only 0x0000 0x0034 Transmit Holding Register TWI_THR Read-write 0x0000 – – – 0x0038 - 0x00FC 296 Reserved AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.1 TWI Control Register Register Name:TWI_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 SWRST 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 MSDIS 2 MSEN 1 STOP 0 START • START: Send a START Condition 0 = No effect. 1 = A frame beginning with a START bit is transmitted according to the features defined in the mode register. This action is necessary when the TWI peripheral wants to read data from a slave. When configured in Master Mode with a write operation, a frame is sent as soon as the user writes a character in the Transmit Holding Register (TWI_THR). • STOP: Send a STOP Condition 0 = No effect. 1 = STOP Condition is sent just after completing the current byte transmission in master read mode. – In single data byte master read, the START and STOP must both be set. – In multiple data bytes master read, the STOP must be set after the last data received but one. – In master read mode, if a NACK bit is received, the STOP is automatically performed. – In multiple data write operation, when both THR and shift register are empty, a STOP condition is automatically sent. • MSEN: TWI Master Transfer Enabled 0 = No effect. 1 = If MSDIS = 0, the master data transfer is enabled. • MSDIS: TWI Master Transfer Disabled 0 = No effect. 1 = The master data transfer is disabled, all pending data is transmitted. The shifter and holding characters (if they contain data) are transmitted in case of write operation. In read operation, the character being transferred must be completely received before disabling. • SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Equivalent to a system reset. 297 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.2 TWI Master Mode Register Register Name:TWI_MMR Address Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 21 20 19 DADR 18 17 16 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 MREAD 11 – 10 – 9 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 – 8 IADRSZ 0 – • IADRSZ: Internal Device Address Size Table 29-5. IADRSZ[9:8] 0 0 No internal device address (Byte command protocol) 0 1 One-byte internal device address 1 0 Two-byte internal device address 1 1 Three-byte internal device address • MREAD: Master Read Direction 0 = Master write direction. 1 = Master read direction. • DADR: Device Address The device address is used to access slave devices in read or write mode. 298 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.3 TWI Internal Address Register Register Name:TWI_IADR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 23 22 21 20 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 IADR 15 14 13 12 IADR 7 6 5 4 IADR • IADR: Internal Address 0, 1, 2 or 3 bytes depending on IADRSZ. – Low significant byte address in 10-bit mode addresses. 299 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.4 TWI Clock Waveform Generator Register Register Name:TWI_CWGR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 17 CKDIV 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CHDIV 7 6 5 4 CLDIV • CLDIV: Clock Low Divider The SCL low period is defined as follows: T low = ( ( CLDIV × 2 CKDIV ) + 3 ) × T MCK • CHDIV: Clock High Divider The SCL high period is defined as follows: T high = ( ( CHDIV × 2 CKDIV ) + 3 ) × T MCK • CKDIV: Clock Divider The CKDIV is used to increase both SCL high and low periods. 300 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.5 TWI Status Register Register Name:TWI_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 NACK 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 TXRDY 1 RXRDY 0 TXCOMP • TXCOMP: Transmission Completed 0 = During the length of the current frame. 1 = When both holding and shift registers are empty and STOP condition has been sent, or when MSEN is set (enable TWI). • RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready 0 = No character has been received since the last TWI_RHR read operation. 1 = A byte has been received in the TWI_RHR since the last read. • TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready 0 = The transmit holding register has not been transferred into shift register. Set to 0 when writing into TWI_THR register. 1 = As soon as data byte is transferred from TWI_THR to internal shifter or if a NACK error is detected, TXRDY is set at the same time as TXCOMP and NACK. TXRDY is also set when MSEN is set (enable TWI). • NACK: Not Acknowledged 0 = Each data byte has been correctly received by the far-end side TWI slave component. 1 = A data byte has not been acknowledged by the slave component. Set at the same time as TXCOMP. Reset after read. 301 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.6 TWI Interrupt Enable Register Register Name:TWI_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 NACK 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 TXRDY 1 RXRDY 0 TXCOMP • TXCOMP: Transmission Completed • RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready • TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready • NACK: Not Acknowledge 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 29.7.7 TWI Interrupt Disable Register Register Name:TWI_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 NACK 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 TXRDY 1 RXRDY 0 TXCOMP • TXCOMP: Transmission Completed • RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready • TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready • NACK: Not Acknowledge 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 302 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.8 TWI Interrupt Mask Register Register Name:TWI_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 NACK 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 TXRDY 1 RXRDY 0 TXCOMP • TXCOMP: Transmission Completed • RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready • TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready • NACK: Not Acknowledge 0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 29.7.9 TWI Receive Holding Register Register Name:TWI_RHR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RXDATA • RXDATA: Receive Holding Data 303 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7.10 TWI Transmit Holding Register Register Name: TWI_THR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXDATA • TXDATA: Transmit Holding Data 304 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30. Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) 30.1 Overview The Atmel Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) provides a synchronous communication link with external devices. It supports many serial synchronous communication protocols generally used in audio and telecom applications such as I2S, Short Frame Sync, Long Frame Sync, etc. The SSC contains an independent receiver and transmitter and a common clock divider. The receiver and the transmitter each interface with three signals: the TD/RD signal for data, the TK/RK signal for the clock and the TF/RF signal for the Frame Sync. The transfers can be programmed to start automatically or on different events detected on the Frame Sync signal. The SSC’s high-level of programmability and its two dedicated PDC channels of up to 32 bits permit a continuous high bit rate data transfer without processor intervention. Featuring connection to two PDC channels, the SSC permits interfacing with low processor overhead to the following: • CODEC’s in master or slave mode • DAC through dedicated serial interface, particularly I2S • Magnetic card reader 305 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 30.2 Block Diagram Figure 30-1. Block Diagram ASB APB Bridge PDC APB TF TK PMC TD MCK PIO SSC Interface RF RK Interrupt Control RD SSC Interrupt 30.3 Application Block Diagram Figure 30-2. Application Block Diagram OS or RTOS Driver Power Management Interrupt Management Test Management SSC Serial AUDIO 306 Codec Time Slot Management Frame Management Line Interface AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.4 Pin Name List Table 30-1. I/O Lines Description Pin Name Pin Description RF Receiver Frame Synchro Input/Output RK Receiver Clock Input/Output RD Receiver Data Input TF Transmitter Frame Synchro Input/Output TK Transmitter Clock Input/Output TD Transmitter Data Output 30.5 30.5.1 Type Product Dependencies I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. Before using the SSC receiver, the PIO controller must be configured to dedicate the SSC receiver I/O lines to the SSC peripheral mode. Before using the SSC transmitter, the PIO controller must be configured to dedicate the SSC transmitter I/O lines to the SSC peripheral mode. 30.5.2 Power Management The SSC is not continuously clocked. The SSC interface may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), therefore the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the SSC clock. 30.5.3 Interrupt The SSC interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling interrupts requires programming the AIC before configuring the SSC. All SSC interrupts can be enabled/disabled configuring the SSC Interrupt mask register. Each pending and unmasked SSC interrupt will assert the SSC interrupt line. The SSC interrupt service routine can get the interrupt origin by reading the SSC interrupt status register. 30.6 Functional Description This chapter contains the functional description of the following: SSC Functional Block, Clock Management, Data format, Start, Transmitter, Receiver and Frame Sync. The receiver and transmitter operate separately. However, they can work synchronously by programming the receiver to use the transmit clock and/or to start a data transfer when transmission starts. Alternatively, this can be done by programming the transmitter to use the receive clock and/or to start a data transfer when reception starts. The transmitter and the receiver can be programmed to operate with the clock signals provided on either the TK or RK pins. This allows the SSC to support many slave-mode data transfers. The maximum clock speed allowed on the TK and RK pins is the master clock divided by 2. 307 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 30-3. SSC Functional Block Diagram Transmitter MCK TK Input Clock Divider Transmit Clock Controller RX clock TF RF Start Selector TX clock Clock Output Controller TK Frame Sync Controller TF Transmit Shift Register TX PDC APB Transmit Holding Register TD Transmit Sync Holding Register Load Shift User Interface Receiver RK Input Receive Clock RX Clock Controller TX Clock RF TF Start Selector Interrupt Control RK Frame Sync Controller RF RD Receive Shift Register RX PDC PDC Clock Output Controller Receive Holding Register Receive Sync Holding Register Load Shift AIC 30.6.1 Clock Management The transmitter clock can be generated by: • an external clock received on the TK I/O pad • the receiver clock • the internal clock divider The receiver clock can be generated by: • an external clock received on the RK I/O pad • the transmitter clock • the internal clock divider Furthermore, the transmitter block can generate an external clock on the TK I/O pad, and the receiver block can generate an external clock on the RK I/O pad. This allows the SSC to support many Master and Slave Mode data transfers. 308 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.6.1.1 Clock Divider Figure 30-4. Divided Clock Block Diagram Clock Divider SSC_CMR MCK /2 12-bit Counter Divided Clock The Master Clock divider is determined by the 12-bit field DIV counter and comparator (so its maximal value is 4095) in the Clock Mode Register SSC_CMR, allowing a Master Clock division by up to 8190. The Divided Clock is provided to both the Receiver and Transmitter. When this field is programmed to 0, the Clock Divider is not used and remains inactive. When DIV is set to a value equal to or greater than 1, the Divided Clock has a frequency of Master Clock divided by 2 times DIV. Each level of the Divided Clock has a duration of the Master Clock multiplied by DIV. This ensures a 50% duty cycle for the Divided Clock regardless of whether the DIV value is even or odd. Figure 30-5. Divided Clock Generation Master Clock Divided Clock DIV = 1 Divided Clock Frequency = MCK/2 Master Clock Divided Clock DIV = 3 Divided Clock Frequency = MCK/6 Table 30-2. 30.6.1.2 Maximum Minimum MCK / 2 MCK / 8190 Transmitter Clock Management The transmitter clock is generated from the receiver clock or the divider clock or an external clock scanned on the TK I/O pad. The transmitter clock is selected by the CKS field in SSC_TCMR (Transmit Clock Mode Register). Transmit Clock can be inverted independently by the CKI bits in SSC_TCMR. The transmitter can also drive the TK I/O pad continuously or be limited to the actual data transfer. The clock output is configured by the SSC_TCMR register. The Transmit Clock Inversion (CKI) bits have no effect on the clock outputs. Programming the TCMR register to select TK pin 309 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 (CKS field) and at the same time Continuous Transmit Clock (CKO field) might lead to unpredictable results. Figure 30-6. Transmitter Clock Management SSC_TCMR.CKS SSC_TCMR.CKO TK Receiver Clock TK Divider Clock 0 Transmitter Clock 1 SSC_TCMR.CKI 30.6.1.3 Receiver Clock Management The receiver clock is generated from the transmitter clock or the divider clock or an external clock scanned on the RK I/O pad. The Receive Clock is selected by the CKS field in SSC_RCMR (Receive Clock Mode Register). Receive Clocks can be inverted independently by the CKI bits in SSC_RCMR. The receiver can also drive the RK I/O pad continuously or be limited to the actual data transfer. The clock output is configured by the SSC_RCMR register. The Receive Clock Inversion (CKI) bits have no effect on the clock outputs. Programming the RCMR register to select RK pin (CKS field) and at the same time Continuous Receive Clock (CKO field) can lead to unpredictable results. Figure 30-7. Receiver Clock Management SSC_RCMR.CKO SSC_RCMR.CKS RK Transmitter Clock RK Divider Clock 0 Receiver Clock 1 SSC_RCMR.CKI 30.6.1.4 Serial Clock Ratio Considerations The Transmitter and the Receiver can be programmed to operate with the clock signals provided on either the TK or RK pins. This allows the SSC to support many slave-mode data transfers. In this case, the maximum clock speed allowed on the RK pin is: – Master Clock divided by 2 if Receiver Frame Synchro is input – Master Clock divided by 3 if Receiver Frame Synchro is output In addition, the maximum clock speed allowed on the TK pin is: – Master Clock divided by 6 if Transmit Frame Synchro is input – Master Clock divided by 2 if Transmit Frame Synchro is output 310 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.6.2 Transmitter Operations A transmitted frame is triggered by a start event and can be followed by synchronization data before data transmission. The start event is configured by setting the Transmit Clock Mode Register (SSC_TCMR). See “Start” on page 312. The frame synchronization is configured setting the Transmit Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR). See “Frame Sync” on page 314. To transmit data, the transmitter uses a shift register clocked by the transmitter clock signal and the start mode selected in the SSC_TCMR. Data is written by the application to the SSC_THR register then transferred to the shift register according to the data format selected. When both the SSC_THR and the transmit shift register are empty, the status flag TXEMPTY is set in SSC_SR. When the Transmit Holding register is transferred in the Transmit shift register, the status flag TXRDY is set in SSC_SR and additional data can be loaded in the holding register. Figure 30-8. Transmitter Block Diagram SSC_CR.TXEN SSC_SR.TXEN SSC_CR.TXDIS SSC_TFMR.DATDEF 1 RF Transmitter Clock TF Start Selector 30.6.3 TD 0 SSC_TFMR.MSBF Transmit Shift Register SSC_TFMR.FSDEN SSC_TCMR.STTDLY SSC_TFMR.DATLEN SSC_TCMR.STTDLY SSC_TFMR.FSDEN SSC_TFMR.DATNB 0 SSC_THR 1 SSC_TSHR SSC_TFMR.FSLEN Receiver Operations A received frame is triggered by a start event and can be followed by synchronization data before data transmission. The start event is configured setting the Receive Clock Mode Register (SSC_RCMR). See “Start” on page 312. The frame synchronization is configured setting the Receive Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR). See “Frame Sync” on page 314. The receiver uses a shift register clocked by the receiver clock signal and the start mode selected in the SSC_RCMR. The data is transferred from the shift register depending on the data format selected. 311 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 When the receiver shift register is full, the SSC transfers this data in the holding register, the status flag RXRDY is set in SSC_SR and the data can be read in the receiver holding register. If another transfer occurs before read of the RHR register, the status flag OVERUN is set in SSC_SR and the receiver shift register is transferred in the RHR register. Figure 30-9. Receiver Block Diagram SSC_CR.RXEN SSC_SR.RXEN SSC_CR.RXDIS RF Receiver Clock TF Start Selector SSC_RFMR.MSBF SSC_RFMR.DATNB Receive Shift Register SSC_RSHR SSC_RHR SSC_RFMR.FSLEN SSC_RFMR.DATLEN RD SSC_RCMR.STTDLY 30.6.4 Start The transmitter and receiver can both be programmed to start their operations when an event occurs, respectively in the Transmit Start Selection (START) field of SSC_TCMR and in the Receive Start Selection (START) field of SSC_RCMR. Under the following conditions the start event is independently programmable: • Continuous. In this case, the transmission starts as soon as a word is written in SSC_THR and the reception starts as soon as the Receiver is enabled. • Synchronously with the transmitter/receiver • On detection of a falling/rising edge on TF/RF • On detection of a low level/high level on TF/RF • On detection of a level change or an edge on TF/RF A start can be programmed in the same manner on either side of the Transmit/Receive Clock Register (RCMR/TCMR). Thus, the start could be on TF (Transmit) or RF (Receive). Moreover, the Receiver can start when data is detected in the bit stream with the Compare Functions. Detection on TF/RF input/output is done by the field FSOS of the Transmit/Receive Frame Mode Register (TFMR/RFMR). 312 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 30-10. Transmit Start Mode TK TF (Input) Start = Low Level on TF Start = Falling Edge on TF Start = High Level on TF Start = Rising Edge on TF Start = Level Change on TF Start = Any Edge on TF TD (Output) TD (Output) X BO STTDLY BO X B1 STTDLY BO X TD (Output) B1 STTDLY TD (Output) BO X B1 STTDLY TD (Output) TD (Output) B1 BO X B1 BO B1 STTDLY X B1 BO BO B1 STTDLY Figure 30-11. Receive Pulse/Edge Start Modes RK RF (Input) Start = Low Level on RF Start = Falling Edge on RF Start = High Level on RF Start = Rising Edge on RF Start = Level Change on RF Start = Any Edge on RF RD (Input) RD (Input) X BO STTDLY BO X B1 STTDLY BO X RD (Input) B1 STTDLY RD (Input) BO X B1 STTDLY RD (Input) RD (Input) B1 BO X B1 BO B1 STTDLY X BO B1 BO B1 STTDLY 313 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 30.6.5 Frame Sync The Transmitter and Receiver Frame Sync pins, TF and RF, can be programmed to generate different kinds of frame synchronization signals. The Frame Sync Output Selection (FSOS) field in the Receive Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR) and in the Transmit Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR) are used to select the required waveform. • Programmable low or high levels during data transfer are supported. • Programmable high levels before the start of data transfers or toggling are also supported. If a pulse waveform is selected, the Frame Sync Length (FSLEN) field in SSC_RFMR and SSC_TFMR programs the length of the pulse, from 1 bit time up to 16 bit time. The periodicity of the Receive and Transmit Frame Sync pulse output can be programmed through the Period Divider Selection (PERIOD) field in SSC_RCMR and SSC_TCMR. 30.6.5.1 Frame Sync Data Frame Sync Data transmits or receives a specific tag during the Frame Sync signal. During the Frame Sync signal, the Receiver can sample the RD line and store the data in the Receive Sync Holding Register and the transmitter can transfer Transmit Sync Holding Register in the Shifter Register. The data length to be sampled/shifted out during the Frame Sync signal is programmed by the FSLEN field in SSC_RFMR/SSC_TFMR and has a maximum value of 16. Concerning the Receive Frame Sync Data operation, if the Frame Sync Length is equal to or lower than the delay between the start event and the actual data reception, the data sampling operation is performed in the Receive Sync Holding Register through the Receive Shift Register. The Transmit Frame Sync Operation is performed by the transmitter only if the bit Frame Sync Data Enable (FSDEN) in SSC_TFMR is set. If the Frame Sync length is equal to or lower than the delay between the start event and the actual data transmission, the normal transmission has priority and the data contained in the Transmit Sync Holding Register is transferred in the Transmit Register, then shifted out. 30.6.5.2 30.6.6 Frame Sync Edge Detection The Frame Sync Edge detection is programmed by the FSEDGE field in SSC_RFMR/SSC_TFMR. This sets the corresponding flags RXSYN/TXSYN in the SSC Status Register (SSC_SR) on frame synchro edge detection (signals RF/TF). Receive Compare Modes Figure 30-12. Receive Compare Modes RK RD (Input) CMP0 CMP1 CMP2 CMP3 Ignored B0 B1 B2 Start FSLEN Up to 16 Bits (4 in This Example) 314 STDLY DATLEN AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.6.6.1 30.6.7 Compare Functions Length of the comparison patterns (Compare 0, Compare 1) and thus the number of bits they are compared to is defined by FSLEN, but with a maximum value of 16 bits. Comparison is always done by comparing the last bits received with the comparison pattern. Compare 0 can be one start event of the Receiver. In this case, the receiver compares at each new sample the last bits received at the Compare 0 pattern contained in the Compare 0 Register (SSC_RC0R). When this start event is selected, the user can program the Receiver to start a new data transfer either by writing a new Compare 0, or by receiving continuously until Compare 1 occurs. This selectio is done with the bit (STOP) in SSC_RCMR. Data Format The data framing format of both the transmitter and the receiver are programmable through the Transmitter Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR) and the Receiver Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR). In either case, the user can independently select: • the event that starts the data transfer (START) • the delay in number of bit periods between the start event and the first data bit (STTDLY) • the length of the data (DATLEN) • the number of data to be transferred for each start event (DATNB). • the length of synchronization transferred for each start event (FSLEN) • the bit sense: most or lowest significant bit first (MSBF). Additionally, the transmitter can be used to transfer synchronization and select the level driven on the TD pin while not in data transfer operation. This is done respectively by the Frame Sync Data Enable (FSDEN) and by the Data Default Value (DATDEF) bits in SSC_TFMR. 315 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 30-3. Data Frame Registers Transmitter Receiver Field Length Comment SSC_TFMR SSC_RFMR DATLEN Up to 32 Size of word SSC_TFMR SSC_RFMR DATNB Up to 16 Number of words transmitted in frame SSC_TFMR SSC_RFMR MSBF SSC_TFMR SSC_RFMR FSLEN Up to 16 Size of Synchro data register SSC_TFMR DATDEF 0 or 1 Data default value ended SSC_TFMR FSDEN Most significant bit first Enable send SSC_TSHR SSC_TCMR SSC_RCMR PERIOD Up to 512 Frame size SSC_TCMR SSC_RCMR STTDLY Up to 255 Size of transmit start delay Figure 30-13. Transmit and Receive Frame Format in Edge/Pulse Start Modes Start Start PERIOD TF/RF (1) FSLEN TD (If FSDEN = 1) TD (If FSDEN = 0) RD Sync Data Data Data From SSC_THR From SSC_THR Default From SSC_TSHR FromDATDEF Default Sync Data Ignored To SSC_RSHR STTDLY From SSC_THR Data Data To SSC_RHR To SSC_RHR DATLEN DATLEN Sync Data FromDATDEF Data Data From SSC_THR From DATDEF Default Default From DATDEF Ignored Sync Data DATNB Note: 1. Example of input on falling edge of TF/RF. Figure 30-14. Transmit Frame Format in Continuous Mode Start TD Data From SSC_THR Data Default From SSC_THR DATLEN DATLEN Start: 1. TXEMPTY set to 1 2. Write into the SSC_THR 316 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Note: 1. STTDLY is set to 0. In this example, SSC_THR is loaded twice. FSDEN value has no effect on the transmission. SyncData cannot be output in continuous mode. Figure 30-15. Receive Frame Format in Continuous Mode Start = Enable Receiver Data Data To SSC_RHR To SSC_RHR DATLEN DATLEN RD Note: 30.6.8 1. STTDLY is set to 0. Loop Mode The receiver can be programmed to receive transmissions from the transmitter. This is done by setting the Loop Mode (LOOP) bit in SSC_RFMR. In this case, RD is connected to TD, RF is connected to TF and RK is connected to TK. 30.6.9 Interrupt Most bits in SSC_SR have a corresponding bit in interrupt management registers. The SSC can be programmed to generate an interrupt when it detects an event. The interrupt is controlled by writing SSC_IER (Interrupt Enable Register) and SSC_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register) These registers enable and disable, respectively, the corresponding interrupt by setting and clearing the corresponding bit in SSC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register), which controls the generation of interrupts by asserting the SSC interrupt line connected to the AIC. Figure 30-16. Interrupt Block Diagram SSC_IMR SSC_IER PDC SSC_IDR Set Clear TXBUFE ENDTX Transmitter TXRDY TXEMPTY TXSYNC Interrupt Control RXBUFF ENDRX SSC Interrupt Receiver RXRDY OVRUN RXSYNC 317 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 30.7 SSC Application Examples The SSC can support several serial communication modes used in audio or high speed serial links. Some standard applications are shown in the following figures. All serial link applications supported by the SSC are not listed here. Figure 30-17. Audio Application Block Diagram Clock SCK TK Word Select WS I2S RECEIVER TF Data SD SSC TD RD Clock SCK RF Word Select WS RK MSB Data SD LSB MSB Right Channel Left Channel Figure 30-18. Codec Application Block Diagram Serial Data Clock (SCLK) TK Frame sync (FSYNC) TF Serial Data Out SSC CODEC TD Serial Data In RD RF RK Serial Data Clock (SCLK) Frame sync (FSYNC) First Time Slot Dstart Dend Serial Data Out Serial Data In 318 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 30-19. Time Slot Application Block Diagram SCLK TK FSYNC TF CODEC First Time Slot Data Out TD SSC RD Data in RF RK CODEC Second Time Slot Serial Data Clock (SCLK) Frame sync (FSYNC) First Time Slot Dstart Second Time Slot Dend Serial Data Out Serial Data in 319 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) User Interface Table 30-4. Offset Register Mapping Register Name Access Reset SSC_CR Write – SSC_CMR Read-write 0x0 0x0 Control Register 0x4 Clock Mode Register 0x8 Reserved – – – 0xC Reserved – – – 0x10 Receive Clock Mode Register SSC_RCMR Read-write 0x0 0x14 Receive Frame Mode Register SSC_RFMR Read-write 0x0 0x18 Transmit Clock Mode Register SSC_TCMR Read-write 0x0 0x1C Transmit Frame Mode Register SSC_TFMR Read-write 0x0 0x20 Receive Holding Register SSC_RHR Read 0x0 0x24 Transmit Holding Register SSC_THR Write – 0x28 Reserved – – – 0x2C Reserved – – – 0x30 Receive Sync. Holding Register SSC_RSHR Read 0x0 0x34 Transmit Sync. Holding Register SSC_TSHR Read-write 0x0 0x38 Receive Compare 0 Register SSC_RC0R Read-write 0x0 0x3C Receive Compare 1 Register SSC_RC1R Read-write 0x0 0x40 Status Register SSC_SR Read 0x000000CC 0x44 Interrupt Enable Register SSC_IER Write – 0x48 Interrupt Disable Register SSC_IDR Write – 0x4C Interrupt Mask Register SSC_IMR Read 0x0 Reserved – – – Reserved for Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) – – – 0x50-0xFC 0x100- 0x124 320 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.1 Name: SSC Control Register SSC_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 SWRST 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 TXDIS 8 TXEN 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 RXDIS 0 RXEN • RXEN: Receive Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables Receive if RXDIS is not set. • RXDIS: Receive Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables Receive. If a character is currently being received, disables at end of current character reception. • TXEN: Transmit Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables Transmit if TXDIS is not set. • TXDIS: Transmit Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables Transmit. If a character is currently being transmitted, disables at end of current character transmission. • SWRST: Software Reset 0: No effect. 1: Performs a software reset. Has priority on any other bit in SSC_CR. 321 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.2 Name: SSC Clock Mode Register SSC_CMR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 1 0 DIV 3 2 DIV • DIV: Clock Divider 0: The Clock Divider is not active. Any Other Value: The Divided Clock equals the Master Clock divided by 2 times DIV. The maximum bit rate is MCK/2. The minimum bit rate is MCK/2 x 4095 = MCK/8190. 322 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.3 Name: SSC Receive Clock Mode Register SSC_RCMR Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 10 9 8 PERIOD 23 22 21 20 STTDLY 15 – 7 14 – 13 – 12 STOP 11 6 5 CKI 4 3 CKO CKG START 2 1 0 CKS • CKS: Receive Clock Selection CKS Selected Receive Clock 0x0 Divided Clock 0x1 TK Clock signal 0x2 RK pin 0x3 Reserved • CKO: Receive Clock Output Mode Selection CKO Receive Clock Output Mode 0x0 None 0x1 Continuous Receive Clock Output 0x2 Receive Clock only during data transfers Output 0x3-0x7 RK pin Input-only Reserved • CKI: Receive Clock Inversion 0: The data inputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are sampled on Receive Clock falling edge. The Frame Sync signal output is shifted out on Receive Clock rising edge. 1: The data inputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are sampled on Receive Clock rising edge. The Frame Sync signal output is shifted out on Receive Clock falling edge. CKI affects only the Receive Clock and not the output clock signal. 323 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • CKG: Receive Clock Gating Selection CKG Receive Clock Gating 0x0 None, continuous clock 0x1 Receive Clock enabled only if RF Low 0x2 Receive Clock enabled only if RF High 0x3 Reserved • START: Receive Start Selection START Receive Start 0x0 Continuous, as soon as the receiver is enabled, and immediately after the end of transfer of the previous data. 0x1 Transmit start 0x2 Detection of a low level on RF signal 0x3 Detection of a high level on RF signal 0x4 Detection of a falling edge on RF signal 0x5 Detection of a rising edge on RF signal 0x6 Detection of any level change on RF signal 0x7 Detection of any edge on RF signal 0x8 Compare 0 0x9-0xF Reserved • STOP: Receive Stop Selection 0: After completion of a data transfer when starting with a Compare 0, the receiver stops the data transfer and waits for a new compare 0. 1: After starting a receive with a Compare 0, the receiver operates in a continuous mode until a Compare 1 is detected. • STTDLY: Receive Start Delay If STTDLY is not 0, a delay of STTDLY clock cycles is inserted between the start event and the actual start of reception. When the Receiver is programmed to start synchronously with the Transmitter, the delay is also applied. Note: It is very important that STTDLY be set carefully. If STTDLY must be set, it should be done in relation to TAG (Receive Sync Data) reception. • PERIOD: Receive Period Divider Selection This field selects the divider to apply to the selected Receive Clock in order to generate a new Frame Sync Signal. If 0, no PERIOD signal is generated. If not 0, a PERIOD signal is generated each 2 x (PERIOD+1) Receive Clock. 324 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.4 Name: SSC Receive Frame Mode Register SSC_RFMR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 FSEDGE 23 – 22 21 FSOS 20 19 18 17 16 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 9 8 7 MSBF 6 – 5 LOOP 4 3 1 0 FSLEN 10 DATNB 2 DATLEN • DATLEN: Data Length 0: Forbidden value (1-bit data length not supported). Any other value: The bit stream contains DATLEN + 1 data bits. Moreover, it defines the transfer size performed by the PDC2 assigned to the Receiver. If DATLEN is lower or equal to 7, data transfers are in bytes. If DATLEN is between 8 and 15 (included), half-words are transferred, and for any other value, 32-bit words are transferred. • LOOP: Loop Mode 0: Normal operating mode. 1: RD is driven by TD, RF is driven by TF and TK drives RK. • MSBF: Most Significant Bit First 0: The lowest significant bit of the data register is sampled first in the bit stream. 1: The most significant bit of the data register is sampled first in the bit stream. • DATNB: Data Number per Frame This field defines the number of data words to be received after each transfer start, which is equal to (DATNB + 1). • FSLEN: Receive Frame Sync Length This field defines the length of the Receive Frame Sync Signal and the number of bits sampled and stored in the Receive Sync Data Register. When this mode is selected by the START field in the Receive Clock Mode Register, it also determines the length of the sampled data to be compared to the Compare 0 or Compare 1 register. Pulse length is equal to (FSLEN + 1) Receive Clock periods. Thus, if FSLEN is 0, the Receive Frame Sync signal is generated during one Receive Clock period. 325 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • FSOS: Receive Frame Sync Output Selection FSOS Selected Receive Frame Sync Signal RF Pin 0x0 None 0x1 Negative Pulse Output 0x2 Positive Pulse Output 0x3 Driven Low during data transfer Output 0x4 Driven High during data transfer Output 0x5 Toggling at each start of data transfer Output 0x6-0x7 Input-only Reserved Undefined • FSEDGE: Frame Sync Edge Detection Determines which edge on Frame Sync will generate the interrupt RXSYN in the SSC Status Register. FSEDGE Frame Sync Edge Detection 0x0 Positive Edge Detection 0x1 Negative Edge Detection 326 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.5 Name: SSC Transmit Clock Mode Register SSC_TCMR Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 10 9 8 PERIOD 23 22 21 20 STTDLY 15 – 7 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 6 5 CKI 4 3 CKO CKG START 2 1 0 CKS • CKS: Transmit Clock Selection CKS Selected Transmit Clock 0x0 Divided Clock 0x1 RK Clock signal 0x2 TK Pin 0x3 Reserved • CKO: Transmit Clock Output Mode Selection CKO Transmit Clock Output Mode 0x0 None 0x1 Continuous Transmit Clock Output 0x2 Transmit Clock only during data transfers Output 0x3-0x7 TK pin Input-only Reserved • CKI: Transmit Clock Inversion 0: The data outputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are shifted out on Transmit Clock falling edge. The Frame sync signal input is sampled on Transmit clock rising edge. 1: The data outputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are shifted out on Transmit Clock rising edge. The Frame sync signal input is sampled on Transmit clock falling edge. CKI affects only the Transmit Clock and not the output clock signal. 327 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • CKG: Transmit Clock Gating Selection CKG Transmit Clock Gating 0x0 None, continuous clock 0x1 Transmit Clock enabled only if TF Low 0x2 Transmit Clock enabled only if TF High 0x3 Reserved • START: Transmit Start Selection START Transmit Start 0x0 Continuous, as soon as a word is written in the SSC_THR Register (if Transmit is enabled), and immediately after the end of transfer of the previous data. 0x1 Receive start 0x2 Detection of a low level on TF signal 0x3 Detection of a high level on TF signal 0x4 Detection of a falling edge on TF signal 0x5 Detection of a rising edge on TF signal 0x6 Detection of any level change on TF signal 0x7 Detection of any edge on TF signal 0x8 - 0xF Reserved • STTDLY: Transmit Start Delay If STTDLY is not 0, a delay of STTDLY clock cycles is inserted between the start event and the actual start of transmission of data. When the Transmitter is programmed to start synchronously with the Receiver, the delay is also applied. Note: STTDLY must be set carefully. If STTDLY is too short in respect to TAG (Transmit Sync Data) emission, data is emitted instead of the end of TAG. • PERIOD: Transmit Period Divider Selection This field selects the divider to apply to the selected Transmit Clock to generate a new Frame Sync Signal. If 0, no period signal is generated. If not 0, a period signal is generated at each 2 x (PERIOD+1) Transmit Clock. 328 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.6 Name: SSC Transmit Frame Mode Register SSC_TFMR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 FSEDGE 23 FSDEN 22 21 FSOS 20 19 18 17 16 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 9 8 7 MSBF 6 – 5 DATDEF 4 3 1 0 FSLEN 10 DATNB 2 DATLEN • DATLEN: Data Length 0: Forbidden value (1-bit data length not supported). Any other value: The bit stream contains DATLEN + 1 data bits. Moreover, it defines the transfer size performed by the PDC2 assigned to the Transmit. If DATLEN is lower or equal to 7, data transfers are bytes, if DATLEN is between 8 and 15 (included), half-words are transferred, and for any other value, 32-bit words are transferred. • DATDEF: Data Default Value This bit defines the level driven on the TD pin while out of transmission. Note that if the pin is defined as multi-drive by the PIO Controller, the pin is enabled only if the SCC TD output is 1. • MSBF: Most Significant Bit First 0: The lowest significant bit of the data register is shifted out first in the bit stream. 1: The most significant bit of the data register is shifted out first in the bit stream. • DATNB: Data Number per frame This field defines the number of data words to be transferred after each transfer start, which is equal to (DATNB +1). • FSLEN: Transmit Frame Sync Length This field defines the length of the Transmit Frame Sync signal and the number of bits shifted out from the Transmit Sync Data Register if FSDEN is 1. Pulse length is equal to (FSLEN + 1) Transmit Clock periods, i.e., the pulse length can range from 1 to 16 Transmit Clock periods. If FSLEN is 0, the Transmit Frame Sync signal is generated during one Transmit Clock period. 329 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • FSOS: Transmit Frame Sync Output Selection FSOS Selected Transmit Frame Sync Signal TF Pin 0x0 None 0x1 Negative Pulse Output 0x2 Positive Pulse Output 0x3 Driven Low during data transfer Output 0x4 Driven High during data transfer Output 0x5 Toggling at each start of data transfer Output 0x6-0x7 Reserved Input-only Undefined • FSDEN: Frame Sync Data Enable 0: The TD line is driven with the default value during the Transmit Frame Sync signal. 1: SSC_TSHR value is shifted out during the transmission of the Transmit Frame Sync signal. • FSEDGE: Frame Sync Edge Detection Determines which edge on frame sync will generate the interrupt TXSYN (Status Register). FSEDGE Frame Sync Edge Detection 0x0 Positive Edge Detection 0x1 Negative Edge Detection 330 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.7 Name: SSC Receive Holding Register SSC_RHR Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RDAT 23 22 21 20 RDAT 15 14 13 12 RDAT 7 6 5 4 RDAT • RDAT: Receive Data Right aligned regardless of the number of data bits defined by DATLEN in SSC_RFMR. 30.8.8 Name: SSC Transmit Holding Register SSC_THR Access Type: 31 Write-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TDAT 23 22 21 20 TDAT 15 14 13 12 TDAT 7 6 5 4 TDAT • TDAT: Transmit Data Right aligned regardless of the number of data bits defined by DATLEN in SSC_TFMR. 331 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.9 Name: SSC Receive Synchronization Holding Register SSC_RSHR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RSDAT 7 6 5 4 RSDAT • RSDAT: Receive Synchronization Data 30.8.10 Name: SSC Transmit Synchronization Holding Register SSC_TSHR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TSDAT 7 6 5 4 TSDAT • TSDAT: Transmit Synchronization Data 332 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.11 Name: SSC Receive Compare 0 Register SSC_RC0R Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CP0 7 6 5 4 CP0 • CP0: Receive Compare Data 0 333 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.12 Name: SSC Receive Compare 1 Register SSC_RC1R Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CP1 7 6 5 4 CP1 • CP1: Receive Compare Data 1 334 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.13 Name: SSC Status Register SSC_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 RXEN 16 TXEN 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 RXSYN 10 TXSYN 9 CP1 8 CP0 7 RXBUFF 6 ENDRX 5 OVRUN 4 RXRDY 3 TXBUFE 2 ENDTX 1 TXEMPTY 0 TXRDY • TXRDY: Transmit Ready 0: Data has been loaded in SSC_THR and is waiting to be loaded in the Transmit Shift Register (TSR). 1: SSC_THR is empty. • TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty 0: Data remains in SSC_THR or is currently transmitted from TSR. 1: Last data written in SSC_THR has been loaded in TSR and last data loaded in TSR has been transmitted. • ENDTX: End of Transmission 0: The register SSC_TCR has not reached 0 since the last write in SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR. 1: The register SSC_TCR has reached 0 since the last write in SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR. • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty 0: SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR have a value other than 0. 1: Both SSC_TCR and SSC_TNCR have a value of 0. • RXRDY: Receive Ready 0: SSC_RHR is empty. 1: Data has been received and loaded in SSC_RHR. • OVRUN: Receive Overrun 0: No data has been loaded in SSC_RHR while previous data has not been read since the last read of the Status Register. 1: Data has been loaded in SSC_RHR while previous data has not yet been read since the last read of the Status Register. • ENDRX: End of Reception 0: Data is written on the Receive Counter Register or Receive Next Counter Register. 1: End of PDC transfer when Receive Counter Register has arrived at zero. 335 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full 0: SSC_RCR or SSC_RNCR have a value other than 0. 1: Both SSC_RCR and SSC_RNCR have a value of 0. • CP0: Compare 0 0: A compare 0 has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: A compare 0 has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. • CP1: Compare 1 0: A compare 1 has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: A compare 1 has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. • TXSYN: Transmit Sync 0: A Tx Sync has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: A Tx Sync has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. • RXSYN: Receive Sync 0: An Rx Sync has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: An Rx Sync has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. • TXEN: Transmit Enable 0: Transmit is disabled. 1: Transmit is enabled. • RXEN: Receive Enable 0: Receive is disabled. 1: Receive is enabled. 336 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.14 Name: SSC Interrupt Enable Register SSC_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 RXSYN 10 TXSYN 9 CP1 8 CP0 7 RXBUFF 6 ENDRX 5 OVRUN 4 RXRDY 3 TXBUFE 2 ENDTX 1 TXEMPTY 0 TXRDY • TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Transmit Ready Interrupt. • TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Transmit Empty Interrupt. • ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the End of Transmission Interrupt. • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt • RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Receive Ready Interrupt. • OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Receive Overrun Interrupt. • ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the End of Reception Interrupt. 337 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Receive Buffer Full Interrupt. • CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Compare 0 Interrupt. • CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Compare 1 Interrupt. • TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Tx Sync Interrupt. • RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Rx Sync Interrupt. 338 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.15 Name: SSC Interrupt Disable Register SSC_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 RXSYN 10 TXSYN 9 CP1 8 CP0 7 RXBUFF 6 ENDRX 5 OVRUN 4 RXRDY 3 TXBUFE 2 ENDTX 1 TXEMPTY 0 TXRDY • TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Transmit Ready Interrupt. • TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Transmit Empty Interrupt. • ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the End of Transmission Interrupt. • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt. • RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Receive Ready Interrupt. • OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Receive Overrun Interrupt. • ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the End of Reception Interrupt. • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable 339 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Receive Buffer Full Interrupt. • CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Compare 0 Interrupt. • CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Compare 1 Interrupt. • TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Tx Sync Interrupt. • RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Rx Sync Interrupt. 340 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 30.8.16 Name: SSC Interrupt Mask Register SSC_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 RXSYN 10 TXSYN 9 CP1 8 CP0 7 RXBUFF 6 ENDRX 5 OVRUN 4 RXRDY 3 TXBUFE 2 ENDTX 1 TXEMPTY 0 TXRDY • TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Mask 0: The Transmit Ready Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Transmit Ready Interrupt is enabled. • TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Mask 0: The Transmit Empty Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Transmit Empty Interrupt is enabled. • ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Mask 0: The End of Transmission Interrupt is disabled. 1: The End of Transmission Interrupt is enabled. • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask 0: The Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt is enabled. • RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Mask 0: The Receive Ready Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Receive Ready Interrupt is enabled. • OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Mask 0: The Receive Overrun Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Receive Overrun Interrupt is enabled. • ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Mask 0: The End of Reception Interrupt is disabled. 1: The End of Reception Interrupt is enabled. • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask 341 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 0: The Receive Buffer Full Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Receive Buffer Full Interrupt is enabled. • CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Mask 0: The Compare 0 Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Compare 0 Interrupt is enabled. • CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Mask 0: The Compare 1 Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Compare 1 Interrupt is enabled. • TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Mask 0: The Tx Sync Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Tx Sync Interrupt is enabled. • RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Mask 0: The Rx Sync Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Rx Sync Interrupt is enabled. 342 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31. Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) 31.1 Overview The Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) provides one full duplex universal synchronous asynchronous serial link. Data frame format is widely programmable (data length, parity, number of stop bits) to support a maximum of standards. The receiver implements parity error, framing error and overrun error detection. The receiver time-out enables handling variable-length frames and the transmitter timeguard facilitates communications with slow remote devices. Multidrop communications are also supported through address bit handling in reception and transmission. The USART features three test modes: remote loopback, local loopback and automatic echo. The USART supports specific operating modes providing interfaces on RS485 buses, with ISO7816 T = 0 or T = 1 smart card slots, infrared transceivers and connection to modem ports. The hardware handshaking feature enables an out-of-band flow control by automatic management of the pins RTS and CTS. The USART supports the connection to the Peripheral DMA Controller, which enables data transfers to the transmitter and from the receiver. The PDC provides chained buffer management without any intervention of the processor. 343 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.2 Block Diagram Figure 31-1. USART Block Diagram Peripheral DMA Controller Channel Channel PIO Controller USART RXD Receiver RTS AIC USART Interrupt TXD Transmitter CTS DTR PMC Modem Signals Control MCK DIV DSR DCD MCK/DIV RI SLCK Baud Rate Generator SCK User Interface APB 344 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.3 Application Block Diagram Figure 31-2. Application Block Diagram IrLAP PPP Modem Driver Serial Driver Field Bus Driver EMV Driver IrDA Driver USART RS232 Drivers RS232 Drivers RS485 Drivers Serial Port Differential Bus Smart Card Slot IrDA Transceivers Modem PSTN 31.4 I/O Lines Description Table 31-1. I/O Line Description Name Description Type Active Level SCK Serial Clock I/O TXD Transmit Serial Data I/O RXD Receive Serial Data Input RI Ring Indicator Input Low DSR Data Set Ready Input Low DCD Data Carrier Detect Input Low DTR Data Terminal Ready Output Low CTS Clear to Send Input Low RTS Request to Send Output Low 345 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.5 31.5.1 Product Dependencies I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the USART may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired USART pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the USART are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller. To prevent the TXD line from falling when the USART is disabled, the use of an internal pull up is mandatory. If the hardware handshaking feature or Modem mode is used, the internal pull up on TXD must also be enabled. All the pins of the modems may or may not be implemented on the USART. Only USART1 is fully equipped with all the modem signals. On USARTs not equipped with the corresponding pin, the associated control bits and statuses have no effect on the behavior of the USART. 31.5.2 Power Management The USART is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the USART Clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the USART. However, if the application does not require USART operations, the USART clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. In this case, the USART will resume its operations where it left off. Configuring the USART does not require the USART clock to be enabled. 31.5.3 Interrupt The USART interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the USART interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not recommended to use the USART interrupt line in edge sensitive mode. 346 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.6 Functional Description The USART is capable of managing several types of serial synchronous or asynchronous communications. It supports the following communication modes: • 5- to 9-bit full-duplex asynchronous serial communication – MSB- or LSB-first – 1, 1.5 or 2 stop bits – Parity even, odd, marked, space or none – By 8 or by 16 over-sampling receiver frequency – Optional hardware handshaking – Optional modem signals management – Optional break management – Optional multidrop serial communication • High-speed 5- to 9-bit full-duplex synchronous serial communication – MSB- or LSB-first – 1 or 2 stop bits – Parity even, odd, marked, space or none – By 8 or by 16 over-sampling frequency – Optional hardware handshaking – Optional modem signals management – Optional break management – Optional multidrop serial communication • RS485 with driver control signal • ISO7816, T0 or T1 protocols for interfacing with smart cards – NACK handling, error counter with repetition and iteration limit • InfraRed IrDA Modulation and Demodulation • Test modes – Remote loopback, local loopback, automatic echo 31.6.1 Baud Rate Generator The Baud Rate Generator provides the bit period clock named the Baud Rate Clock to both the receiver and the transmitter. The Baud Rate Generator clock source can be selected by setting the USCLKS field in the Mode Register (US_MR) between: • the Master Clock MCK • a division of the Master Clock, the divider being product dependent, but generally set to 8 • the external clock, available on the SCK pin The Baud Rate Generator is based upon a 16-bit divider, which is programmed with the CD field of the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). If CD is programmed at 0, the Baud Rate Generator does not generate any clock. If CD is programmed at 1, the divider is bypassed and becomes inactive. 347 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 If the external SCK clock is selected, the duration of the low and high levels of the signal provided on the SCK pin must be longer than a Master Clock (MCK) period. The frequency of the signal provided on SCK must be at least 4.5 times lower than MCK. Figure 31-3. Baud Rate Generator USCLKS MCK MCK/DIV SCK Reserved CD CD SCK 0 1 16-bit Counter 2 FIDI >1 3 1 0 SYNC OVER 0 0 Sampling Divider 0 Baud Rate Clock 1 1 SYNC Sampling Clock USCLKS = 3 31.6.1.1 Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode If the USART is programmed to operate in asynchronous mode, the selected clock is first divided by CD, which is field programmed in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). The resulting clock is provided to the receiver as a sampling clock and then divided by 16 or 8, depending on the programming of the OVER bit in US_MR. If OVER is set to 1, the receiver sampling is 8 times higher than the baud rate clock. If OVER is cleared, the sampling is performed at 16 times the baud rate clock. The following formula performs the calculation of the Baud Rate. SelectedClock Baudrate = ---------------------------------------------( 8 ( 2 – Over )CD ) This gives a maximum baud rate of MCK divided by 8, assuming that MCK is the highest possible clock and that OVER is programmed at 1. 31.6.1.2 Baud Rate Calculation Example Table 31-2 shows calculations of CD to obtain a baud rate at 38400 bauds for different source clock frequencies. This table also shows the actual resulting baud rate and the error. Table 31-2. 348 Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0) Source Clock Expected Baud Rate MHz Bit/s 3 686 400 38 400 6.00 6 38 400.00 0.00% 4 915 200 38 400 8.00 8 38 400.00 0.00% 5 000 000 38 400 8.14 8 39 062.50 1.70% 7 372 800 38 400 12.00 12 38 400.00 0.00% Calculation Result CD Actual Baud Rate Error Bit/s AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 31-2. Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0) (Continued) Source Clock Expected Baud Rate Calculation Result CD Actual Baud Rate Error 8 000 000 38 400 13.02 13 38 461.54 0.16% 12 000 000 38 400 19.53 20 37 500.00 2.40% 12 288 000 38 400 20.00 20 38 400.00 0.00% 14 318 180 38 400 23.30 23 38 908.10 1.31% 14 745 600 38 400 24.00 24 38 400.00 0.00% 18 432 000 38 400 30.00 30 38 400.00 0.00% 24 000 000 38 400 39.06 39 38 461.54 0.16% 24 576 000 38 400 40.00 40 38 400.00 0.00% 25 000 000 38 400 40.69 40 38 109.76 0.76% 32 000 000 38 400 52.08 52 38 461.54 0.16% 32 768 000 38 400 53.33 53 38 641.51 0.63% 33 000 000 38 400 53.71 54 38 194.44 0.54% 40 000 000 38 400 65.10 65 38 461.54 0.16% 50 000 000 38 400 81.38 81 38 580.25 0.47% The baud rate is calculated with the following formula: BaudRate = MCK ⁄ CD × 16 The baud rate error is calculated with the following formula. It is not recommended to work with an error higher than 5%. ExpectedBaudRate Error = 1 – ⎛ ---------------------------------------------------------⎞ ⎝ ActualBaudRate ⎠ 31.6.1.3 Fractional Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode The Baud Rate generator previously defined is subject to the following limitation: the output frequency changes by only integer multiples of the reference frequency. An approach to this problem is to integrate a fractional N clock generator that has a high resolution. The generator architecture is modified to obtain Baud Rate changes by a fraction of the reference source clock. This fractional part is programmed with the FP field in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). If FP is not 0, the fractional part is activated. The resolution is one eighth of the clock divider. This feature is only available when using USART normal mode. The fractional Baud Rate is calculated using the following formula: SelectedClock Baudrate = -----------------------------------------------------------------⎛ 8 ( 2 – Over ) ⎛ CD + FP --------⎞ ⎞ ⎝ ⎝ 8 ⎠⎠ The modified architecture is presented below: 349 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 31-4. Fractional Baud Rate Generator FP USCLKS CD Modulus Control FP MCK MCK/DIV SCK Reserved CD SCK 0 1 16-bit Counter 2 3 glitch-free logic 1 0 FIDI >1 0 0 SYNC OVER Sampling Divider 0 Baud Rate Clock 1 1 SYNC USCLKS = 3 31.6.1.4 Sampling Clock Baud Rate in Synchronous Mode If the USART is programmed to operate in synchronous mode, the selected clock is simply divided by the field CD in US_BRGR. BaudRate = SelectedClock ----------------------------------------CD In synchronous mode, if the external clock is selected (USCLKS = 3), the clock is provided directly by the signal on the USART SCK pin. No division is active. The value written in US_BRGR has no effect. The external clock frequency must be at least 4.5 times lower than the system clock. When either the external clock SCK or the internal clock divided (MCK/DIV) is selected, the value programmed in CD must be even if the user has to ensure a 50:50 mark/space ratio on the SCK pin. If the internal clock MCK is selected, the Baud Rate Generator ensures a 50:50 duty cycle on the SCK pin, even if the value programmed in CD is odd. 31.6.1.5 Baud Rate in ISO 7816 Mode The ISO7816 specification defines the bit rate with the following formula: Di B = ------ × f Fi where: • B is the bit rate • Di is the bit-rate adjustment factor • Fi is the clock frequency division factor • f is the ISO7816 clock frequency (Hz) 350 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Di is a binary value encoded on a 4-bit field, named DI, as represented in Table 31-3. Table 31-3. Binary and Decimal Values for Di DI field 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 1000 1001 1 2 4 8 16 32 12 20 Di (decimal) Fi is a binary value encoded on a 4-bit field, named FI, as represented in Table 31-4. Table 31-4. Binary and Decimal Values for Fi FI field 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 Fi (decimal 372 372 558 744 1116 1488 1860 512 768 1024 1536 2048 Table 31-5 shows the resulting Fi/Di Ratio, which is the ratio between the ISO7816 clock and the baud rate clock. Table 31-5. Possible Values for the Fi/Di Ratio Fi/Di 372 558 774 1116 1488 1806 512 768 1024 1536 2048 1 372 558 744 1116 1488 1860 512 768 1024 1536 2048 2 186 279 372 558 744 930 256 384 512 768 1024 4 93 139.5 186 279 372 465 128 192 256 384 512 8 46.5 69.75 93 139.5 186 232.5 64 96 128 192 256 16 23.25 34.87 46.5 69.75 93 116.2 32 48 64 96 128 32 11.62 17.43 23.25 34.87 46.5 58.13 16 24 32 48 64 12 31 46.5 62 93 124 155 42.66 64 85.33 128 170.6 20 18.6 27.9 37.2 55.8 74.4 93 25.6 38.4 51.2 76.8 102.4 If the USART is configured in ISO7816 Mode, the clock selected by the USCLKS field in the Mode Register (US_MR) is first divided by the value programmed in the field CD in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). The resulting clock can be provided to the SCK pin to feed the smart card clock inputs. This means that the CLKO bit can be set in US_MR. This clock is then divided by the value programmed in the FI_DI_RATIO field in the FI_DI_Ratio register (US_FIDI). This is performed by the Sampling Divider, which performs a division by up to 2047 in ISO7816 Mode. The non-integer values of the Fi/Di Ratio are not supported and the user must program the FI_DI_RATIO field to a value as close as possible to the expected value. The FI_DI_RATIO field resets to the value 0x174 (372 in decimal) and is the most common divider between the ISO7816 clock and the bit rate (Fi = 372, Di = 1). Figure 31-5 shows the relation between the Elementary Time Unit, corresponding to a bit time, and the ISO 7816 clock. 351 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 31-5. Elementary Time Unit (ETU) FI_DI_RATIO ISO7816 Clock Cycles ISO7816 Clock on SCK ISO7816 I/O Line on TXD 1 ETU 31.6.2 Receiver and Transmitter Control After reset, the receiver is disabled. The user must enable the receiver by setting the RXEN bit in the Control Register (US_CR). However, the receiver registers can be programmed before the receiver clock is enabled. After reset, the transmitter is disabled. The user must enable it by setting the TXEN bit in the Control Register (US_CR). However, the transmitter registers can be programmed before being enabled. The Receiver and the Transmitter can be enabled together or independently. At any time, the software can perform a reset on the receiver or the transmitter of the USART by setting the corresponding bit, RSTRX and RSTTX respectively, in the Control Register (US_CR). The software resets clear the status flag and reset internal state machines but the user interface configuration registers hold the value configured prior to software reset. Regardless of what the receiver or the transmitter is performing, the communication is immediately stopped. The user can also independently disable the receiver or the transmitter by setting RXDIS and TXDIS respectively in US_CR. If the receiver is disabled during a character reception, the USART waits until the end of reception of the current character, then the reception is stopped. If the transmitter is disabled while it is operating, the USART waits the end of transmission of both the current character and character being stored in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR). If a timeguard is programmed, it is handled normally. 31.6.3 31.6.3.1 Synchronous and Asynchronous Modes Transmitter Operations The transmitter performs the same in both synchronous and asynchronous operating modes (SYNC = 0 or SYNC = 1). One start bit, up to 9 data bits, one optional parity bit and up to two stop bits are successively shifted out on the TXD pin at each falling edge of the programmed serial clock. The number of data bits is selected by the CHRL field and the MODE 9 bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). Nine bits are selected by setting the MODE 9 bit regardless of the CHRL field. The parity bit is set according to the PAR field in US_MR. The even, odd, space, marked or none parity bit can be configured. The MSBF field in US_MR configures which data bit is sent first. If written at 1, the most significant bit is sent first. At 0, the less significant bit is sent first. The number of stop bits is selected by the NBSTOP field in US_MR. The 1.5 stop bit is supported in asynchronous mode only. 352 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 31-6. Character Transmit Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled One Stop Baud Rate Clock TXD Start Bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Bit Stop Bit The characters are sent by writing in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR). The transmitter reports two status bits in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR): TXRDY (Transmitter Ready), which indicates that US_THR is empty and TXEMPTY, which indicates that all the characters written in US_THR have been processed. When the current character processing is completed, the last character written in US_THR is transferred into the Shift Register of the transmitter and US_THR becomes empty, thus TXRDY raises. Both TXRDY and TXEMPTY bits are low since the transmitter is disabled. Writing a character in US_THR while TXRDY is active has no effect and the written character is lost. Figure 31-7. Transmitter Status Baud Rate Clock TXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Start D0 Bit Bit Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit Write US_THR TXRDY TXEMPTY 31.6.3.2 Asynchronous Receiver If the USART is programmed in asynchronous operating mode (SYNC = 0), the receiver oversamples the RXD input line. The oversampling is either 16 or 8 times the Baud Rate clock, depending on the OVER bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). The receiver samples the RXD line. If the line is sampled during one half of a bit time at 0, a start bit is detected and data, parity and stop bits are successively sampled on the bit rate clock. If the oversampling is 16, (OVER at 0), a start is detected at the eighth sample at 0. Then, data bits, parity bit and stop bit are sampled on each 16 sampling clock cycle. If the oversampling is 8 (OVER at 1), a start bit is detected at the fourth sample at 0. Then, data bits, parity bit and stop bit are sampled on each 8 sampling clock cycle. The number of data bits, first bit sent and parity mode are selected by the same fields and bits as the transmitter, i.e. respectively CHRL, MODE9, MSBF and PAR. For the synchronization mechanism only, the number of stop bits has no effect on the receiver as it considers only one stop bit, regardless of the field NBSTOP, so that resynchronization between the receiver and the 353 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 transmitter can occur. Moreover, as soon as the stop bit is sampled, the receiver starts looking for a new start bit so that resynchronization can also be accomplished when the transmitter is operating with one stop bit. Figure 31-8 and Figure 31-9 illustrate start detection and character reception when USART operates in asynchronous mode. Figure 31-8. Asynchronous Start Detection Baud Rate Clock Sampling Clock (x16) RXD Sampling 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 D0 Sampling Start Detection RXD Sampling 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 Start Rejection Figure 31-9. Asynchronous Character Reception Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled Baud Rate Clock RXD Start Detection 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples D0 31.6.3.3 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Bit Stop Bit Synchronous Receiver In synchronous mode (SYNC = 1), the receiver samples the RXD signal on each rising edge of the Baud Rate Clock. If a low level is detected, it is considered as a start. All data bits, the parity bit and the stop bits are sampled and the receiver waits for the next start bit. Synchronous mode operations provide a high speed transfer capability. Configuration fields and bits are the same as in asynchronous mode. Figure 31-10 illustrates a character reception in synchronous mode. 354 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 31-10. Synchronous Mode Character Reception Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled 1 Stop Baud Rate Clock RXD Sampling Start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 Stop Bit D7 Parity Bit 31.6.3.4 Receiver Operations When a character reception is completed, it is transferred to the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR) and the RXRDY bit in the Status Register (US_CSR) rises. If a character is completed while the RXRDY is set, the OVRE (Overrun Error) bit is set. The last character is transferred into US_RHR and overwrites the previous one. The OVRE bit is cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA (Reset Status) bit at 1. Figure 31-11. Receiver Status Baud Rate Clock RXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Start D0 Bit Bit Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit RSTSTA = 1 Write US_CR Read US_RHR RXRDY OVRE 355 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.6.3.5 Parity The USART supports five parity modes selected by programming the PAR field in the Mode Register (US_MR). The PAR field also enables the Multidrop mode, see “Multidrop Mode” on page 357. Even and odd parity bit generation and error detection are supported. If even parity is selected, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 0 if a number of 1s in the character data bit is even, and at 1 if the number of 1s is odd. Accordingly, the receiver parity checker counts the number of received 1s and reports a parity error if the sampled parity bit does not correspond. If odd parity is selected, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 1 if a number of 1s in the character data bit is even, and at 0 if the number of 1s is odd. Accordingly, the receiver parity checker counts the number of received 1s and reports a parity error if the sampled parity bit does not correspond. If the mark parity is used, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 1 for all characters. The receiver parity checker reports an error if the parity bit is sampled at 0. If the space parity is used, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 0 for all characters. The receiver parity checker reports an error if the parity bit is sampled at 1. If parity is disabled, the transmitter does not generate any parity bit and the receiver does not report any parity error. Table 31-6 shows an example of the parity bit for the character 0x41 (character ASCII “A”) depending on the configuration of the USART. Because there are two bits at 1, 1 bit is added when a parity is odd, or 0 is added when a parity is even. Table 31-6. Parity Bit Examples Character Hexa Binary Parity Bit Parity Mode A 0x41 0100 0001 1 Odd A 0x41 0100 0001 0 Even A 0x41 0100 0001 1 Mark A 0x41 0100 0001 0 Space A 0x41 0100 0001 None None When the receiver detects a parity error, it sets the PARE (Parity Error) bit in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). The PARE bit can be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA bit at 1. Figure 31-12 illustrates the parity bit status setting and clearing. 356 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 31-12. Parity Error Baud Rate Clock RXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Bad Stop Parity Bit Bit RSTSTA = 1 Write US_CR PARE RXRDY 31.6.3.6 Multidrop Mode If the PAR field in the Mode Register (US_MR) is programmed to the value 0x6 or 0x07, the USART runs in Multidrop Mode. This mode differentiates the data characters and the address characters. Data is transmitted with the parity bit at 0 and addresses are transmitted with the parity bit at 1. If the USART is configured in multidrop mode, the receiver sets the PARE parity error bit when the parity bit is high and the transmitter is able to send a character with the parity bit high when the Control Register is written with the SENDA bit at 1. To handle parity error, the PARE bit is cleared when the Control Register is written with the bit RSTSTA at 1. The transmitter sends an address byte (parity bit set) when SENDA is written to US_CR. In this case, the next byte written to US_THR is transmitted as an address. Any character written in US_THR without having written the command SENDA is transmitted normally with the parity at 0. 31.6.3.7 Transmitter Timeguard The timeguard feature enables the USART interface with slow remote devices. The timeguard function enables the transmitter to insert an idle state on the TXD line between two characters. This idle state actually acts as a long stop bit. The duration of the idle state is programmed in the TG field of the Transmitter Timeguard Register (US_TTGR). When this field is programmed at zero no timeguard is generated. Otherwise, the transmitter holds a high level on TXD after each transmitted byte during the number of bit periods programmed in TG in addition to the number of stop bits. As illustrated in Figure 31-13, the behavior of TXRDY and TXEMPTY status bits is modified by the programming of a timeguard. TXRDY rises only when the start bit of the next character is sent, and thus remains at 0 during the timeguard transmission if a character has been written in US_THR. TXEMPTY remains low until the timeguard transmission is completed as the timeguard is part of the current character being transmitted. 357 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 31-13. Timeguard Operations TG = 4 TG = 4 Baud Rate Clock TXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit Write US_THR TXRDY TXEMPTY Table 31-7 indicates the maximum length of a timeguard period that the transmitter can handle in relation to the function of the Baud Rate. Table 31-7. 31.6.3.8 Maximum Timeguard Length Depending on Baud Rate Baud Rate Bit time Timeguard Bit/sec µs ms 1 200 833 212.50 9 600 104 26.56 14400 69.4 17.71 19200 52.1 13.28 28800 34.7 8.85 33400 29.9 7.63 56000 17.9 4.55 57600 17.4 4.43 115200 8.7 2.21 Receiver Time-out The Receiver Time-out provides support in handling variable-length frames. This feature detects an idle condition on the RXD line. When a time-out is detected, the bit TIMEOUT in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR) rises and can generate an interrupt, thus indicating to the driver an end of frame. The time-out delay period (during which the receiver waits for a new character) is programmed in the TO field of the Receiver Time-out Register (US_RTOR). If the TO field is programmed at 0, the Receiver Time-out is disabled and no time-out is detected. The TIMEOUT bit in US_CSR remains at 0. Otherwise, the receiver loads a 16-bit counter with the value programmed in TO. This counter is decremented at each bit period and reloaded each time a new character is received. If the counter reaches 0, the TIMEOUT bit in the Status Register rises. Then, the user can either: • Stop the counter clock until a new character is received. This is performed by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the STTTO (Start Time-out) bit at 1. In this case, the idle state 358 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary on RXD before a new character is received will not provide a time-out. This prevents having to handle an interrupt before a character is received and allows waiting for the next idle state on RXD after a frame is received. • Obtain an interrupt while no character is received. This is performed by writing US_CR with the RETTO (Reload and Start Time-out) bit at 1. If RETTO is performed, the counter starts counting down immediately from the value TO. This enables generation of a periodic interrupt so that a user time-out can be handled, for example when no key is pressed on a keyboard. If STTTO is performed, the counter clock is stopped until a first character is received. The idle state on RXD before the start of the frame does not provide a time-out. This prevents having to obtain a periodic interrupt and enables a wait of the end of frame when the idle state on RXD is detected. If RETTO is performed, the counter starts counting down immediately from the value TO. This enables generation of a periodic interrupt so that a user time-out can be handled, for example when no key is pressed on a keyboard. Figure 31-14 shows the block diagram of the Receiver Time-out feature. Figure 31-14. Receiver Time-out Block Diagram TO Baud Rate Clock 1 D Q Clock 16-bit Time-out Counter 16-bit Value = STTTO Character Received Load Clear TIMEOUT 0 RETTO Table 31-8 gives the maximum time-out period for some standard baud rates. Table 31-8. Maximum Time-out Period Baud Rate Bit Time Time-out bit/sec µs ms 600 1 667 109 225 1 200 833 54 613 2 400 417 27 306 4 800 208 13 653 9 600 104 6 827 14400 69 4 551 19200 52 3 413 28800 35 2 276 33400 30 1 962 359 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 31-8. 31.6.3.9 Maximum Time-out Period (Continued) Baud Rate Bit Time Time-out 56000 18 1 170 57600 17 1 138 200000 5 328 Framing Error The receiver is capable of detecting framing errors. A framing error happens when the stop bit of a received character is detected at level 0. This can occur if the receiver and the transmitter are fully desynchronized. A framing error is reported on the FRAME bit of the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). The FRAME bit is asserted in the middle of the stop bit as soon as the framing error is detected. It is cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA bit at 1. Figure 31-15. Framing Error Status Baud Rate Clock RXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit RSTSTA = 1 Write US_CR FRAME RXRDY 31.6.3.10 Transmit Break The user can request the transmitter to generate a break condition on the TXD line. A break condition drives the TXD line low during at least one complete character. It appears the same as a 0x00 character sent with the parity and the stop bits at 0. However, the transmitter holds the TXD line at least during one character until the user requests the break condition to be removed. A break is transmitted by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the STTBRK bit at 1. This can be performed at any time, either while the transmitter is empty (no character in either the Shift Register or in US_THR) or when a character is being transmitted. If a break is requested while a character is being shifted out, the character is first completed before the TXD line is held low. Once STTBRK command is requested further STTBRK commands are ignored until the end of the break is completed. The break condition is removed by writing US_CR with the STPBRK bit at 1. If the STPBRK is requested before the end of the minimum break duration (one character, including start, data, parity and stop bits), the transmitter ensures that the break condition completes. 360 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The transmitter considers the break as though it is a character, i.e. the STTBRK and STPBRK commands are taken into account only if the TXRDY bit in US_CSR is at 1 and the start of the break condition clears the TXRDY and TXEMPTY bits as if a character is processed. Writing US_CR with the both STTBRK and STPBRK bits at 1 can lead to an unpredictable result. All STPBRK commands requested without a previous STTBRK command are ignored. A byte written into the Transmit Holding Register while a break is pending, but not started, is ignored. After the break condition, the transmitter returns the TXD line to 1 for a minimum of 12 bit times. Thus, the transmitter ensures that the remote receiver detects correctly the end of break and the start of the next character. If the timeguard is programmed with a value higher than 12, the TXD line is held high for the timeguard period. After holding the TXD line for this period, the transmitter resumes normal operations. Figure 31-16 illustrates the effect of both the Start Break (STTBRK) and Stop Break (STPBRK) commands on the TXD line. Figure 31-16. Break Transmission Baud Rate Clock TXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 STTBRK = 1 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit Break Transmission End of Break STPBRK = 1 Write US_CR TXRDY TXEMPTY 31.6.3.11 Receive Break The receiver detects a break condition when all data, parity and stop bits are low. This corresponds to detecting a framing error with data at 0x00, but FRAME remains low. When the low stop bit is detected, the receiver asserts the RXBRK bit in US_CSR. This bit may be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the bit RSTSTA at 1. An end of receive break is detected by a high level for at least 2/16 of a bit period in asynchronous operating mode or one sample at high level in synchronous operating mode. The end of break detection also asserts the RXBRK bit. 31.6.3.12 Hardware Handshaking The USART features a hardware handshaking out-of-band flow control. The RTS and CTS pins are used to connect with the remote device, as shown in Figure 31-17. 361 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 31-17. Connection with a Remote Device for Hardware Handshaking USART Remote Device TXD RXD RXD TXD CTS RTS RTS CTS Setting the USART to operate with hardware handshaking is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x2. The USART behavior when hardware handshaking is enabled is the same as the behavior in standard synchronous or asynchronous mode, except that the receiver drives the RTS pin as described below and the level on the CTS pin modifies the behavior of the transmitter as described below. Using this mode requires using the PDC channel for reception. The transmitter can handle hardware handshaking in any case. Figure 31-18 shows how the receiver operates if hardware handshaking is enabled. The RTS pin is driven high if the receiver is disabled and if the status RXBUFF (Receive Buffer Full) coming from the PDC channel is high. Normally, the remote device does not start transmitting while its CTS pin (driven by RTS) is high. As soon as the Receiver is enabled, the RTS falls, indicating to the remote device that it can start transmitting. Defining a new buffer to the PDC clears the status bit RXBUFF and, as a result, asserts the pin RTS low. Figure 31-18. Receiver Behavior when Operating with Hardware Handshaking RXD RXEN = 1 RXDIS = 1 Write US_CR RTS RXBUFF Figure 31-19 shows how the transmitter operates if hardware handshaking is enabled. The CTS pin disables the transmitter. If a character is being processing, the transmitter is disabled only after the completion of the current character and transmission of the next character happens as soon as the pin CTS falls. Figure 31-19. Transmitter Behavior when Operating with Hardware Handshaking CTS TXD 362 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.6.4 ISO7816 Mode The USART features an ISO7816-compatible operating mode. This mode permits interfacing with smart cards and Security Access Modules (SAM) communicating through an ISO7816 link. Both T = 0 and T = 1 protocols defined by the ISO7816 specification are supported. Setting the USART in ISO7816 mode is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x4 for protocol T = 0 and to the value 0x5 for protocol T = 1. 31.6.4.1 ISO7816 Mode Overview The ISO7816 is a half duplex communication on only one bidirectional line. The baud rate is determined by a division of the clock provided to the remote device (see “Baud Rate Generator” on page 347). The USART connects to a smart card as shown in Figure 31-20. The TXD line becomes bidirectional and the Baud Rate Generator feeds the ISO7816 clock on the SCK pin. As the TXD pin becomes bidirectional, its output remains driven by the output of the transmitter but only when the transmitter is active while its input is directed to the input of the receiver. The USART is considered as the master of the communication as it generates the clock. Figure 31-20. Connection of a Smart Card to the USART USART SCK TXD CLK I/O Smart Card When operating in ISO7816, either in T = 0 or T = 1 modes, the character format is fixed. The configuration is 8 data bits, even parity and 1 or 2 stop bits, regardless of the values programmed in the CHRL, MODE9, PAR and CHMODE fields. MSBF can be used to transmit LSB or MSB first. Parity Bit (PAR) can be used to transmit in normal or inverse mode. Refer to “USART Mode Register” on page 375 and “PAR: Parity Type” on page 376. The USART cannot operate concurrently in both receiver and transmitter modes as the communication is unidirectional at a time. It has to be configured according to the required mode by enabling or disabling either the receiver or the transmitter as desired. Enabling both the receiver and the transmitter at the same time in ISO7816 mode may lead to unpredictable results. The ISO7816 specification defines an inverse transmission format. Data bits of the character must be transmitted on the I/O line at their negative value. The USART does not support this format and the user has to perform an exclusive OR on the data before writing it in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR) or after reading it in the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR). 31.6.4.2 Protocol T = 0 In T = 0 protocol, a character is made up of one start bit, eight data bits, one parity bit and one guard time, which lasts two bit times. The transmitter shifts out the bits and does not drive the I/O line during the guard time. If no parity error is detected, the I/O line remains at 1 during the guard time and the transmitter can continue with the transmission of the next character, as shown in Figure 31-21. 363 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 If a parity error is detected by the receiver, it drives the I/O line at 0 during the guard time, as shown in Figure 31-22. This error bit is also named NACK, for Non Acknowledge. In this case, the character lasts 1 bit time more, as the guard time length is the same and is added to the error bit time which lasts 1 bit time. When the USART is the receiver and it detects an error, it does not load the erroneous character in the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR). It appropriately sets the PARE bit in the Status Register (US_SR) so that the software can handle the error. Figure 31-21. T = 0 Protocol without Parity Error Baud Rate Clock RXD Start Bit D0 D2 D1 D4 D3 D5 D6 D7 Parity Guard Guard Next Bit Time 1 Time 2 Start Bit Figure 31-22. T = 0 Protocol with Parity Error Baud Rate Clock Error I/O Start Bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Guard Bit Time 1 Guard Start Time 2 Bit D0 D1 Repetition 31.6.4.3 Receive Error Counter The USART receiver also records the total number of errors. This can be read in the Number of Error (US_NER) register. The NB_ERRORS field can record up to 255 errors. Reading US_NER automatically clears the NB_ERRORS field. 31.6.4.4 Receive NACK Inhibit The USART can also be configured to inhibit an error. This can be achieved by setting the INACK bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). If INACK is at 1, no error signal is driven on the I/O line even if a parity bit is detected, but the INACK bit is set in the Status Register (US_SR). The INACK bit can be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTNACK bit at 1. Moreover, if INACK is set, the erroneous received character is stored in the Receive Holding Register, as if no error occurred. However, the RXRDY bit does not raise. 31.6.4.5 Transmit Character Repetition When the USART is transmitting a character and gets a NACK, it can automatically repeat the character before moving on to the next one. Repetition is enabled by writing the MAX_ITERATION field in the Mode Register (US_MR) at a value higher than 0. Each character can be transmitted up to eight times; the first transmission plus seven repetitions. If MAX_ITERATION does not equal zero, the USART repeats the character as many times as the value loaded in MAX_ITERATION. 364 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary When the USART repetition number reaches MAX_ITERATION, the ITERATION bit is set in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). If the repetition of the character is acknowledged by the receiver, the repetitions are stopped and the iteration counter is cleared. The ITERATION bit in US_CSR can be cleared by writing the Control Register with the RSIT bit at 1. 31.6.4.6 Disable Successive Receive NACK The receiver can limit the number of successive NACKs sent back to the remote transmitter. This is programmed by setting the bit DSNACK in the Mode Register (US_MR). The maximum number of NACK transmitted is programmed in the MAX_ITERATION field. As soon as MAX_ITERATION is reached, the character is considered as correct, an acknowledge is sent on the line and the ITERATION bit in the Channel Status Register is set. 31.6.4.7 Protocol T = 1 When operating in ISO7816 protocol T = 1, the transmission is similar to an asynchronous format with only one stop bit. The parity is generated when transmitting and checked when receiving. Parity error detection sets the PARE bit in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). 31.6.5 IrDA Mode The USART features an IrDA mode supplying half-duplex point-to-point wireless communication. It embeds the modulator and demodulator which allows a glueless connection to the infrared transceivers, as shown in Figure 31-23. The modulator and demodulator are compliant with the IrDA specification version 1.1 and support data transfer speeds ranging from 2.4 Kb/s to 115.2 Kb/s. The USART IrDA mode is enabled by setting the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x8. The IrDA Filter Register (US_IF) allows configuring the demodulator filter. The USART transmitter and receiver operate in a normal asynchronous mode and all parameters are accessible. Note that the modulator and the demodulator are activated. Figure 31-23. Connection to IrDA Transceivers USART IrDA Transceivers Receiver Demodulator RXD Transmitter Modulator TXD RX TX The receiver and the transmitter must be enabled or disabled according to the direction of the transmission to be managed. To receive IrDA signals, the following needs to be done: • Disable TX and Enable RX 365 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Configure the TXD pin as PIO and set it as an output at 0 (to avoid LED emission). Disable the internal pull-up (better for power consumption). Receive data 31.6.5.1 IrDA Modulation For baud rates up to and including 115.2 Kbits/sec, the RZI modulation scheme is used. “0” is represented by a light pulse of 3/16th of a bit time. Some examples of signal pulse duration are shown in Table 31-9. Table 31-9. IrDA Pulse Duration Baud Rate Pulse Duration (3/16) 2.4 Kb/s 78.13 µs 9.6 Kb/s 19.53 µs 19.2 Kb/s 9.77 µs 38.4 Kb/s 4.88 µs 57.6 Kb/s 3.26 µs 115.2 Kb/s 1.63 µs Figure 31-24 shows an example of character transmission. Figure 31-24. IrDA Modulation Start Bit Transmitter Output 0 Stop Bit Data Bits 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 TXD 3 16 Bit Period Bit Period 31.6.5.2 IrDA Baud Rate Table 31-10 gives some examples of CD values, baud rate error and pulse duration. Note that the requirement on the maximum acceptable error of ±1.87% must be met. Table 31-10. IrDA Baud Rate Error Peripheral Clock 366 Baud Rate CD Baud Rate Error Pulse Time 3 686 400 115 200 2 0.00% 1.63 20 000 000 115 200 11 1.38% 1.63 32 768 000 115 200 18 1.25% 1.63 40 000 000 115 200 22 1.38% 1.63 3 686 400 57 600 4 0.00% 3.26 20 000 000 57 600 22 1.38% 3.26 32 768 000 57 600 36 1.25% 3.26 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 31-10. IrDA Baud Rate Error (Continued) Peripheral Clock 31.6.5.3 Baud Rate CD Baud Rate Error Pulse Time 40 000 000 57 600 43 0.93% 3.26 3 686 400 38 400 6 0.00% 4.88 20 000 000 38 400 33 1.38% 4.88 32 768 000 38 400 53 0.63% 4.88 40 000 000 38 400 65 0.16% 4.88 3 686 400 19 200 12 0.00% 9.77 20 000 000 19 200 65 0.16% 9.77 32 768 000 19 200 107 0.31% 9.77 40 000 000 19 200 130 0.16% 9.77 3 686 400 9 600 24 0.00% 19.53 20 000 000 9 600 130 0.16% 19.53 32 768 000 9 600 213 0.16% 19.53 40 000 000 9 600 260 0.16% 19.53 3 686 400 2 400 96 0.00% 78.13 20 000 000 2 400 521 0.03% 78.13 32 768 000 2 400 853 0.04% 78.13 IrDA Demodulator The demodulator is based on the IrDA Receive filter comprised of an 8-bit down counter which is loaded with the value programmed in US_IF. When a falling edge is detected on the RXD pin, the Filter Counter starts counting down at the Master Clock (MCK) speed. If a rising edge is detected on the RXD pin, the counter stops and is reloaded with US_IF. If no rising edge is detected when the counter reaches 0, the input of the receiver is driven low during one bit time. Figure 31-25 illustrates the operations of the IrDA demodulator. Figure 31-25. IrDA Demodulator Operations MCK RXD Counter Value Receiver Input 6 5 4 3 Pulse Rejected 2 6 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Pulse Accepted As the IrDA mode uses the same logic as the ISO7816, note that the FI_DI_RATIO field in US_FIDI must be set to a value higher than 0 in order to assure IrDA communications operate correctly. 367 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.6.6 RS485 Mode The USART features the RS485 mode to enable line driver control. While operating in RS485 mode, the USART behaves as though in asynchronous or synchronous mode and configuration of all the parameters is possible. The difference is that the RTS pin is driven high when the transmitter is operating. The behavior of the RTS pin is controlled by the TXEMPTY bit. A typical connection of the USART to a RS485 bus is shown in Figure 31-26. Figure 31-26. Typical Connection to a RS485 Bus USART RXD Differential Bus TXD RTS The USART is set in RS485 mode by programming the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x1. The RTS pin is at a level inverse to the TXEMPTY bit. Significantly, the RTS pin remains high when a timeguard is programmed so that the line can remain driven after the last character completion. Figure 31-27 gives an example of the RTS waveform during a character transmission when the timeguard is enabled. Figure 31-27. Example of RTS Drive with Timeguard TG = 4 Baud Rate Clock TXD Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit Write US_THR TXRDY TXEMPTY RTS 368 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.6.7 Modem Mode The USART features modem mode, which enables control of the signals: DTR (Data Terminal Ready), DSR (Data Set Ready), RTS (Request to Send), CTS (Clear to Send), DCD (Data Carrier Detect) and RI (Ring Indicator). While operating in modem mode, the USART behaves as a DTE (Data Terminal Equipment) as it drives DTR and RTS and can detect level change on DSR, DCD, CTS and RI. Setting the USART in modem mode is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x3. While operating in modem mode the USART behaves as though in asynchronous mode and all the parameter configurations are available. Table 31-11 gives the correspondence of the USART signals with modem connection standards. Table 31-11. Circuit References USART Pin V24 CCITT Direction TXD 2 103 From terminal to modem RTS 4 105 From terminal to modem DTR 20 108.2 From terminal to modem RXD 3 104 From modem to terminal CTS 5 106 From terminal to modem DSR 6 107 From terminal to modem DCD 8 109 From terminal to modem RI 22 125 From terminal to modem The control of the DTR output pin is performed by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the DTRDIS and DTREN bits respectively at 1. The disable command forces the corresponding pin to its inactive level, i.e. high. The enable command forces the corresponding pin to its active level, i.e. low. RTS output pin is automatically controlled in this mode The level changes are detected on the RI, DSR, DCD and CTS pins. If an input change is detected, the RIIC, DSRIC, DCDIC and CTSIC bits in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR) are set respectively and can trigger an interrupt. The status is automatically cleared when US_CSR is read. Furthermore, the CTS automatically disables the transmitter when it is detected at its inactive state. If a character is being transmitted when the CTS rises, the character transmission is completed before the transmitter is actually disabled. 31.6.8 Test Modes The USART can be programmed to operate in three different test modes. The internal loopback capability allows on-board diagnostics. In the loopback mode the USART interface pins are disconnected or not and reconfigured for loopback internally or externally. 31.6.8.1 Normal Mode Normal mode connects the RXD pin on the receiver input and the transmitter output on the TXD pin. 369 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 31-28. Normal Mode Configuration RXD Receiver TXD Transmitter 31.6.8.2 Automatic Echo Mode Automatic echo mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. When a bit is received on the RXD pin, it is sent to the TXD pin, as shown in Figure 31-29. Programming the transmitter has no effect on the TXD pin. The RXD pin is still connected to the receiver input, thus the receiver remains active. Figure 31-29. Automatic Echo Mode Configuration RXD Receiver TXD Transmitter 31.6.8.3 Local Loopback Mode Local loopback mode connects the output of the transmitter directly to the input of the receiver, as shown in Figure 31-30. The TXD and RXD pins are not used. The RXD pin has no effect on the receiver and the TXD pin is continuously driven high, as in idle state. Figure 31-30. Local Loopback Mode Configuration RXD Receiver Transmitter 31.6.8.4 370 1 TXD Remote Loopback Mode Remote loopback mode directly connects the RXD pin to the TXD pin, as shown in Figure 31-31. The transmitter and the receiver are disabled and have no effect. This mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 31-31. Remote Loopback Mode Configuration Receiver 1 RXD TXD Transmitter 371 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7 (Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) User Interface Table 31-12. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x0000 Control Register US_CR Write-only – 0x0004 Mode Register US_MR Read-write – 0x0008 Interrupt Enable Register US_IER Write-only – 0x000C Interrupt Disable Register US_IDR Write-only – 0x0010 Interrupt Mask Register US_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x0014 Channel Status Register US_CSR Read-only – 0x0018 Receiver Holding Register US_RHR Read-only 0x0 0x001C Transmitter Holding Register US_THR Write-only – 0x0020 Baud Rate Generator Register US_BRGR Read-write 0x0 0x0024 Receiver Time-out Register US_RTOR Read-write 0x0 0x0028 Transmitter Timeguard Register US_TTGR Read-write 0x0 – – – 0x2C - 0x3C 0x0040 FI DI Ratio Register US_FIDI Read-write 0x174 0x0044 Number of Errors Register US_NER Read-only – 0x0048 Reserved – – – 0x004C IrDA Filter Register US_IF Read-write 0x0 Reserved – – – Reserved for PDC Registers – – – 0x5C - 0xFC 0x100 - 0x128 372 Reserved AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.1 Name: USART Control Register US_CR Access Type:Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 RTSDIS 18 RTSEN 17 DTRDIS 16 DTREN 15 RETTO 14 RSTNACK 13 RSTIT 12 SENDA 11 STTTO 10 STPBRK 9 STTBRK 8 RSTSTA 7 TXDIS 6 TXEN 5 RXDIS 4 RXEN 3 RSTTX 2 RSTRX 1 – 0 – • RSTRX: Reset Receiver 0: No effect. 1: Resets the receiver. • RSTTX: Reset Transmitter 0: No effect. 1: Resets the transmitter. • RXEN: Receiver Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the receiver, if RXDIS is 0. • RXDIS: Receiver Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the receiver. • TXEN: Transmitter Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the transmitter if TXDIS is 0. • TXDIS: Transmitter Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the transmitter. • RSTSTA: Reset Status Bits 0: No effect. 1: Resets the status bits PARE, FRAME, OVRE, and RXBRK in US_CSR. • STTBRK: Start Break 0: No effect. 1: Starts transmission of a break after the characters present in US_THR and the Transmit Shift Register have been transmitted. No effect if a break is already being transmitted. 373 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • STPBRK: Stop Break 0: No effect. 1: Stops transmission of the break after a minimum of one character length and transmits a high level during 12-bit periods. No effect if no break is being transmitted. • STTTO: Start Time-out 0: No effect. 1: Starts waiting for a character before clocking the time-out counter. Resets the status bit TIMEOUT in US_CSR. • SENDA: Send Address 0: No effect. 1: In Multidrop Mode only, the next character written to the US_THR is sent with the address bit set. • RSTIT: Reset Iterations 0: No effect. 1: Resets ITERATION in US_CSR. No effect if the ISO7816 is not enabled. • RSTNACK: Reset Non Acknowledge 0: No effect 1: Resets NACK in US_CSR. • RETTO: Rearm Time-out 0: No effect 1: Restart Time-out • DTREN: Data Terminal Ready Enable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin DTR at 0. • DTRDIS: Data Terminal Ready Disable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin DTR to 1. • RTSEN: Request to Send Enable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin RTS to 0. • RTSDIS: Request to Send Disable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin RTS to 1. 374 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.2 Name: USART Mode Register US_MR Access Type:Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 FILTER 27 – 26 25 MAX_ITERATION 24 23 – 22 – 21 DSNACK 20 INACK 19 OVER 18 CLKO 17 MODE9 16 MSBF 15 14 13 12 11 10 PAR 9 8 SYNC 4 3 2 1 0 CHMODE 7 NBSTOP 6 5 CHRL USCLKS USART_MODE • USART_MODE USART_MODE Mode of the USART 0 0 0 0 Normal 0 0 0 1 RS485 0 0 1 0 Hardware Handshaking 0 0 1 1 Modem 0 1 0 0 IS07816 Protocol: T = 0 0 1 0 1 Reserved 0 1 1 0 IS07816 Protocol: T = 1 0 1 1 1 Reserved 1 0 0 0 IrDA 1 1 x x Reserved • USCLKS: Clock Selection USCLKS Selected Clock 0 0 MCK 0 1 MCK/DIV (DIV = 8) 1 0 Reserved 1 1 SCK 375 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • CHRL: Character Length. CHRL Character Length 0 0 5 bits 0 1 6 bits 1 0 7 bits 1 1 8 bits • SYNC: Synchronous Mode Select 0: USART operates in Asynchronous Mode. 1: USART operates in Synchronous Mode. • PAR: Parity Type PAR Parity Type 0 0 0 Even parity 0 0 1 Odd parity 0 1 0 Parity forced to 0 (Space) 0 1 1 Parity forced to 1 (Mark) 1 0 x No parity 1 1 x Multidrop mode • NBSTOP: Number of Stop Bits NBSTOP Asynchronous (SYNC = 0) Synchronous (SYNC = 1) 0 0 1 stop bit 1 stop bit 0 1 1.5 stop bits Reserved 1 0 2 stop bits 2 stop bits 1 1 Reserved Reserved • CHMODE: Channel Mode CHMODE Mode Description 0 0 Normal Mode 0 1 Automatic Echo. Receiver input is connected to the TXD pin. 1 0 Local Loopback. Transmitter output is connected to the Receiver Input.. 1 1 Remote Loopback. RXD pin is internally connected to the TXD pin. • MSBF: Bit Order 0: Least Significant Bit is sent/received first. 1: Most Significant Bit is sent/received first. 376 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • MODE9: 9-bit Character Length 0: CHRL defines character length. 1: 9-bit character length. • CLKO: Clock Output Select 0: The USART does not drive the SCK pin. 1: The USART drives the SCK pin if USCLKS does not select the external clock SCK. • OVER: Oversampling Mode 0: 16x Oversampling. 1: 8x Oversampling. • INACK: Inhibit Non Acknowledge 0: The NACK is generated. 1: The NACK is not generated. • DSNACK: Disable Successive NACK 0: NACK is sent on the ISO line as soon as a parity error occurs in the received character (unless INACK is set). 1: Successive parity errors are counted up to the value specified in the MAX_ITERATION field. These parity errors generate a NACK on the ISO line. As soon as this value is reached, no additional NACK is sent on the ISO line. The flag ITERATION is asserted. • MAX_ITERATION Defines the maximum number of iterations in mode ISO7816, protocol T= 0. • FILTER: Infrared Receive Line Filter 0: The USART does not filter the receive line. 1: The USART filters the receive line using a three-sample filter (1/16-bit clock) (2 over 3 majority). 377 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7.3 Name: USART Interrupt Enable Register US_IER Access Type:Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 CTSIC 18 DCDIC 17 DSRIC 16 RIIC 15 – 14 – 13 NACK 12 RXBUFF 11 TXBUFE 10 ITERATION 9 TXEMPTY 8 TIMEOUT 7 PARE 6 FRAME 5 OVRE 4 ENDTX 3 ENDRX 2 RXBRK 1 TXRDY 0 RXRDY • RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Enable • TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Enable • RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Enable • ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Enable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Enable • OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable • FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Enable • PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Enable • TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Enable • TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Enable • ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Enable • TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable • RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Enable • NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Enable • RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Enable • DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Enable • DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Enable • CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Enable 378 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.4 Name: USART Interrupt Disable Register US_IDR Access Type:Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 CTSIC 18 DCDIC 17 DSRIC 16 RIIC 15 – 14 – 13 NACK 12 RXBUFF 11 TXBUFE 10 ITERATION 9 TXEMPTY 8 TIMEOUT 7 PARE 6 FRAME 5 OVRE 4 ENDTX 3 ENDRX 2 RXBRK 1 TXRDY 0 RXRDY • RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Disable • TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Disable • RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Disable • ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Disable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Disable • OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable • FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Disable • PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Disable • TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Disable • TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Disable • ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Disable • TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable • RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Disable • NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Disable • RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Disable • DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Disable • DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Disable • CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Disable 379 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7.5 Name: USART Interrupt Mask Register US_IMR Access Type:Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 CTSIC 18 DCDIC 17 DSRIC 16 RIIC 15 – 14 – 13 NACK 12 RXBUFF 11 TXBUFE 10 ITERATION 9 TXEMPTY 8 TIMEOUT 7 PARE 6 FRAME 5 OVRE 4 ENDTX 3 ENDRX 2 RXBRK 1 TXRDY 0 RXRDY • RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Mask • TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Mask • RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Mask • ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Mask • ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Mask • OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask • FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Mask • PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Mask • TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Mask • TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Mask • ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Mask • TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask • RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Mask • NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Mask • RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Mask • DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Mask • DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Mask • CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Mask 380 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.6 Name: USART Channel Status Register US_CSR Access Type:Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 CTS 22 DCD 21 DSR 20 RI 19 CTSIC 18 DCDIC 17 DSRIC 16 RIIC 15 – 14 – 13 NACK 12 RXBUFF 11 TXBUFE 10 ITERATION 9 TXEMPTY 8 TIMEOUT 7 PARE 6 FRAME 5 OVRE 4 ENDTX 3 ENDRX 2 RXBRK 1 TXRDY 0 RXRDY • RXRDY: Receiver Ready 0: No complete character has been received since the last read of US_RHR or the receiver is disabled. If characters were being received when the receiver was disabled, RXRDY changes to 1 when the receiver is enabled. 1: At least one complete character has been received and US_RHR has not yet been read. • TXRDY: Transmitter Ready 0: A character is in the US_THR waiting to be transferred to the Transmit Shift Register, or an STTBRK command has been requested, or the transmitter is disabled. As soon as the transmitter is enabled, TXRDY becomes 1. 1: There is no character in the US_THR. • RXBRK: Break Received/End of Break 0: No Break received or End of Break detected since the last RSTSTA. 1: Break Received or End of Break detected since the last RSTSTA. • ENDRX: End of Receiver Transfer 0: The End of Transfer signal from the Receive PDC channel is inactive. 1: The End of Transfer signal from the Receive PDC channel is active. • ENDTX: End of Transmitter Transfer 0: The End of Transfer signal from the Transmit PDC channel is inactive. 1: The End of Transfer signal from the Transmit PDC channel is active. • OVRE: Overrun Error 0: No overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. • FRAME: Framing Error 0: No stop bit has been detected low since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one stop bit has been detected low since the last RSTSTA. 381 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • PARE: Parity Error 0: No parity error has been detected since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one parity error has been detected since the last RSTSTA. • TIMEOUT: Receiver Time-out 0: There has not been a time-out since the last Start Time-out command (STTTO in US_CR) or the Time-out Register is 0. 1: There has been a time-out since the last Start Time-out command (STTTO in US_CR). • TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty 0: There are characters in either US_THR or the Transmit Shift Register, or the transmitter is disabled. 1: There are no characters in US_THR, nor in the Transmit Shift Register. • ITERATION: Max number of Repetitions Reached 0: Maximum number of repetitions has not been reached since the last RSIT. 1: Maximum number of repetitions has been reached since the last RSIT. • TXBUFE: Transmission Buffer Empty 0: The signal Buffer Empty from the Transmit PDC channel is inactive. 1: The signal Buffer Empty from the Transmit PDC channel is active. • RXBUFF: Reception Buffer Full 0: The signal Buffer Full from the Receive PDC channel is inactive. 1: The signal Buffer Full from the Receive PDC channel is active. • NACK: Non Acknowledge 0: No Non Acknowledge has not been detected since the last RSTNACK. 1: At least one Non Acknowledge has been detected since the last RSTNACK. • RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the RI pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the RI pin since the last read of US_CSR. • DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the DSR pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the DSR pin since the last read of US_CSR. • DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the DCD pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the DCD pin since the last read of US_CSR. • CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the CTS pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the CTS pin since the last read of US_CSR. • RI: Image of RI Input 0: RI is at 0. 1: RI is at 1. 382 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • DSR: Image of DSR Input 0: DSR is at 0 1: DSR is at 1. • DCD: Image of DCD Input 0: DCD is at 0. 1: DCD is at 1. • CTS: Image of CTS Input 0: CTS is at 0. 1: CTS is at 1. 383 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7.7 Name: USART Receive Holding Register US_RHR Access Type:Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 RXSYNH 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 RXCHR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RXCHR • RXCHR: Received Character Last character received if RXRDY is set. • RXSYNH: Received Sync 0: Last Character received is a Data. 1: Last Character received is a Command. 384 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.8 Name: USART Transmit Holding Register US_THR Access Type:Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 TXSYNH 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 TXCHR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXCHR • TXCHR: Character to be Transmitted Next character to be transmitted after the current character if TXRDY is not set. • TXSYNH: Sync Field to be transmitted 0: The next character sent is encoded as a data. Start Frame Delimiter is DATA SYNC. 1: The next character sent is encoded as a command. Start Frame Delimiter is COMMAND SYNC. 385 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7.9 Name: USART Baud Rate Generator Register US_BRGR Access Type:Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 17 FP 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CD 7 6 5 4 CD • CD: Clock Divider USART_MODE ≠ ISO7816 SYNC = 0 CD OVER = 0 USART_MODE = ISO7816 OVER = 1 0 1 to 65535 SYNC = 1 Baud Rate Clock Disabled Baud Rate = Selected Clock/16/CD Baud Rate = Selected Clock/8/CD Baud Rate = Selected Clock /CD Baud Rate = Selected Clock/CD/FI_DI_RATIO • FP: Fractional Part 0: Fractional divider is disabled. 1 - 7: Baudrate resolution, defined by FP x 1/8. 386 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.10 Name: USART Receiver Time-out Register US_RTOR Access Type:Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TO 7 6 5 4 TO • TO: Time-out Value 0: The Receiver Time-out is disabled. 1 - 65535: The Receiver Time-out is enabled and the Time-out delay is TO x Bit Period. 387 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7.11 Name: USART Transmitter Timeguard Register US_TTGR Access Type:Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TG • TG: Timeguard Value 0: The Transmitter Timeguard is disabled. 1 - 255: The Transmitter timeguard is enabled and the timeguard delay is TG x Bit Period. 388 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 31.7.12 Name: USART FI DI RATIO Register US_FIDI Access Type:Read-write Reset Value :0x174 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 9 FI_DI_RATIO 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FI_DI_RATIO • FI_DI_RATIO: FI Over DI Ratio Value 0: If ISO7816 mode is selected, the Baud Rate Generator generates no signal. 1 - 2047: If ISO7816 mode is selected, the Baud Rate is the clock provided on SCK divided by FI_DI_RATIO. 31.7.13 Name: USART Number of Errors Register US_NER Access Type:Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NB_ERRORS • NB_ERRORS: Number of Errors Total number of errors that occurred during an ISO7816 transfer. This register automatically clears when read. 389 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 31.7.14 Name: USART IrDA FILTER Register US_IF Access Type:Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IRDA_FILTER • IRDA_FILTER: IrDA Filter Sets the filter of the IrDA demodulator. 390 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32. Timer Counter (TC) 32.1 Overview The Timer Counter (TC) includes three identical 16-bit Timer Counter channels. Each channel can be independently programmed to perform a wide range of functions including frequency measurement, event counting, interval measurement, pulse generation, delay timing and pulse width modulation. Each channel has three external clock inputs, five internal clock inputs and two multi-purpose input/output signals which can be configured by the user. Each channel drives an internal interrupt signal which can be programmed to generate processor interrupts. The Timer Counter block has two global registers which act upon all three TC channels. The Block Control Register allows the three channels to be started simultaneously with the same instruction. The Block Mode Register defines the external clock inputs for each channel, allowing them to be chained. Table 32-1 gives the assignment of the device Timer Counter clock inputs common to Timer Counter 0 to 2 Table 32-1. Timer Counter Clock Assignment Name Definition TIMER_CLOCK1 MCK/2 TIMER_CLOCK2 MCK/8 TIMER_CLOCK3 MCK/32 TIMER_CLOCK4 MCK/128 TIMER_CLOCK5 MCK/1024 391 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.2 Block Diagram Figure 32-1. Timer Counter Block Diagram Parallel I/O Controller TIMER_CLOCK1 TCLK0 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIOA1 TIOA2 TIMER_CLOCK3 XC0 XC1 TCLK1 Timer/Counter Channel 0 TIOA TIOA0 TIOB0 TIOA0 TIOB TIMER_CLOCK4 XC2 TCLK2 TIMER_CLOCK5 TIOB0 TC0XC0S SYNC TCLK0 TCLK1 TCLK2 INT0 TCLK0 XC0 TCLK1 TIOA0 XC1 Timer/Counter Channel 1 TIOA TIOA1 TIOB1 TIOA1 TIOB TIOA2 TCLK2 XC2 TIOB1 SYNC TC1XC1S TCLK0 XC0 TCLK1 XC1 TCLK2 XC2 Timer/Counter Channel 2 INT1 TIOA TIOA2 TIOB2 TIOA2 TIOB TIOA0 TIOA1 TC2XC2S TIOB2 SYNC INT2 Timer Counter Advanced Interrupt Controller Table 32-2. Signal Name Description Block/Channel Signal Name XC0, XC1, XC2 Channel Signal External Clock Inputs TIOA Capture Mode: Timer Counter Input Waveform Mode: Timer Counter Output TIOB Capture Mode: Timer Counter Input Waveform Mode: Timer Counter Input/Output INT SYNC 392 Description Interrupt Signal Output Synchronization Input Signal AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.3 Pin Name List Table 32-3. 32.4 32.4.1 TC pin list Pin Name Description Type TCLK0-TCLK2 External Clock Input Input TIOA0-TIOA2 I/O Line A I/O TIOB0-TIOB2 I/O Line B I/O Product Dependencies I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the TC pins to their peripheral functions. 32.4.2 Power Management The TC is clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the Timer Counter clock. 32.4.3 Interrupt The TC has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the TC interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the TC. 393 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.5 Functional Description 32.5.1 TC Description The three channels of the Timer Counter are independent and identical in operation. The registers for channel programming are listed in Table 32-4 on page 407. 32.5.2 16-bit Counter Each channel is organized around a 16-bit counter. The value of the counter is incremented at each positive edge of the selected clock. When the counter has reached the value 0xFFFF and passes to 0x0000, an overflow occurs and the COVFS bit in TC_SR (Status Register) is set. The current value of the counter is accessible in real time by reading the Counter Value Register, TC_CV. The counter can be reset by a trigger. In this case, the counter value passes to 0x0000 on the next valid edge of the selected clock. 32.5.3 Clock Selection At block level, input clock signals of each channel can either be connected to the external inputs TCLK0, TCLK1 or TCLK2, or be connected to the internal I/O signals TIOA0, TIOA1 or TIOA2 for chaining by programming the TC_BMR (Block Mode). See Figure 32-2 on page 395. Each channel can independently select an internal or external clock source for its counter: • Internal clock signals: TIMER_CLOCK1, TIMER_CLOCK2, TIMER_CLOCK3, TIMER_CLOCK4, TIMER_CLOCK5 • External clock signals: XC0, XC1 or XC2 This selection is made by the TCCLKS bits in the TC Channel Mode Register. The selected clock can be inverted with the CLKI bit in TC_CMR. This allows counting on the opposite edges of the clock. The burst function allows the clock to be validated when an external signal is high. The BURST parameter in the Mode Register defines this signal (none, XC0, XC1, XC2). See Figure 32-3 on page 395 Note: 394 In all cases, if an external clock is used, the duration of each of its levels must be longer than the master clock period. The external clock frequency must be at least 2.5 times lower than the master clock AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 32-2. Clock Chaining Selection TC0XC0S Timer/Counter Channel 0 TCLK0 TIOA1 XC0 TIOA2 TIOA0 XC1 = TCLK1 XC2 = TCLK2 TIOB0 SYNC TC1XC1S Timer/Counter Channel 1 TCLK1 XC0 = TCLK2 TIOA0 TIOA1 XC1 TIOA2 XC2 = TCLK2 TIOB1 SYNC Timer/Counter Channel 2 TC2XC2S XC0 = TCLK0 TCLK2 TIOA2 XC1 = TCLK1 TIOA0 XC2 TIOB2 TIOA1 SYNC Figure 32-3. Clock Selection TCCLKS TIMER_CLOCK1 TIMER_CLOCK2 CLKI TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK5 Selected Clock XC0 XC1 XC2 BURST 1 395 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.5.4 Clock Control The clock of each counter can be controlled in two different ways: it can be enabled/disabled and started/stopped. See Figure 32-4. • The clock can be enabled or disabled by the user with the CLKEN and the CLKDIS commands in the Control Register. In Capture Mode it can be disabled by an RB load event if LDBDIS is set to 1 in TC_CMR. In Waveform Mode, it can be disabled by an RC Compare event if CPCDIS is set to 1 in TC_CMR. When disabled, the start or the stop actions have no effect: only a CLKEN command in the Control Register can re-enable the clock. When the clock is enabled, the CLKSTA bit is set in the Status Register. • The clock can also be started or stopped: a trigger (software, synchro, external or compare) always starts the clock. The clock can be stopped by an RB load event in Capture Mode (LDBSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) or a RC compare event in Waveform Mode (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR). The start and the stop commands have effect only if the clock is enabled. Figure 32-4. Clock Control Selected Clock Trigger CLKSTA CLKEN Q Q S CLKDIS S R R Counter Clock 32.5.5 Stop Event Disable Event TC Operating Modes Each channel can independently operate in two different modes: • Capture Mode provides measurement on signals. • Waveform Mode provides wave generation. The TC Operating Mode is programmed with the WAVE bit in the TC Channel Mode Register. In Capture Mode, TIOA and TIOB are configured as inputs. In Waveform Mode, TIOA is always configured to be an output and TIOB is an output if it is not selected to be the external trigger. 32.5.6 Trigger A trigger resets the counter and starts the counter clock. Three types of triggers are common to both modes, and a fourth external trigger is available to each mode. The following triggers are common to both modes: 396 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • Software Trigger: Each channel has a software trigger, available by setting SWTRG in TC_CCR. • SYNC: Each channel has a synchronization signal SYNC. When asserted, this signal has the same effect as a software trigger. The SYNC signals of all channels are asserted simultaneously by writing TC_BCR (Block Control) with SYNC set. • Compare RC Trigger: RC is implemented in each channel and can provide a trigger when the counter value matches the RC value if CPCTRG is set in TC_CMR. The channel can also be configured to have an external trigger. In Capture Mode, the external trigger signal can be selected between TIOA and TIOB. In Waveform Mode, an external event can be programmed on one of the following signals: TIOB, XC0, XC1 or XC2. This external event can then be programmed to perform a trigger by setting ENETRG in TC_CMR. If an external trigger is used, the duration of the pulses must be longer than the master clock period in order to be detected. Regardless of the trigger used, it will be taken into account at the following active edge of the selected clock. This means that the counter value can be read differently from zero just after a trigger, especially when a low frequency signal is selected as the clock. 32.5.7 Capture Operating Mode This mode is entered by clearing the WAVE parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register). Capture Mode allows the TC channel to perform measurements such as pulse timing, frequency, period, duty cycle and phase on TIOA and TIOB signals which are considered as inputs. Figure 32-5 shows the configuration of the TC channel when programmed in Capture Mode. 32.5.8 Capture Registers A and B Registers A and B (RA and RB) are used as capture registers. This means that they can be loaded with the counter value when a programmable event occurs on the signal TIOA. The LDRA parameter in TC_CMR defines the TIOA edge for the loading of register A, and the LDRB parameter defines the TIOA edge for the loading of Register B. RA is loaded only if it has not been loaded since the last trigger or if RB has been loaded since the last loading of RA. RB is loaded only if RA has been loaded since the last trigger or the last loading of RB. Loading RA or RB before the read of the last value loaded sets the Overrun Error Flag (LOVRS) in TC_SR (Status Register). In this case, the old value is overwritten. 32.5.9 Trigger Conditions In addition to the SYNC signal, the software trigger and the RC compare trigger, an external trigger can be defined. The ABETRG bit in TC_CMR selects TIOA or TIOB input signal as an external trigger. The ETRGEDG parameter defines the edge (rising, falling or both) detected to generate an external trigger. If ETRGEDG = 0 (none), the external trigger is disabled. 397 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 398 MTIOA MTIOB 1 If RA is not loaded or RB is Loaded Edge Detector ETRGEDG SWTRG Timer/Counter Channel ABETRG BURST CLKI S R OVF LDRB Edge Detector Edge Detector Capture Register A LDBSTOP R S CLKEN LDRA If RA is Loaded CPCTRG 16-bit Counter RESET Trig CLK Q Q CLKSTA LDBDIS Capture Register B CLKDIS TC1_SR TIOA TIOB SYNC XC2 XC1 XC0 TIMER_CLOCK5 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIMER_CLOCK1 TCCLKS Compare RC = Register C COVFS INT Figure 32-5. Capture Mode CPCS LOVRS LDRBS ETRGS LDRAS TC1_IMR AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.5.10 Waveform Operating Mode Waveform operating mode is entered by setting the WAVE parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register). In Waveform Operating Mode the TC channel generates 1 or 2 PWM signals with the same frequency and independently programmable duty cycles, or generates different types of one-shot or repetitive pulses. In this mode, TIOA is configured as an output and TIOB is defined as an output if it is not used as an external event (EEVT parameter in TC_CMR). Figure 32-6 shows the configuration of the TC channel when programmed in Waveform Operating Mode. 32.5.11 Waveform Selection Depending on the WAVSEL parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register), the behavior of TC_CV varies. With any selection, RA, RB and RC can all be used as compare registers. RA Compare is used to control the TIOA output, RB Compare is used to control the TIOB output (if correctly configured) and RC Compare is used to control TIOA and/or TIOB outputs. 399 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 400 TIOB SYNC XC2 XC1 XC0 TIMER_CLOCK5 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIMER_CLOCK1 1 EEVT BURST Timer/Counter Channel Edge Detector EEVTEDG SWTRG ENETRG CLKI Trig CLK R S OVF WAVSEL RESET 16-bit Counter WAVSEL Q Compare RA = Register A Q CLKSTA Compare RC = Compare RB = CPCSTOP CPCDIS Register C CLKDIS Register B R S CLKEN CPAS INT BSWTRG BEEVT BCPB BCPC ASWTRG AEEVT ACPA ACPC Output Controller Output Controller TCCLKS TIOB MTIOB TIOA MTIOA Figure 32-6. Waveform Mode CPCS CPBS COVFS TC1_SR ETRGS TC1_IMR AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.5.11.1 WAVSEL = 00 When WAVSEL = 00, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to 0xFFFF. Once 0xFFFF has been reached, the value of TC_CV is reset. Incrementation of TC_CV starts again and the cycle continues. See Figure 32-7. An external event trigger or a software trigger can reset the value of TC_CV. It is important to note that the trigger may occur at any time. See Figure 32-8. RC Compare cannot be programmed to generate a trigger in this configuration. At the same time, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1 in TC_CMR). Figure 32-7. WAVSEL= 00 without trigger Counter Value Counter cleared by compare match with 0xFFFF 0xFFFF RC RB RA Waveform Examples Time TIOB TIOA 401 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 32-8. WAVSEL= 00 with trigger Counter cleared by compare match with 0xFFFF Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by trigger RC RB RA Time Waveform Examples TIOB TIOA 32.5.11.2 WAVSEL = 10 When WAVSEL = 10, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to the value of RC, then automatically reset on a RC Compare. Once the value of TC_CV has been reset, it is then incremented and so on. See Figure 32-9. It is important to note that TC_CV can be reset at any time by an external event or a software trigger if both are programmed correctly. See Figure 32-10. In addition, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1 in TC_CMR). Figure 32-9. WAVSEL = 10 Without Trigger Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by compare match with RC RC RB RA Waveform Examples Time TIOB TIOA 402 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 32-10. WAVSEL = 10 With Trigger Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by compare match with RC Counter cleared by trigger RC RB RA Waveform Examples Time TIOB TIOA 32.5.11.3 WAVSEL = 01 When WAVSEL = 01, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to 0xFFFF. Once 0xFFFF is reached, the value of TC_CV is decremented to 0, then re-incremented to 0xFFFF and so on. See Figure 32-11. A trigger such as an external event or a software trigger can modify TC_CV at any time. If a trigger occurs while TC_CV is incrementing, TC_CV then decrements. If a trigger is received while TC_CV is decrementing, TC_CV then increments. See Figure 32-12. RC Compare cannot be programmed to generate a trigger in this configuration. At the same time, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1). 403 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 32-11. WAVSEL = 01 Without Trigger Counter decremented by compare match with 0xFFFF Counter Value 0xFFFF RC RB RA Time Waveform Examples TIOB TIOA Figure 32-12. WAVSEL = 01 With Trigger Counter Value Counter decremented by compare match with 0xFFFF 0xFFFF Counter decremented by trigger RC RB Counter incremented by trigger RA Time Waveform Examples TIOB TIOA 32.5.11.4 WAVSEL = 11 When WAVSEL = 11, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to RC. Once RC is reached, the value of TC_CV is decremented to 0, then re-incremented to RC and so on. See Figure 32-13. A trigger such as an external event or a software trigger can modify TC_CV at any time. If a trigger occurs while TC_CV is incrementing, TC_CV then decrements. If a trigger is received while TC_CV is decrementing, TC_CV then increments. See Figure 32-14. RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1). 404 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 32-13. WAVSEL = 11 Without Trigger Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter decremented by compare match with RC RC RB RA Time Waveform Examples TIOB TIOA Figure 32-14. WAVSEL = 11 With Trigger Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter decremented by compare match with RC RC RB Counter decremented by trigger Counter incremented by trigger RA Waveform Examples Time TIOB TIOA 405 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.5.12 External Event/Trigger Conditions An external event can be programmed to be detected on one of the clock sources (XC0, XC1, XC2) or TIOB. The external event selected can then be used as a trigger. The EEVT parameter in TC_CMR selects the external trigger. The EEVTEDG parameter defines the trigger edge for each of the possible external triggers (rising, falling or both). If EEVTEDG is cleared (none), no external event is defined. If TIOB is defined as an external event signal (EEVT = 0), TIOB is no longer used as an output and the compare register B is not used to generate waveforms and subsequently no IRQs. In this case the TC channel can only generate a waveform on TIOA. When an external event is defined, it can be used as a trigger by setting bit ENETRG in TC_CMR. As in Capture Mode, the SYNC signal and the software trigger are also available as triggers. RC Compare can also be used as a trigger depending on the parameter WAVSEL. 32.5.13 Output Controller The output controller defines the output level changes on TIOA and TIOB following an event. TIOB control is used only if TIOB is defined as output (not as an external event). The following events control TIOA and TIOB: software trigger, external event and RC compare. RA compare controls TIOA and RB compare controls TIOB. Each of these events can be programmed to set, clear or toggle the output as defined in the corresponding parameter in TC_CMR. 406 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6 Timer Counter (TC) User Interface Table 32-4. Register Mapping Offset(1) Register Name Access Reset 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x00 Channel Control Register TC_CCR Write-only – 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x04 Channel Mode Register TC_CMR Read-write 0 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x08 Reserved 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x0C Reserved 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x10 Counter Value TC_CV Read-only 0 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x14 Register A TC_RA Read-write (2) 0 Read-write (2) 0 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x18 Register B TC_RB 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x1C Register C TC_RC Read-write 0 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x20 Status Register TC_SR Read-only 0 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x24 Interrupt Enable Register TC_IER Write-only – 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x28 Interrupt Disable Register TC_IDR Write-only – 0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x2C Interrupt Mask Register TC_IMR Read-only 0 0xC0 Block Control Register TC_BCR Write-only – 0xC4 Block Mode Register TC_BMR Read-write 0 0xFC Reserved – – – Notes: 1. Channel index range from 0 to 2. 2. Read-only if WAVE = 0 407 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.6.1 TC Block Control Register Register Name: TC_BCR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – SYNC • SYNC: Synchro Command 0 = No effect. 1 = Asserts the SYNC signal which generates a software trigger simultaneously for each of the channels. 408 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6.2 TC Block Mode Register Register Name: TC_BMR Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 – – TC2XC2S TC1XC1S 0 TC0XC0S • TC0XC0S: External Clock Signal 0 Selection TC0XC0S Signal Connected to XC0 0 0 TCLK0 0 1 none 1 0 TIOA1 1 1 TIOA2 • TC1XC1S: External Clock Signal 1 Selection TC1XC1S Signal Connected to XC1 0 0 TCLK1 0 1 none 1 0 TIOA0 1 1 TIOA2 • TC2XC2S: External Clock Signal 2 Selection TC2XC2S Signal Connected to XC2 0 0 TCLK2 0 1 none 1 0 TIOA0 1 1 TIOA1 409 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.6.3 TC Channel Control Register Register Name: TC_CCRx [x=0..2] Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – SWTRG CLKDIS CLKEN • CLKEN: Counter Clock Enable Command 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the clock if CLKDIS is not 1. • CLKDIS: Counter Clock Disable Command 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the clock. • SWTRG: Software Trigger Command 0 = No effect. 1 = A software trigger is performed: the counter is reset and the clock is started. 410 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6.4 TC Channel Mode Register: Capture Mode Register Name: TC_CMRx [x=0..2] (WAVE = 0) Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 WAVE CPCTRG – – – ABETRG 7 6 5 3 2 LDBDIS LDBSTOP 16 LDRB 4 BURST CLKI LDRA 9 8 ETRGEDG 1 0 TCCLKS • TCCLKS: Clock Selection TCCLKS Clock Selected 0 0 0 TIMER_CLOCK1 0 0 1 TIMER_CLOCK2 0 1 0 TIMER_CLOCK3 0 1 1 TIMER_CLOCK4 1 0 0 TIMER_CLOCK5 1 0 1 XC0 1 1 0 XC1 1 1 1 XC2 • CLKI: Clock Invert 0 = Counter is incremented on rising edge of the clock. 1 = Counter is incremented on falling edge of the clock. • BURST: Burst Signal Selection BURST 0 0 The clock is not gated by an external signal. 0 1 XC0 is ANDed with the selected clock. 1 0 XC1 is ANDed with the selected clock. 1 1 XC2 is ANDed with the selected clock. • LDBSTOP: Counter Clock Stopped with RB Loading 0 = Counter clock is not stopped when RB loading occurs. 1 = Counter clock is stopped when RB loading occurs. 411 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • LDBDIS: Counter Clock Disable with RB Loading 0 = Counter clock is not disabled when RB loading occurs. 1 = Counter clock is disabled when RB loading occurs. • ETRGEDG: External Trigger Edge Selection ETRGEDG Edge 0 0 none 0 1 rising edge 1 0 falling edge 1 1 each edge • ABETRG: TIOA or TIOB External Trigger Selection 0 = TIOB is used as an external trigger. 1 = TIOA is used as an external trigger. • CPCTRG: RC Compare Trigger Enable 0 = RC Compare has no effect on the counter and its clock. 1 = RC Compare resets the counter and starts the counter clock. • WAVE 0 = Capture Mode is enabled. 1 = Capture Mode is disabled (Waveform Mode is enabled). • LDRA: RA Loading Selection LDRA Edge 0 0 none 0 1 rising edge of TIOA 1 0 falling edge of TIOA 1 1 each edge of TIOA • LDRB: RB Loading Selection LDRB 412 Edge 0 0 none 0 1 rising edge of TIOA 1 0 falling edge of TIOA 1 1 each edge of TIOA AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6.5 TC Channel Mode Register: Waveform Mode Register Name: TC_CMRx [x=0..2] (WAVE = 1) Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 BSWTRG 23 22 21 ASWTRG 15 28 27 BEEVT 20 19 AEEVT 14 WAVE 13 7 6 CPCDIS CPCSTOP 24 BCPB 18 11 ENETRG 5 25 17 16 ACPC 12 WAVSEL 26 BCPC ACPA 10 9 EEVT 4 3 BURST CLKI 8 EEVTEDG 2 1 0 TCCLKS • TCCLKS: Clock Selection TCCLKS Clock Selected 0 0 0 TIMER_CLOCK1 0 0 1 TIMER_CLOCK2 0 1 0 TIMER_CLOCK3 0 1 1 TIMER_CLOCK4 1 0 0 TIMER_CLOCK5 1 0 1 XC0 1 1 0 XC1 1 1 1 XC2 • CLKI: Clock Invert 0 = Counter is incremented on rising edge of the clock. 1 = Counter is incremented on falling edge of the clock. • BURST: Burst Signal Selection BURST 0 0 The clock is not gated by an external signal. 0 1 XC0 is ANDed with the selected clock. 1 0 XC1 is ANDed with the selected clock. 1 1 XC2 is ANDed with the selected clock. • CPCSTOP: Counter Clock Stopped with RC Compare 0 = Counter clock is not stopped when counter reaches RC. 1 = Counter clock is stopped when counter reaches RC. 413 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • CPCDIS: Counter Clock Disable with RC Compare 0 = Counter clock is not disabled when counter reaches RC. 1 = Counter clock is disabled when counter reaches RC. • EEVTEDG: External Event Edge Selection EEVTEDG Edge 0 0 none 0 1 rising edge 1 0 falling edge 1 1 each edge • EEVT: External Event Selection EEVT Signal selected as external event TIOB Direction 0 0 TIOB input (1) 0 1 XC0 output 1 0 XC1 output 1 1 XC2 output Note: 1. If TIOB is chosen as the external event signal, it is configured as an input and no longer generates waveforms and subsequently no IRQs. • ENETRG: External Event Trigger Enable 0 = The external event has no effect on the counter and its clock. In this case, the selected external event only controls the TIOA output. 1 = The external event resets the counter and starts the counter clock. • WAVSEL: Waveform Selection WAVSEL Effect 0 0 UP mode without automatic trigger on RC Compare 1 0 UP mode with automatic trigger on RC Compare 0 1 UPDOWN mode without automatic trigger on RC Compare 1 1 UPDOWN mode with automatic trigger on RC Compare • WAVE 0 = Waveform Mode is disabled (Capture Mode is enabled). 1 = Waveform Mode is enabled. 414 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • ACPA: RA Compare Effect on TIOA ACPA Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle • ACPC: RC Compare Effect on TIOA ACPC Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle • AEEVT: External Event Effect on TIOA AEEVT Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle • ASWTRG: Software Trigger Effect on TIOA ASWTRG Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle • BCPB: RB Compare Effect on TIOB BCPB Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle 415 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • BCPC: RC Compare Effect on TIOB BCPC Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle • BEEVT: External Event Effect on TIOB BEEVT Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle • BSWTRG: Software Trigger Effect on TIOB BSWTRG 416 Effect 0 0 none 0 1 set 1 0 clear 1 1 toggle AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6.6 TC Counter Value Register Register Name: TC_CVx [x=0..2] Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CV 7 6 5 4 CV • CV: Counter Value CV contains the counter value in real time. 417 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.6.7 TC Register A Register Name: TC_RAx [x=0..2] Access Type: Read-only if WAVE = 0, Read-write if WAVE = 1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RA 7 6 5 4 RA • RA: Register A RA contains the Register A value in real time. 418 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6.8 TC Register B Register Name: TC_RBx [x=0..2] Access Type: Read-only if WAVE = 0, Read-write if WAVE = 1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RB 7 6 5 4 RB • RB: Register B RB contains the Register B value in real time. 32.6.9 TC Register C Register Name: TC_RCx [x=0..2] Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RC 7 6 5 4 RC • RC: Register C RC contains the Register C value in real time. 419 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.6.10 TC Status Register Register Name: TC_SRx [x=0..2] Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – MTIOB MTIOA CLKSTA 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ETRGS LDRBS LDRAS CPCS CPBS CPAS LOVRS COVFS • COVFS: Counter Overflow Status 0 = No counter overflow has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1 = A counter overflow has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. • LOVRS: Load Overrun Status 0 = Load overrun has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1. 1 = RA or RB have been loaded at least twice without any read of the corresponding register since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0. • CPAS: RA Compare Status 0 = RA Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 0. 1 = RA Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 1. • CPBS: RB Compare Status 0 = RB Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 0. 1 = RB Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 1. • CPCS: RC Compare Status 0 = RC Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1 = RC Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. • LDRAS: RA Loading Status 0 = RA Load has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1. 1 = RA Load has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0. • LDRBS: RB Loading Status 0 = RB Load has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1. 1 = RB Load has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0. • ETRGS: External Trigger Status 0 = External trigger has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1 = External trigger has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 420 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • CLKSTA: Clock Enabling Status 0 = Clock is disabled. 1 = Clock is enabled. • MTIOA: TIOA Mirror 0 = TIOA is low. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOA pin is low. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOA is driven low. 1 = TIOA is high. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOA pin is high. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOA is driven high. • MTIOB: TIOB Mirror 0 = TIOB is low. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOB pin is low. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOB is driven low. 1 = TIOB is high. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOB pin is high. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOB is driven high. 421 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.6.11 TC Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: TC_IERx [x=0..2] Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ETRGS LDRBS LDRAS CPCS CPBS CPAS LOVRS COVFS • COVFS: Counter Overflow 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Counter Overflow Interrupt. • LOVRS: Load Overrun 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Load Overrun Interrupt. • CPAS: RA Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RA Compare Interrupt. • CPBS: RB Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RB Compare Interrupt. • CPCS: RC Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RC Compare Interrupt. • LDRAS: RA Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RA Load Interrupt. • LDRBS: RB Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RB Load Interrupt. • ETRGS: External Trigger 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the External Trigger Interrupt. 422 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 32.6.12 TC Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: TC_IDRx [x=0..2] Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ETRGS LDRBS LDRAS CPCS CPBS CPAS LOVRS COVFS • COVFS: Counter Overflow 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Counter Overflow Interrupt. • LOVRS: Load Overrun 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Load Overrun Interrupt (if WAVE = 0). • CPAS: RA Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RA Compare Interrupt (if WAVE = 1). • CPBS: RB Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RB Compare Interrupt (if WAVE = 1). • CPCS: RC Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RC Compare Interrupt. • LDRAS: RA Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RA Load Interrupt (if WAVE = 0). • LDRBS: RB Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RB Load Interrupt (if WAVE = 0). • ETRGS: External Trigger 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the External Trigger Interrupt. 423 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 32.6.13 TC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: TC_IMRx [x=0..2] Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ETRGS LDRBS LDRAS CPCS CPBS CPAS LOVRS COVFS • COVFS: Counter Overflow 0 = The Counter Overflow Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Counter Overflow Interrupt is enabled. • LOVRS: Load Overrun 0 = The Load Overrun Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Load Overrun Interrupt is enabled. • CPAS: RA Compare 0 = The RA Compare Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The RA Compare Interrupt is enabled. • CPBS: RB Compare 0 = The RB Compare Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The RB Compare Interrupt is enabled. • CPCS: RC Compare 0 = The RC Compare Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The RC Compare Interrupt is enabled. • LDRAS: RA Loading 0 = The Load RA Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Load RA Interrupt is enabled. • LDRBS: RB Loading 0 = The Load RB Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Load RB Interrupt is enabled. • ETRGS: External Trigger 0 = The External Trigger Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The External Trigger Interrupt is enabled. 424 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33. Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) 33.1 Overview The PWM macrocell controls several channels independently. Each channel controls one square output waveform. Characteristics of the output waveform such as period, duty-cycle and polarity are configurable through the user interface. Each channel selects and uses one of the clocks provided by the clock generator. The clock generator provides several clocks resulting from the division of the PWM macrocell master clock. All PWM macrocell accesses are made through APB mapped registers. Channels can be synchronized, to generate non overlapped waveforms. All channels integrate a double buffering system in order to prevent an unexpected output waveform while modifying the period or the duty-cycle. 33.2 Block Diagram Figure 33-1. Pulse Width Modulation Controller Block Diagram PWM Controller PWMx Channel Period PWMx Update Duty Cycle Clock Selector Comparator PWMx Counter PIO PWM0 Channel Period PWM0 Update Duty Cycle Clock Selector PMC MCK Clock Generator Comparator PWM0 Counter APB Interface Interrupt Generator AIC APB 425 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.3 I/O Lines Description Each channel outputs one waveform on one external I/O line. Table 33-1. 33.4 33.4.1 I/O Line Description Name Description Type PWMx PWM Waveform Output for channel x Output Product Dependencies I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the PWM may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired PWM pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the PWM are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO controller. All of the PWM outputs may or may not be enabled. If an application requires only four channels, then only four PIO lines will be assigned to PWM outputs. 33.4.2 Power Management The PWM is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the PWM clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the PWM. However, if the application does not require PWM operations, the PWM clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. In this case, the PWM will resume its operations where it left off. Configuring the PWM does not require the PWM clock to be enabled. 33.4.3 33.5 Interrupt Sources The PWM interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the PWM interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not recommended to use the PWM interrupt line in edge sensitive mode. Functional Description The PWM macrocell is primarily composed of a clock generator module and 4 channels. – Clocked by the system clock, MCK, the clock generator module provides 13 clocks. – Each channel can independently choose one of the clock generator outputs. – Each channel generates an output waveform with attributes that can be defined independently for each channel through the user interface registers. 426 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.5.1 PWM Clock Generator Figure 33-2. Functional View of the Clock Generator Block Diagram MCK modulo n counter MCK MCK/2 MCK/4 MCK/8 MCK/16 MCK/32 MCK/64 MCK/128 MCK/256 MCK/512 MCK/1024 Divider A PREA clkA DIVA PWM_MR Divider B PREB clkB DIVB PWM_MR Caution: Before using the PWM macrocell, the programmer must first enable the PWM clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC). The PWM macrocell master clock, MCK, is divided in the clock generator module to provide different clocks available for all channels. Each channel can independently select one of the divided clocks. The clock generator is divided in three blocks: – a modulo n counter which provides 11 clocks: FMCK, FMCK/2, FMCK/4, FMCK/8, FMCK/16, FMCK/32, FMCK/64, FMCK/128, FMCK/256, FMCK/512, FMCK/1024 – two linear dividers (1, 1/2, 1/3, ... 1/255) that provide two separate clocks: clkA and clkB Each linear divider can independently divide one of the clocks of the modulo n counter. The selection of the clock to be divided is made according to the PREA (PREB) field of the PWM Mode register (PWM_MR). The resulting clock clkA (clkB) is the clock selected divided by DIVA (DIVB) field value in the PWM Mode register (PWM_MR). 427 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 After a reset of the PWM controller, DIVA (DIVB) and PREA (PREB) in the PWM Mode register are set to 0. This implies that after reset clkA (clkB) are turned off. At reset, all clocks provided by the modulo n counter are turned off except clock “clk”. This situation is also true when the PWM master clock is turned off through the Power Management Controller. 33.5.2 33.5.2.1 PWM Channel Block Diagram Figure 33-3. Functional View of the Channel Block Diagram inputs from clock generator Channel Clock Selector Internal Counter Comparator PWMx output waveform inputs from APB bus Each of the 4 channels is composed of three blocks: • A clock selector which selects one of the clocks provided by the clock generator described in Section 33.5.1 “PWM Clock Generator” on page 427. • An internal counter clocked by the output of the clock selector. This internal counter is incremented or decremented according to the channel configuration and comparators events. The size of the internal counter is 16 bits. • A comparator used to generate events according to the internal counter value. It also computes the PWMx output waveform according to the configuration. 33.5.2.2 Waveform Properties The different properties of output waveforms are: • the internal clock selection. The internal channel counter is clocked by one of the clocks provided by the clock generator described in the previous section. This channel parameter is defined in the CPRE field of the PWM_CMRx register. This field is reset at 0. • the waveform period. This channel parameter is defined in the CPRD field of the PWM_CPRDx register. - If the waveform is left aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024), the resulting period formula will be: ( X × CPRD ) ---------------------------------MCK 428 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively: ( CRPD × DIVA ) ( CRPD × DIVAB ) --------------------------------------------- or ------------------------------------------------MCK MCK If the waveform is center aligned then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be: (-------------------------------------------2 × X × CPRD ) MCK By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively: (------------------------------------------------------2 × CPRD × DIVA ) ( 2 × CPRD × DIVB ) or ------------------------------------------------------MCK MCK • the waveform duty cycle. This channel parameter is defined in the CDTY field of the PWM_CDTYx register. If the waveform is left aligned then: period – 1 ⁄ fchannel_x_clock × CDTY )duty cycle = (------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------period If the waveform is center aligned, then: ( ( period ⁄ 2 ) – 1 ⁄ fchannel_x_clock × CDTY ) -) duty cycle = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------( period ⁄ 2 ) • the waveform polarity. At the beginning of the period, the signal can be at high or low level. This property is defined in the CPOL field of the PWM_CMRx register. By default the signal starts by a low level. • the waveform alignment. The output waveform can be left or center aligned. Center aligned waveforms can be used to generate non overlapped waveforms. This property is defined in the CALG field of the PWM_CMRx register. The default mode is left aligned. Figure 33-4. Non Overlapped Center Aligned Waveforms No overlap PWM0 PWM1 Period Note: See Figure 33-5 on page 431 for a detailed description of center aligned waveforms. 429 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 When center aligned, the internal channel counter increases up to CPRD and.decreases down to 0. This ends the period. When left aligned, the internal channel counter increases up to CPRD and is reset. This ends the period. Thus, for the same CPRD value, the period for a center aligned channel is twice the period for a left aligned channel. Waveforms are fixed at 0 when: • CDTY = CPRD and CPOL = 0 • CDTY = 0 and CPOL = 1 Waveforms are fixed at 1 (once the channel is enabled) when: • CDTY = 0 and CPOL = 0 • CDTY = CPRD and CPOL = 1 The waveform polarity must be set before enabling the channel. This immediately affects the channel output level. Changes on channel polarity are not taken into account while the channel is enabled. 430 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 33-5. Waveform Properties PWM_MCKx CHIDx(PWM_SR) CHIDx(PWM_ENA) CHIDx(PWM_DIS) Center Aligned CALG(PWM_CMRx) = 1 PWM_CCNTx CPRD(PWM_CPRDx) CDTY(PWM_CDTYx) Period Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 0 Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 1 CHIDx(PWM_ISR) Left Aligned CALG(PWM_CMRx) = 0 PWM_CCNTx CPRD(PWM_CPRDx) CDTY(PWM_CDTYx) Period Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 0 Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 1 CHIDx(PWM_ISR) 431 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.5.3 33.5.3.1 PWM Controller Operations Initialization Before enabling the output channel, this channel must have been configured by the software application: • Configuration of the clock generator if DIVA and DIVB are required • Selection of the clock for each channel (CPRE field in the PWM_CMRx register) • Configuration of the waveform alignment for each channel (CALG field in the PWM_CMRx register) • Configuration of the period for each channel (CPRD in the PWM_CPRDx register). Writing in PWM_CPRDx Register is possible while the channel is disabled. After validation of the channel, the user must use PWM_CUPDx Register to update PWM_CPRDx as explained below. • Configuration of the duty cycle for each channel (CDTY in the PWM_CDTYx register). Writing in PWM_CDTYx Register is possible while the channel is disabled. After validation of the channel, the user must use PWM_CUPDx Register to update PWM_CDTYx as explained below. • Configuration of the output waveform polarity for each channel (CPOL in the PWM_CMRx register) • Enable Interrupts (Writing CHIDx in the PWM_IER register) • Enable the PWM channel (Writing CHIDx in the PWM_ENA register) It is possible to synchronize different channels by enabling them at the same time by means of writing simultaneously several CHIDx bits in the PWM_ENA register. • In such a situation, all channels may have the same clock selector configuration and the same period specified. 33.5.3.2 Source Clock Selection Criteria The large number of source clocks can make selection difficult. The relationship between the value in the Period Register (PWM_CPRDx) and the Duty Cycle Register (PWM_CDTYx) can help the user in choosing. The event number written in the Period Register gives the PWM accuracy. The Duty Cycle quantum cannot be lower than 1/PWM_CPRDx value. The higher the value of PWM_CPRDx, the greater the PWM accuracy. For example, if the user sets 15 (in decimal) in PWM_CPRDx, the user is able to set a value between 1 up to 14 in PWM_CDTYx Register. The resulting duty cycle quantum cannot be lower than 1/15 of the PWM period. 33.5.3.3 Changing the Duty Cycle or the Period It is possible to modulate the output waveform duty cycle or period. To prevent unexpected output waveform, the user must use the update register (PWM_CUPDx) to change waveform parameters while the channel is still enabled. The user can write a new period value or duty cycle value in the update register (PWM_CUPDx). This register holds the new value until the end of the current cycle and updates the value for the next cycle. Depending on the CPD field in the PWM_CMRx register, PWM_CUPDx either updates PWM_CPRDx or PWM_CDTYx. Note that even if the update register is used, the period must not be smaller than the duty cycle. 432 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 33-6. Synchronized Period or Duty Cycle Update User's Writing PWM_CUPDx Value 0 1 PWM_CPRDx PWM_CMRx. CPD PWM_CDTYx End of Cycle To prevent overwriting the PWM_CUPDx by software, the user can use status events in order to synchronize his software. Two methods are possible. In both, the user must enable the dedicated interrupt in PWM_IER at PWM Controller level. The first method (polling method) consists of reading the relevant status bit in PWM_ISR Register according to the enabled channel(s). See Figure 33-7. The second method uses an Interrupt Service Routine associated with the PWM channel. Note: Reading the PWM_ISR register automatically clears CHIDx flags. Figure 33-7. Polling Method PWM_ISR Read Acknowledgement and clear previous register state Writing in CPD field Update of the Period or Duty Cycle CHIDx = 1 YES Writing in PWM_CUPDx The last write has been taken into account Note: Polarity and alignment can be modified only when the channel is disabled. 433 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.5.3.4 Interrupts Depending on the interrupt mask in the PWM_IMR register, an interrupt is generated at the end of the corresponding channel period. The interrupt remains active until a read operation in the PWM_ISR register occurs. A channel interrupt is enabled by setting the corresponding bit in the PWM_IER register. A channel interrupt is disabled by setting the corresponding bit in the PWM_IDR register. 434 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) User Interface Table 33-2. Offset Register Mapping (1) Register Name Access Reset 0x00 PWM Mode Register PWM_MR Read-write 0 0x04 PWM Enable Register PWM_ENA Write-only - 0x08 PWM Disable Register PWM_DIS Write-only - 0x0C PWM Status Register PWM_SR Read-only 0 0x10 PWM Interrupt Enable Register PWM_IER Write-only - 0x14 PWM Interrupt Disable Register PWM_IDR Write-only - 0x18 PWM Interrupt Mask Register PWM_IMR Read-only 0 0x1C PWM Interrupt Status Register PWM_ISR Read-only 0 0x4C - 0xFC Reserved – – 0x100 - 0x1FC Reserved 0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x00 PWM Channel Mode Register PWM_CMR Read-write 0x0 0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x04 PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register PWM_CDTY Read-write 0x0 0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x08 PWM Channel Period Register PWM_CPRD Read-write 0x0 0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x0C PWM Channel Counter Register PWM_CCNT Read-only 0x0 0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x10 PWM Channel Update Register PWM_CUPD Write-only - Note: – 1. Some registers are indexed with “ch_num” index ranging from 0 to X-1. 435 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.1 PWM Mode Register Register Name: PWM_MR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 23 22 21 20 19 11 26 25 24 18 17 16 10 9 8 1 0 PREB DIVB 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 7 6 5 4 PREA 3 2 DIVA • DIVA, DIVB: CLKA, CLKB Divide Factor DIVA, DIVB CLKA, CLKB 0 CLKA, CLKB clock is turned off 1 CLKA, CLKB clock is clock selected by PREA, PREB 2-255 CLKA, CLKB clock is clock selected by PREA, PREB divided by DIVA, DIVB factor. • PREA, PREB PREA, PREB 0 0 0 0 MCK. 0 0 0 1 MCK/2 0 0 1 0 MCK/4 0 0 1 1 MCK/8 0 1 0 0 MCK/16 0 1 0 1 MCK/32 0 1 1 0 MCK/64 0 1 1 1 MCK/128 1 0 0 0 MCK/256 1 0 0 1 MCK/512 1 0 1 0 MCK/1024 Other 436 Divider Input Clock Reserved AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6.2 PWM Enable Register Register Name: PWM_ENA Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable PWM output for channel x. 437 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.3 PWM Disable Register Register Name: PWM_DIS Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable PWM output for channel x. 438 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6.4 PWM Status Register Register Name: PWM_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = PWM output for channel x is disabled. 1 = PWM output for channel x is enabled. 439 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.5 PWM Interrupt Enable Register Register Name:PWM_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable interrupt for PWM channel x. 440 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6.6 PWM Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: PWM_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable interrupt for PWM channel x. 441 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.7 PWM Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: PWM_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID. 0 = Interrupt for PWM channel x is disabled. 1 = Interrupt for PWM channel x is enabled. 442 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6.8 PWM Interrupt Status Register Register Name: PWM_ISR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 CHID3 2 CHID2 1 CHID1 0 CHID0 • CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = No new channel period has been achieved since the last read of the PWM_ISR register. 1 = At least one new channel period has been achieved since the last read of the PWM_ISR register. Note: Reading PWM_ISR automatically clears CHIDx flags. 443 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.9 PWM Channel Mode Register Register Name: PWM_CMR[0..X-1] Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 CPD 9 CPOL 8 CALG 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 2 1 0 CPRE • CPRE: Channel Pre-scaler CPRE Channel Pre-scaler 0 0 0 0 MCK 0 0 0 1 MCK/2 0 0 1 0 MCK/4 0 0 1 1 MCK/8 0 1 0 0 MCK/16 0 1 0 1 MCK/32 0 1 1 0 MCK/64 0 1 1 1 MCK/128 1 0 0 0 MCK/256 1 0 0 1 MCK/512 1 0 1 0 MCK/1024 1 0 1 1 CLKA 1 1 0 0 CLKB Other Reserved • CALG: Channel Alignment 0 = The period is left aligned. 1 = The period is center aligned. • CPOL: Channel Polarity 0 = The output waveform starts at a low level. 1 = The output waveform starts at a high level. • CPD: Channel Update Period 0 = Writing to the PWM_CUPDx will modify the duty cycle at the next period start event. 1 = Writing to the PWM_CUPDx will modify the period at the next period start event. 444 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6.10 PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register Register Name:PWM_CDTY[0..X-1] Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CDTY 23 22 21 20 CDTY 15 14 13 12 CDTY 7 6 5 4 CDTY Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant. • CDTY: Channel Duty Cycle Defines the waveform duty cycle. This value must be defined between 0 and CPRD (PWM_CPRx). 445 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.11 PWM Channel Period Register Register Name:PWM_CPRD[0. X-1] Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CPRD 23 22 21 20 CPRD 15 14 13 12 CPRD 7 6 5 4 CPRD Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant. • CPRD: Channel Period If the waveform is left-aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: – By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be: (--------------------------------X × CPRD -) MCK – By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively: (-------------------------------------------CRPD × DIVA -) ( CRPD × DIVAB ) or ------------------------------------------------MCK MCK If the waveform is center-aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: – By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be: ( 2 × X × CPRD ) -------------------------------------------MCK – By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively: (------------------------------------------------------2 × CPRD × DIVA ) ( 2 × CPRD × DIVB ) or ------------------------------------------------------MCK MCK 446 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 33.6.12 PWM Channel Counter Register Register Name: PWM_CCNT[0..X-1] Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CNT 23 22 21 20 CNT 15 14 13 12 CNT 7 6 5 4 CNT • CNT: Channel Counter Register Internal counter value. This register is reset when: • the channel is enabled (writing CHIDx in the PWM_ENA register). • the counter reaches CPRD value defined in the PWM_CPRDx register if the waveform is left aligned. 447 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 33.6.13 PWM Channel Update Register Register Name: PWM_CUPD[0..X-1] Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CUPD 23 22 21 20 CUPD 15 14 13 12 CUPD 7 6 5 4 CUPD This register acts as a double buffer for the period or the duty cycle. This prevents an unexpected waveform when modifying the waveform period or duty-cycle. Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant. CPD (PWM_CMRx Register) 448 0 The duty-cycle (CDTY in the PWM_CDTYx register) is updated with the CUPD value at the beginning of the next period. 1 The period (CPRD in the PWM_CPRDx register) is updated with the CUPD value at the beginning of the next period. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34. USB Device Port (UDP) 34.1 Overview The USB Device Port (UDP) is compliant with the Universal Serial Bus (USB) V2.0 full-speed device specification. Each endpoint can be configured in one of several USB transfer types. It can be associated with one or two banks of a dual-port RAM used to store the current data payload. If two banks are used, one DPR bank is read or written by the processor, while the other is read or written by the USB device peripheral. This feature is mandatory for isochronous endpoints. Thus the device maintains the maximum bandwidth (1M bytes/s) by working with endpoints with two banks of DPR. Table 34-1. USB Endpoint Description Mnemonic Dual-Bank(1) Max. Endpoint Size Endpoint Type 0 EP0 No 8 Control/Bulk/Interrupt 1 EP1 Yes 64 Bulk/Iso/Interrupt 2 EP2 Yes 64 Bulk/Iso/Interrupt 3 EP3 No 64 Control/Bulk/Interrupt 4 EP4 Yes 256 Bulk/Iso/Interrupt EP5 Yes 256 Bulk/Iso/Interrupt Endpoint Number 5 Note: 1. The Dual-Bank function provides two banks for an endpoint. This feature is used for ping-pong mode. Suspend and resume are automatically detected by the USB device, which notifies the processor by raising an interrupt. Depending on the product, an external signal can be used to send a wake up to the USB host controller. 449 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.2 Block Diagram Figure 34-1. Block Diagram Atmel Bridge MCK APB to MCU Bus UDPCK USB Device txoen U s e r I n t e r f a c e udp_int external_resume W r a p p e r Dual Port RAM FIFO W r a p p e r eopn Serial Interface Engine 12 MHz SIE txd rxdm Embedded USB Transceiver DP DM rxd rxdp Suspend/Resume Logic Master Clock Domain Recovered 12 MHz Domain Access to the UDP is via the APB bus interface. Read and write to the data FIFO are done by reading and writing 8-bit values to APB registers. The UDP peripheral requires two clocks: one peripheral clock used by the MCK domain and a 48 MHz clock used by the 12 MHz domain. A USB 2.0 full-speed pad is embedded and controlled by the Serial Interface Engine (SIE). The signal external_resume is optional. It allows the UDP peripheral to wake up once in system mode. The host is then notified that the device asks for a resume. This optional feature must be also negotiated with the host during the enumeration. 450 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.3 Product Dependencies For further details on the USB Device hardware implementation, see the specific Product Properties document. The USB physical transceiver is integrated into the product. The bidirectional differential signals DP and DM are available from the product boundary. Two I/O lines may be used by the application: • One to check that VBUS is still available from the host. Self-powered devices may use this entry to be notified that the host has been powered off. In this case, the board pullup on DP must be disabled in order to prevent feeding current to the host. • One to control the board pullup on DP. Thus, when the device is ready to communicate with the host, it activates its DP pullup through this control line. 34.3.1 I/O Lines DP and DM are not controlled by any PIO controllers. The embedded USB physical transceiver is controlled by the USB device peripheral. To reserve an I/O line to check VBUS, the programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign this I/O in input PIO mode. To reserve an I/O line to control the board pullup, the programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign this I/O in output PIO mode. 34.3.2 Power Management The USB device peripheral requires a 48 MHz clock. This clock must be generated by a PLL with an accuracy of ± 0.25%. Thus, the USB device receives two clocks from the Power Management Controller (PMC): the master clock, MCK, used to drive the peripheral user interface, and the UDPCK, used to interface with the bus USB signals (recovered 12 MHz domain). WARNING: The UDP peripheral clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) must be enabled before any read/write operations to the UDP registers including the UDP_TXCV register. 34.3.3 Interrupt The USB device interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the USB device interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the UDP. 451 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.4 Typical Connection Figure 34-2. Board Schematic to Interface USB Device Peripheral PIO 5V Bus Monitoring 27 K 47 K 3V3 PIO Pullup Control 0: Enable 1: Disable 1.5K REXT DDM 2 1 3 Type B 4 Connector DDP REXT 330 K 34.4.1 330 K USB Device Transceiver The USB device transceiver is embedded in the product. A few discrete components are required as follows: • the application detects all device states as defined in chapter 9 of the USB specification; – pullup enable/disable – VBUS monitoring • to reduce power consumption the host is disconnected • for line termination. Pullup enable/disable is done through a MOSFET controlled by a PIO. The pullup is enabled when the PIO drives a 0. Thus PIO default state to 1 corresponds to a pullup disable. Once the pullup is enabled, the host will force a device reset 100 ms later. Bus powered devices must connect the pullup within 100 ms. 34.4.2 VBUS Monitoring VBUS monitoring is required to detect host connection. VBUS monitoring is done using a standard PIO with internal pullup disabled. When the host is switched off, it should be considered as a disconnect, the pullup must be disabled in order to prevent powering the host through the pullup resistor. When the host is disconnected and the transceiver is enabled, then DDP and DDM are floating. This may lead to over consumption. A solution is to connect 330 KΩ pulldowns on DP and DM. These pulldowns do not alter DDP and DDM signal integrity. 452 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary A termination serial resistor must be connected to DP and DM. The resistor value is defined in the electrical specification of the product (REXT). 453 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.5 Functional Description 34.5.1 USB V2.0 Full-speed Introduction The USB V2.0 full-speed provides communication services between host and attached USB devices. Each device is offered with a collection of communication flows (pipes) associated with each endpoint. Software on the host communicates with a USB device through a set of communication flows. Figure 34-3. Example of USB V2.0 Full-speed Communication Control USB Host V2.0 Software Client 1 Software Client 2 Data Flow: Control Transfer EP0 Data Flow: Isochronous In Transfer USB Device 2.0 EP1 Block 1 Data Flow: Isochronous Out Transfer EP2 Data Flow: Control Transfer EP0 Data Flow: Bulk In Transfer USB Device 2.0 EP4 Block 2 Data Flow: Bulk Out Transfer EP5 USB Device endpoint configuration requires that in the first instance Control Transfer must be EP0. The Control Transfer endpoint EP0 is always used when a USB device is first configured (USB v. 2.0 specifications). 34.5.1.1 USB V2.0 Full-speed Transfer Types A communication flow is carried over one of four transfer types defined by the USB device. Table 34-2. Transfer USB Communication Flow Direction Bandwidth Supported Endpoint Size Error Detection Retrying Bidirectional Not guaranteed 8, 16, 32, 64 Yes Automatic Isochronous Unidirectional Guaranteed 256 Yes No Interrupt Unidirectional Not guaranteed ≤64 Yes Yes Bulk Unidirectional Not guaranteed 8, 16, 32, 64 Yes Yes Control 454 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.5.1.2 USB Bus Transactions Each transfer results in one or more transactions over the USB bus. There are three kinds of transactions flowing across the bus in packets: 1. Setup Transaction 2. Data IN Transaction 3. Data OUT Transaction 34.5.1.3 USB Transfer Event Definitions As indicated below, transfers are sequential events carried out on the USB bus. Table 34-3. USB Transfer Events • Setup transaction > Data IN transactions > Status OUT transaction Control Transfers(1) (3) Interrupt IN Transfer (device toward host) • Setup transaction > Data OUT transactions > Status IN transaction • Setup transaction > Status IN transaction • Data IN transaction > Data IN transaction Interrupt OUT Transfer (host toward device) • Data OUT transaction > Data OUT transaction Isochronous IN Transfer(2) (device toward host) • Data IN transaction > Data IN transaction Isochronous OUT Transfer(2) (host toward device) • Data OUT transaction > Data OUT transaction Bulk IN Transfer (device toward host) • Data IN transaction > Data IN transaction Bulk OUT Transfer (host toward device) • Data OUT transaction > Data OUT transaction Notes: 1. Control transfer must use endpoints with no ping-pong attributes. 2. Isochronous transfers must use endpoints with ping-pong attributes. 3. Control transfers can be aborted using a stall handshake. A status transaction is a special type of host-to-device transaction used only in a control transfer. The control transfer must be performed using endpoints with no ping-pong attributes. According to the control sequence (read or write), the USB device sends or receives a status transaction. 455 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 34-4. Control Read and Write Sequences Setup Stage Control Read Setup TX Data Stage Data OUT TX No Data Control Notes: Setup TX Data OUT TX Data Stage Setup Stage Control Write Status Stage Data IN TX Setup Stage Status Stage Setup TX Status IN TX Data IN TX Status IN TX Status Stage Status OUT TX 1. During the Status IN stage, the host waits for a zero length packet (Data IN transaction with no data) from the device using DATA1 PID. Refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0, for more information on the protocol layer. 2. During the Status OUT stage, the host emits a zero length packet to the device (Data OUT transaction with no data). 34.5.2 34.5.2.1 Handling Transactions with USB V2.0 Device Peripheral Setup Transaction Setup is a special type of host-to-device transaction used during control transfers. Control transfers must be performed using endpoints with no ping-pong attributes. A setup transaction needs to be handled as soon as possible by the firmware. It is used to transmit requests from the host to the device. These requests are then handled by the USB device and may require more arguments. The arguments are sent to the device by a Data OUT transaction which follows the setup transaction. These requests may also return data. The data is carried out to the host by the next Data IN transaction which follows the setup transaction. A status transaction ends the control transfer. When a setup transfer is received by the USB endpoint: • The USB device automatically acknowledges the setup packet • RXSETUP is set in the UDP_ CSRx register • An endpoint interrupt is generated while the RXSETUP is not cleared. This interrupt is carried out to the microcontroller if interrupts are enabled for this endpoint. Thus, firmware must detect the RXSETUP polling the UDP_ CSRx or catching an interrupt, read the setup packet in the FIFO, then clear the RXSETUP. RXSETUP cannot be cleared before the setup packet has been read in the FIFO. Otherwise, the USB device would accept the next Data OUT transfer and overwrite the setup packet in the FIFO. 456 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 34-5. Setup Transaction Followed by a Data OUT Transaction Setup Received USB Bus Packets Setup PID Data Setup Setup Handled by Firmware ACK PID RXSETUP Flag Data OUT PID Data OUT Data OUT PID Data OUT ACK PID Cleared by Firmware Set by USB Device Peripheral RX_Data_BKO (UDP_CSRx) 34.5.2.2 NAK PID Interrupt Pending Set by USB Device FIFO (DPR) Content Data Out Received XX Data Setup XX Data OUT Data IN Transaction Data IN transactions are used in control, isochronous, bulk and interrupt transfers and conduct the transfer of data from the device to the host. Data IN transactions in isochronous transfer must be done using endpoints with ping-pong attributes. Using Endpoints Without Ping-pong Attributes To perform a Data IN transaction using a non ping-pong endpoint: 1. The application checks if it is possible to write in the FIFO by polling TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register (TXPKTRDY must be cleared). 2. The application writes the first packet of data to be sent in the endpoint’s FIFO, writing zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register, 3. The application notifies the USB peripheral it has finished by setting the TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 4. The application is notified that the endpoint’s FIFO has been released by the USB device when TXCOMP in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register has been set. Then an interrupt for the corresponding endpoint is pending while TXCOMP is set. 5. The microcontroller writes the second packet of data to be sent in the endpoint’s FIFO, writing zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register, 6. The microcontroller notifies the USB peripheral it has finished by setting the TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 7. The application clears the TXCOMP in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx. After the last packet has been sent, the application must clear TXCOMP once this has been set. TXCOMP is set by the USB device when it has received an ACK PID signal for the Data IN packet. An interrupt is pending while TXCOMP is set. Warning: TX_COMP must be cleared after TX_PKTRDY has been set. Note: Refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0, for more information on the Data IN protocol layer. 457 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 34-6. Data IN Transfer for Non Ping-pong Endpoint Prevous Data IN TX USB Bus Packets Data IN PID Microcontroller Load Data in FIFO Data IN 1 ACK PID Data IN PID NAK PID Data is Sent on USB Bus Data IN PID ACK PID Data IN 2 TXPKTRDY Flag (UDP_CSRx) Set by the firmware Cleared by Hw Set by the firmware Cleared by Hw Interrupt Pending Interrupt Pending TXCOMP Flag (UDP_CSRx) Payload in FIFO Cleared by Firmware DPR access by the firmware FIFO (DPR) Content Data IN 1 Cleared by Firmware DPR access by the hardware Load In Progress Data IN 2 Using Endpoints With Ping-pong Attribute The use of an endpoint with ping-pong attributes is necessary during isochronous transfer. This also allows handling the maximum bandwidth defined in the USB specification during bulk transfer. To be able to guarantee a constant or the maximum bandwidth, the microcontroller must prepare the next data payload to be sent while the current one is being sent by the USB device. Thus two banks of memory are used. While one is available for the microcontroller, the other one is locked by the USB device. Figure 34-7. Bank Swapping Data IN Transfer for Ping-pong Endpoints Microcontroller 1st Data Payload USB Device Write Bank 0 Endpoint 1 USB Bus Read Read and Write at the Same Time 2nd Data Payload Bank 0 Endpoint 1 1st Data Payload Bank 0 Endpoint 1 Bank 1 Endpoint 1 2nd Data Payload 3rd Data Payload Bank 0 Endpoint 1 458 Data IN Packet Bank 1 Endpoint 1 Data IN Packet Data IN Packet 3rd Data Payload AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary When using a ping-pong endpoint, the following procedures are required to perform Data IN transactions: 1. The microcontroller checks if it is possible to write in the FIFO by polling TXPKTRDY to be cleared in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 2. The microcontroller writes the first data payload to be sent in the FIFO (Bank 0), writing zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register. 3. The microcontroller notifies the USB peripheral it has finished writing in Bank 0 of the FIFO by setting the TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 4. Without waiting for TXPKTRDY to be cleared, the microcontroller writes the second data payload to be sent in the FIFO (Bank 1), writing zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register. 5. The microcontroller is notified that the first Bank has been released by the USB device when TXCOMP in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register is set. An interrupt is pending while TXCOMP is being set. 6. Once the microcontroller has received TXCOMP for the first Bank, it notifies the USB device that it has prepared the second Bank to be sent rising TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 7. At this step, Bank 0 is available and the microcontroller can prepare a third data payload to be sent. Figure 34-8. Data IN Transfer for Ping-pong Endpoint Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 0 USB Bus Packets Data IN PID TXPKTRDY Flag (UDP_MCSRx) Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 1 USB Device Send Bank 0 ACK PID Data IN Data IN PID Cleared by USB Device, Data Payload Fully Transmitted Set by Firmware, Data Payload Written in FIFO Bank 0 Data IN ACK PID Set by Firmware, Data Payload Written in FIFO Bank 1 Interrupt Pending Set by USB Device TXCOMP Flag (UDP_CSRx) Set by USB Device Interrupt Cleared by Firmware FIFO (DPR) Written by Microcontroller Bank 0 FIFO (DPR) Bank 1 Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 0 USB Device Send Bank 1 Read by USB Device Written by Microcontroller Written by Microcontroller Read by USB Device Warning: There is software critical path due to the fact that once the second bank is filled, the driver has to wait for TX_COMP to set TX_PKTRDY. If the delay between receiving TX_COMP is set and TX_PKTRDY is set is too long, some Data IN packets may be NACKed, reducing the bandwidth. Warning: TX_COMP must be cleared after TX_PKTRDY has been set. 459 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.5.2.3 Data OUT Transaction Data OUT transactions are used in control, isochronous, bulk and interrupt transfers and conduct the transfer of data from the host to the device. Data OUT transactions in isochronous transfers must be done using endpoints with ping-pong attributes. Data OUT Transaction Without Ping-pong Attributes To perform a Data OUT transaction, using a non ping-pong endpoint: 1. The host generates a Data OUT packet. 2. This packet is received by the USB device endpoint. While the FIFO associated to this endpoint is being used by the microcontroller, a NAK PID is returned to the host. Once the FIFO is available, data are written to the FIFO by the USB device and an ACK is automatically carried out to the host. 3. The microcontroller is notified that the USB device has received a data payload polling RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. An interrupt is pending for this endpoint while RX_DATA_BK0 is set. 4. The number of bytes available in the FIFO is made available by reading RXBYTECNT in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 5. The microcontroller carries out data received from the endpoint’s memory to its memory. Data received is available by reading the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register. 6. The microcontroller notifies the USB device that it has finished the transfer by clearing RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 7. A new Data OUT packet can be accepted by the USB device. Figure 34-9. Data OUT Transfer for Non Ping-pong Endpoints USB Bus Packets Host Sends Data Payload Microcontroller Transfers Data Host Sends the Next Data Payload Data OUT PID ACK PID Data OUT 1 Data OUT2 PID RX_DATA_BK0 (UDP_CSRx) NAK PID Data OUT PID Data OUT2 ACK PID Interrupt Pending Set by USB Device FIFO (DPR) Content Data OUT2 Host Resends the Next Data Payload Data OUT 1 Written by USB Device Cleared by Firmware, Data Payload Written in FIFO Data OUT 1 Microcontroller Read Data OUT 2 Written by USB Device An interrupt is pending while the flag RX_DATA_BK0 is set. Memory transfer between the USB device, the FIFO and microcontroller memory can not be done after RX_DATA_BK0 has been cleared. Otherwise, the USB device would accept the next Data OUT transfer and overwrite the current Data OUT packet in the FIFO. Using Endpoints With Ping-pong Attributes During isochronous transfer, using an endpoint with ping-pong attributes is obligatory. To be able to guarantee a constant bandwidth, the microcontroller must read the previous data payload sent by the host, while the current data payload is received by the USB device. Thus two 460 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary banks of memory are used. While one is available for the microcontroller, the other one is locked by the USB device. Figure 34-10. Bank Swapping in Data OUT Transfers for Ping-pong Endpoints Microcontroller USB Device Write USB Bus Read Data IN Packet Bank 0 Endpoint 1 1st Data Payload Bank 0 Endpoint 1 Bank 1 Endpoint 1 2nd Data Payload Bank 1 Endpoint 1 Bank 0 Endpoint 1 3rd Data Payload Write and Read at the Same Time 1st Data Payload 2nd Data Payload Data IN Packet Data IN Packet 3rd Data Payload Bank 0 Endpoint 1 When using a ping-pong endpoint, the following procedures are required to perform Data OUT transactions: 1. The host generates a Data OUT packet. 2. This packet is received by the USB device endpoint. It is written in the endpoint’s FIFO Bank 0. 3. The USB device sends an ACK PID packet to the host. The host can immediately send a second Data OUT packet. It is accepted by the device and copied to FIFO Bank 1. 4. The microcontroller is notified that the USB device has received a data payload, polling RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. An interrupt is pending for this endpoint while RX_DATA_BK0 is set. 5. The number of bytes available in the FIFO is made available by reading RXBYTECNT in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 6. The microcontroller transfers out data received from the endpoint’s memory to the microcontroller’s memory. Data received is made available by reading the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register. 7. The microcontroller notifies the USB peripheral device that it has finished the transfer by clearing RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 8. A third Data OUT packet can be accepted by the USB peripheral device and copied in the FIFO Bank 0. 9. If a second Data OUT packet has been received, the microcontroller is notified by the flag RX_DATA_BK1 set in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. An interrupt is pending for this endpoint while RX_DATA_BK1 is set. 10. The microcontroller transfers out data received from the endpoint’s memory to the microcontroller’s memory. Data received is available by reading the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register. 461 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 11. The microcontroller notifies the USB device it has finished the transfer by clearing RX_DATA_BK1 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. 12. A fourth Data OUT packet can be accepted by the USB device and copied in the FIFO Bank 0. Figure 34-11. Data OUT Transfer for Ping-pong Endpoint Microcontroller Reads Data 1 in Bank 0, Host Sends Second Data Payload Host Sends First Data Payload USB Bus Packets Data OUT PID RX_DATA_BK0 Flag (UDP_CSRx) Data OUT 1 Data OUT PID Data OUT 2 Set by USB Device, Data Payload Written in FIFO Endpoint Bank 0 ACK PID Data OUT 3 A P Cleared by Firmware Set by USB Device, Data Payload Written in FIFO Endpoint Bank 1 Interrupt Pending Data OUT1 Data OUT 1 Data OUT 3 Write by USB Device Read By Microcontroller Write In Progress FIFO (DPR) Bank 1 Data OUT 2 Write by USB Device Note: Data OUT PID Cleared by Firmware Interrupt Pending RX_DATA_BK1 Flag (UDP_CSRx) FIFO (DPR) Bank 0 ACK PID Microcontroller Reads Data2 in Bank 1, Host Sends Third Data Payload Data OUT 2 Read By Microcontroller An interrupt is pending while the RX_DATA_BK0 or RX_DATA_BK1 flag is set. Warning: When RX_DATA_BK0 and RX_DATA_BK1 are both set, there is no way to determine which one to clear first. Thus the software must keep an internal counter to be sure to clear alternatively RX_DATA_BK0 then RX_DATA_BK1. This situation may occur when the software application is busy elsewhere and the two banks are filled by the USB host. Once the application comes back to the USB driver, the two flags are set. 34.5.2.4 Stall Handshake A stall handshake can be used in one of two distinct occasions. (For more information on the stall handshake, refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0.) • A functional stall is used when the halt feature associated with the endpoint is set. (Refer to Chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0, for more information on the halt feature.) • To abort the current request, a protocol stall is used, but uniquely with control transfer. The following procedure generates a stall packet: 1. The microcontroller sets the FORCESTALL flag in the UDP_ CSRx endpoint’s register. 2. The host receives the stall packet. 462 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 3. The microcontroller is notified that the device has sent the stall by polling the STALLSENT to be set. An endpoint interrupt is pending while STALLSENT is set. The microcontroller must clear STALLSENT to clear the interrupt. When a setup transaction is received after a stall handshake, STALLSENT must be cleared in order to prevent interrupts due to STALLSENT being set. Figure 34-12. Stall Handshake (Data IN Transfer) USB Bus Packets Data IN PID Stall PID Cleared by Firmware FORCESTALL Set by Firmware Interrupt Pending Cleared by Firmware STALLSENT Set by USB Device Figure 34-13. Stall Handshake (Data OUT Transfer) USB Bus Packets Data OUT PID Data OUT Stall PID Set by Firmware FORCESTALL Interrupt Pending STALLSENT Cleared by Firmware Set by USB Device 463 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.5.2.5 Transmit Data Cancellation Some endpoints have dual-banks whereas some endpoints have only one bank. The procedure to cancel transmission data held in these banks is described below. To see the organization of dual-bank availablity refer to Table 34-1 ”USB Endpoint Description”. Endpoints Without Dual-Banks There are two possibilities: In one case, TXPKTRDY field in UDP_CSR has already been set. In the other instance, TXPKTRDY is not set. • TXPKTRDY is not set: – Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset Endpoint Register”.) • TXPKTRDY has already been set: – Clear TXPKTRDY so that no packet is ready to be sent – Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset Endpoint Register”.) Endpoints With Dual-Banks There are two possibilities: In one case, TXPKTRDY field in UDP_CSR has already been set. In the other instance, TXPKTRDY is not set. • TXPKTRDY is not set: – Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset Endpoint Register”.) • TXPKTRDY has already been set: – Clear TXPKTRDY and read it back until actually read at 0. – Set TXPKTRDY and read it back until actually read at 1. – Clear TXPKTRDY so that no packet is ready to be sent. – Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset Endpoint Register”.) 464 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.5.3 Controlling Device States A USB device has several possible states. Refer to Chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0. Figure 34-14. USB Device State Diagram Attached Hub Reset or Deconfigured Hub Configured Bus Inactive Powered Suspended Bus Activity Power Interruption Reset Bus Inactive Suspended Default Bus Activity Reset Address Assigned Bus Inactive Address Suspended Bus Activity Device Deconfigured Device Configured Bus Inactive Configured Suspended Bus Activity Movement from one state to another depends on the USB bus state or on standard requests sent through control transactions via the default endpoint (endpoint 0). After a period of bus inactivity, the USB device enters Suspend Mode. Accepting Suspend/Resume requests from the USB host is mandatory. Constraints in Suspend Mode are very strict for bus-powered applications; devices may not consume more than 500 µA on the USB bus. While in Suspend Mode, the host may wake up a device by sending a resume signal (bus activity) or a USB device may send a wake up request to the host, e.g., waking up a PC by moving a USB mouse. The wake up feature is not mandatory for all devices and must be negotiated with the host. 465 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.5.3.1 Not Powered State Self powered devices can detect 5V VBUS using a PIO as described in the typical connection section. When the device is not connected to a host, device power consumption can be reduced by disabling MCK for the UDP, disabling UDPCK and disabling the transceiver. DDP and DDM lines are pulled down by 330 KΩ resistors. 34.5.3.2 Entering Attached State When no device is connected, the USB DP and DM signals are tied to GND by 15 KΩ pull-down resistors integrated in the hub downstream ports. When a device is attached to a hub downstream port, the device connects a 1.5 KΩ pull-up resistor on DP. The USB bus line goes into IDLE state, DP is pulled up by the device 1.5 KΩ resistor to 3.3V and DM is pulled down by the 15 KΩ resistor of the host. After pullup connection, the device enters the powered state. In this state, the UDPCK and MCK must be enabled in the Power Management Controller. The transceiver can remain disabled. 34.5.3.3 From Powered State to Default State After its connection to a USB host, the USB device waits for an end-of-bus reset. The unmaskable flag ENDBUSRES is set in the register UDP_ISR and an interrupt is triggered. Once the ENDBUSRES interrupt has been triggered, the device enters Default State. In this state, the UDP software must: • Enable the default endpoint, setting the EPEDS flag in the UDP_CSR[0] register and, optionally, enabling the interrupt for endpoint 0 by writing 1 to the UDP_IER register. The enumeration then begins by a control transfer. • Configure the interrupt mask register which has been reset by the USB reset detection • Enable the transceiver clearing the TXVDIS flag in the UDP_TXVC register. In this state UDPCK and MCK must be enabled. Warning: Each time an ENDBUSRES interrupt is triggered, the Interrupt Mask Register and UDP_CSR registers have been reset. 34.5.3.4 From Default State to Address State After a set address standard device request, the USB host peripheral enters the address state. Warning: Before the device enters in address state, it must achieve the Status IN transaction of the control transfer, i.e., the UDP device sets its new address once the TXCOMP flag in the UDP_CSR[0] register has been received and cleared. To move to address state, the driver software sets the FADDEN flag in the UDP_GLB_STAT register, sets its new address, and sets the FEN bit in the UDP_FADDR register. 34.5.3.5 From Address State to Configured State Once a valid Set Configuration standard request has been received and acknowledged, the device enables endpoints corresponding to the current configuration. This is done by setting the EPEDS and EPTYPE fields in the UDP_CSRx registers and, optionally, enabling corresponding interrupts in the UDP_IER register. 34.5.3.6 Entering in Suspend State When a Suspend (no bus activity on the USB bus) is detected, the RXSUSP signal in the UDP_ISR register is set. This triggers an interrupt if the corresponding bit is set in the UDP_IMR 466 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary register.This flag is cleared by writing to the UDP_ICR register. Then the device enters Suspend Mode. In this state bus powered devices must drain less than 500uA from the 5V VBUS. As an example, the microcontroller switches to slow clock, disables the PLL and main oscillator, and goes into Idle Mode. It may also switch off other devices on the board. The USB device peripheral clocks can be switched off. Resume event is asynchronously detected. MCK and UDPCK can be switched off in the Power Management controller and the USB transceiver can be disabled by setting the TXVDIS field in the UDP_TXVC register. Warning: Read, write operations to the UDP registers are allowed only if MCK is enabled for the UDP peripheral. Switching off MCK for the UDP peripheral must be one of the last operations after writing to the UDP_TXVC and acknowledging the RXSUSP. 34.5.3.7 Receiving a Host Resume In suspend mode, a resume event on the USB bus line is detected asynchronously, transceiver and clocks are disabled (however the pullup shall not be removed). Once the resume is detected on the bus, the WAKEUP signal in the UDP_ISR is set. It may generate an interrupt if the corresponding bit in the UDP_IMR register is set. This interrupt may be used to wake up the core, enable PLL and main oscillators and configure clocks. Warning: Read, write operations to the UDP registers are allowed only if MCK is enabled for the UDP peripheral. MCK for the UDP must be enabled before clearing the WAKEUP bit in the UDP_ICR register and clearing TXVDIS in the UDP_TXVC register. 34.5.3.8 Sending a Device Remote Wakeup In Suspend state it is possible to wake up the host sending an external resume. • The device must wait at least 5 ms after being entered in suspend before sending an external resume. • The device has 10 ms from the moment it starts to drain current and it forces a K state to resume the host. • The device must force a K state from 1 to 15 ms to resume the host To force a K state to the bus (DM at 3.3V and DP tied to GND), it is possible to use a transistor to connect a pullup on DM. The K state is obtained by disabling the pullup on DP and enabling the pullup on DM. This should be under the control of the application. Figure 34-15. Board Schematic to Drive a K State 3V3 PIO 0: Force Wake UP (K State) 1: Normal Mode 1.5 K DM 467 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6 USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface WARNING: The UDP peripheral clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) must be enabled before any read/write operations to the UDP registers including the UDP_TXCV register. Table 34-4. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x000 Frame Number Register UDP_FRM_NUM Read-only 0x0000_0000 0x004 Global State Register UDP_GLB_STAT Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x008 Function Address Register UDP_FADDR Read-write 0x0000_0100 0x00C Reserved – – – 0x010 Interrupt Enable Register UDP_IER Write-only 0x014 Interrupt Disable Register UDP_IDR Write-only 0x018 Interrupt Mask Register UDP_IMR Read-only 0x0000_1200 0x01C Interrupt Status Register UDP_ISR Read-only –(1) 0x020 Interrupt Clear Register UDP_ICR Write-only 0x024 Reserved – – – 0x028 Reset Endpoint Register UDP_RST_EP Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x02C Reserved – – – 0x030 + 0x4 * ( ept_num - 1 ) Endpoint Control and Status Register UDP_CSR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x050 + 0x4 * ( ept_num - 1 ) Endpoint FIFO Data Register UDP_FDR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x070 Reserved – – – Read-write 0x0000_0000 – – 0x074 Transceiver Control Register UDP_TXVC 0x078 - 0xFC Reserved – Notes: (2) 1. Reset values are not defined for UDP_ISR. 2. See Warning above the ”Register Mapping” on this page. 468 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.6.1 UDP Frame Number Register Register Name: UDP_ FRM_NUM Access Type: Read-only 31 --- 30 --- 29 --- 28 --- 27 --- 26 --- 25 --- 24 --- 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 FRM_OK 16 FRM_ERR 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 9 FRM_NUM 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FRM_NUM • FRM_NUM[10:0]: Frame Number as Defined in the Packet Field Formats This 11-bit value is incremented by the host on a per frame basis. This value is updated at each start of frame. Value Updated at the SOF_EOP (Start of Frame End of Packet). • FRM_ERR: Frame Error This bit is set at SOF_EOP when the SOF packet is received containing an error. This bit is reset upon receipt of SOF_PID. • FRM_OK: Frame OK This bit is set at SOF_EOP when the SOF packet is received without any error. This bit is reset upon receipt of SOF_PID (Packet Identification). In the Interrupt Status Register, the SOF interrupt is updated upon receiving SOF_PID. This bit is set without waiting for EOP. Note: In the 8-bit Register Interface, FRM_OK is bit 4 of FRM_NUM_H and FRM_ERR is bit 3 of FRM_NUM_L. 469 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.2 UDP Global State Register Register Name: UDP_ GLB_STAT Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 8 – – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 CONFG 0 FADDEN This register is used to get and set the device state as specified in Chapter 9 of the USB Serial Bus Specification, Rev.2.0. • FADDEN: Function Address Enable Read: 0 = Device is not in address state. 1 = Device is in address state. Write: 0 = No effect, only a reset can bring back a device to the default state. 1 = Sets device in address state. This occurs after a successful Set Address request. Beforehand, the UDP_ FADDR register must have been initialized with Set Address parameters. Set Address must complete the Status Stage before setting FADDEN. Refer to chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more details. • CONFG: Configured Read: 0 = Device is not in configured state. 1 = Device is in configured state. Write: 0 = Sets device in a non configured state 1 = Sets device in configured state. The device is set in configured state when it is in address state and receives a successful Set Configuration request. Refer to Chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more details. 470 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.6.3 UDP Function Address Register Register Name: UDP_ FADDR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 8 – FEN 7 – 6 5 4 3 FADD 2 1 0 • FADD[6:0]: Function Address Value The Function Address Value must be programmed by firmware once the device receives a set address request from the host, and has achieved the status stage of the no-data control sequence. Refer to the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information. After power up or reset, the function address value is set to 0. • FEN: Function Enable Read: 0 = Function endpoint disabled. 1 = Function endpoint enabled. Write: 0 = Disables function endpoint. 1 = Default value. The Function Enable bit (FEN) allows the microcontroller to enable or disable the function endpoints. The microcontroller sets this bit after receipt of a reset from the host. Once this bit is set, the USB device is able to accept and transfer data packets from and to the host. 471 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.4 UDP Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: UDP_ IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 WAKEUP 12 – 11 SOFINT 10 – 9 8 RXRSM RXSUSP 7 6 5 EP5INT 4 EP4INT 3 EP3INT 2 EP2INT 1 EP1INT 0 EP0INT • EP0INT: Enable Endpoint 0 Interrupt • EP1INT: Enable Endpoint 1 Interrupt • EP2INT: Enable Endpoint 2Interrupt • EP3INT: Enable Endpoint 3 Interrupt • EP4INT: Enable Endpoint 4 Interrupt • EP5INT: Enable Endpoint 5 Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables corresponding Endpoint Interrupt. • RXSUSP: Enable UDP Suspend Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables UDP Suspend Interrupt. • RXRSM: Enable UDP Resume Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables UDP Resume Interrupt. • SOFINT: Enable Start Of Frame Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables Start Of Frame Interrupt. • WAKEUP: Enable UDP bus Wakeup Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables USB bus Interrupt. 472 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.6.5 UDP Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: UDP_ IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 WAKEUP 12 – 11 SOFINT 10 – 9 8 RXRSM RXSUSP 7 6 5 EP5INT 4 EP4INT 3 EP3INT 2 EP2INT 1 EP1INT 0 EP0INT • EP0INT: Disable Endpoint 0 Interrupt • EP1INT: Disable Endpoint 1 Interrupt • EP2INT: Disable Endpoint 2 Interrupt • EP3INT: Disable Endpoint 3 Interrupt • EP4INT: Disable Endpoint 4 Interrupt • EP5INT: Disable Endpoint 5 Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables corresponding Endpoint Interrupt. • RXSUSP: Disable UDP Suspend Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables UDP Suspend Interrupt. • RXRSM: Disable UDP Resume Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables UDP Resume Interrupt. • SOFINT: Disable Start Of Frame Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables Start Of Frame Interrupt • WAKEUP: Disable USB Bus Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables USB Bus Wakeup Interrupt. 473 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.6 UDP Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: UDP_ IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 WAKEUP 12 – 11 SOFINT 10 – 9 8 RXRSM RXSUSP 7 6 5 EP5INT 4 EP4INT 3 EP3INT 2 EP2INT 1 EP1INT 0 EP0INT • EP0INT: Mask Endpoint 0 Interrupt • EP1INT: Mask Endpoint 1 Interrupt • EP2INT: Mask Endpoint 2 Interrupt • EP3INT: Mask Endpoint 3 Interrupt • EP4INT: Mask Endpoint 4 Interrupt • EP5INT: Mask Endpoint 5 Interrupt 0 = Corresponding Endpoint Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Corresponding Endpoint Interrupt is enabled. • RXSUSP: Mask UDP Suspend Interrupt 0 = UDP Suspend Interrupt is disabled. 1 = UDP Suspend Interrupt is enabled. • RXRSM: Mask UDP Resume Interrupt. 0 = UDP Resume Interrupt is disabled. 1 = UDP Resume Interrupt is enabled. • SOFINT: Mask Start Of Frame Interrupt 0 = Start of Frame Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Start of Frame Interrupt is enabled. • BIT12: UDP_IMR Bit 12 Bit 12 of UDP_IMR cannot be masked and is always read at 1. 474 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • WAKEUP: USB Bus WAKEUP Interrupt 0 = USB Bus Wakeup Interrupt is disabled. 1 = USB Bus Wakeup Interrupt is enabled. Note: When the USB block is in suspend mode, the application may power down the USB logic. In this case, any USB HOST resume request that is made must be taken into account and, thus, the reset value of the RXRSM bit of the register UDP_ IMR is enabled. 475 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.7 UDP Interrupt Status Register Register Name: UDP_ ISR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 WAKEUP 12 ENDBUSRES 11 SOFINT 10 – 9 8 RXRSM RXSUSP 7 6 5 EP5INT 4 EP4INT 3 EP3INT 2 EP2INT 1 EP1INT 0 EP0INT • EP0INT: Endpoint 0 Interrupt Status • EP1INT: Endpoint 1 Interrupt Status • EP2INT: Endpoint 2 Interrupt Status • EP3INT: Endpoint 3 Interrupt Status • EP4INT: Endpoint 4 Interrupt Status • EP5INT: Endpoint 5 Interrupt Status 0 = No Endpoint0 Interrupt pending. 1 = Endpoint0 Interrupt has been raised. Several signals can generate this interrupt. The reason can be found by reading UDP_ CSR0: RXSETUP set to 1 RX_DATA_BK0 set to 1 RX_DATA_BK1 set to 1 TXCOMP set to 1 STALLSENT set to 1 EP0INT is a sticky bit. Interrupt remains valid until EP0INT is cleared by writing in the corresponding UDP_ CSR0 bit. • RXSUSP: UDP Suspend Interrupt Status 0 = No UDP Suspend Interrupt pending. 1 = UDP Suspend Interrupt has been raised. The USB device sets this bit when it detects no activity for 3ms. The USB device enters Suspend mode. • RXRSM: UDP Resume Interrupt Status 0 = No UDP Resume Interrupt pending. 1 =UDP Resume Interrupt has been raised. The USB device sets this bit when a UDP resume signal is detected at its port. 476 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary After reset, the state of this bit is undefined, the application must clear this bit by setting the RXRSM flag in the UDP_ ICR register. • SOFINT: Start of Frame Interrupt Status 0 = No Start of Frame Interrupt pending. 1 = Start of Frame Interrupt has been raised. This interrupt is raised each time a SOF token has been detected. It can be used as a synchronization signal by using isochronous endpoints. • ENDBUSRES: End of BUS Reset Interrupt Status 0 = No End of Bus Reset Interrupt pending. 1 = End of Bus Reset Interrupt has been raised. This interrupt is raised at the end of a UDP reset sequence. The USB device must prepare to receive requests on the endpoint 0. The host starts the enumeration, then performs the configuration. • WAKEUP: UDP Resume Interrupt Status 0 = No Wakeup Interrupt pending. 1 = A Wakeup Interrupt (USB Host Sent a RESUME or RESET) occurred since the last clear. After reset the state of this bit is undefined, the application must clear this bit by setting the WAKEUP flag in the UDP_ ICR register. 477 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.8 UDP Interrupt Clear Register Register Name: UDP_ ICR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 WAKEUP 12 ENDBUSRES 11 SOFINT 10 – 9 RXRSM 8 RXSUSP 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 – 0 – • RXSUSP: Clear UDP Suspend Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears UDP Suspend Interrupt. • RXRSM: Clear UDP Resume Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears UDP Resume Interrupt. • SOFINT: Clear Start Of Frame Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears Start Of Frame Interrupt. • ENDBUSRES: Clear End of Bus Reset Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears End of Bus Reset Interrupt. • WAKEUP: Clear Wakeup Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears Wakeup Interrupt. 478 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.6.9 UDP Reset Endpoint Register Register Name: UDP_ RST_EP Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 8 – – 7 6 5 EP5 4 EP4 3 EP3 2 EP2 1 EP1 0 EP0 • EP0: Reset Endpoint 0 • EP1: Reset Endpoint 1 • EP2: Reset Endpoint 2 • EP3: Reset Endpoint 3 • EP4: Reset Endpoint 4 • EP5: Reset Endpoint 5 This flag is used to reset the FIFO associated with the endpoint and the bit RXBYTECOUNT in the register UDP_CSRx.It also resets the data toggle to DATA0. It is useful after removing a HALT condition on a BULK endpoint. Refer to Chapter 5.8.5 in the USB Serial Bus Specification, Rev.2.0. Warning: This flag must be cleared at the end of the reset. It does not clear UDP_ CSRx flags. 0 = No reset. 1 = Forces the corresponding endpoint FIF0 pointers to 0, therefore RXBYTECNT field is read at 0 in UDP_ CSRx register. Reseting the endpoint is a two-step operation: 1. Set the corresponding EPx field. 2. Clear the corresponding EPx field. 479 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.10 UDP Endpoint Control and Status Register Register Name: UDP_ CSRx [x = 0..5] Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 25 RXBYTECNT 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RXBYTECNT 15 EPEDS 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 DTGLE 10 9 EPTYPE 8 7 6 RX_DATA_ BK1 5 FORCE STALL 4 3 STALLSENT ISOERROR 2 1 RX_DATA_ BK0 0 DIR TXPKTRDY RXSETUP TXCOMP WARNING: Due to synchronization between MCK and UDPCK, the software application must wait for the end of the write operation before executing another write by polling the bits which must be set/cleared. //! Clear flags of UDP UDP_CSR register and waits for synchronization #define Udp_ep_clr_flag(pInterface, endpoint, flags) { \ pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] &= ~(flags); \ while ( (pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] & (flags)) == (flags) ); \ } //! Set flags of UDP UDP_CSR register and waits for synchronization #define Udp_ep_set_flag(pInterface, endpoint, flags) { \ pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] |= (flags); \ while ( (pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] & (flags)) != (flags) ); \ } Note: In a preemptive environment, set or clear the flag and wait for a time of 1 UDPCK clock cycle and 1peripheral clock cycle. However, RX_DATA_BLK0, TXPKTRDY, RX_DATA_BK1 require wait times of 3 UDPCK clock cycles and 3 peripheral clock cycles before accessing DPR. • TXCOMP: Generates an IN Packet with Data Previously Written in the DPR This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one. Write (Cleared by the firmware): 0 = Clear the flag, clear the interrupt. 1 = No effect. Read (Set by the USB peripheral): 0 = Data IN transaction has not been acknowledged by the Host. 1 = Data IN transaction is achieved, acknowledged by the Host. After having issued a Data IN transaction setting TXPKTRDY, the device firmware waits for TXCOMP to be sure that the host has acknowledged the transaction. 480 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • RX_DATA_BK0: Receive Data Bank 0 This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one. Write (Cleared by the firmware): 0 = Notify USB peripheral device that data have been read in the FIFO's Bank 0. 1 = To leave the read value unchanged. Read (Set by the USB peripheral): 0 = No data packet has been received in the FIFO's Bank 0. 1 = A data packet has been received, it has been stored in the FIFO's Bank 0. When the device firmware has polled this bit or has been interrupted by this signal, it must transfer data from the FIFO to the microcontroller memory. The number of bytes received is available in RXBYTCENT field. Bank 0 FIFO values are read through the UDP_ FDRx register. Once a transfer is done, the device firmware must release Bank 0 to the USB peripheral device by clearing RX_DATA_BK0. After setting or clearing this bit, a wait time of 3 UDPCK clock cycles and 3 peripheral clock cycles is required before accessing DPR. • RXSETUP: Received Setup This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one. Read: 0 = No setup packet available. 1 = A setup data packet has been sent by the host and is available in the FIFO. Write: 0 = Device firmware notifies the USB peripheral device that it has read the setup data in the FIFO. 1 = No effect. This flag is used to notify the USB device firmware that a valid Setup data packet has been sent by the host and successfully received by the USB device. The USB device firmware may transfer Setup data from the FIFO by reading the UDP_ FDRx register to the microcontroller memory. Once a transfer has been done, RXSETUP must be cleared by the device firmware. Ensuing Data OUT transaction is not accepted while RXSETUP is set. • STALLSENT: Stall Sent (Control, Bulk Interrupt Endpoints) / ISOERROR (Isochronous Endpoints) This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one. STALLSENT: This ends a STALL handshake. Read: 0 = The host has not acknowledged a STALL. 1 = Host has acknowledged the stall. Write: 0 = Resets the STALLSENT flag, clears the interrupt. 1 = No effect. This is mandatory for the device firmware to clear this flag. Otherwise the interrupt remains. 481 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Refer to chapters 8.4.5 and 9.4.5 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on the STALL handshake. ISOERROR: A CRC error has been detected in an isochronous transfer. Read: 0 = No error in the previous isochronous transfer. 1 = CRC error has been detected, data available in the FIFO are corrupted. Write: 0 = Resets the ISOERROR flag, clears the interrupt. 1 = No effect. • TXPKTRDY: Transmit Packet Ready This flag is cleared by the USB device. This flag is set by the USB device firmware. Read: 0 = Can be set to one to send the FIFO data. 1 = The data is waiting to be sent upon reception of token IN. Write: 0 = Can be written if old value is zero. 1 = A new data payload is has been written in the FIFO by the firmware and is ready to be sent. This flag is used to generate a Data IN transaction (device to host). Device firmware checks that it can write a data payload in the FIFO, checking that TXPKTRDY is cleared. Transfer to the FIFO is done by writing in the UDP_ FDRx register. Once the data payload has been transferred to the FIFO, the firmware notifies the USB device setting TXPKTRDY to one. USB bus transactions can start. TXCOMP is set once the data payload has been received by the host. After setting or clearing this bit, a wait time of 3 UDPCK clock cycles and 3 peripheral clock cycles is required before accessing DPR. • FORCESTALL: Force Stall (used by Control, Bulk and Isochronous Endpoints) Read: 0 = Normal state. 1 = Stall state. Write: 0 = Return to normal state. 1 = Send STALL to the host. Refer to chapters 8.4.5 and 9.4.5 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on the STALL handshake. Control endpoints: During the data stage and status stage, this bit indicates that the microcontroller cannot complete the request. Bulk and interrupt endpoints: This bit notifies the host that the endpoint is halted. The host acknowledges the STALL, device firmware is notified by the STALLSENT flag. 482 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • RX_DATA_BK1: Receive Data Bank 1 (only used by endpoints with ping-pong attributes) This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one. Write (Cleared by the firmware): 0 = Notifies USB device that data have been read in the FIFO’s Bank 1. 1 = No effect. Read (Set by the USB peripheral): 0 = No data packet has been received in the FIFO's Bank 1. 1 = A data packet has been received, it has been stored in FIFO's Bank 1. When the device firmware has polled this bit or has been interrupted by this signal, it must transfer data from the FIFO to microcontroller memory. The number of bytes received is available in RXBYTECNT field. Bank 1 FIFO values are read through UDP_ FDRx register. Once a transfer is done, the device firmware must release Bank 1 to the USB device by clearing RX_DATA_BK1. • DIR: Transfer Direction (only available for control endpoints) Read/Write 0 = Allows Data OUT transactions in the control data stage. 1 = Enables Data IN transactions in the control data stage. Refer to Chapter 8.5.3 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on the control data stage. This bit must be set before UDP_ CSRx/RXSETUP is cleared at the end of the setup stage. According to the request sent in the setup data packet, the data stage is either a device to host (DIR = 1) or host to device (DIR = 0) data transfer. It is not necessary to check this bit to reverse direction for the status stage. • EPTYPE[2:0]: Endpoint Type Read/Write 000 Control 001 Isochronous OUT 101 Isochronous IN 010 Bulk OUT 110 Bulk IN 011 Interrupt OUT 111 Interrupt IN • DTGLE: Data Toggle Read-only 0 = Identifies DATA0 packet. 1 = Identifies DATA1 packet. Refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on DATA0, DATA1 packet definitions. 483 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • EPEDS: Endpoint Enable Disable Read: 0 = Endpoint disabled. 1 = Endpoint enabled. Write: 0 = Disables endpoint. 1 = Enables endpoint. Control endpoints are always enabled. Reading or writing this field has no effect on control endpoints. Note: After reset, all endpoints are configured as control endpoints (zero). • RXBYTECNT[10:0]: Number of Bytes Available in the FIFO Read-only When the host sends a data packet to the device, the USB device stores the data in the FIFO and notifies the microcontroller. The microcontroller can load the data from the FIFO by reading RXBYTECENT bytes in the UDP_ FDRx register. 484 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.6.11 UDP FIFO Data Register Register Name: UDP_ FDRx [x = 0..5] Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 8 – – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FIFO_DATA • FIFO_DATA[7:0]: FIFO Data Value The microcontroller can push or pop values in the FIFO through this register. RXBYTECNT in the corresponding UDP_ CSRx register is the number of bytes to be read from the FIFO (sent by the host). The maximum number of bytes to write is fixed by the Max Packet Size in the Standard Endpoint Descriptor. It can not be more than the physical memory size associated to the endpoint. Refer to the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information. 485 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 34.6.12 UDP Transceiver Control Register Register Name: UDP_ TXVC Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 8 – TXVDIS 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 0 – – WARNING: The UDP peripheral clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) must be enabled before any read/write operations to the UDP registers including the UDP_TXCV register. • TXVDIS: Transceiver Disable When UDP is disabled, power consumption can be reduced significantly by disabling the embedded transceiver. This can be done by setting TXVDIS field. To enable the transceiver, TXVDIS must be cleared. NOTE: If the USB pullup is not connected on DP, the user should not write in any UDP register other than the UDP_ TXVC register. This is because if DP and DM are floating at 0, or pulled down, then SE0 is received by the device with the consequence of a USB Reset. 486 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 35.1 Overview The ADC is based on a Successive Approximation Register (SAR) 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). It also integrates an 8-to-1 analog multiplexer, making possible the analog-todigital conversions of 8 analog lines. The conversions extend from 0V to ADVREF. The ADC supports an 8-bit or 10-bit resolution mode, and conversion results are reported in a common register for all channels, as well as in a channel-dedicated register. Software trigger, external trigger on rising edge of the ADTRG pin or internal triggers from Timer Counter output(s) are configurable. The ADC also integrates a Sleep Mode and a conversion sequencer and connects with a PDC channel. These features reduce both power consumption and processor intervention. Finally, the user can configure ADC timings, such as Startup Time and Sample & Hold Time. 35.2 Block Diagram Figure 35-1. Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram Timer Counter Channels PMC MCK ADC Controller Trigger Selection ADTRG Control Logic ADC Interrupt AIC ADC cell VDDIN ADVREF ASB AD- Dedicated Analog Inputs PDC ADUser Interface AD- AD- Analog Inputs Multiplexed with I/O lines PIO AD- Peripheral Bridge Successive Approximation Register Analog-to-Digital Converter APB AD- GND 487 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 35.3 Signal Description Table 35-1. ADC Pin Description Pin Name Description ADVREF Reference voltage AD0 - AD7 Analog input channels ADTRG External trigger 35.4 Product Dependencies 35.4.1 Power Management The ADC Controller clock (MCK) is always clocked. 35.4.2 Interrupt Sources The ADC interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the ADC interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. 35.4.3 Analog Inputs The analog input pins can be multiplexed with PIO lines. In this case, the assignment of the ADC input is automatically done as soon as the corresponding channel is enabled by writing the register ADC_CHER. By default, after reset, the PIO line is configured as input with its pull-up enabled and the ADC input is connected to the GND. 35.4.4 I/O Lines The pin ADTRG may be shared with other peripheral functions through the PIO Controller. In this case, the PIO Controller should be set accordingly to assign the pin ADTRG to the ADC function. 35.4.5 Timer Triggers Timer Counters may or may not be used as hardware triggers depending on user requirements. Thus, some or all of the timer counters may be non-connected. 35.4.6 488 Conversion Performances For performance and electrical characteristics of the ADC, see the DC Characteristics section. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.5 35.5.1 Functional Description Analog-to-digital Conversion The ADC uses the ADC Clock to perform conversions. Converting a single analog value to a 10bit digital data requires Sample and Hold Clock cycles as defined in the field SHTIM of the “ADC Mode Register” on page 496 and 10 ADC Clock cycles. The ADC Clock frequency is selected in the PRESCAL field of the Mode Register (ADC_MR). The ADC clock range is between MCK/2, if PRESCAL is 0, and MCK/128, if PRESCAL is set to 63 (0x3F). PRESCAL must be programmed in order to provide an ADC clock frequency according to the parameters given in the Product definition section. 35.5.2 Conversion Reference The conversion is performed on a full range between 0V and the reference voltage pin ADVREF. Analog inputs between these voltages convert to values based on a linear conversion. 35.5.3 Conversion Resolution The ADC supports 8-bit or 10-bit resolutions. The 8-bit selection is performed by setting the bit LOWRES in the ADC Mode Register (ADC_MR). By default, after a reset, the resolution is the highest and the DATA field in the data registers is fully used. By setting the bit LOWRES, the ADC switches in the lowest resolution and the conversion results can be read in the eight lowest significant bits of the data registers. The two highest bits of the DATA field in the corresponding ADC_CDR register and of the LDATA field in the ADC_LCDR register read 0. Moreover, when a PDC channel is connected to the ADC, 10-bit resolution sets the transfer request sizes to 16-bit. Setting the bit LOWRES automatically switches to 8-bit data transfers. In this case, the destination buffers are optimized. 489 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 35.5.4 Conversion Results When a conversion is completed, the resulting 10-bit digital value is stored in the Channel Data Register (ADC_CDR) of the current channel and in the ADC Last Converted Data Register (ADC_LCDR). The channel EOC bit in the Status Register (ADC_SR) is set and the DRDY is set. In the case of a connected PDC channel, DRDY rising triggers a data transfer request. In any case, either EOC and DRDY can trigger an interrupt. Reading one of the ADC_CDR registers clears the corresponding EOC bit. Reading ADC_LCDR clears the DRDY bit and the EOC bit corresponding to the last converted channel. Figure 35-2. EOCx and DRDY Flag Behavior Write the ADC_CR with START = 1 Read the ADC_CDRx Write the ADC_CR with START = 1 Read the ADC_LCDR CHx (ADC_CHSR) EOCx (ADC_SR) Conversion Time Conversion Time DRDY (ADC_SR) 490 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary If the ADC_CDR is not read before further incoming data is converted, the corresponding Overrun Error (OVRE) flag is set in the Status Register (ADC_SR). In the same way, new data converted when DRDY is high sets the bit GOVRE (General Overrun Error) in ADC_SR. The OVRE and GOVRE flags are automatically cleared when ADC_SR is read. Figure 35-3. GOVRE and OVREx Flag Behavior Read ADC_SR ADTRG CH0 (ADC_CHSR) CH1 (ADC_CHSR) ADC_LCDR Undefined Data ADC_CDR0 Undefined Data ADC_CDR1 EOC0 (ADC_SR) EOC1 (ADC_SR) Data B Data A Data C Data A Data C Undefined Data Data B Conversion Conversion Conversion Read ADC_CDR0 Read ADC_CDR1 GOVRE (ADC_SR) DRDY (ADC_SR) OVRE0 (ADC_SR) Warning: If the corresponding channel is disabled during a conversion or if it is disabled and then reenabled during a conversion, its associated data and its corresponding EOC and OVRE flags in ADC_SR are unpredictable. 491 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 35.5.5 Conversion Triggers Conversions of the active analog channels are started with a software or a hardware trigger. The software trigger is provided by writing the Control Register (ADC_CR) with the bit START at 1. The hardware trigger can be one of the TIOA outputs of the Timer Counter channels, or the external trigger input of the ADC (ADTRG). The hardware trigger is selected with the field TRGSEL in the Mode Register (ADC_MR). The selected hardware trigger is enabled with the bit TRGEN in the Mode Register (ADC_MR). If a hardware trigger is selected, the start of a conversion is triggered after a delay starting at each rising edge of the selected signal. Due to asynchronism handling, the delay may vary in a range of 2 MCK clock periods to 1 ADC clock period. trigger start delay If one of the TIOA outputs is selected, the corresponding Timer Counter channel must be programmed in Waveform Mode. Only one start command is necessary to initiate a conversion sequence on all the channels. The ADC hardware logic automatically performs the conversions on the active channels, then waits for a new request. The Channel Enable (ADC_CHER) and Channel Disable (ADC_CHDR) Registers enable the analog channels to be enabled or disabled independently. If the ADC is used with a PDC, only the transfers of converted data from enabled channels are performed and the resulting data buffers should be interpreted accordingly. Warning: Enabling hardware triggers does not disable the software trigger functionality. Thus, if a hardware trigger is selected, the start of a conversion can be initiated either by the hardware or the software trigger. 35.5.6 Sleep Mode and Conversion Sequencer The ADC Sleep Mode maximizes power saving by automatically deactivating the ADC when it is not being used for conversions. Sleep Mode is selected by setting the bit SLEEP in the Mode Register ADC_MR. The SLEEP mode is automatically managed by a conversion sequencer, which can automatically process the conversions of all channels at lowest power consumption. When a start conversion request occurs, the ADC is automatically activated. As the analog cell requires a start-up time, the logic waits during this time and starts the conversion on the enabled channels. When all conversions are complete, the ADC is deactivated until the next trigger. Triggers occurring during the sequence are not taken into account. The conversion sequencer allows automatic processing with minimum processor intervention and optimized power consumption. Conversion sequences can be performed periodically using a Timer/Counter output. The periodic acquisition of several samples can be processed automatically without any intervention of the processor thanks to the PDC. Note: 492 The reference voltage pins always remain connected in normal mode as in sleep mode. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.5.7 ADC Timings Each ADC has its own minimal Startup Time that is programmed through the field STARTUP in the Mode Register ADC_MR. In the same way, a minimal Sample and Hold Time is necessary for the ADC to guarantee the best converted final value between two channels selection. This time has to be programmed through the bitfield SHTIM in the Mode Register ADC_MR. Warning: No input buffer amplifier to isolate the source is included in the ADC. This must be taken into consideration to program a precise value in the SHTIM field. See the section, ADC Characteristics in the product datasheet. 493 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 35.6 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) User Interface Table 35-2. Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Control Register ADC_CR Write-only – 0x04 Mode Register ADC_MR Read-write 0x00000000 0x08 Reserved – – – 0x0C Reserved – – – 0x10 Channel Enable Register ADC_CHER Write-only – 0x14 Channel Disable Register ADC_CHDR Write-only – 0x18 Channel Status Register ADC_CHSR Read-only 0x00000000 0x1C Status Register ADC_SR Read-only 0x000C0000 0x20 Last Converted Data Register ADC_LCDR Read-only 0x00000000 0x24 Interrupt Enable Register ADC_IER Write-only – 0x28 Interrupt Disable Register ADC_IDR Write-only – 0x2C Interrupt Mask Register ADC_IMR Read-only 0x00000000 0x30 Channel Data Register 0 ADC_CDR0 Read-only 0x00000000 0x34 Channel Data Register 1 ADC_CDR1 Read-only 0x00000000 ... ... ... ADC_CDR7 Read-only 0x00000000 – – – ... 0x4C 0x50 - 0xFC 494 Register Mapping ... Channel Data Register 7 Reserved AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.1 ADC Control Register Register Name: ADC_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 START 0 SWRST • SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the ADC simulating a hardware reset. • START: Start Conversion 0 = No effect. 1 = Begins analog-to-digital conversion. 495 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 35.6.2 ADC Mode Register Register Name: ADC_MR Access Type: Read/Write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 23 – 22 21 20 19 STARTUP 15 14 13 12 26 25 24 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 TRGSEL 1 0 TRGEN SHTIM PRESCAL 7 – 6 – 5 SLEEP 4 LOWRES • TRGEN: Trigger Enable TRGEN Selected TRGEN 0 Hardware triggers are disabled. Starting a conversion is only possible by software. 1 Hardware trigger selected by TRGSEL field is enabled. • TRGSEL: Trigger Selection TRGSEL Selected TRGSEL 0 0 0 TIOA Ouput of the Timer Counter Channel 0 0 0 1 TIOA Ouput of the Timer Counter Channel 1 0 1 0 TIOA Ouput of the Timer Counter Channel 2 0 1 1 Reserved 1 0 0 Reserved 1 0 1 Reserved 1 1 0 External trigger 1 1 1 Reserved • LOWRES: Resolution LOWRES Selected Resolution 0 10-bit resolution 1 8-bit resolution • SLEEP: Sleep Mode SLEEP 496 Selected Mode 0 Normal Mode 1 Sleep Mode AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • PRESCAL: Prescaler Rate Selection ADCClock = MCK / ( (PRESCAL+1) * 2 ) • STARTUP: Start Up Time Startup Time = (STARTUP+1) * 8 / ADCClock • SHTIM: Sample & Hold Time Sample & Hold Time = SHTIM/ADCClock 497 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.3 ADC Channel Enable Register Register Name: ADC_CHER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 CH7 6 CH6 5 CH5 4 CH4 3 CH3 2 CH2 1 CH1 0 CH0 • CHx: Channel x Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding channel. 35.6.4 ADC Channel Disable Register Register Name: ADC_CHDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 CH7 6 CH6 5 CH5 4 CH4 3 CH3 2 CH2 1 CH1 0 CH0 • CHx: Channel x Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding channel. Warning: If the corresponding channel is disabled during a conversion or if it is disabled then reenabled during a conversion, its associated data and its corresponding EOC and OVRE flags in ADC_SR are unpredictable. 498 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.5 ADC Channel Status Register Register Name: ADC_CHSR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 CH7 6 CH6 5 CH5 4 CH4 3 CH3 2 CH2 1 CH1 0 CH0 • CHx: Channel x Status 0 = Corresponding channel is disabled. 1 = Corresponding channel is enabled. 499 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.6 ADC Status Register Register Name: ADC_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 RXBUFF 18 ENDRX 17 GOVRE 16 DRDY 15 OVRE7 14 OVRE6 13 OVRE5 12 OVRE4 11 OVRE3 10 OVRE2 9 OVRE1 8 OVRE0 7 EOC7 6 EOC6 5 EOC5 4 EOC4 3 EOC3 2 EOC2 1 EOC1 0 EOC0 • EOCx: End of Conversion x 0 = Corresponding analog channel is disabled, or the conversion is not finished. 1 = Corresponding analog channel is enabled and conversion is complete. • OVREx: Overrun Error x 0 = No overrun error on the corresponding channel since the last read of ADC_SR. 1 = There has been an overrun error on the corresponding channel since the last read of ADC_SR. • DRDY: Data Ready 0 = No data has been converted since the last read of ADC_LCDR. 1 = At least one data has been converted and is available in ADC_LCDR. • GOVRE: General Overrun Error 0 = No General Overrun Error occurred since the last read of ADC_SR. 1 = At least one General Overrun Error has occurred since the last read of ADC_SR. • ENDRX: End of RX Buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in ADC_RCR or ADC_RNCR. 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in ADC_RCR or ADC_RNCR. • RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = ADC_RCR or ADC_RNCR have a value other than 0. 1 = Both ADC_RCR and ADC_RNCR have a value of 0. 500 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.7 ADC Last Converted Data Register Register Name: ADC_LCDR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 LDATA 0 LDATA • LDATA: Last Data Converted The analog-to-digital conversion data is placed into this register at the end of a conversion and remains until a new conversion is completed. 35.6.8 ADC Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: ADC_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 RXBUFF 18 ENDRX 17 GOVRE 16 DRDY 15 OVRE7 14 OVRE6 13 OVRE5 12 OVRE4 11 OVRE3 10 OVRE2 9 OVRE1 8 OVRE0 7 EOC7 6 EOC6 5 EOC5 4 EOC4 3 EOC3 2 EOC2 1 EOC1 0 EOC0 • EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Enable x • OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable x • DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable • GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Enable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 501 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.9 ADC Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: ADC_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 RXBUFF 18 ENDRX 17 GOVRE 16 DRDY 15 OVRE7 14 OVRE6 13 OVRE5 12 OVRE4 11 OVRE3 10 OVRE2 9 OVRE1 8 OVRE0 7 EOC7 6 EOC6 5 EOC5 4 EOC4 3 EOC3 2 EOC2 1 EOC1 0 EOC0 • EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Disable x • OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable x • DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable • GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Disable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 502 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.10 ADC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: ADC_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 RXBUFF 18 ENDRX 17 GOVRE 16 DRDY 15 OVRE7 14 OVRE6 13 OVRE5 12 OVRE4 11 OVRE3 10 OVRE2 9 OVRE1 8 OVRE0 7 EOC7 6 EOC6 5 EOC5 4 EOC4 3 EOC3 2 EOC2 1 EOC1 0 EOC0 • EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Mask x • OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask x • DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask • GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Mask • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 503 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 35.6.11 ADC Channel Data Register Register Name: ADC_CDRx Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 DATA 0 DATA • DATA: Converted Data The analog-to-digital conversion data is placed into this register at the end of a conversion and remains until a new conversion is completed. The Convert Data Register (CDR) is only loaded if the corresponding analog channel is enabled. 504 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 505 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 506 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 36. Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) 36.1 Description The Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) is compliant with the American FIPS (Federal Information Processing Standard) Publication 197 specification. The AES supports all five confidentiality modes of operation for symmetrical key block cipher algorithms (ECB, CBC, OFB, CFB and CTR), as specified in the NIST Special Publication 80038A Recommendation. It is compatible with all these modes via Peripheral DMA Controller channels, minimizing processor intervention for large buffer transfers. • For the AT91SAM7XC256 and AT91SAM7XC128, the 128-bit key is stored in four 32-bit registers (AES_KEYWxR) which are all write-only. • For the AT91SAM7XC512, the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit keys are stored in four/six/eight 32-bit registers (AES_KEYWxR), respectively, which are all write-only. The 128-bit input data and initialization vector (for some modes) are each stored in four 32-bit registers (AES_IDATAxR and AES_IVxR) which are all write-only. As soon as the initialization vector, the input data and the key are configured, the encryption/decryption process may be started. Then the encrypted/decrypted data is ready to be read out on the four 32-bit output data registers (AES_ODATAxR) or through the PDC channels. 36.2 Product Dependencies 36.2.1 Power Management The AES may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), so the programmer must first to configure the PMC to enable the AES clock. 36.2.2 Interrupt The AES interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the AES interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the AES. 36.3 Functional Description The Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) specifies a FIPS-approved cryptographic algorithm that can be used to protect electronic data. The AES algorithm is a symmetric block cipher that can encrypt (encipher) and decrypt (decipher) information. Encryption converts data to an unintelligible form called ciphertext. Decrypting the ciphertext converts the data back into its original form, called plaintext. The CIPHER bit in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR) allows selection between the encryption and the decryption processes. The AES is capable of using cryptographic keys of 128/192/256 bits to encrypt and decrypt data in blocks of 128 bits. This 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit key is defined in the Key Registers (AES_KEYWxR). The input to the encryption processes of the CBC, CFB, and OFB modes includes, in addition to the plaintext, a 128-bit data block called the initialization vector (IV), which must be set in the Initialization Vector Registers (AES_IVxR). The initialization vector is used in an initial step in the encryption of a message and in the corresponding decryption of the message. The Initialization Vector Registers are also used by the CTR mode to set the counter value. 507 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.3.1 Operation Modes The AES supports the following modes of operation: • ECB: Electronic Code Book • CBC: Cipher Block Chaining • OFB: Output Feedback • CFB: Cipher Feedback – CFB8 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 8 bits) – CFB16 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 16 bits) – CFB32 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 32 bits) – CFB64 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 64 bits) – CFB128 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 128 bits) • CTR: Counter The data pre-processing, post-processing and data chaining for the concerned modes are automatically performed. Refer to the NIST Special Publication 800-38A Recommendation for more complete information. These modes are selected by setting the OPMOD field in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR). In CFB mode, five data sizes are possible (8 bits, 16 bits, 32 bits, 64 bits or 128 bits), configurable by means of the CFBS field in the mode register. (See “AES Mode Register” on page 516.). 36.3.2 Start Modes The SMOD field in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR) allows selection of the encryption (or decryption) start mode. 36.3.2.1 Manual Mode The sequence is as follows: • Write the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit key in the Key Registers (AES_KEYWxR). • Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (AES_IVxR). Note: The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB. • Set the bit DATRDY (Data Ready) in the AES Interrupt Enable register (AES_IER), depending on whether an interrupt is required or not at the end of processing. • Write the data to be encrypted/decrypted in the authorized Input Data Registers (See Table 36-1). Table 36-1. 508 Authorized Input Data Registers Operation Mode Input Data Registers to Write ECB All CBC All OFB All 128-bit CFB All 64-bit CFB AES_IDATA1R and AES_IDATA2R 32-bit CFB AES_IDATA1R AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 36-1. Authorized Input Data Registers (Continued) Operation Mode Input Data Registers to Write 16-bit CFB AES_IDATA1R 8-bit CFB AES_IDATA1R CTR All Note: In 64-bit CFB mode, writing to AES_IDATA3R and AES_IDATA4R registers is not allowed and may lead to errors in processing. Note: In 32-, 16- and 8-bit CFB modes, writing to AES_IDATA2R, AES_IDATA3R and AES_IDATA4R registers is not allowed and may lead to errors in processing. • Set the START bit in the AES Control register AES_CR to begin the encryption or the decryption process. • When processing completes, the bit DATRDY in the AES Interrupt Status Register (AES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit DATRDY in AES_IER, the interrupt line of the AES is activated. • When the software reads one of the Output Data Registers (AES_ODATAxR), the DATRDY bit is automatically cleared. 36.3.2.2 Auto Mode The Auto Mode is similar to the manual one, except that in this mode, as soon as the correct number of Input Data registers is written, processing is automatically started without any action in the Control Register. 36.3.2.3 PDC Mode The Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) can be used in association with the AES to perform an encryption/decryption of a buffer without any action by the software during processing. In this starting mode, the type of the data transfer (byte, half-word or word) depends on the operation mode. Table 36-2. Data Transfer Type for the Different Operation Modes Operation Mode Data Transfer Type (PDC) ECB Word CBC Word OFB Word CFB 128-bit Word CFB 64-bit Word CFB 32-bit Word CFB 16-bit Half-word CFB 8-bit Byte CTR Word The sequence is as follows: • Write the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit key in the Key Registers (AES_KEYWxR). • Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (AES_IVxR). 509 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Note: The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB. • Set the Transmit Pointer Register (AES_TPR) to the address where the data buffer to encrypt/decrypt is stored and the Receive Pointer Register (AES_RPR) where it must be encrypted/decrypted. Note: Transmit and receive buffers can be identical. • Set the Transmit and the Receive Counter Registers (AES_TCR and AES_RCR) to the same value. This value must be a multiple of the data transfer type size (see Table 36-2). Note: The same requirements are necessary for the Next Pointer(s) and Counter(s) of the PDC (AES_TNPR, AES_RNPR, AES_TNCR, AES_RNCR). • If not already done, set the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF if the next pointers and counters are used) in the AES Interrupt Enable register (AES_IER), depending on whether an interrupt is required or not at the end of processing. • Enable the PDC in transmission and reception to start the processing (AES_PTCR). • When the processing completes, the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF) in the AES Interrupt Status Register (AES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the corresponding bit in AES_IER, the interrupt line of the AES is activated. 36.3.3 Last Output Data Mode This mode is used to generate cryptographic checksums on data (MAC) by means of cipher block chaining encryption algorithm (CBC-MAC algorithm for example). After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data registers for Manual and Auto mode or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer for PDC mode (See Table 36-3 on page 512). The Last Output Data bit (LOD) in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR) allows retrieval of only the last data of several encryption/decryption processes. Therefore, there is no need to define a read buffer in PDC mode. This data is only available on the Output Data Registers (AES_ODATAxR). 36.3.3.1 Manual and Auto Modes If LOD = 0 The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read (See Figure 36-1). Figure 36-1. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 0 Write START bit in AES_CR (Manual mode) or Write AES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode) Read the AES_ODATAxR DATRDY Encryption or Decryption Process 510 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary If the user does not want to read the output data registers between each encryption/decryption, the DATRDY flag will not be cleared. If the DATRDY flag is not cleared, the user cannot know the end of the following encryptions/decryptions. If LOD = 1 The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one Input Data Register is written, so before the start of a new transfer (See Figure 36-2). No more Output Data Register reads are necessary between consecutive encryptions/decryptions. Figure 36-2. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 1 Write START bit in AES_CR (Manual mode) or Write AES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode) Write AES_IDATAxR register(s) DATRDY Encryption or Decryption Process 36.3.3.2 PDC Mode If LOD = 0 The end of the encryption/decryption is notified by the ENDRX (or RXBUFF) flag rise (see Figure 36-3). Figure 36-3. PDC Mode with LOD = 0 Enable PDC Channels (Receive and Transmit Channels) Multiple Encryption or Decryption Processes ENDRX (or RXBUFF) If LOD = 1 The user must first wait for the ENDTX (or TXBUFE) flag to rise, then for DATRDY to ensure that the encryption/decryption is completed (see Figure 36-4). In this case, no receive buffers are required. The output data is only available on the Output Data Registers (AES_ODATAxR). 511 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 36-4. PDC Mode with LOD = 1 Enable PDC Channels (only Transmit Channels) DATRDY Multiple Encryption or Decryption Processes ENDTX (or TXBUFE) Table 36-3 summarizes the different cases. Table 36-3. Last Output Mode Behavior versus Start Modes Manual and Auto Modes PDC Mode LOD = 0 LOD = 1 LOD = 0 LOD = 1 DATRDY Flag Clearing Condition(1) At least one Output Data Register must be read At least one Input Data Register must be written Not used Managed by the PDC Encrypted/Decrypted Data Result Location In the Output Data Registers In the Output Data Registers At the address specified in the Receive Pointer Register (AES_RPR) In the Output Data Registers End of Encryption/Decryption DATRDY DATRDY ENDRX (or RXBUFF) ENDTX (or TXBUFE) then DATRDY Note: 1. Depending on the mode, there are other ways of clearing the DATRDY flag. See “AES Interrupt Status Register” on page 522. Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data transfer may lead to unpredictable result. 36.3.4 36.3.4.1 Security Features Countermeasures The AES also features hardware countermeasures that can be useful to protect data against Differential Power Analysis (DPA) attacks. These countermeasures can be enabled through the CTYPE field in the AES Mode Register. This field is write-only, and all changes to it are taken into account if, at the same time, the Countermeasure Key (CKEY field) is correctly written (see “AES Mode Register” on page 516). Note: Enabling countermeasures has an impact on the AES encryption/decryption throughput. By default, all the countermeasures are enabled. The best throughput is achieved with all the countermeasures disabled. On the other hand, the best protection is achieved with all of them enabled. The LOADSEED bit in the AES Control Register (AES_CR) restarts the countermeasures generator to an internal predefined value. 512 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 36.3.4.2 Unspecified Register Access Detection When an unspecified register access occurs, the URAD bit in the Interrupt Status Register (AES_ISR) raises. Its source is then reported in the Unspecified Register Access Type field (URAT). Only the last unspecified register access is available through the URAT field. Several kinds of unspecified register accesses can occur: • Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode • Output Data Register read during data processing • Mode Register written during data processing • Output Data Register read during sub-keys generation • Mode Register written during sub-keys generation • Write-only register read access The URAD bit and the URAT field can only be reset by the SWRST bit in the AES_CR control register. 513 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.4 Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) User Interface Table 36-4. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Control Register AES_CR Write-only – 0x04 Mode Register AES_MR Read-write 0x0 0x08-0x0C Reserved – – – 0x10 Interrupt Enable Register AES_IER Write-only – 0x14 Interrupt Disable Register AES_IDR Write-only – 0x18 Interrupt Mask Register AES_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x1C Interrupt Status Register AES_ISR Read-only 0x0000001E 0x20 Key Word 1 Register AES_KEYW1R Write-only – 0x24 Key Word 2 Register AES_KEYW2R Write-only – 0x28 Key Word 3 Register AES_KEYW3R Write-only – 0x2C Key Word 4 Register AES_KEYW4R Write-only – Key Word 5 Register (1) AES_KEYW5R Write-only – Key Word 6 Register (1) AES_KEYW6R Write-only – Key Word 7 Register (1) AES_KEYW7R Write-only – 0x3C Key Word 8 Register (1) AES_KEYW8R Write-only – 0x40 Input Data 1 Register AES_IDATA1R Write-only – 0x44 Input Data 2 Register AES_IDATA2R Write-only – 0x48 Input Data 3 Register AES_IDATA3R Write-only – 0x4C Input Data 4 Register AES_IDATA4R Write-only – 0x50 Output Data 1 Register AES_ODATA1R Read-only 0x0 0x54 Output Data 2 Register AES_ODATA2R Read-only 0xC01F0000 0x58 Output Data 3 Register AES_ODATA3R Read-only 0x0 0x5C Output Data 4 Register AES_ODATA4R Read-only 0x0 0x60 Initialization Vector 1 Register AES_IV1R Write-only – 0x64 Initialization Vector 2 Register AES_IV2R Write-only – 0x68 Initialization Vector 3 Register AES_IV3R Write-only – 0x6C Initialization Vector 4 Register AES_IV4R Write-only – 0x30 0x34 0x38 0x70 - 0xFC Reserved – – – 0x100-0x124 Reserved for the PDC – – – Note: 514 1. Not available in the AT91SAM7XC256 and the AT91SAM7XC128. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 36.4.1 Name: AES Control Register AES_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – LOADSEED 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – SWRST 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – START • START: Start Processing 0 = No effect 1 = Starts manual encryption/decryption process. • SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the AES. A software triggered hardware reset of the AES interface is performed. • LOADSEED: Random Number Generator Seed Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Restarts the countermeasures generator to an internal predefined value. 515 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.4.2 Name: AES Mode Register AES_MR Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 – – – 23 22 21 28 15 20 19 18 – 14 13 12 6 5 25 24 17 16 CFBS 11 10 9 KEYSIZE(1) OPMOD 7 26 CTYPE CKEY LOD 27 4 PROCDLY 8 SMOD 3 2 1 0 – – – CIPHER • CIPHER: Processing Mode 0 = Decrypts data. 1 = Encrypts data. • PROCDLY: Processing Delay Processing Time = 12 × ( PROCDLY + 1 ) The processing time represents the number of clock cycles that the AES needs in order to perform one encryption/decryption with no countermeasures activated. Note: The best performance is achieved with PROCDLY equal to 0. • SMOD: Start Mode SMOD Description 0 0 Manual Mode 0 1 Auto Mode PDC Mode 1 0 • LOD = 0: The encrypted/decrypted data are available at the address specified in the receive pointer registers (AES_RPR, AES_RNPR). • LOD = 1: The encrypted/decrypted data are available in the output data registers. 1 1 Reserved • KEYSIZE: Key Size(1) KEYSIZE Note: 516 Description 0 0 AES Key Size is 128 bits 0 1 AES Key Size is 192 bits(1) 1 X AES Key Size is 256 bits(1) 1. The key size for AT91SAM7XC128 and AT91SAM7XC256 is 128 bits. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • OPMOD: Operation Mode OPMOD Description 0 0 0 ECB: Electronic Code Book mode 0 0 1 CBC: Cipher Block Chaining mode 0 1 0 OFB: Output Feedback mode 0 1 1 CFB: Cipher Feedback mode 1 0 0 CTR: Counter mode others Reserved • LOD: Last Output Data Mode 0 = No effect. After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data registers (Manual and Auto modes), or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer (PDC mode). In Manual and Auto modes, the DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data registers is read. 1 = The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written. No more Output Data Register reads is necessary between consecutive encryptions/decryptions (see “Last Output Data Mode” on page 510). Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data encryption/decryption process may lead to unpredictable results. • CFBS: Cipher Feedback Data Size CFBS Description 0 0 0 128-bit 0 0 1 64-bit 0 1 0 32-bit 0 1 1 16-bit 1 0 0 8-bit Others Reserved • CKEY: Countermeasure Key This field should be written with the value 0xE to allow CTYPE field changes. If the field is written with a different value, changes made through the CTYPE field will not be taken into account. Note: CKEY field is write-only. • CTYPE: Countermeasure Type CTYPE Description X X X X 0 Countermeasure type 1 is disabled X X X X 1 Countermeasure type 1 is enabled X X X 0 X Countermeasure type 2 is disabled 517 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 CTYPE Description X X X 1 X Countermeasure type 2 is enabled X X 0 X X Countermeasure type 3 is disabled X X 1 X X Countermeasure type 3 is enabled X 0 X X X Countermeasure type 4 is disabled X 1 X X X Countermeasure type 4 is enabled 0 X X X X Countermeasure type 5 is disabled 1 X X X X Countermeasure type 5 is enabled Note: All the countermeasures are enabled by default. Note: CTYPE field is write-only and can only be modified if CKEY is correctly set. 518 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 36.4.3 Name: AES Interrupt Enable Register AES_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – URAD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 519 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.4.4 Name: AES Interrupt Disable Register AES_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – URAD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 520 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 36.4.5 Name: AES Interrupt Mask Register AES_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – URAD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 521 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.4.6 Name: AES Interrupt Status Register AES_ISR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – URAD URAT 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready 0 = Output data is not valid. 1 = Encryption or decryption process is completed. DATRDY is cleared when a Manual encryption/decryption occurs (START bit in AES_CR) or when a software triggered hardware reset of the AES interface is performed (SWRST bit in AES_CR). LOD = 0 (AES_MR): In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read. In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically. LOD = 1 (AES_MR): In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written. In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically. • ENDRX: End of RX Buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in AES_RCR or AES_RNCR. 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in AES_RCR or AES_RNCR. Note: This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared. • ENDTX: End of TX Buffer 0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in AES_TCR or AES_TNCR. 1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in AES_TCR or AES_TNCR. Note: This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set. • RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = AES_RCR or AES_RNCR has a value other than 0. 1 =This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared. Both AES_RCR and AES_RNCR have a value of 0. Note: • TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty 0 = AES_TCR or AES_TNCR has a value other than 0. 522 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 1 = Both AES_TCR and AES_TNCR have a value of 0. Note: This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set. • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Status 0 = No unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST. 1 = At least one unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST. URAD bit is reset only by the SWRST bit in the AES_CR control register. • URAT: Unspecified Register Access Type: URAT Description 0 0 0 Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode. 0 0 1 Output Data Register read during the data processing. 0 1 0 Mode Register written during the data processing. 0 1 1 Output Data Register read during the sub-keys generation. 1 0 0 Mode Register written during the sub-keys generation. 1 0 1 Write-only register read access. others Reserved Only the last Unspecified Register Access Type is available through the URAT field. URAT field is reset only by the SWRST bit in the AES_CR control register. 523 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.4.7 Name: AES Key Word x Register AES_KEYWxR Access Type: 31 Write-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 KEYWx 23 22 21 20 KEYWx 15 14 13 12 KEYWx 7 6 5 4 KEYWx • KEYWx: Key Word x The four/six/eight 32-bit Key Word registers set the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption. KEYW1 corresponds to the first word of the key and respectively KEYW4/KEYW6/KEYW8 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application. 524 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 36.4.8 Name: AES Input Data x Register AES_IDATAxR Access Type: 31 Write-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 IDATAx 23 22 21 20 IDATAx 15 14 13 12 IDATAx 7 6 5 4 IDATAx • IDATAx: Input Data Word x The four 32-bit Input Data registers set the 128-bit data block used for encryption/decryption. IDATA1 corresponds to the first word of the data to be encrypted/decrypted, and IDATA4 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the input data from being read by another application. 36.4.9 Name: AES Output Data x Register AES_ODATAxR Access Type: 31 Read-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ODATAx 23 22 21 20 ODATAx 15 14 13 12 ODATAx 7 6 5 4 ODATAx • ODATAx: Output Data x The four 32-bit Output Data registers contain the 128-bit data block that has been encrypted/decrypted. ODATA1 corresponds to the first word, ODATA4 to the last one. 525 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 36.4.10 Name: AES Initialization Vector x Register AES_IVxR Access Type: 31 Write-only 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 IVx 23 22 21 20 IVx 15 14 13 12 IVx 7 6 5 4 IVx • IVx: Initialization Vector x The four 32-bit Initialization Vector registers set the 128-bit Initialization Vector data block that is used by some modes of operation as an additional initial input. IV1 corresponds to the first word of the Initialization Vector, IV4 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the Initialization Vector from being read by another application. For CBC, OFB and CFB modes, the Initialization Vector corresponds to the initialization vector. For CTR mode, it corresponds to the counter value. Note: 526 These registers are not used in ECB mode and must not be written. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37. Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) 37.1 Overview The Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) is compliant with the American FIPS (Federal Information Processing Standard) Publication 46-3 specification. The TDES supports the four different confidentiality modes of operation (ECB, CBC, OFB and CFB), specified in the FIPS (Federal Information Processing Standard) Publication 81 and is compatible with the Peripheral Data Controller channels for all of these modes, minimizing processor intervention for large buffer transfers. The 64-bit long keys and input data (and initialization vector for some modes) are each stored in two 32-bit registers (TDES_KEYxWxR, TDES_IDATAxR and TDES_IVxR) which are both writeonly. As soon as the initialization vector, the input data and the key are configured, the encryption/decryption process may be started. Then the encrypted/decrypted data is ready to be read out on the two 32-bit output data registers (TDES_ODATAxR) or through the PDC channels. 37.2 Product Dependencies 37.2.1 Power Management The TDES may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), so the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the TDES clock. 37.2.2 Interrupt The TDES interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the TDES interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the TDES. 37.3 Functional Description The Data Encryption Standard (DES) and the Triple Data Encryption Algorithm (TDEA) specify FIPS-approved cryptographic algorithms that can be used to protect electronic data. The TDES bit in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR) is used to select either the single DES or the Triple DES mode. Encryption (enciphering) converts data to an unintelligible form called ciphertext. Decrypting (deciphering) the ciphertext converts the data back into its original form, called plaintext. The CIPHER bit in the TDES Mode Register is used to choose between encryption and decryption. A DES is capable of using cryptographic keys of 64 bits to encrypt and decrypt data in blocks of 64 bits. This 64-bit key is defined in the Key 1 Word Registers (TDES_KEY1WxR). A TDEA key consists of three DES keys, which is also referred to as a key bundle. These three 64-bit keys are defined, respectively, in the Key 1, 2 and 3 Word Registers (TDES_KEY1WxR, TDES_KEY2WxR and TDES_KEY3WxR). In Triple DES mode (TDESMOD set to 1), the KEYMOD bit in the TDES Mode Register is used to choose between a two- and a three-key algorithm: – In three-key encryption mode, the data is first encrypted with Key 1, then decrypted using Key 2 and then encrypted with Key 3. – In three-key decryption mode, the data is decrypted with Key 3, then encrypted with Key 2 and then decrypted using Key 1. 527 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 – In two-key encryption mode, the data is first encrypted with Key 1, then decrypted using Key 2 and then encrypted with Key 1. – In two-key decryption mode, the data is decrypted with Key 1, then encrypted with Key 2 and then decrypted using Key 1. The input to the encryption processes of the CBC, CFB, and OFB modes includes, in addition to the plaintext, a 64-bit data block called the initialization vector (IV), which must be set in the Initialization Vector Registers (TDES_IVxR). The initialization vector is used in an initial step in the encryption of a message and in the corresponding decryption of the message. 37.3.1 Operation Modes The TDES supports the following modes of operation: • ECB: Electronic Code Book • CBC: Cipher Block Chaining • OFB: Output Feedback • CFB: Cipher Feedback – CFB8 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 8 bits) – CFB16 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 16 bits) – CFB32 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 32 bits) – CFB64 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 64 bits) The data pre-processing, post-processing and data chaining for each mode are automatically performed. Refer to the FIPS Publication 81 for more complete information. These modes are selected by setting the OPMOD field in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR). In CFB mode, four data sizes are possible (8, 16, 32 and 64 bits), configurable by means of the CFBS field in the mode register. (See “TDES Mode Register” on page 536.). 37.3.2 Start Modes The SMOD field in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR) allows selection of encryption (or decryption) start mode. 37.3.2.1 Manual Mode The sequence is as follows: • Write the 64-bit key(s) in the different Key Word Registers (TDES_KEYxWxR), depending on whether one, two or three keys are required. • Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (TDES_IVxR). Note: The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB. • Set the bit DATRDY (Data Ready) in the TDES Interrupt Enable register (TDES_IER), depending on whether an interrupt is required or not at the end of processing. • Write the data to be encrypted/decrypted in the authorized Input Data Registers (See Table 37-1). Table 37-1. 528 Authorized Input Data Registers Operation Mode Input Data Registers to Write ECB All CBC All AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 37-1. Note: Authorized Input Data Registers (Continued) Operation Mode Input Data Registers to Write OFB All CFB 64-bit All CFB 32-bit TDES_IDATA1R CFB 16-bit TDES_IDATA1R CFB 8-bit TDES_IDATA1R In 32-, 16- and 8-bit CFB mode, writing to TDES_IDATA2R register is not allowed and may lead to errors in processing. • Set the START bit in the TDES Control register TDES_CR to begin the encryption or the decryption process. • When the processing completes, the bit DATRDY in the TDES Interrupt Status Register (TDES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit DATRDY in TDES_IER, the interrupt line of the TDES is activated. • When the software reads one of the Output Data Registers (TDES_ODATAxR), the DATRDY bit is automatically cleared. 37.3.2.2 Auto Mode The Auto Mode is similar to Manual Mode, except that, as soon as the correct number of Input Data registers is written, processing is automatically started without any action in the control register. 37.3.2.3 PDC Mode The Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) can be used in association with the TDES to perform an encryption/decryption of a buffer without any action by the software during processing. In this starting mode, the type of the data transfer (byte, half-word or word) depends on the operation mode as per Table 37-2. Table 37-2. Data Transfer Type for Different Operation Modes Operation Mode Data Transfer Type (PDC) ECB Word CBC Word OFB Word CFB 64-bit Word CFB 32-bit Word CFB 16-bit Half-word CFB 8-bit Byte The sequence is as follows: • Write the 64-bit key(s) in the different Key Word Registers (TDES_KEYxWxR), depending on whether one, two or three keys are required. • Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (TDES_IVxR). Note: The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB. 529 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • Set the Transmit Pointer Register (TDES_TPR) to the address where the data buffer to encrypt/decrypt is stored and the Receive Pointer Register (TDES_RPR) where it must be encrypted/decrypted. Note: Transmit and receive buffers can be identical. • Set the Transmit and the Receive Counter Registers (TDES_TCR and TDES_RCR) to the same value. This value must be a multiple of the data transfer type size (see Table 37-2). Note: The same requirements are necessary for the Next Pointer(s) and Counter(s) of the PDC (TDES_TNPR, TDES_RNPR, TDES_TNCR, TDES_RNCR). • If not already done, set the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF if the next pointers and counters are used) in the TDES Interrupt Enable register (TDES_IER), depending on whether an interrupt is required or not at the end of processing. • Enable the PDC in transmission and reception to start the processing (TDES_PTCR). • When the processing completes, the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF) in the TDES Interrupt Status Register (TDES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the corresponding bit in TDES_IER, the interrupt line of the TDES is activated. 37.3.3 Last Output Data Mode This mode is used to generate cryptographic checksums on data (MAC) using a CBC or a CFB encryption algorithm (See FIPS Publication 81 Appendix F). After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data registers for Manual and Auto mode or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer for PDC mode (See Table on page 532). The Last Output Data bit (LOD) in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR) retrieves only the last data of several encryption/decryption processes. Therefore, there is no need to define a read buffer in PDC mode. This data is only available on the Output Data Registers (TDES_ODATAxR). 37.3.3.1 Manual and Auto Modes If LOD = 0: The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read. See Figure 37-1. Figure 37-1. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 0 Write START bit in TDES_CR (Manual mode) or Write TDES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode) Read the TDES_ODATAxR DATRDY Encryption or Decryption Process 530 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary If the user does not want to read the output data registers between each encryption/decryption, the DATRDY flag will not be cleared. If the DATRDY flag is not cleared, the user will not be informed of the end of the encryptions/decryptions that follow. If LOD = 1: The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one Input Data Register is written, before the start of a new transfer. See Figure 37-2. No further Output Data Register reads are necessary between consecutive encryptions/decryptions. Figure 37-2. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 1 Write START bit in TDES_CR (Manual mode) or Write TDES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode) Write TDES_IDATAxR register(s) DATRDY Encryption or Decryption Process 37.3.3.2 PDC Mode If LOD = 0: The end of the encryption/decryption is notified by the ENDRX (or RXBUFF) flag rise See Figure 37-3. Figure 37-3. PDC mode with LOD = 0: Enable PDC Channels (Receive and Transmit Channels) Multiple Encryption or Decryption Process ENDRX (or RXBUFF) If LOD = 1: The user must first wait for the ENDTX (or TXBUFE) flag rise, then for DATRDY to ensure that the encryption/decryption is completed. See Figure 37-4. In this case, no receive buffers are required. The output data is only available on the Output Data Registers (TDES_ODATAxR). 531 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 37-4. PDC Mode with LOD = 1: Enable PDC Channels (only Transmit Channels) DATRDY Multiple Encryption or Decryption Process ENDTX (or TXBUFE) Table 37-3 summarizes the different cases. Table 37-3. Last Output Mode Behavior versus Start Modes Manual and Auto Modes DATRDY Flag Clearing Condition(1) PDC Mode LOD = 0 LOD = 1 LOD = 0 LOD = 1 At least one Output Data Register must be read At least one Input Data Register must be written Not used Managed by the PDC In the Output Data Registers ENDTX (or TXBUFE) then DATRDY Encrypted/Decrypted Data Result Location In the Output Data Registers In the Output Data Registers At the address specified in the Receive Pointer Register (TDES_RPR) End of Encryption/Decryption DATRDY DATRDY ENDRX (or RXBUFF) Note: 1. Depending on the mode, there are other ways of clearing the DATRDY flag. See “TDES Interrupt Status Register” on page 541. Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data transfer may lead to unpredictable result. 532 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.3.4 Security Features When an unspecified register access occurs, the URAD bit in the Interrupt Status Register (TDES_ISR) raises. Its source is then reported in the Unspecified Register Access Type field (URAT). Only the last unspecified register access is available through the URAT field. Several kinds of unspecified register accesses can occur: • Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode • Output Data Register read during the data processing • Mode Register written during the data processing • Write-only register read access The URAD bit and the URAT field can only be reset by the SWRST bit in the TDES_CR control register. 533 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 37.4 Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) User Interface Table 37-4. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Control Register TDES_CR Write-only – 0x04 Mode Register TDES_MR Read-write 0x2 0x08-0x0C Reserved – – – 0x10 Interrupt Enable Register TDES_IER Write-only – 0x14 Interrupt Disable Register TDES_IDR Write-only – 0x18 Interrupt Mask Register TDES_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x1C Interrupt Status Register TDES_ISR Read-only 0x0000001E 0x20 Key 1 Word 1 Register TDES_KEY1W1R Write-only – 0x24 Key 1 Word 2 Register TDES_KEY1W2R Write-only – 0x28 Key 2 Word 1 Register TDES_KEY2W1R Write-only – 0x2C Key 2 Word 2 Register TDES_KEY2W2R Write-only – 0x30 Key 3 Word 1 Register TDES_KEY3W1R Write-only – 0x34 Key 3 Word 2 Register TDES_KEY3W2R Write-only – 0x38-0x3C Reserved – – – 0x40 Input Data 1 Register TDES_IDATA1R Write-only – 0x44 Input Data 2 Register TDES_IDATA2R Write-only – – – – 0x48-0x4C Reserved 0x50 Output Data 1 Register TDES_ODATA1R Read-only 0x0 0x54 Output Data 2 Register TDES_ODATA2R Read-only 0x0 – – – 0x58-0x5C Reserved 0x60 Initialization Vector 1 Register TDES_IV1R Write-only – 0x64 Initialization Vector 2 Register TDES_IV2R Write-only – 0x68 - 0xFC Reserved – – – 0x100-0x124 Reserved for the PDC – – – 534 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.1 TDES Control Register Register name: TDES_CR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – SWRST 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – – – – – START • START: Start Processing 0 = No effect 1 = Starts Manual encryption/decryption process. • SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the TDES. A software triggered hardware reset of the TDES interface is performed. 535 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 37.4.2 Name: TDES Mode Register TDES_MR Access Type: Read-write 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 LOD – – – OPMOD 16 CFBS 9 8 SMOD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – KEYMOD – – TDESMOD CIPHER • CIPHER: Processing Mode 0 = Decrypts data. 1 = Encrypts data. • TDESMOD: Single or Triple DES Mode 0 = Single DES processing using TDES_KEY1WxR registers. 1= Triple DES processing using TDES_KEY1WxR, TDES_KEY2WxR and TDES_KEY3WxR registers. • KEYMOD: Key Mode 0 = Three-key algorithm is selected. 1 = Two-key algorithm is selected. There is no need to write TDES_KEY3WxR registers. • SMOD: Start Mode SMOD Description 0 0 Manual Mode. 0 1 Auto Mode. PDC Mode. 1 0 • LOD = 0: The encrypted/decrypted data are available at the address specified in the receive pointer registers (TDES_RPR, TDES_RNPR). • LOD = 1: The encrypted/decrypted data are available in the output data registers. 1 1 Reserved • OPMOD: Operation Mode OPMOD 536 Description 0 0 ECB: Electronic Code Book mode 0 1 CBC: Cipher Block Chaining mode 1 0 OFB: Output Feedback mode 1 1 CFB: Cipher Feedback mode AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • LOD: Last Output Data Mode 0 = No effect. After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data registers (Manual and Auto modes), or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer (PDC mode). In Manual and Auto modes, the DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data registers is read. 1 = The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written. No more Output Data Register reads are necessary between consecutive encryptions/decryptions (See “Last Output Data Mode” on page 530.). Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data encryption/decryption process may lead to unpredictable result. • CFBS: Cipher Feedback Data Size CFBS Description 0 0 64-bit 0 1 32-bit 1 0 16-bit 1 1 8-bit 537 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 37.4.3 Name: TDES Interrupt Enable Register TDES_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – URAD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 538 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.4 Name: TDES Interrupt Disable Register TDES_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – URAD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 539 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 37.4.5 Name: TDES Interrupt Mask Register TDES_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – – – – – URAD 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask • ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask • ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask • RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask • TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 540 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.6 Name: TDES Interrupt Status Register TDES_ISR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 – – – – – – – – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 – – – – – – – – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 – – – URAD URAT 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 – – – TXBUFE RXBUFF ENDTX ENDRX DATRDY • DATRDY: Data Ready 0 = Output data is not valid. 1 = Encryption or decryption process is completed. DATRDY is cleared when a Manual encryption/decryption occurs (START bit in TDES_CR) or when a software triggered hardware reset of the TDES interface is performed (SWRST bit in TDES_CR). LOD = 0 (TDES_MR): In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read. In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically. LOD = 1 (TDES_MR): In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written. In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically. • ENDRX: End of RX Buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TDES_RCR or TDES_RNCR. 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TDES_RCR or TDES_RNCR. Note: This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared. • ENDTX: End of TX Buffer 0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TDES_TCR or TDES_TNCR. 1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TDES_TCR or TDES_TNCR. Note: This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set. • RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = TDES_RCR or TDES_RNCR has a value other than 0. 1 =This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared. Both TDES_RCR and TDES_RNCR have a value of 0. Note: • TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty 0 = TDES_TCR or TDES_TNCR has a value other than 0. 541 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 1 = Both TDES_TCR and TDES_TNCR have a value of 0. Note: This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set. • URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Status 0 = No unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST. 1 = At least one unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST. URAD bit is reset only by the SWRST bit in the TDES_CR control register. • URAT: Unspecified Register Access Type: URAT Description 0 0 Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode. 0 1 Output Data Register read during the data processing. 1 0 Mode Register written during the data processing. 1 1 Write-only register read access. Only the last Unspecified Register Access Type is available through the URAT field. URAT field is reset only by the SWRST bit in the TDES_CR control register. 542 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.7 Name: TDES Key 1 Word x Register TDES_KEY1WxR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 KEY1Wx 23 22 21 20 KEY1Wx 15 14 13 12 KEY1Wx 7 6 5 4 KEY1Wx • KEY1Wx: Key 1 Word x The two 32-bit Key 1 Word Registers allow to set the 64-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption. KEY1W1 corresponds to the first word of the key and KEY1W2 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application. 543 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 37.4.8 Name: TDES Key 2 Word x Register TDES_KEY2WxR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 KEY2Wx 23 22 21 20 KEY2Wx 15 14 13 12 KEY2Wx 7 6 5 4 KEY2Wx • KEY2Wx: Key 2 Word x The two 32-bit Key 2 Word Registers allow to set the 64-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption. KEY2W1 corresponds to the first word of the key and KEY2W2 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application. Note: 544 KEY2WxR registers are not used in DES mode. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.9 Name: TDES Key 3 Word x Register TDES_KEY3WxR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 KEY3Wx 23 22 21 20 KEY3Wx 15 14 13 12 KEY3Wx 7 6 5 4 KEY3Wx • KEY3Wx: Key 3 Word x The two 32-bit Key 3 Word Registers allow to set the 64-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption. KEY3W1 corresponds to the first word of the key and KEY3W2 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application. Note: KEY3WxR registers are not used in DES mode and TDES with two-key algorithm selected. 545 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.10 Name: TDES Input Data x Register TDES_IDATAxR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 IDATAx 23 22 21 20 IDATAx 15 14 13 12 IDATAx 7 6 5 4 IDATAx • IDATAx: Input Data x The two 32-bit Input Data registers allow to set the 64-bit data block used for encryption/decryption. IDATA1 corresponds to the first word of the data to be encrypted/decrypted, and IDATA2 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the input data from being read by another application. 546 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.11 Name: TDES Output Data x Register TDES_ODATAxR Access Type: Read-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ODATAx 23 22 21 20 ODATAx 15 14 13 12 ODATAx 7 6 5 4 ODATAx • ODATAx: Output Data x The two 32-bit Output Data registers contain the 64-bit data block which has been encrypted/decrypted. ODATA1 corresponds to the first word, ODATA2 to the last one. 547 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 37.4.12 Name: TDES Initialization Vector x Register TDES_IVxR Access Type: Write-only 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 IVx 23 22 21 20 IVx 15 14 13 12 IVx 7 6 5 4 IVx • IVx: Initialization Vector x The two 32-bit Initialization Vector registers are used to set the 64-bit initialization vector data block, which is used by some modes of operation as an additional initial input. IV1 corresponds to the first word of the Initialization Vector, IV2 to the last one. These registers are write-only to prevent the Initialization Vector from being read by another application. Note: These registers are not used for ECB mode and must not be written. 548 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38. Controller Area Network (CAN) 38.1 Overview The CAN controller provides all the features required to implement the serial communication protocol CAN defined by Robert Bosch GmbH, the CAN specification as referred to by ISO/11898A (2.0 Part A and 2.0 Part B) for high speeds and ISO/11519-2 for low speeds. The CAN Controller is able to handle all types of frames (Data, Remote, Error and Overload) and achieves a bitrate of 1 Mbit/sec. CAN controller accesses are made through configuration registers. 8 independent message objects (mailboxes) are implemented. Any mailbox can be programmed as a reception buffer block (even non-consecutive buffers). For the reception of defined messages, one or several message objects can be masked without participating in the buffer feature. An interrupt is generated when the buffer is full. According to the mailbox configuration, the first message received can be locked in the CAN controller registers until the application acknowledges it, or this message can be discarded by new received messages. Any mailbox can be programmed for transmission. Several transmission mailboxes can be enabled in the same time. A priority can be defined for each mailbox independently. An internal 16-bit timer is used to stamp each received and sent message. This timer starts counting as soon as the CAN controller is enabled. This counter can be reset by the application or automatically after a reception in the last mailbox in Time Triggered Mode. The CAN controller offers optimized features to support the Time Triggered Communication (TTC) protocol. 549 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 38.2 Block Diagram Figure 38-1. CAN Block Diagram Controller Area Network CANRX CAN Protocol Controller PIO CANTX Error Counter Mailbox Priority Encoder Control & Status MB0 MB1 MCK PMC MBx (x = number of mailboxes - 1) CAN Interrupt User Interface Internal Bus 550 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.3 Application Block Diagram Figure 38-2. 38.4 Application Block Diagram Layers Implementation CAN-based Profiles Software CAN-based Application Layer Software CAN Data Link Layer CAN Controller CAN Physical Layer Transceiver I/O Lines Description Table 38-1. I/O Lines Description Name Description Type CANRX CAN Receive Serial Data Input CANTX CAN Transmit Serial Data Output 38.5 38.5.1 Product Dependencies I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the CAN may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired CAN pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the CAN are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller. 38.5.2 Power Management The programmer must first enable the CAN clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the CAN. A Low-power Mode is defined for the CAN controller: If the application does not require CAN operations, the CAN clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. Before stopping the clock, the CAN Controller must be in Low-power Mode to complete the current transfer. After restarting the clock, the application must disable the Low-power Mode of the CAN controller. 38.5.3 Interrupt The CAN interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the CAN interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not recommended to use the CAN interrupt line in edge-sensitive mode. 551 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.6 CAN Controller Features 38.6.1 CAN Protocol Overview The Controller Area Network (CAN) is a multi-master serial communication protocol that efficiently supports real-time control with a very high level of security with bit rates up to 1 Mbit/s. The CAN protocol supports four different frame types: • Data frames: They carry data from a transmitter node to the receiver nodes. The overall maximum data frame length is 108 bits for a standard frame and 128 bits for an extended frame. • Remote frames: A destination node can request data from the source by sending a remote frame with an identifier that matches the identifier of the required data frame. The appropriate data source node then sends a data frame as a response to this node request. • Error frames: An error frame is generated by any node that detects a bus error. • Overload frames: They provide an extra delay between the preceding and the successive data frames or remote frames. The Atmel CAN controller provides the CPU with full functionality of the CAN protocol V2.0 Part A and V2.0 Part B. It minimizes the CPU load in communication overhead. The Data Link Layer and part of the physical layer are automatically handled by the CAN controller itself. The CPU reads or writes data or messages via the CAN controller mailboxes. An identifier is assigned to each mailbox. The CAN controller encapsulates or decodes data messages to build or to decode bus data frames. Remote frames, error frames and overload frames are automatically handled by the CAN controller under supervision of the software application. 38.6.2 Mailbox Organization The CAN module has 8 buffers, also called channels or mailboxes. An identifier that corresponds to the CAN identifier is defined for each active mailbox. Message identifiers can match the standard frame identifier or the extended frame identifier. This identifier is defined for the first time during the CAN initialization, but can be dynamically reconfigured later so that the mailbox can handle a new message family. Several mailboxes can be configured with the same ID. Each mailbox can be configured in receive or in transmit mode independently. The mailbox object type is defined in the MOT field of the CAN_MMRx register. 38.6.2.1 Message Acceptance Procedure If the MIDE field in the CAN_MIDx register is set, the mailbox can handle the extended format identifier; otherwise, the mailbox handles the standard format identifier. Once a new message is received, its ID is masked with the CAN_MAMx value and compared with the CAN_MIDx value. If accepted, the message ID is copied to the CAN_MIDx register. 552 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-3. Message Acceptance Procedure CAN_MAMx CAN_MIDx & Message Received & == No Message Refused Yes Message Accepted CAN_MFIDx If a mailbox is dedicated to receiving several messages (a family of messages) with different IDs, the acceptance mask defined in the CAN_MAMx register must mask the variable part of the ID family. Once a message is received, the application must decode the masked bits in the CAN_MIDx. To speed up the decoding, masked bits are grouped in the family ID register (CAN_MFIDx). For example, if the following message IDs are handled by the same mailbox: ID0 101000100100010010000100 0 11 00b ID1 101000100100010010000100 0 11 01b ID2 101000100100010010000100 0 11 10b ID3 101000100100010010000100 0 11 11b ID4 101000100100010010000100 1 11 00b ID5 101000100100010010000100 1 11 01b ID6 101000100100010010000100 1 11 10b ID7 101000100100010010000100 1 11 11b The CAN_MIDx and CAN_MAMx of Mailbox x must be initialized to the corresponding values: CAN_MIDx = 001 101000100100010010000100 x 11 xxb CAN_MAMx = 001 111111111111111111111111 0 11 00b If Mailbox x receives a message with ID6, then CAN_MIDx and CAN_MFIDx are set: CAN_MIDx = 001 101000100100010010000100 1 11 10b CAN_MFIDx = 00000000000000000000000000000110b If the application associates a handler for each message ID, it may define an array of pointers to functions: void (*pHandler[8])(void); When a message is received, the corresponding handler can be invoked using CAN_MFIDx register and there is no need to check masked bits: unsigned int MFID0_register; MFID0_register = Get_CAN_MFID0_Register(); // Get_CAN_MFID0_Register() returns the value of the CAN_MFID0 register pHandler[MFID0_register](); 553 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.6.2.2 Receive Mailbox When the CAN module receives a message, it looks for the first available mailbox with the lowest number and compares the received message ID with the mailbox ID. If such a mailbox is found, then the message is stored in its data registers. Depending on the configuration, the mailbox is disabled as long as the message has not been acknowledged by the application (Receive only), or, if new messages with the same ID are received, then they overwrite the previous ones (Receive with overwrite). It is also possible to configure a mailbox in Consumer Mode. In this mode, after each transfer request, a remote frame is automatically sent. The first answer received is stored in the corresponding mailbox data registers. Several mailboxes can be chained to receive a buffer. They must be configured with the same ID in Receive Mode, except for the last one, which can be configured in Receive with Overwrite Mode. The last mailbox can be used to detect a buffer overflow. Mailbox Object Type The first message received is stored in mailbox data registers. Data remain available until the next transfer request. Receive Receive with overwrite The last message received is stored in mailbox data register. The next message always overwrites the previous one. The application has to check whether a new message has not overwritten the current one while reading the data registers. A remote frame is sent by the mailbox. The answer received is stored in mailbox data register. This extends Receive mailbox features. Data remain available until the next transfer request. Consumer 38.6.2.3 Description Transmit Mailbox When transmitting a message, the message length and data are written to the transmit mailbox with the correct identifier. For each transmit mailbox, a priority is assigned. The controller automatically sends the message with the highest priority first (set with the field PRIOR in CAN_MMRx register). It is also possible to configure a mailbox in Producer Mode. In this mode, when a remote frame is received, the mailbox data are sent automatically. By enabling this mode, a producer can be done using only one mailbox instead of two: one to detect the remote frame and one to send the answer. Mailbox Object Type Description Transmit The message stored in the mailbox data registers will try to win the bus arbitration immediately or later according to or not the Time Management Unit configuration (see Section 38.6.3). The application is notified that the message has been sent or aborted. Producer The message prepared in the mailbox data registers will be sent after receiving the next remote frame. This extends transmit mailbox features. 554 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.6.3 Time Management Unit The CAN Controller integrates a free-running 16-bit internal timer. The counter is driven by the bit clock of the CAN bus line. It is enabled when the CAN controller is enabled (CANEN set in the CAN_MR register). It is automatically cleared in the following cases: • after a reset • when the CAN controller is in Low-power Mode is enabled (LPM bit set in the CAN_MR and SLEEP bit set in the CAN_SR) • after a reset of the CAN controller (CANEN bit in the CAN_MR register) • in Time-triggered Mode, when a message is accepted by the last mailbox (rising edge of the MRDY signal in the CAN_MSRlast_mailbox_number register). The application can also reset the internal timer by setting TIMRST in the CAN_TCR register. The current value of the internal timer is always accessible by reading the CAN_TIM register. When the timer rolls-over from FFFFh to 0000h, TOVF (Timer Overflow) signal in the CAN_SR register is set. TOVF bit in the CAN_SR register is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register. Depending on the corresponding interrupt mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated while TOVF is set. In a CAN network, some CAN devices may have a larger counter. In this case, the application can also decide to freeze the internal counter when the timer reaches FFFFh and to wait for a restart condition from another device. This feature is enabled by setting TIMFRZ in the CAN_MR register. The CAN_TIM register is frozen to the FFFFh value. A clear condition described above restarts the timer. A timer overflow (TOVF) interrupt is triggered. To monitor the CAN bus activity, the CAN_TIM register is copied to the CAN _TIMESTP register after each start of frame or end of frame and a TSTP interrupt is triggered. If TEOF bit in the CAN_MR register is set, the value is captured at each End Of Frame, else it is captured at each Start Of Frame. Depending on the corresponding mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated while TSTP is set in the CAN_SR. TSTP bit is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register. The time management unit can operate in one of the two following modes: • Timestamping mode: The value of the internal timer is captured at each Start Of Frame or each End Of Frame • Time Triggered mode: A mailbox transfer operation is triggered when the internal timer reaches the mailbox trigger. Timestamping Mode is enabled by clearing TTM field in the CAN_MR register. Time Triggered Mode is enabled by setting TTM field in the CAN_MR register. 555 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.6.4 38.6.4.1 CAN 2.0 Standard Features CAN Bit Timing Configuration All controllers on a CAN bus must have the same bit rate and bit length. At different clock frequencies of the individual controllers, the bit rate has to be adjusted by the time segments. The CAN protocol specification partitions the nominal bit time into four different segments: Figure 38-4. Partition of the CAN Bit Time NOMINAL BIT TIME SYNC_SEG PROP_SEG PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2 Sample Point • TIME QUANTUM The TIME QUANTUM (TQ) is a fixed unit of time derived from the MCK period. The total number of TIME QUANTA in a bit time is programmable from 8 to 25. SYNC SEG: SYNChronization Segment. This part of the bit time is used to synchronize the various nodes on the bus. An edge is expected to lie within this segment. It is 1 TQ long. • PROP SEG: PROPagation Segment. This part of the bit time is used to compensate for the physical delay times within the network. It is twice the sum of the signal’s propagation time on the bus line, the input comparator delay, and the output driver delay. It is programmable to be 1,2,..., 8 TQ long. This parameter is defined in the PROPAG field of the ”CAN Baudrate Register”. • PHASE SEG1, PHASE SEG2: PHASE Segment 1 and 2. The Phase-Buffer-Segments are used to compensate for edge phase errors. These segments can be lengthened (PHASE SEG1) or shortened (PHASE SEG2) by resynchronization. Phase Segment 1 is programmable to be 1,2,..., 8 TQ long. Phase Segment 2 length has to be at least as long as the Information Processing Time (IPT) and may not be more than the length of Phase Segment 1. These parameters are defined in the PHASE1 and PHASE2 fields of the ”CAN Baudrate Register”. • INFORMATION PROCESSING TIME: The Information Processing Time (IPT) is the time required for the logic to determine the bit level of a sampled bit. The IPT begins at the sample point, is measured in TQ and is fixed at 2 TQ for the Atmel CAN. Since Phase Segment 2 also begins at the sample point and is the last segment in the bit time, PHASE SEG2 shall not be less than the IPT. • SAMPLE POINT: 556 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The SAMPLE POINT is the point in time at which the bus level is read and interpreted as the value of that respective bit. Its location is at the end of PHASE_SEG1. • SJW: ReSynchronization Jump Width. The ReSynchronization Jump Width defines the limit to the amount of lengthening or shortening of the Phase Segments. SJW is programmable to be the minimum of PHASE SEG1 and 4 TQ. If the SMP field in the CAN_BR register is set, then the incoming bit stream is sampled three times with a period of half a CAN clock period, centered on sample point. In the CAN controller, the length of a bit on the CAN bus is determined by the parameters (BRP, PROPAG, PHASE1 and PHASE2). t BIT = t CSC + t PRS + t PHS1 + t PHS2 The time quantum is calculated as follows: t CSC = ( BRP + 1 ) ⁄ MCK Note: The BRP field must be within the range [1, 0x7F], i.e., BRP = 0 is not authorized. t PRS = t CSC × ( PROPAG + 1 ) t PHS1 = t CSC × ( PHASE1 + 1 ) t PHS2 = t CSC × ( PHASE2 + 1 ) To compensate for phase shifts between clock oscillators of different controllers on the bus, the CAN controller must resynchronize on any relevant signal edge of the current transmission. The resynchronization shortens or lengthens the bit time so that the position of the sample point is shifted with regard to the detected edge. The resynchronization jump width (SJW) defines the maximum of time by which a bit period may be shortened or lengthened by resynchronization. t SJW = t CSC × ( SJW + 1 ) Figure 38-5. CAN Bit Timing MCK CAN Clock tCSC tPRS tPHS1 tPHS2 NOMINAL BIT TIME SYNC_ SEG PROP_SEG PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2 Sample Point Transmission Point Example of bit timing determination for CAN baudrate of 500 Kbit/s: MCK = 48MHz CAN baudrate= 500kbit/s => bit time= 2us 557 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Delay of the bus driver: 50 ns Delay of the receiver: 30ns Delay of the bus line (20m): 110ns The total number of time quanta in a bit time must be comprised between 8 and 25. If we fix the bit time to 16 time quanta: Tcsc = 1 time quanta = bit time / 16 = 125 ns => BRP = (Tcsc x MCK) - 1 = 5 The propagation segment time is equal to twice the sum of the signal’s propagation time on the bus line, the receiver delay and the output driver delay: Tprs = 2 * (50+30+110) ns = 380 ns = 3 Tcsc => PROPAG = Tprs/Tcsc - 1 = 2 The remaining time for the two phase segments is: Tphs1 + Tphs2 = bit time - Tcsc - Tprs = (16 - 1 - 3)Tcsc Tphs1 + Tphs2 = 12 Tcsc Because this number is even, we choose Tphs2 = Tphs1 (else we would choose Tphs2 = Tphs1 + Tcsc) Tphs1 = Tphs2 = (12/2) Tcsc = 6 Tcsc => PHASE1 = PHASE2 = Tphs1/Tcsc - 1 = 5 The resynchronization jump width must be comprised between 1 Tcsc and the minimum of 4 Tcsc and Tphs1. We choose its maximum value: Tsjw = Min(4 Tcsc,Tphs1) = 4 Tcsc => SJW = Tsjw/Tcsc - 1 = 3 Finally: CAN_BR = 0x00053255 38.6.4.2 CAN Bus Synchronization Two types of synchronization are distinguished: “hard synchronization” at the start of a frame and “resynchronization” inside a frame. After a hard synchronization, the bit time is restarted with the end of the SYNC_SEG segment, regardless of the phase error. Resynchronization causes a reduction or increase in the bit time so that the position of the sample point is shifted with respect to the detected edge. The effect of resynchronization is the same as that of hard synchronization when the magnitude of the phase error of the edge causing the resynchronization is less than or equal to the programmed value of the resynchronization jump width (tSJW). When the magnitude of the phase error is larger than the resynchronization jump width and • the phase error is positive, then PHASE_SEG1 is lengthened by an amount equal to the resynchronization jump width. • the phase error is negative, then PHASE_SEG2 is shortened by an amount equal to the resynchronization jump width. 558 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-6. CAN Resynchronization THE PHASE ERROR IS POSITIVE (the transmitter is slower than the receiver) Nominal Sample point Sample point after resynchronization Received data bit Nominal bit time (before resynchronization) SYNC_ SEG PROP_SEG PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2 Phase error (max Tsjw) Phase error Bit time with resynchronization SYNC_ SEG SYNC_ SEG PROP_SEG PHASE_SEG1 THE PHASE ERROR IS NEGATIVE (the transmitter is faster than the receiver) PHASE_SEG2 Sample point after resynchronization SYNC_ SEG Nominal Sample point Received data bit Nominal bit time (before resynchronization) PHASE_SEG2 SYNC_ SEG PROP_SEG PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2 SYNC_ SEG Phase error Bit time with resynchronization PHASE_ SYNC_ SEG2 SEG PROP_SEG PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2 SYNC_ SEG Phase error (max Tsjw) 38.6.4.3 Autobaud Mode The autobaud feature is enabled by setting the ABM field in the CAN_MR register. In this mode, the CAN controller is only listening to the line without acknowledging the received messages. It can not send any message. The errors flags are updated. The bit timing can be adjusted until no error occurs (good configuration found). In this mode, the error counters are frozen. To go back to the standard mode, the ABM bit must be cleared in the CAN_MR register. 38.6.4.4 Error Detection There are five different error types that are not mutually exclusive. Each error concerns only specific fields of the CAN data frame (refer to the Bosch CAN specification for their correspondence): • CRC error (CERR bit in the CAN_SR register): With the CRC, the transmitter calculates a checksum for the CRC bit sequence from the Start of Frame bit until the end of the Data Field. This CRC sequence is transmitted in the CRC field of the Data or Remote Frame. • Bit-stuffing error (SERR bit in the CAN_SR register): If a node detects a sixth consecutive equal bit level during the bit-stuffing area of a frame, it generates an Error Frame starting with the next bit-time. • Bit error (BERR bit in CAN_SR register): A bit error occurs if a transmitter sends a dominant bit but detects a recessive bit on the bus line, or if it sends a recessive bit but detects a dominant bit on the bus line. An error frame is generated and starts with the next bit time. • Form Error (FERR bit in the CAN_SR register): If a transmitter detects a dominant bit in one of the fix-formatted segments CRC Delimiter, ACK Delimiter or End of Frame, a form error has occurred and an error frame is generated. 559 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • Acknowledgment error (AERR bit in the CAN_SR register): The transmitter checks the Acknowledge Slot, which is transmitted by the transmitting node as a recessive bit, contains a dominant bit. If this is the case, at least one other node has received the frame correctly. If not, an Acknowledge Error has occurred and the transmitter will start in the next bit-time an Error Frame transmission. 38.6.4.5 Fault Confinement To distinguish between temporary and permanent failures, every CAN controller has two error counters: REC (Receive Error Counter) and TEC (Transmit Error Counter). The two counters are incremented upon detected errors and are decremented upon correct transmissions or receptions, respectively. Depending on the counter values, the state of the node changes: the initial state of the CAN controller is Error Active, meaning that the controller can send Error Active flags. The controller changes to the Error Passive state if there is an accumulation of errors. If the CAN controller fails or if there is an extreme accumulation of errors, there is a state transition to Bus Off. Figure 38-7. Line Error Mode Init TEC < 127 and REC < 127 ERROR PASSIVE ERROR ACTIVE TEC > 127 or REC > 127 128 occurences of 11 consecutive recessive bits or CAN controller reset BUS OFF TEC > 255 An error active unit takes part in bus communication and sends an active error frame when the CAN controller detects an error. An error passive unit cannot send an active error frame. It takes part in bus communication, but when an error is detected, a passive error frame is sent. Also, after a transmission, an error passive unit waits before initiating further transmission. A bus off unit is not allowed to have any influence on the bus. For fault confinement, two errors counters (TEC and REC) are implemented. These counters are accessible via the CAN_ECR register. The state of the CAN controller is automatically updated according to these counter values. If the CAN controller is in Error Active state, then the ERRA bit is set in the CAN_SR register. The corresponding interrupt is pending while the interrupt is not masked in the CAN_IMR register. If the CAN controller is in Error Passive Mode, then the ERRP bit is set in the CAN_SR register and an interrupt remains pending while the ERRP bit is set in the CAN_IMR register. If the CAN is in Bus Off Mode, then the BOFF bit is set in the CAN_SR register. As for ERRP and ERRA, an interrupt is pending while the BOFF bit is set in the CAN_IMR register. 560 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary When one of the error counters values exceeds 96, an increased error rate is indicated to the controller through the WARN bit in CAN_SR register, but the node remains error active. The corresponding interrupt is pending while the interrupt is set in the CAN_IMR register. Refer to the Bosch CAN specification v2.0 for details on fault confinement. 38.6.4.6 Error Interrupt Handler WARN, BOFF, ERRA and ERRP (CAN_SR) represent the current status of the CAN bus and are not latched. They reflect the current TEC and REC (CAN_ECR) values as described in Section 38.6.4.5 “Fault Confinement” on page 560. Based on that, if these bits are used as an interrupt, the user can enter into an interrupt and not see the corresponding status register if the TEC and REC counter have changed their state. When entering Bus Off Mode, the only way to exit from this state is 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits or a CAN controller reset. In Error Active Mode, the user reads: • ERRA =1 • ERRP = 0 • BOFF = 0 In Error Passive Mode, the user reads: • ERRA = 0 • ERRP =1 • BOFF = 0 In Bus Off Mode, the user reads: • ERRA = 0 • ERRP =1 • BOFF =1 The CAN interrupt handler should do the following: • Only enable one error mode interrupt at a time. • Look at and check the REC and TEC values in the interrupt handler to determine the current state. 38.6.4.7 Overload The overload frame is provided to request a delay of the next data or remote frame by the receiver node (“Request overload frame”) or to signal certain error conditions (“Reactive overload frame”) related to the intermission field respectively. Reactive overload frames are transmitted after detection of the following error conditions: • Detection of a dominant bit during the first two bits of the intermission field • Detection of a dominant bit in the last bit of EOF by a receiver, or detection of a dominant bit by a receiver or a transmitter at the last bit of an error or overload frame delimiter The CAN controller can generate a request overload frame automatically after each message sent to one of the CAN controller mailboxes. This feature is enabled by setting the OVL bit in the CAN_MR register. 561 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Reactive overload frames are automatically handled by the CAN controller even if the OVL bit in the CAN_MR register is not set. An overload flag is generated in the same way as an error flag, but error counters do not increment. 38.6.5 Low-power Mode In Low-power Mode, the CAN controller cannot send or receive messages. All mailboxes are inactive. In Low-power Mode, the SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is set; otherwise, the WAKEUP signal in the CAN_SR register is set. These two fields are exclusive except after a CAN controller reset (WAKEUP and SLEEP are stuck at 0 after a reset). After power-up reset, the Lowpower Mode is disabled and the WAKEUP bit is set in the CAN_SR register only after detection of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the bus. 38.6.5.1 Enabling Low-power Mode A software application can enable Low-power Mode by setting the LPM bit in the CAN_MR global register. The CAN controller enters Low-power Mode once all pending transmit messages are sent. When the CAN controller enters Low-power Mode, the SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is set. Depending on the corresponding mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated while SLEEP is set. The SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is automatically cleared once WAKEUP is set. The WAKEUP signal is automatically cleared once SLEEP is set. Reception is disabled while the SLEEP signal is set to one in the CAN_SR register. It is important to note that those messages with higher priority than the last message transmitted can be received between the LPM command and entry in Low-power Mode. Once in Low-power Mode, the CAN controller clock can be switched off by programming the chip’s Power Management Controller (PMC). The CAN controller drains only the static current. Error counters are disabled while the SLEEP signal is set to one. Thus, to enter Low-power Mode, the software application must: – Set LPM field in the CAN_MR register – Wait for SLEEP signal rising Now the CAN Controller clock can be disabled. This is done by programming the Power Management Controller (PMC). 562 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-8. Enabling Low-power Mode Arbitration lost Mailbox 1 CAN BUS Mailbox 3 LPEN= 1 LPM (CAN_MR) SLEEP (CAN_SR) WAKEUP (CAN_SR) MRDY (CAN_MSR1) MRDY (CAN_MSR3) CAN_TIM 38.6.5.2 0x0 Disabling Low-power Mode The CAN controller can be awake after detecting a CAN bus activity. Bus activity detection is done by an external module that may be embedded in the chip. When it is notified of a CAN bus activity, the software application disables Low-power Mode by programming the CAN controller. To disable Low-power Mode, the software application must: – Enable the CAN Controller clock. This is done by programming the Power Management Controller (PMC). – Clear the LPM field in the CAN_MR register The CAN controller synchronizes itself with the bus activity by checking for eleven consecutive “recessive” bits. Once synchronized, the WAKEUP signal in the CAN_SR register is set. Depending on the corresponding mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated while WAKEUP is set. The SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is automatically cleared once WAKEUP is set. WAKEUP signal is automatically cleared once SLEEP is set. If no message is being sent on the bus, then the CAN controller is able to send a message eleven bit times after disabling Low-power Mode. If there is bus activity when Low-power mode is disabled, the CAN controller is synchronized with the bus activity in the next interframe. The previous message is lost (see Figure 38-9). 563 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-9. Disabling Low-power Mode Bus Activity Detected CAN BUS Message lost Message x Interframe synchronization LPM (CAN_MR) SLEEP (CAN_SR) WAKEUP (CAN_SR) MRDY (CAN_MSRx) 38.7 38.7.1 Functional Description CAN Controller Initialization After power-up reset, the CAN controller is disabled. The CAN controller clock must be activated by the Power Management Controller (PMC) and the CAN controller interrupt line must be enabled by the interrupt controller (AIC). The CAN controller must be initialized with the CAN network parameters. The CAN_BR register defines the sampling point in the bit time period. CAN_BR must be set before the CAN controller is enabled by setting the CANEN field in the CAN_MR register. The CAN controller is enabled by setting the CANEN flag in the CAN_MR register. At this stage, the internal CAN controller state machine is reset, error counters are reset to 0, error flags are reset to 0. Once the CAN controller is enabled, bus synchronization is done automatically by scanning eleven recessive bits. The WAKEUP bit in the CAN_SR register is automatically set to 1 when the CAN controller is synchronized (WAKEUP and SLEEP are stuck at 0 after a reset). The CAN controller can start listening to the network in Autobaud Mode. In this case, the error counters are locked and a mailbox may be configured in Receive Mode. By scanning error flags, the CAN_BR register values synchronized with the network. Once no error has been detected, the application disables the Autobaud Mode, clearing the ABM field in the CAN_MR register. 564 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-10. Possible Initialization Procedure Enable CAN Controller Clock (PMC) Enable CAN Controller Interrupt Line (AIC) Configure a Mailbox in Reception Mode Change CAN_BR value (ABM == 1 and CANEN == 1) Errors ? Yes (CAN_SR or CAN_MSRx) No ABM = 0 and CANEN = 0 CANEN = 1 (ABM == 0) End of Initialization 38.7.2 CAN Controller Interrupt Handling There are two different types of interrupts. One type of interrupt is a message-object related interrupt, the other is a system interrupt that handles errors or system-related interrupt sources. All interrupt sources can be masked by writing the corresponding field in the CAN_IDR register. They can be unmasked by writing to the CAN_IER register. After a power-up reset, all interrupt sources are disabled (masked). The current mask status can be checked by reading the CAN_IMR register. The CAN_SR register gives all interrupt source states. The following events may initiate one of the two interrupts: • Message object interrupt – Data registers in the mailbox object are available to the application. In Receive Mode, a new message was received. In Transmit Mode, a message was transmitted successfully. – A sent transmission was aborted. • System interrupts – Bus off interrupt: The CAN module enters the bus off state. – Error passive interrupt: The CAN module enters Error Passive Mode. – Error Active Mode: The CAN module is neither in Error Passive Mode nor in Bus Off mode. 565 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary – Warn Limit interrupt: The CAN module is in Error-active Mode, but at least one of its error counter value exceeds 96. – Wake-up interrupt: This interrupt is generated after a wake-up and a bus synchronization. – Sleep interrupt: This interrupt is generated after a Low-power Mode enable once all pending messages in transmission have been sent. – Internal timer counter overflow interrupt: This interrupt is generated when the internal timer rolls over. – Timestamp interrupt: This interrupt is generated after the reception or the transmission of a start of frame or an end of frame. The value of the internal counter is copied in the CAN_TIMESTP register. All interrupts are cleared by clearing the interrupt source except for the internal timer counter overflow interrupt and the timestamp interrupt. These interrupts are cleared by reading the CAN_SR register. 566 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.7.3 CAN Controller Message Handling 38.7.3.1 Receive Handling Two modes are available to configure a mailbox to receive messages. In Receive Mode, the first message received is stored in the mailbox data register. In Receive with Overwrite Mode, the last message received is stored in the mailbox. 38.7.3.2 Simple Receive Mailbox A mailbox is in Receive Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance Mask must be set before the Receive Mode is enabled. After Receive Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically cleared until the first message is received. When the first message has been accepted by the mailbox, the MRDY flag is set. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be masked depending on the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register. Message data are stored in the mailbox data register until the software application notifies that data processing has ended. This is done by asking for a new transfer command, setting the MTCR flag in the CAN_MCRx register. This automatically clears the MRDY signal. The MMI flag in the CAN_MSRx register notifies the software that a message has been lost by the mailbox. This flag is set when messages are received while MRDY is set in the CAN_MSRx register. This flag is cleared by reading the CAN_MSRs register. A receive mailbox prevents from overwriting the first message by new ones while MRDY flag is set in the CAN_MSRx register. See Figure 38-11. Figure 38-11. Receive Mailbox Message ID = CAN_MIDx CAN BUS Message 1 Message 2 lost Message 3 MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MMI (CAN_MSRx) (CAN_MDLx CAN_MDHx) Message 1 Message 3 MTCR (CAN_MCRx) Reading CAN_MSRx Reading CAN_MDHx & CAN_MDLx Writing CAN_MCRx Note: In the case of ARM architecture, CAN_MSRx, CAN_MDLx, CAN_MDHx can be read using an optimized ldm assembler instruction. 567 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.7.3.3 Receive with Overwrite Mailbox A mailbox is in Receive with Overwrite Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance masks must be set before Receive Mode is enabled. After Receive Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically cleared until the first message is received. When the first message has been accepted by the mailbox, the MRDY flag is set. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt is masked depending on the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register. If a new message is received while the MRDY flag is set, this new message is stored in the mailbox data register, overwriting the previous message. The MMI flag in the CAN_MSRx register notifies the software that a message has been dropped by the mailbox. This flag is cleared when reading the CAN_MSRx register. The CAN controller may store a new message in the CAN data registers while the application reads them. To check that CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx do not belong to different messages, the application must check the MMI field in the CAN_MSRx register before and after reading CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx. If the MMI flag is set again after the data registers have been read, the software application has to re-read CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx (see Figure 38-12). Figure 38-12. Receive with Overwrite Mailbox Message ID = CAN_MIDx CAN BUS Message 1 Message 2 Message 3 Message 4 MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MMI (CAN_MSRx) (CAN_MDLx CAN_MDHx) Message 1 Message 2 Message 3 Message 4 MTCR (CAN_MCRx) Reading CAN_MSRx Reading CAN_MDHx & CAN_MDLx Writing CAN_MCRx 38.7.3.4 Chaining Mailboxes Several mailboxes may be used to receive a buffer split into several messages with the same ID. In this case, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced first. In the receive and receive with overwrite modes, the field PRIOR in the CAN_MMRx register has no effect. If Mailbox 0 and Mailbox 5 accept messages with the same ID, the first message is received by Mailbox 0 and the second message is received by Mailbox 5. Mailbox 0 must be configured in Receive Mode (i.e., the first message received is considered) and Mailbox 5 must be configured in Receive with Overwrite Mode. Mailbox 0 cannot be configured in Receive with Overwrite Mode; otherwise, all messages are accepted by this mailbox and Mailbox 5 is never serviced. 568 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary If several mailboxes are chained to receive a buffer split into several messages, all mailboxes except the last one (with the highest number) must be configured in Receive Mode. The first message received is handled by the first mailbox, the second one is refused by the first mailbox and accepted by the second mailbox, the last message is accepted by the last mailbox and refused by previous ones (see Figure 38-13). Figure 38-13. Chaining Three Mailboxes to Receive a Buffer Split into Three Messages Buffer split in 3 messages CAN BUS Message s1 Message s2 Message s3 MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MMI (CAN_MSRx) MRDY (CAN_MSRy) MMI (CAN_MSRy) MRDY (CAN_MSRz) MMI (CAN_MSRz) Reading CAN_MSRx, CAN_MSRy and CAN_MSRz Reading CAN_MDH & CAN_MDL for mailboxes x, y and z Writing MBx MBy MBz in CAN_TCR If the number of mailboxes is not sufficient (the MMI flag of the last mailbox raises), the user must read each data received on the last mailbox in order to retrieve all the messages of the buffer split (see Figure 38-14). 569 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-14. Chaining Three Mailboxes to Receive a Buffer Split into Four Messages Buffer split in 4 messages CAN BUS Message s1 Message s2 Message s3 Message s4 MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MMI (CAN_MSRx) MRDY (CAN_MSRy) MMI (CAN_MSRy) MRDY (CAN_MSRz) MMI (CAN_MSRz) Reading CAN_MSRx, CAN_MSRy and CAN_MSRz Reading CAN_MDH & CAN_MDL for mailboxes x, y and z Writing MBx MBy MBz in CAN_TCR 38.7.3.5 Transmission Handling A mailbox is in Transmit Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance mask must be set before Receive Mode is enabled. After Transmit Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically set until the first command is sent. When the MRDY flag is set, the software application can prepare a message to be sent by writing to the CAN_MDx registers. The message is sent once the software asks for a transfer command setting the MTCR bit and the message data length in the CAN_MCRx register. The MRDY flag remains at zero as long as the message has not been sent or aborted. It is important to note that no access to the mailbox data register is allowed while the MRDY flag is cleared. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be masked depending on the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register. It is also possible to send a remote frame setting the MRTR bit instead of setting the MDLC field. The answer to the remote frame is handled by another reception mailbox. In this case, the device acts as a consumer but with the help of two mailboxes. It is possible to handle the remote frame emission and the answer reception using only one mailbox configured in Consumer Mode. Refer to the section “Remote Frame Handling” on page 571. Several messages can try to win the bus arbitration in the same time. The message with the highest priority is sent first. Several transfer request commands can be generated at the same time by setting MBx bits in the CAN_TCR register. The priority is set in the PRIOR field of the CAN_MMRx register. Priority 0 is the highest priority, priority 15 is the lowest priority. Thus it is possible to use a part of the message ID to set the PRIOR field. If two mailboxes have the same priority, the message of the mailbox with the lowest number is sent first. Thus if mailbox 0 and 570 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary mailbox 5 have the same priority and have a message to send at the same time, then the message of the mailbox 0 is sent first. Setting the MACR bit in the CAN_MCRx register aborts the transmission. Transmission for several mailboxes can be aborted by writing MBx fields in the CAN_MACR register. If the message is being sent when the abort command is set, then the application is notified by the MRDY bit set and not the MABT in the CAN_MSRx register. Otherwise, if the message has not been sent, then the MRDY and the MABT are set in the CAN_MSR register. When the bus arbitration is lost by a mailbox message, the CAN controller tries to win the next bus arbitration with the same message if this one still has the highest priority. Messages to be sent are re-tried automatically until they win the bus arbitration. This feature can be disabled by setting the bit DRPT in the CAN_MR register. In this case if the message was not sent the first time it was transmitted to the CAN transceiver, it is automatically aborted. The MABT flag is set in the CAN_MSRx register until the next transfer command. Figure 38-15 shows three MBx message attempts being made (MRDY of MBx set to 0). The first MBx message is sent, the second is aborted and the last one is trying to be aborted but too late because it has already been transmitted to the CAN transceiver. Figure 38-15. Transmitting Messages CAN BUS MBx message MBx message MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MABT (CAN_MSRx) MTCR (CAN_MCRx) MACR (CAN_MCRx) Abort MBx message Try to Abort MBx message Reading CAN_MSRx Writing CAN_MDHx & CAN_MDLx 38.7.3.6 Remote Frame Handling Producer/consumer model is an efficient means of handling broadcasted messages. The push model allows a producer to broadcast messages; the pull model allows a customer to ask for messages. 571 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-16. Producer / Consumer Model Producer Request PUSH MODEL CAN Data Frame Consumer Indication(s) PULL MODEL Producer Indications Response Consumer CAN Remote Frame Request(s) CAN Data Frame Confirmation(s) In Pull Mode, a consumer transmits a remote frame to the producer. When the producer receives a remote frame, it sends the answer accepted by one or many consumers. Using transmit and receive mailboxes, a consumer must dedicate two mailboxes, one in Transmit Mode to send remote frames, and at least one in Receive Mode to capture the producer’s answer. The same structure is applicable to a producer: one reception mailbox is required to get the remote frame and one transmit mailbox to answer. Mailboxes can be configured in Producer or Consumer Mode. A lonely mailbox can handle the remote frame and the answer. With 8 mailboxes, the CAN controller can handle 8 independent producers/consumers. 38.7.3.7 Producer Configuration A mailbox is in Producer Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance masks must be set before Receive Mode is enabled. After Producer Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically set until the first transfer command. The software application prepares data to be sent by writing to the CAN_MDHx and the CAN_MDLx registers, then by setting the MTCR bit in the CAN_MCRx register. Data is sent after the reception of a remote frame as soon as it wins the bus arbitration. The MRDY flag remains at zero as long as the message has not been sent or aborted. No access to the mailbox data register can be done while MRDY flag is cleared. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be masked according to the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register. If a remote frame is received while no data are ready to be sent (signal MRDY set in the CAN_MSRx register), then the MMI signal is set in the CAN_MSRx register. This bit is cleared by reading the CAN_MSRx register. The MRTR field in the CAN_MSRx register has no meaning. This field is used only when using Receive and Receive with Overwrite modes. 572 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary After a remote frame has been received, the mailbox functions like a transmit mailbox. The message with the highest priority is sent first. The transmitted message may be aborted by setting the MACR bit in the CAN_MCR register. Please refer to the section “Transmission Handling” on page 570. Figure 38-17. Producer Handling Remote Frame CAN BUS Message 1 Remote Frame Remote Frame Message 2 MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MMI (CAN_MSRx) Reading CAN_MSRx MTCR (CAN_MCRx) (CAN_MDLx CAN_MDHx) 38.7.3.8 Message 1 Message 2 Consumer Configuration A mailbox is in Consumer Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance masks must be set before Receive Mode is enabled. After Consumer Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically cleared until the first transfer request command. The software application sends a remote frame by setting the MTCR bit in the CAN_MCRx register or the MBx bit in the global CAN_TCR register. The application is notified of the answer by the MRDY flag set in the CAN_MSRx register. The application can read the data contents in the CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx registers. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be masked according to the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register. The MRTR bit in the CAN_MCRx register has no effect. This field is used only when using Transmit Mode. After a remote frame has been sent, the consumer mailbox functions as a reception mailbox. The first message received is stored in the mailbox data registers. If other messages intended for this mailbox have been sent while the MRDY flag is set in the CAN_MSRx register, they will be lost. The application is notified by reading the MMI field in the CAN_MSRx register. The read operation automatically clears the MMI flag. If several messages are answered by the Producer, the CAN controller may have one mailbox in consumer configuration, zero or several mailboxes in Receive Mode and one mailbox in Receive with Overwrite Mode. In this case, the consumer mailbox must have a lower number than the Receive with Overwrite mailbox. The transfer command can be triggered for all mailboxes at the same time by setting several MBx fields in the CAN_TCR register. 573 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 38-18. Consumer Handling Remote Frame CAN BUS Message x Remote Frame Message y MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MMI (CAN_MSRx) MTCR (CAN_MCRx) (CAN_MDLx CAN_MDHx) 38.7.4 Message y Message x CAN Controller Timing Modes Using the free running 16-bit internal timer, the CAN controller can be set in one of the two following timing modes: • Timestamping Mode: The value of the internal timer is captured at each Start Of Frame or each End Of Frame. • Time Triggered Mode: The mailbox transfer operation is triggered when the internal timer reaches the mailbox trigger. Timestamping Mode is enabled by clearing the TTM bit in the CAN_MR register. Time Triggered Mode is enabled by setting the TTM bit in the CAN_MR register. 38.7.4.1 Timestamping Mode Each mailbox has its own timestamp value. Each time a message is sent or received by a mailbox, the 16-bit value MTIMESTAMP of the CAN_TIMESTP register is transferred to the LSB bits of the CAN_MSRx register. The value read in the CAN_MSRx register corresponds to the internal timer value at the Start Of Frame or the End Of Frame of the message handled by the mailbox. Figure 38-19. Mailbox Timestamp Start of Frame CAN BUS Message 1 End of Frame Message 2 CAN_TIM TEOF (CAN_MR) TIMESTAMP (CAN_TSTP) Timestamp 1 MTIMESTAMP (CAN_MSRx) Timestamp 1 MTIMESTAMP (CAN_MSRy) Timestamp 2 Timestamp 2 574 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.7.4.2 Time Triggered Mode In Time Triggered Mode, basic cycles can be split into several time windows. A basic cycle starts with a reference message. Each time a window is defined from the reference message, a transmit operation should occur within a pre-defined time window. A mailbox must not win the arbitration in a previous time window, and it must not be retried if the arbitration is lost in the time window. Figure 38-20. Time Triggered Principle Time Cycle Reference Message Reference Message Time Windows for Messages Global Time Time Trigger Mode is enabled by setting the TTM field in the CAN_MR register. In Time Triggered Mode, as in Timestamp Mode, the CAN_TIMESTP field captures the values of the internal counter, but the MTIMESTAMP fields in the CAN_MSRx registers are not active and are read at 0. 38.7.4.3 Synchronization by a Reference Message In Time Triggered Mode, the internal timer counter is automatically reset when a new message is received in the last mailbox. This reset occurs after the reception of the End Of Frame on the rising edge of the MRDY signal in the CAN_MSRx register. This allows synchronization of the internal timer counter with the reception of a reference message and the start a new time window. 38.7.4.4 Transmitting within a Time Window A time mark is defined for each mailbox. It is defined in the 16-bit MTIMEMARK field of the CAN_MMRx register. At each internal timer clock cycle, the value of the CAN_TIM is compared with each mailbox time mark. When the internal timer counter reaches the MTIMEMARK value, an internal timer event for the mailbox is generated for the mailbox. In Time Triggered Mode, transmit operations are delayed until the internal timer event for the mailbox. The application prepares a message to be sent by setting the MTCR in the CAN_MCRx register. The message is not sent until the CAN_TIM value is less than the MTIMEMARK value defined in the CAN_MMRx register. If the transmit operation is failed, i.e., the message loses the bus arbitration and the next transmit attempt is delayed until the next internal time trigger event. This prevents overlapping the next time window, but the message is still pending and is retried in the next time window when CAN_TIM value equals the MTIMEMARK value. It is also possible to prevent a retry by setting the DRPT field in the CAN_MR register. 38.7.4.5 Freezing the Internal Timer Counter The internal counter can be frozen by setting TIMFRZ in the CAN_MR register. This prevents an unexpected roll-over when the counter reaches FFFFh. When this occurs, it automatically freezes until a new reset is issued, either due to a message received in the last mailbox or any other reset counter operations. The TOVF bit in the CAN_SR register is set when the counter is 575 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary frozen. The TOVF bit in the CAN_SR register is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register. Depending on the corresponding interrupt mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated when TOVF is set. Figure 38-21. Time Triggered Operations Message x Arbitration Lost End of Frame CAN BUS Reference Message Message y Arbitration Win Message y Internal Counter Reset CAN_TIM Cleared by software MRDY (CAN_MSRlast_mailbox_number) Timer Event x MTIMEMARKx == CAN_TIM MRDY (CAN_MSRx) MTIMEMARKy == CAN_TIM Timer Event y MRDY (CAN_MSRy) Time Window Basic Cycle Message x Arbitration Win End of Frame CAN BUS Reference Message Message x Internal Counter Reset CAN_TIM Cleared by software MRDY (CAN_MSRlast_mailbox_number) Timer Event x MTIMEMARKx == CAN_TIM MRDY (CAN_MSRx) Time Window Basic Cycle 576 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8 Controller Area Network (CAN) User Interface Table 38-2. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x0000 Mode Register CAN_MR Read-write 0x0 0x0004 Interrupt Enable Register CAN_IER Write-only - 0x0008 Interrupt Disable Register CAN_IDR Write-only - 0x000C Interrupt Mask Register CAN_IMR Read-only 0x0 0x0010 Status Register CAN_SR Read-only 0x0 0x0014 Baudrate Register CAN_BR Read-write 0x0 0x0018 Timer Register CAN_TIM Read-only 0x0 0x001C Timestamp Register CAN_TIMESTP Read-only 0x0 0x0020 Error Counter Register CAN_ECR Read-only 0x0 0x0024 Transfer Command Register CAN_TCR Write-only - 0x0028 Abort Command Register CAN_ACR Write-only - – – – 0x0100 - 0x01FC Reserved 0x0200 Mailbox 0 Mode Register CAN_MMR0 Read-write 0x0 0x0204 Mailbox 0 Acceptance Mask Register CAN_MAM0 Read-write 0x0 0x0208 Mailbox 0 ID Register CAN_MID0 Read-write 0x0 0x020C Mailbox 0 Family ID Register CAN_MFID0 Read-only 0x0 0x0210 Mailbox 0 Status Register CAN_MSR0 Read-only 0x0 0x0214 Mailbox 0 Data Low Register CAN_MDL0 Read-write 0x0 0x0218 Mailbox 0 Data High Register CAN_MDH0 Read-write 0x0 0x021C Mailbox 0 Control Register CAN_MCR0 Write-only - 0x0220 Mailbox 1 Mode Register CAN_MMR1 Read-write 0x0 0x0224 Mailbox 1 Acceptance Mask Register CAN_MAM1 Read-write 0x0 0x0228 Mailbox 1 ID register CAN_MID1 Read-write 0x0 0x022C Mailbox 1 Family ID Register CAN_MFID1 Read-only 0x0 0x0230 Mailbox 1 Status Register CAN_MSR1 Read-only 0x0 0x0234 Mailbox 1 Data Low Register CAN_MDL1 Read-write 0x0 0x0238 Mailbox 1 Data High Register CAN_MDH1 Read-write 0x0 0x023C Mailbox 1 Control Register CAN_MCR1 Write-only - ... ... - ... ... 577 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.1 Name: CAN Mode Register CAN_MR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 25 RXSYNC 24 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 DRPT 6 TIMFRZ 5 TTM 4 TEOF 3 OVL 2 ABM 1 LPM 0 CANEN • CANEN: CAN Controller Enable 0 = The CAN Controller is disabled. 1 = The CAN Controller is enabled. • LPM: Disable/Enable Low Power Mode w Power Mode. 1 = Enable Low Power M CAN controller enters Low Power Mode once all pending messages have been transmitted. • ABM: Disable/Enable Autobaud/Listen mode 0 = Disable Autobaud/listen mode. 1 = Enable Autobaud/listen mode. • OVL: Disable/Enable Overload Frame 0 = No overload frame is generated. 1 = An overload frame is generated after each successful reception for mailboxes configured in Receive with/without overwrite Mode, Producer and Consumer. • TEOF: Timestamp messages at each end of Frame 0 = The value of CAN_TIM is captured in the CAN_TIMESTP register at each Start Of Frame. 1 = The value of CAN_TIM is captured in the CAN_TIMESTP register at each End Of Frame. • TTM: Disable/Enable Time Triggered Mode 0 = Time Triggered Mode is disabled. 1 = Time Triggered Mode is enabled. • TIMFRZ: Enable Timer Freeze 0 = The internal timer continues to be incremented after it reached 0xFFFF. 1 = The internal timer stops incrementing after reaching 0xFFFF. It is restarted after a timer reset. See “Freezing the Internal Timer Counter” on page 575. 578 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • DRPT: Disable Repeat 0 = When a transmit mailbox loses the bus arbitration, the transfer request remains pending. 1 = When a transmit mailbox lose the bus arbitration, the transfer request is automatically aborted. It automatically raises the MABT and MRDT flags in the corresponding CAN_MSRx. • RXSYNC: Reception Synchronization Stage (not readable) This field allows configuration of the reception stage of the macrocell (for debug purposes only) RXSYNC Reception Synchronization Stage 0 Rx Signal with Double Synchro Stages (2 Positive Edges) 1 Rx Signal with Double Synchro Stages (One Positive Edge and One Negative Edge) 2 Rx Signal with Single Synchro Stage (Positive Edge) others Rx Signal with No Synchro Stage 579 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.2 Name: CAN Interrupt Enable Register CAN_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 BERR 27 FERR 26 AERR 25 SERR 24 CERR 23 TSTP 22 TOVF 21 WAKEUP 20 SLEEP 19 BOFF 18 ERRP 17 WARN 16 ERRA 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 MB7 6 MB6 5 MB5 4 MB4 3 MB3 2 MB2 1 MB1 0 MB0 • MBx: Mailbox x Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable Mailbox x interrupt. • ERRA: Error Active Mode Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable ERRA interrupt. • WARN: Warning Limit Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable WARN interrupt. • ERRP: Error Passive Mode Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable ERRP interrupt. • BOFF: Bus Off Mode Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable BOFF interrupt. • SLEEP: Sleep Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable SLEEP interrupt. • WAKEUP: Wakeup Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable SLEEP interrupt. • TOVF: Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable TOVF interrupt. 580 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • TSTP: TimeStamp Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable TSTP interrupt. • CERR: CRC Error Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable CRC Error interrupt. • SERR: Stuffing Error Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable Stuffing Error interrupt. • AERR: Acknowledgment Error Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable Acknowledgment Error interrupt. • FERR: Form Error Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable Form Error interrupt. • BERR: Bit Error Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable Bit Error interrupt. 581 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.3 Name: CAN Interrupt Disable Register CAN_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 BERR 27 FERR 26 AERR 25 SERR 24 CERR 23 TSTP 22 TOVF 21 WAKEUP 20 SLEEP 19 BOFF 18 ERRP 17 WARN 16 ERRA 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 MB7 6 MB6 5 MB5 4 MB4 3 MB3 2 MB2 1 MB1 0 MB0 • MBx: Mailbox x Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable Mailbox x interrupt. • ERRA: Error Active Mode Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable ERRA interrupt. • WARN: Warning Limit Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable WARN interrupt. • ERRP: Error Passive Mode Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable ERRP interrupt. • BOFF: Bus Off Mode Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable BOFF interrupt. • SLEEP: Sleep Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable SLEEP interrupt. • WAKEUP: Wakeup Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable WAKEUP interrupt. • TOVF: Timer Overflow Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable TOVF interrupt. 582 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • TSTP: TimeStamp Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable TSTP interrupt. • CERR: CRC Error Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable CRC Error interrupt. • SERR: Stuffing Error Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable Stuffing Error interrupt. • AERR: Acknowledgment Error Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable Acknowledgment Error interrupt. • FERR: Form Error Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable Form Error interrupt. • BERR: Bit Error Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable Bit Error interrupt. 583 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.4 Name: CAN Interrupt Mask Register CAN_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 BERR 27 FERR 26 AERR 25 SERR 24 CERR 23 TSTP 22 TOVF 21 WAKEUP 20 SLEEP 19 BOFF 18 ERRP 17 WARN 16 ERRA 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 MB7 6 MB6 5 MB5 4 MB4 3 MB3 2 MB2 1 MB1 0 MB0 • MBx: Mailbox x Interrupt Mask 0 = Mailbox x interrupt is disabled. 1 = Mailbox x interrupt is enabled. • ERRA: Error Active Mode Interrupt Mask 0 = ERRA interrupt is disabled. 1 = ERRA interrupt is enabled. • WARN: Warning Limit Interrupt Mask 0 = Warning Limit interrupt is disabled. 1 = Warning Limit interrupt is enabled. • ERRP: Error Passive Mode Interrupt Mask 0 = ERRP interrupt is disabled. 1 = ERRP interrupt is enabled. • BOFF: Bus Off Mode Interrupt Mask 0 = BOFF interrupt is disabled. 1 = BOFF interrupt is enabled. • SLEEP: Sleep Interrupt Mask 0 = SLEEP interrupt is disabled. 1 = SLEEP interrupt is enabled. • WAKEUP: Wakeup Interrupt Mask 0 = WAKEUP interrupt is disabled. 1 = WAKEUP interrupt is enabled. • TOVF: Timer Overflow Interrupt Mask 0 = TOVF interrupt is disabled. 1 = TOVF interrupt is enabled. 584 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • TSTP: Timestamp Interrupt Mask 0 = TSTP interrupt is disabled. 1 = TSTP interrupt is enabled. • CERR: CRC Error Interrupt Mask 0 = CRC Error interrupt is disabled. 1 = CRC Error interrupt is enabled. • SERR: Stuffing Error Interrupt Mask 0 = Bit Stuffing Error interrupt is disabled. 1 = Bit Stuffing Error interrupt is enabled. • AERR: Acknowledgment Error Interrupt Mask 0 = Acknowledgment Error interrupt is disabled. 1 = Acknowledgment Error interrupt is enabled. • FERR: Form Error Interrupt Mask 0 = Form Error interrupt is disabled. 1 = Form Error interrupt is enabled. • BERR: Bit Error Interrupt Mask 0 = Bit Error interrupt is disabled. 1 = Bit Error interrupt is enabled. 585 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.5 Name: CAN Status Register CAN_SR Access Type: Read-only 31 OVLSY 30 TBSY 29 RBSY 28 BERR 27 FERR 26 AERR 25 SERR 24 CERR 23 TSTP 22 TOVF 21 WAKEUP 20 SLEEP 19 BOFF 18 ERRP 17 WARN 16 ERRA 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 MB7 6 MB6 5 MB5 4 MB4 3 MB3 2 MB2 1 MB1 0 MB0 • MBx: Mailbox x Event 0 = No event occurred on Mailbox x. 1 = An event occurred on Mailbox x. An event corresponds to MRDY, MABT fields in the CAN_MSRx register. • ERRA: Error Active Mode 0 = CAN controller is not in Error Active Mode. 1 = CAN controller is in Error Active Mode. This flag is set depending on TEC and REC counter values. It is set when node is neither in Error Passive Mode nor in Bus Off Mode. This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on page 561 for more information. • WARN: Warning Limit 0 = CAN controller Warning Limit is not reached. 1 = CAN controller Warning Limit is reached. This flag is set depending on TEC and REC counter values. It is set when at least one of the counter values exceeds 96. This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on page 561 for more information. • ERRP: Error Passive Mode 0 = CAN controller is not in Error Passive Mode. 1 = CAN controller is in Error Passive Mode. This flag is set depending on TEC and REC counters values. A node is error passive when TEC counter is greater or equal to 128 (decimal) or when the REC counter is greater or equal to 128 (decimal). This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on page 561 for more information. 586 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • BOFF: Bus Off Mode 0 = CAN controller is not in Bus Off Mode. 1 = CAN controller is in Bus Off Mode. This flag is set depending on TEC counter value. A node is bus off when TEC counter is greater or equal to 256 (decimal). This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on page 561 for more information. • SLEEP: CAN controller in Low power Mode 0 = CAN controller is not in low power mode. 1 = CAN controller is in low power mode. This flag is automatically reset when Low power mode is disabled • WAKEUP: CAN controller is not in Low power Mode 0 = CAN controller is in low power mode. 1 = CAN controller is not in low power mode. When a WAKEUP event occurs, the CAN controller is synchronized with the bus activity. Messages can be transmitted or received. The CAN controller clock must be available when a WAKEUP event occurs. This flag is automatically reset when the CAN Controller enters Low Power mode. • TOVF: Timer Overflow 0 = The timer has not rolled-over FFFFh to 0000h. 1 = The timer rolls-over FFFFh to 0000h. This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register. • TSTP Timestamp 0 = No bus activity has been detected. 1 = A start of frame or an end of frame has been detected (according to the TEOF field in the CAN_MR register). This flag is automatically cleared by reading the CAN_SR register. • CERR: Mailbox CRC Error 0 = No CRC error occurred during a previous transfer. 1 = A CRC error occurred during a previous transfer. A CRC error has been detected during last reception. This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register. • SERR: Mailbox Stuffing Error 0 = No stuffing error occurred during a previous transfer. 1 = A stuffing error occurred during a previous transfer. A form error results from the detection of more than five consecutive bit with the same polarity. This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register. 587 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • AERR: Acknowledgment Error 0 = No acknowledgment error occurred during a previous transfer. 1 = An acknowledgment error occurred during a previous transfer. An acknowledgment error is detected when no detection of the dominant bit in the acknowledge slot occurs. This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register. • FERR: Form Error 0 = No form error occurred during a previous transfer 1 = A form error occurred during a previous transfer A form error results from violations on one or more of the fixed form of the following bit fields: – CRC delimiter – ACK delimiter – End of frame – Error delimiter – Overload delimiter This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register. • BERR: Bit Error 0 = No bit error occurred during a previous transfer. 1 = A bit error occurred during a previous transfer. A bit error is set when the bit value monitored on the line is different from the bit value sent. This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register. • RBSY: Receiver busy 0 = CAN receiver is not receiving a frame. 1 = CAN receiver is receiving a frame. Receiver busy. This status bit is set by hardware while CAN receiver is acquiring or monitoring a frame (remote, data, overload or error frame). It is automatically reset when CAN is not receiving. • TBSY: Transmitter busy 0 = CAN transmitter is not transmitting a frame. 1 = CAN transmitter is transmitting a frame. Transmitter busy. This status bit is set by hardware while CAN transmitter is generating a frame (remote, data, overload or error frame). It is automatically reset when CAN is not transmitting. • OVLSY: Overload busy 0 = CAN transmitter is not transmitting an overload frame. 1 = CAN transmitter is transmitting a overload frame. It is automatically reset when the bus is not transmitting an overload frame. 588 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.6 Name: CAN Baudrate Register CAN_BR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 SMP 23 – 22 21 20 19 BRP 18 17 16 15 – 14 – 13 12 11 – 10 9 PROPAG 8 7 – 6 5 PHASE1 4 3 – 2 1 PHASE2 0 SJW Any modification on one of the fields of the CANBR register must be done while CAN module is disabled. To compute the different Bit Timings, please refer to the Section 38.6.4.1 “CAN Bit Timing Configuration” on page 556. • PHASE2: Phase 2 segment This phase is used to compensate the edge phase error. t PHS2 = t CSC × ( PHASE2 + 1 ) Warning: PHASE2 value must be different from 0. • PHASE1: Phase 1 segment This phase is used to compensate for edge phase error. t PHS1 = t CSC × ( PHASE1 + 1 ) • PROPAG: Programming time segment This part of the bit time is used to compensate for the physical delay times within the network. t PRS = t CSC × ( PROPAG + 1 ) • SJW: Re-synchronization jump width To compensate for phase shifts between clock oscillators of different controllers on bus. The controller must re-synchronize on any relevant signal edge of the current transmission. The synchronization jump width defines the maximum of clock cycles a bit period may be shortened or lengthened by re-synchronization. t SJW = t CSC × ( SJW + 1 ) • BRP: Baudrate Prescaler. This field allows user to program the period of the CAN system clock to determine the individual bit timing. t CSC = ( BRP + 1 ) ⁄ MCK The BRP field must be within the range [1, 0x7F], i.e., BRP = 0 is not authorized. • SMP: Sampling Mode 0 = The incoming bit stream is sampled once at sample point. 1 = The incoming bit stream is sampled three times with a period of a MCK clock period, centered on sample point. SMP Sampling Mode is automatically disabled if BRP = 0. 589 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.7 Name: CAN Timer Register CAN_TIM Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 TIMER15 14 TIMER14 13 TIMER13 12 TIMER12 11 TIMER11 10 TIMER10 9 TIMER9 8 TIMER8 7 TIMER7 6 TIMER6 5 TIMER5 4 TIMER4 3 TIMER3 2 TIMER2 1 TIMER1 0 TIMER0 • TIMERx: Timer This field represents the internal CAN controller 16-bit timer value. 590 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.8 Name: CAN Timestamp Register CAN_TIMESTP Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 MTIMESTAMP 15 MTIMESTAMP 14 MTIMESTAMP 13 MTIMESTAMP 12 MTIMESTAMP 11 MTIMESTAMP 10 MTIMESTAMP 9 MTIMESTAMP 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MTIMESTAMP 7 MTIMESTAMP 6 MTIMESTAMP 5 MTIMESTAMP 4 MTIMESTAMP 3 MTIMESTAMP 2 MTIMESTAMP 1 MTIMESTAMP 0 • MTIMESTAMPx: Timestamp This field represents the internal CAN controller 16-bit timer value. If the TEOF bit is cleared in the CAN_MR register, the internal Timer Counter value is captured in the MTIMESTAMP field at each start of frame. Else the value is captured at each end of frame. When the value is captured, the TSTP flag is set in the CAN_SR register. If the TSTP mask in the CAN_IMR register is set, an interrupt is generated while TSTP flag is set in the CAN_SR register. This flag is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register. Note: The CAN_TIMESTP register is reset when the CAN is disabled then enabled thanks to the CANEN bit in the CAN_MR. 591 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.9 Name: CAN Error Counter Register CAN_ECR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 3 2 1 0 TEC 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 7 6 5 4 REC • REC: Receive Error Counter When a receiver detects an error, REC will be increased by one, except when the detected error is a BIT ERROR while sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG. When a receiver detects a dominant bit as the first bit after sending an ERROR FLAG, REC is increased by 8. When a receiver detects a BIT ERROR while sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG, REC is increased by 8. Any node tolerates up to 7 consecutive dominant bits after sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG, PASSIVE ERROR FLAG or OVERLOAD FLAG. After detecting the 14th consecutive dominant bit (in case of an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG) or after detecting the 8th consecutive dominant bit following a PASSIVE ERROR FLAG, and after each sequence of additional eight consecutive dominant bits, each receiver increases its REC by 8. After successful reception of a message, REC is decreased by 1 if it was between 1 and 127. If REC was 0, it stays 0, and if it was greater than 127, then it is set to a value between 119 and 127. • TEC: Transmit Error Counter When a transmitter sends an ERROR FLAG, TEC is increased by 8 except when – the transmitter is error passive and detects an ACKNOWLEDGMENT ERROR because of not detecting a dominant ACK and does not detect a dominant bit while sending its PASSIVE ERROR FLAG. – the transmitter sends an ERROR FLAG because a STUFF ERROR occurred during arbitration and should have been recessive and has been sent as recessive but monitored as dominant. When a transmitter detects a BIT ERROR while sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG, the TEC will be increased by 8. Any node tolerates up to 7 consecutive dominant bits after sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG, PASSIVE ERROR FLAG or OVERLOAD FLAG. After detecting the 14th consecutive dominant bit (in case of an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG) or after detecting the 8th consecutive dominant bit following a PASSIVE ERROR FLAG, and after each sequence of additional eight consecutive dominant bits every transmitter increases its TEC by 8. After a successful transmission the TEC is decreased by 1 unless it was already 0. 592 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.10 Name: CAN Transfer Command Register CAN_TCR Access Type: Write-only 31 TIMRST 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 MB7 6 MB6 5 MB5 4 MB4 3 MB3 2 MB2 1 MB1 0 MB0 This register initializes several transfer requests at the same time. • MBx: Transfer Request for Mailbox x Mailbox Object Type Description Receive It receives the next message. Receive with overwrite This triggers a new reception. Transmit Sends data prepared in the mailbox as soon as possible. Consumer Sends a remote frame. Producer Sends data prepared in the mailbox after receiving a remote frame from a consumer. This flag clears the MRDY and MABT flags in the corresponding CAN_MSRx register. When several mailboxes are requested to be transmitted simultaneously, they are transmitted in turn, starting with the mailbox with the highest priority. If several mailboxes have the same priority, then the mailbox with the lowest number is sent first (i.e., MB0 will be transferred before MB1). • TIMRST: Timer Reset Resets the internal timer counter. If the internal timer counter is frozen, this command automatically re-enables it. This command is useful in Time Triggered mode. 593 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.11 Name: CAN Abort Command Register CAN_ACR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 MB7 6 MB6 5 MB5 4 MB4 3 MB3 2 MB2 1 MB1 0 MB0 This register initializes several abort requests at the same time. • MBx: Abort Request for Mailbox x Mailbox Object Type Description Receive No action Receive with overwrite No action Transmit Cancels transfer request if the message has not been transmitted to the CAN transceiver. Consumer Cancels the current transfer before the remote frame has been sent. Producer Cancels the current transfer. The next remote frame is not serviced. It is possible to set MACR field (in the CAN_MCRx register) for each mailbox. 594 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 595 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.12 Name: CAN Message Mode Register CAN_MMRx Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 18 15 14 13 12 11 MTIMEMARK15 MTIMEMARK14 MTIMEMARK13 MTIMEMARK12 MTIMEMARK11 25 24 MOT 17 16 10 9 8 MTIMEMARK10 MTIMEMARK9 MTIMEMARK8 PRIOR 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MTIMEMARK7 MTIMEMARK6 MTIMEMARK5 MTIMEMARK4 MTIMEMARK3 MTIMEMARK2 MTIMEMARK1 MTIMEMARK0 • MTIMEMARK: Mailbox Timemark This field is active in Time Triggered Mode. Transmit operations are allowed when the internal timer counter reaches the Mailbox Timemark. See “Transmitting within a Time Window” on page 575. In Timestamp Mode, MTIMEMARK is set to 0. • PRIOR: Mailbox Priority This field has no effect in receive and receive with overwrite modes. In these modes, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced first. When several mailboxes try to transmit a message at the same time, the mailbox with the highest priority is serviced first. If several mailboxes have the same priority, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced first (i.e., MBx0 is serviced before MBx 15 if they have the same priority). • MOT: Mailbox Object Type This field allows the user to define the type of the mailbox. All mailboxes are independently configurable. Five different types are possible for each mailbox: MOT Mailbox Object Type 0 0 0 Mailbox is disabled. This prevents receiving or transmitting any messages with this mailbox. 0 0 1 Reception Mailbox. Mailbox is configured for reception. If a message is received while the mailbox data register is full, it is discarded. 0 1 0 Reception mailbox with overwrite. Mailbox is configured for reception. If a message is received while the mailbox is full, it overwrites the previous message. 0 1 1 Transmit mailbox. Mailbox is configured for transmission. 1 0 0 Consumer Mailbox. Mailbox is configured in reception but behaves as a Transmit Mailbox, i.e., it sends a remote frame and waits for an answer. 1 0 1 Producer Mailbox. Mailbox is configured in transmission but also behaves like a reception mailbox, i.e., it waits to receive a Remote Frame before sending its contents. 1 1 X Reserved 596 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.13 Name: CAN Message Acceptance Mask Register CAN_MAMx Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 MIDE 28 27 26 MIDvA 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 MIDvA 15 14 13 MIDvB 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MIDvB 7 6 5 4 MIDvB To prevent concurrent access with the internal CAN core, the application must disable the mailbox before writing to CAN_MAMx registers. • MIDvB: Complementary bits for identifier in extended frame mode Acceptance mask for corresponding field of the message IDvB register of the mailbox. • MIDvA: Identifier for standard frame mode Acceptance mask for corresponding field of the message IDvA register of the mailbox. • MIDE: Identifier Version 0= Compares IDvA from the received frame with the CAN_MIDx register masked with CAN_MAMx register. 1= Compares IDvA and IDvB from the received frame with the CAN_MIDx register masked with CAN_MAMx register. 597 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.14 Name: CAN Message ID Register CAN_MIDx Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 MIDE 28 27 26 MIDvA 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 MIDvA 15 14 13 MIDvB 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MIDvB 7 6 5 4 MIDvB To prevent concurrent access with the internal CAN core, the application must disable the mailbox before writing to CAN_MIDx registers. • MIDvB: Complementary bits for identifier in extended frame mode If MIDE is cleared, MIDvB value is 0. • MIDE: Identifier Version This bit allows the user to define the version of messages processed by the mailbox. If set, mailbox is dealing with version 2.0 Part B messages; otherwise, mailbox is dealing with version 2.0 Part A messages. • MIDvA: Identifier for standard frame mode 598 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.15 Name: CAN Message Family ID Register CAN_MFIDx Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 27 26 MFID 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MFID 15 14 13 12 MFID 7 6 5 4 MFID • MFID: Family ID This field contains the concatenation of CAN_MIDx register bits masked by the CAN_MAMx register. This field is useful to speed up message ID decoding. The message acceptance procedure is described below. As an example: CAN_MIDx = 0x305A4321 CAN_MAMx = 0x3FF0F0FF CAN_MFIDx = 0x000000A3 599 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.16 Name: CAN Message Status Register CAN_MSRx Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 23 MRDY 22 MABT 21 – 20 MRTR 19 18 15 14 13 12 11 25 – 24 MMI 17 16 9 8 MTIMESTAMP9 MTIMESTAMP8 MDLC 10 MTIMESTAMP15 MTIMESTAMP14 MTIMESTAMP13 MTIMESTAMP12 MTIMESTAMP11 MTIMESTAMP10 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MTIMESTAMP7 MTIMESTAMP6 MTIMESTAMP5 MTIMESTAMP4 MTIMESTAMP3 MTIMESTAMP2 MTIMESTAMP1 MTIMESTAMP0 These register fields are updated each time a message transfer is received or aborted. MMI is cleared by reading the CAN_MSRx register. MRDY, MABT are cleared by writing MTCR or MACR in the CAN_MCRx register. Warning: MRTR and MDLC state depends partly on the mailbox object type. • MTIMESTAMP: Timer value This field is updated only when time-triggered operations are disabled (TTM cleared in CAN_MR register). If the TEOF field in the CAN_MR register is cleared, TIMESTAMP is the internal timer value at the start of frame of the last message received or sent by the mailbox. If the TEOF field in the CAN_MR register is set, TIMESTAMP is the internal timer value at the end of frame of the last message received or sent by the mailbox. In Time Triggered Mode, MTIMESTAMP is set to 0. • MDLC: Mailbox Data Length Code Mailbox Object Type Description Receive Length of the first mailbox message received Receive with overwrite Length of the last mailbox message received Transmit No action Consumer Length of the mailbox message received Producer Length of the mailbox message to be sent after the remote frame reception 600 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • MRTR: Mailbox Remote Transmission Request Mailbox Object Type Description Receive The first frame received has the RTR bit set. Receive with overwrite The last frame received has the RTR bit set. Transmit Reserved Consumer Reserved. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRTR is reset to 1. Producer Reserved. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRTR is reset to 0. • MABT: Mailbox Message Abort An interrupt is triggered when MABT is set. 0 = Previous transfer is not aborted. 1 = Previous transfer has been aborted. This flag is cleared by writing to CAN_MCRx register Mailbox Object Type Description Receive Reserved Receive with overwrite Reserved Transmit Previous transfer has been aborted Consumer The remote frame transfer request has been aborted. Producer The response to the remote frame transfer has been aborted. • MRDY: Mailbox Ready An interrupt is triggered when MRDY is set. 0 = Mailbox data registers can not be read/written by the software application. CAN_MDx are locked by the CAN_MDx. 1 = Mailbox data registers can be read/written by the software application. This flag is cleared by writing to CAN_MCRx register. Mailbox Object Type Description Receive At least one message has been received since the last mailbox transfer order. Data from the first frame received can be read in the CAN_MDxx registers. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 0. Receive with overwrite At least one frame has been received since the last mailbox transfer order. Data from the last frame received can be read in the CAN_MDxx registers. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 0. Transmit Mailbox data have been transmitted. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 1. Consumer At least one message has been received since the last mailbox transfer order. Data from the first message received can be read in the CAN_MDxx registers. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 0. Producer A remote frame has been received, mailbox data have been transmitted. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 1. 601 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • MMI: Mailbox Message Ignored 0 = No message has been ignored during the previous transfer 1 = At least one message has been ignored during the previous transfer Cleared by reading the CAN_MSRx register. Mailbox Object Type Description Receive Set when at least two messages intended for the mailbox have been sent. The first one is available in the mailbox data register. Others have been ignored. A mailbox with a lower priority may have accepted the message. Receive with overwrite Set when at least two messages intended for the mailbox have been sent. The last one is available in the mailbox data register. Previous ones have been lost. Transmit Reserved Consumer A remote frame has been sent by the mailbox but several messages have been received. The first one is available in the mailbox data register. Others have been ignored. Another mailbox with a lower priority may have accepted the message. Producer A remote frame has been received, but no data are available to be sent. 602 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.17 Name: CAN Message Data Low Register CAN_MDLx Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MDL 23 22 21 20 MDL 15 14 13 12 MDL 7 6 5 4 MDL • MDL: Message Data Low Value When MRDY field is set in the CAN_MSRx register, the lower 32 bits of a received message can be read or written by the software application. Otherwise, the MDL value is locked by the CAN controller to send/receive a new message. In Receive with overwrite, the CAN controller may modify MDL value while the software application reads MDH and MDL registers. To check that MDH and MDL do not belong to different messages, the application has to check the MMI field in the CAN_MSRx register. In this mode, the software application must re-read CAN_MDH and CAN_MDL, while the MMI bit in the CAN_MSRx register is set. Bytes are received/sent on the bus in the following order: 1. CAN_MDL[7:0] 2. CAN_MDL[15:8] 3. CAN_MDL[23:16] 4. CAN_MDL[31:24] 5. CAN_MDH[7:0] 6. CAN_MDH[15:8] 7. CAN_MDH[23:16] 8. CAN_MDH[31:24] 603 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.18 Name: CAN Message Data High Register CAN_MDHx Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MDH 23 22 21 20 MDH 15 14 13 12 MDH 7 6 5 4 MDH • MDH: Message Data High Value When MRDY field is set in the CAN_MSRx register, the upper 32 bits of a received message are read or written by the software application. Otherwise, the MDH value is locked by the CAN controller to send/receive a new message. In Receive with overwrite, the CAN controller may modify MDH value while the software application reads MDH and MDL registers. To check that MDH and MDL do not belong to different messages, the application has to check the MMI field in the CAN_MSRx register. In this mode, the software application must re-read CAN_MDH and CAN_MDL, while the MMI bit in the CAN_MSRx register is set. Bytes are received/sent on the bus in the following order: 1. CAN_MDL[7:0] 2. CAN_MDL[15:8] 3. CAN_MDL[23:16] 4. CAN_MDL[31:24] 5. CAN_MDH[7:0] 6. CAN_MDH[15:8] 7. CAN_MDH[23:16] 8. CAN_MDH[31:24] 604 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 38.8.19 Name: CAN Message Control Register CAN_MCRx Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 23 MTCR 22 MACR 21 – 20 MRTR 19 18 15 – 14 13 – 12 11 – 7 – 6 5 – 4 3 – – – – – 25 24 – – 17 16 10 9 – – 8 – 2 – 1 0 – – MDLC • MDLC: Mailbox Data Length Code Mailbox Object Type Description Receive No action. Receive with overwrite No action. Transmit Length of the mailbox message. Consumer No action. Producer Length of the mailbox message to be sent after the remote frame reception. • MRTR: Mailbox Remote Transmission Request Mailbox Object Type Description Receive No action Receive with overwrite No action Transmit Set the RTR bit in the sent frame Consumer No action, the RTR bit in the sent frame is set automatically Producer No action Consumer situations can be handled automatically by setting the mailbox object type in Consumer. This requires only one mailbox. It can also be handled using two mailboxes, one in reception, the other in transmission. The MRTR and the MTCR bits must be set in the same time. 605 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • MACR: Abort Request for Mailbox x Mailbox Object Type Description Receive No action Receive with overwrite No action Transmit Cancels transfer request if the message has not been transmitted to the CAN transceiver. Consumer Cancels the current transfer before the remote frame has been sent. Producer Cancels the current transfer. The next remote frame will not be serviced. It is possible to set MACR field for several mailboxes in the same time, setting several bits to the CAN_ACR register. • MTCR: Mailbox Transfer Command Mailbox Object Type Receive Receive with overwrite Transmit Description Allows the reception of the next message. Triggers a new reception. Sends data prepared in the mailbox as soon as possible. Consumer Sends a remote transmission frame. Producer Sends data prepared in the mailbox after receiving a remote frame from a Consumer. This flag clears the MRDY and MABT flags in the CAN_MSRx register. When several mailboxes are requested to be transmitted simultaneously, they are transmitted in turn. The mailbox with the highest priority is serviced first. If several mailboxes have the same priority, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced first (i.e., MBx0 will be serviced before MBx 15 if they have the same priority). It is possible to set MTCR for several mailboxes at the same time by writing to the CAN_TCR register. 606 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39. Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) 39.1 Overview The EMAC module implements a 10/100 Ethernet MAC compatible with the IEEE 802.3 standard using an address checker, statistics and control registers, receive and transmit blocks, and a DMA interface. The address checker recognizes four specific 48-bit addresses and contains a 64-bit hash register for matching multicast and unicast addresses. It can recognize the broadcast address of all ones, copy all frames, and act on an external address match signal. The statistics register block contains registers for counting various types of event associated with transmit and receive operations. These registers, along with the status words stored in the receive buffer list, enable software to generate network management statistics compatible with IEEE 802.3. 39.2 Block Diagram Figure 39-1. EMAC Block Diagram Address Checker APB Slave Register Interface Statistics Registers MDIO Control Registers DMA Interface RX FIFO TX FIFO Ethernet Receive MII/RMII ASB Master Ethernet Transmit 607 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.3 Functional Description The EMAC has several clock domains: • System bus clock (AHB and APB): DMA and register blocks • Transmi clock: transmit block • Receive clock: receive and address checker blocks The only system constraint is 160 MHz for the system bus clock, above which MDC would toggle at above 2.5 MHz. The system bus clock must run at least as fast as the receive clock and transmit clock (25 MHz at 100 Mbps, and 2.5 MHz at 10 Mbps). Figure 39-1 illustrates the different blocks of the EMAC module. The control registers drive the MDIO interface, setup up DMA activity, start frame transmission and select modes of operation such as full- or half-duplex. The receive block checks for valid preamble, FCS, alignment and length, and presents received frames to the address checking block and DMA interface. The transmit block takes data from the DMA interface, adds preamble and, if necessary, pad and FCS, and transmits data according to the CSMA/CD (carrier sense multiple access with collision detect) protocol. The start of transmission is deferred if CRS (carrier sense) is active. If COL (collision) becomes active during transmission, a jam sequence is asserted and the transmission is retried after a random back off. CRS and COL have no effect in full duplex mode. The DMA block connects to external memory through its ASB bus interface. It contains receive and transmit FIFOs for buffering frame data. It loads the transmit FIFO and empties the receive FIFO using ASB bus master operations. Receive data is not sent to memory until the address checking logic has determined that the frame should be copied. Receive or transmit frames are stored in one or more buffers. Receive buffers have a fixed length of 128 bytes. Transmit buffers range in length between 0 and 2047 bytes, and up to 128 buffers are permitted per frame. The DMA block manages the transmit and receive framebuffer queues. These queues can hold multiple frames. 39.3.1 Memory Interface Frame data is transferred to and from the EMAC through the DMA interface. All transfers are 32bit words and may be single accesses or bursts of 2, 3 or 4 words. Burst accesses do not cross sixteen-byte boundaries. Bursts of 4 words are the default data transfer; single accesses or bursts of less than four words may be used to transfer data at the beginning or the end of a buffer. The DMA controller performs six types of operation on the bus. In order of priority, these are: 1. Receive buffer manager write 2. Receive buffer manager read 3. Transmit data DMA read 4. Receive data DMA write 5. Transmit buffer manager read 6. Transmit buffer manager write 608 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.3.1.1 FIFO The FIFO depths are 28 bytes for receive and 28 bytes for transmit and are a function of the system clock speed, memory latency and network speed. Data is typically transferred into and out of the FIFOs in bursts of four words. For receive, a bus request is asserted when the FIFO contains four words and has space for three more. For transmit, a bus request is generated when there is space for four words, or when there is space for two words if the next transfer is to be only one or two words. Thus the bus latency must be less than the time it takes to load the FIFO and transmit or receive three words (12 bytes) of data. At 100 Mbit/s, it takes 960 ns to transmit or receive 12 bytes of data. In addition, six master clock cycles should be allowed for data to be loaded from the bus and to propagate through the FIFOs. For a 60 MHz master clock this takes 100 ns, making the bus latency requirement 860 ns. 39.3.1.2 Receive Buffers Received frames, including CRC/FCS optionally, are written to receive buffers stored in memory. Each receive buffer is 128 bytes long. The start location for each receive buffer is stored in memory in a list of receive buffer descriptors at a location pointed to by the receive buffer queue pointer register. The receive buffer start location is a word address. For the first buffer of a frame, the start location can be offset by up to three bytes depending on the value written to bits 14 and 15 of the network configuration register. If the start location of the buffer is offset the available length of the first buffer of a frame is reduced by the corresponding number of bytes. Each list entry consists of two words, the first being the address of the receive buffer and the second being the receive status. If the length of a receive frame exceeds the buffer length, the status word for the used buffer is written with zeroes except for the “start of frame” bit and the offset bits, if appropriate. Bit zero of the address field is written to one to show the buffer has been used. The receive buffer manager then reads the location of the next receive buffer and fills that with receive frame data. The final buffer descriptor status word contains the complete frame status. Refer to Table 39-1 for details of the receive buffer descriptor list. Table 39-1. Receive Buffer Descriptor Entry Bit Function Word 0 31:2 Address of beginning of buffer 1 Wrap - marks last descriptor in receive buffer descriptor list. 0 Ownership - needs to be zero for the EMAC to write data to the receive buffer. The EMAC sets this to one once it has successfully written a frame to memory. Software has to clear this bit before the buffer can be used again. Word 1 31 Global all ones broadcast address detected 30 Multicast hash match 29 Unicast hash match 28 External address match 27 Reserved for future use 609 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 39-1. Receive Buffer Descriptor Entry (Continued) Bit Function 26 Specific address register 1 match 25 Specific address register 2 match 24 Specific address register 3 match 23 Specific address register 4 match 22 Type ID match 21 VLAN tag detected (i.e., type id of 0x8100) 20 Priority tag detected (i.e., type id of 0x8100 and null VLAN identifier) 19:17 VLAN priority (only valid if bit 21 is set) 16 Concatenation format indicator (CFI) bit (only valid if bit 21 is set) 15 End of frame - when set the buffer contains the end of a frame. If end of frame is not set, then the only other valid status are bits 12, 13 and 14. 14 Start of frame - when set the buffer contains the start of a frame. If both bits 15 and 14 are set, then the buffer contains a whole frame. 13:12 Receive buffer offset - indicates the number of bytes by which the data in the first buffer is offset from the word address. Updated with the current values of the network configuration register. If jumbo frame mode is enabled through bit 3 of the network configuration register, then bits 13:12 of the receive buffer descriptor entry are used to indicate bits 13:12 of the frame length. 11:0 Length of frame including FCS (if selected). Bits 13:12 are also used if jumbo frame mode is selected. To receive frames, the buffer descriptors must be initialized by writing an appropriate address to bits 31 to 2 in the first word of each list entry. Bit zero must be written with zero. Bit one is the wrap bit and indicates the last entry in the list. The start location of the receive buffer descriptor list must be written to the receive buffer queue pointer register before setting the receive enable bit in the network control register to enable receive. As soon as the receive block starts writing received frame data to the receive FIFO, the receive buffer manager reads the first receive buffer location pointed to by the receive buffer queue pointer register. If the filter block then indicates that the frame should be copied to memory, the receive data DMA operation starts writing data into the receive buffer. If an error occurs, the buffer is recovered. If the current buffer pointer has its wrap bit set or is the 1024th descriptor, the next receive buffer location is read from the beginning of the receive descriptor list. Otherwise, the next receive buffer location is read from the next word in memory. There is an 11-bit counter to count out the 2048 word locations of a maximum length, receive buffer descriptor list. This is added with the value originally written to the receive buffer queue pointer register to produce a pointer into the list. A read of the receive buffer queue pointer register returns the pointer value, which is the queue entry currently being accessed. The counter is reset after receive status is written to a descriptor that has its wrap bit set or rolls over to zero after 1024 descriptors have been accessed. The value written to the receive buffer pointer register may be any word-aligned address, provided that there are at least 2048 word locations available between the pointer and the top of the memory. Section 3.6 of the AMBA™ 2.0 specification states that bursts should not cross 1K boundaries. As receive buffer manager writes are bursts of two words, to ensure that this does not occur, it is 610 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary best to write the pointer register with the least three significant bits set to zero. As receive buffers are used, the receive buffer manager sets bit zero of the first word of the descriptor to indicate used. If a receive error is detected the receive buffer currently being written is recovered. Previous buffers are not recovered. Software should search through the used bits in the buffer descriptors to find out how many frames have been received. It should be checking the start-offrame and end-of-frame bits, and not rely on the value returned by the receive buffer queue pointer register which changes continuously as more buffers are used. For CRC errored frames, excessive length frames or length field mismatched frames, all of which are counted in the statistics registers, it is possible that a frame fragment might be stored in a sequence of receive buffers. Software can detect this by looking for start of frame bit set in a buffer following a buffer with no end of frame bit set. For a properly working Ethernet system, there should be no excessively long frames or frames greater than 128 bytes with CRC/FCS errors. Collision fragments are less than 128 bytes long. Therefore, it is a rare occurrence to find a frame fragment in a receive buffer. If bit zero is set when the receive buffer manager reads the location of the receive buffer, then the buffer has already been used and cannot be used again until software has processed the frame and cleared bit zero. In this case, the DMA block sets the buffer not available bit in the receive status register and triggers an interrupt. If bit zero is set when the receive buffer manager reads the location of the receive buffer and a frame is being received, the frame is discarded and the receive resource error statistics register is incremented. A receive overrun condition occurs when bus was not granted in time or because HRESP was not OK (bus error). In a receive overrun condition, the receive overrun interrupt is asserted and the buffer currently being written is recovered. The next frame received with an address that is recognized reuses the buffer. If bit 17 of the network configuration register is set, the FCS of received frames shall not be copied to memory. The frame length indicated in the receive status field shall be reduced by four bytes in this case. 39.3.1.3 Transmit Buffer Frames to be transmitted are stored in one or more transmit buffers. Transmit buffers can be between 0 and 2047 bytes long, so it is possible to transmit frames longer than the maximum length specified in IEEE Standard 802.3. Zero length buffers are allowed. The maximum number of buffers permitted for each transmit frame is 128. The start location for each transmit buffer is stored in memory in a list of transmit buffer descriptors at a location pointed to by the transmit buffer queue pointer register. Each list entry consists of two words, the first being the byte address of the transmit buffer and the second containing the transmit control and status. Frames can be transmitted with or without automatic CRC generation. If CRC is automatically generated, pad is also automatically generated to take frames to a minimum length of 64 bytes. Table 39-2 on page 612 defines an entry in the transmit buffer descriptor list. To transmit frames, the buffer descriptors must be initialized by writing an appropriate byte address to bits 31 to 0 in the first word of each list entry. The second transmit buffer descriptor is initialized with control information that indicates the length of the buffer, whether or not it is to be transmitted with CRC and whether the buffer is the last buffer in the frame. After transmission, the control bits are written back to the second word of the first buffer along with the “used” bit and other status information. Bit 31 is the “used” bit which must be zero when 611 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 the control word is read if transmission is to happen. It is written to one when a frame has been transmitted. Bits 27, 28 and 29 indicate various transmit error conditions. Bit 30 is the “wrap” bit which can be set for any buffer within a frame. If no wrap bit is encountered after 1024 descriptors, the queue pointer rolls over to the start in a similar fashion to the receive queue. The transmit buffer queue pointer register must not be written while transmit is active. If a new value is written to the transmit buffer queue pointer register, the queue pointer resets itself to point to the beginning of the new queue. If transmit is disabled by writing to bit 3 of the network control, the transmit buffer queue pointer register resets to point to the beginning of the transmit queue. Note that disabling receive does not have the same effect on the receive queue pointer. Once the transmit queue is initialized, transmit is activated by writing to bit 9, the Transmit Start bit of the network control register. Transmit is halted when a buffer descriptor with its used bit set is read, or if a transmit error occurs, or by writing to the transmit halt bit of the network control register. (Transmission is suspended if a pause frame is received while the pause enable bit is set in the network configuration register.) Rewriting the start bit while transmission is active is allowed. Transmission control is implemented with a Tx_go variable which is readable in the transmit status register at bit location 3. The Tx_go variable is reset when: – transmit is disabled – a buffer descriptor with its ownership bit set is read – a new value is written to the transmit buffer queue pointer register – bit 10, tx_halt, of the network control register is written – there is a transmit error such as too many retries or a transmit underrun. To set tx_go, write to bit 9, tx_start, of the network control register. Transmit halt does not take effect until any ongoing transmit finishes. If a collision occurs during transmission of a multibuffer frame, transmission automatically restarts from the first buffer of the frame. If a “used” bit is read midway through transmission of a multi-buffer frame, this is treated as a transmit error. Transmission stops, tx_er is asserted and the FCS is bad. If transmission stops due to a transmit error, the transmit queue pointer resets to point to the beginning of the transmit queue. Software needs to re-initialize the transmit queue after a transmit error. If transmission stops due to a “used” bit being read at the start of the frame, the transmission queue pointer is not reset and transmit starts from the same transmit buffer descriptor when the transmit start bit is written Table 39-2. Transmit Buffer Descriptor Entry Bit Function Word 0 31:0 Byte Address of buffer Word 1 31 Used. Needs to be zero for the EMAC to read data from the transmit buffer. The EMAC sets this to one for the first buffer of a frame once it has been successfully transmitted. Software has to clear this bit before the buffer can be used again. Note: 30 612 This bit is only set for the first buffer in a frame unlike receive where all buffers have the Used bit set once used. Wrap. Marks last descriptor in transmit buffer descriptor list. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 39-2. Transmit Buffer Descriptor Entry (Continued) Bit Function 29 Retry limit exceeded, transmit error detected 28 Transmit underrun, occurs either when hresp is not OK (bus error) or the transmit data could not be fetched in time or when buffers are exhausted in mid frame. 27 Buffers exhausted in mid frame 26:17 Reserved 16 No CRC. When set, no CRC is appended to the current frame. This bit only needs to be set for the last buffer of a frame. 15 Last buffer. When set, this bit indicates the last buffer in the current frame has been reached. 14:11 Reserved 10:0 Length of buffer 39.3.2 Transmit Block This block transmits frames in accordance with the Ethernet IEEE 802.3 CSMA/CD protocol. Frame assembly starts by adding preamble and the start frame delimiter. Data is taken from the transmit FIFO a word at a time. Data is transmitted least significant nibble first. If necessary, padding is added to increase the frame length to 60 bytes. CRC is calculated as a 32-bit polynomial. This is inverted and appended to the end of the frame, taking the frame length to a minimum of 64 bytes. If the No CRC bit is set in the second word of the last buffer descriptor of a transmit frame, neither pad nor CRC are appended. In full-duplex mode, frames are transmitted immediately. Back-to-back frames are transmitted at least 96 bit times apart to guarantee the interframe gap. In half-duplex mode, the transmitter checks carrier sense. If asserted, it waits for it to de-assert and then starts transmission after the interframe gap of 96 bit times. If the collision signal is asserted during transmission, the transmitter transmits a jam sequence of 32 bits taken from the data register and then retry transmission after the back off time has elapsed. The back-off time is based on an XOR of the 10 least significant bits of the data coming from the transmit FIFO and a 10-bit pseudo random number generator. The number of bits used depends on the number of collisions seen. After the first collision, 1 bit is used, after the second 2, and so on up to 10. Above 10, all 10 bits are used. An error is indicated and no further attempts are made if 16 attempts cause collisions. If transmit DMA underruns, bad CRC is automatically appended using the same mechanism as jam insertion and the tx_er signal is asserted. For a properly configured system, this should never happen. If the back pressure bit is set in the network control register in half duplex mode, the transmit block transmits 64 bits of data, which can consist of 16 nibbles of 1011 or in bit-rate mode 64 1s, whenever it sees an incoming frame to force a collision. This provides a way of implementing flow control in half-duplex mode. 613 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.3.3 Pause Frame Support The start of an 802.3 pause frame is as follows: Table 39-3. Start of an 802.3 Pause Frame Destination Address Source Address Type (Mac Control Frame) Pause Opcode Pause Time 0x0180C2000001 6 bytes 0x8808 0x0001 2 bytes The network configuration register contains a receive pause enable bit (13). If a valid pause frame is received, the pause time register is updated with the frame’s pause time, regardless of its current contents and regardless of the state of the configuration register bit 13. An interrupt (12) is triggered when a pause frame is received, assuming it is enabled in the interrupt mask register. If bit 13 is set in the network configuration register and the value of the pause time register is non-zero, no new frame is transmitted until the pause time register has decremented to zero. The loading of a new pause time, and hence the pausing of transmission, only occurs when the EMAC is configured for full-duplex operation. If the EMAC is configured for half-duplex, there is no transmission pause, but the pause frame received interrupt is still triggered. A valid pause frame is defined as having a destination address that matches either the address stored in specific address register 1 or matches 0x0180C2000001 and has the MAC control frame type ID of 0x8808 and the pause opcode of 0x0001. Pause frames that have FCS or other errors are treated as invalid and are discarded. Valid pause frames received increment the Pause Frame Received statistic register. The pause time register decrements every 512 bit times (i.e., 128 rx_clks in nibble mode) once transmission has stopped. For test purposes, the register decrements every rx_clk cycle once transmission has stopped if bit 12 (retry test) is set in the network configuration register. If the pause enable bit (13) is not set in the network configuration register, then the decrementing occurs regardless of whether transmission has stopped or not. An interrupt (13) is asserted whenever the pause time register decrements to zero (assuming it is enabled in the interrupt mask register). 39.3.4 Receive Block The receive block checks for valid preamble, FCS, alignment and length, presents received frames to the DMA block and stores the frames destination address for use by the address checking block. If, during frame reception, the frame is found to be too long or rx_er is asserted, a bad frame indication is sent to the DMA block. The DMA block then ceases sending data to memory. At the end of frame reception, the receive block indicates to the DMA block whether the frame is good or bad. The DMA block recovers the current receive buffer if the frame was bad. The receive block signals the register block to increment the alignment error, the CRC (FCS) error, the short frame, long frame, jabber error, the receive symbol error statistics and the length field mismatch statistics. The enable bit for jumbo frames in the network configuration register allows the EMAC to receive jumbo frames of up to 10240 bytes in size. This operation does not form part of the IEEE802.3 specification and is disabled by default. When jumbo frames are enabled, frames received with a frame size greater than 10240 bytes are discarded. 614 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.3.5 Address Checking Block The address checking (or filter) block indicates to the DMA block which receive frames should be copied to memory. Whether a frame is copied depends on what is enabled in the network configuration register, the state of the external match pin, the contents of the specific address and hash registers and the frame’s destination address. In this implementation of the EMAC, the frame’s source address is not checked. Provided that bit 18 of the Network Configuration register is not set, a frame is not copied to memory if the EMAC is transmitting in half duplex mode at the time a destination address is received. If bit 18 of the Network Configuration register is set, frames can be received while transmitting in half-duplex mode. Ethernet frames are transmitted a byte at a time, least significant bit first. The first six bytes (48 bits) of an Ethernet frame make up the destination address. The first bit of the destination address, the LSB of the first byte of the frame, is the group/individual bit: this is One for multicast addresses and Zero for unicast. The All Ones address is the broadcast address, and a special case of multicast. The EMAC supports recognition of four specific addresses. Each specific address requires two registers, specific address register bottom and specific address register top. Specific address register bottom stores the first four bytes of the destination address and specific address register top contains the last two bytes. The addresses stored can be specific, group, local or universal. The destination address of received frames is compared against the data stored in the specific address registers once they have been activated. The addresses are deactivated at reset or when their corresponding specific address register bottom is written. They are activated when specific address register top is written. If a receive frame address matches an active address, the frame is copied to memory. The following example illustrates the use of the address match registers for a MAC address of 21:43:65:87:A9:CB. Preamble 55 SFD D5 DA (Octet0 - LSB) 21 DA(Octet 1) 43 DA(Octet 2) 65 DA(Octet 3) 87 DA(Octet 4) A9 DA (Octet5 - MSB) CB SA (LSB) 00 SA 00 SA 00 SA 00 SA 00 SA (MSB) 43 SA (LSB) 21 615 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 The sequence above shows the beginning of an Ethernet frame. Byte order of transmission is from top to bottom as shown. For a successful match to specific address 1, the following address matching registers must be set up: • Base address + 0x98 0x87654321 (Bottom) • Base address + 0x9C 0x0000CBA9 (Top) And for a successful match to the Type ID register, the following should be set up: • Base address + 0xB8 0x00004321 39.3.6 Broadcast Address The broadcast address of 0xFFFFFFFFFFFF is recognized if the ‘no broadcast’ bit in the network configuration register is zero. 39.3.7 Hash Addressing The hash address register is 64 bits long and takes up two locations in the memory map. The least significant bits are stored in hash register bottom and the most significant bits in hash register top. The unicast hash enable and the multicast hash enable bits in the network configuration register enable the reception of hash matched frames. The destination address is reduced to a 6-bit index into the 64-bit hash register using the following hash function. The hash function is an exclusive or of every sixth bit of the destination address. hash_index[5] = da[5] ^ da[11] ^ da[17] ^ da[23] ^ da[29] ^ da[35] ^ da[41] ^ da[47] hash_index[4] = da[4] ^ da[10] ^ da[16] ^ da[22] ^ da[28] ^ da[34] ^ da[40] ^ da[46] hash_index[3] = da[3] ^ da[09] ^ da[15] ^ da[21] ^ da[27] ^ da[33] ^ da[39] ^ da[45] hash_index[2] = da[2] ^ da[08] ^ da[14] ^ da[20] ^ da[26] ^ da[32] ^ da[38] ^ da[44] hash_index[1] = da[1] ^ da[07] ^ da[13] ^ da[19] ^ da[25] ^ da[31] ^ da[37] ^ da[43] hash_index[0] = da[0] ^ da[06] ^ da[12] ^ da[18] ^ da[24] ^ da[30] ^ da[36] ^ da[42] da[0] represents the least significant bit of the first byte received, that is, the multicast/unicast indicator, and da[47] represents the most significant bit of the last byte received. If the hash index points to a bit that is set in the hash register, then the frame is matched according to whether the frame is multicast or unicast. A multicast match is signalled if the multicast hash enable bit is set. da[0] is 1 and the hash index points to a bit set in the hash register. A unicast match is signalled if the unicast hash enable bit is set. da[0] is 0 and the hash index points to a bit set in the hash register. To receive all multicast frames, the hash register should be set with all ones and the multicast hash enable bit should be set in the network configuration register. 39.3.8 616 Copy All Frames (or Promiscuous Mode) If the copy all frames bit is set in the network configuration register, then all non-errored frames are copied to memory. For example, frames that are too long, too short, or have FCS errors or AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary rx_er asserted during reception are discarded and all others are received. Frames with FCS errors are copied to memory if bit 19 in the network configuration register is set. 39.3.9 Type ID Checking The contents of the type_id register are compared against the length/type ID of received frames (i.e., bytes 13 and 14). Bit 22 in the receive buffer descriptor status is set if there is a match. The reset state of this register is zero which is unlikely to match the length/type ID of any valid Ethernet frame. Note: 39.3.10 A type ID match does not affect whether a frame is copied to memory. VLAN Support An Ethernet encoded 802.1Q VLAN tag looks like this: Table 39-4. 802.1Q VLAN Tag TPID (Tag Protocol Identifier) 16 bits TCI (Tag Control Information) 16 bits 0x8100 First 3 bits priority, then CFI bit, last 12 bits VID The VLAN tag is inserted at the 13th byte of the frame, adding an extra four bytes to the frame. If the VID (VLAN identifier) is null (0x000), this indicates a priority-tagged frame. The MAC can support frame lengths up to 1536 bytes, 18 bytes more than the original Ethernet maximum frame length of 1518 bytes. This is achieved by setting bit 8 in the network configuration register. The following bits in the receive buffer descriptor status word give information about VLAN tagged frames: • Bit 21 set if receive frame is VLAN tagged (i.e. type id of 0x8100) • Bit 20 set if receive frame is priority tagged (i.e. type id of 0x8100 and null VID). (If bit 20 is set bit 21 is set also.) • Bit 19, 18 and 17 set to priority if bit 21 is set • Bit 16 set to CFI if bit 21 is set 39.3.11 PHY Maintenance The register EMAC_MAN enables the EMAC to communicate with a PHY by means of the MDIO interface. It is used during auto-negotiation to ensure that the EMAC and the PHY are configured for the same speed and duplex configuration. The PHY maintenance register is implemented as a shift register. Writing to the register starts a shift operation which is signalled as complete when bit two is set in the network status register (about 2000 MCK cycles later when bit ten is set to zero, and bit eleven is set to one in the network configuration register). An interrupt is generated as this bit is set. During this time, the MSB of the register is output on the MDIO pin and the LSB updated from the MDIO pin with each MDC cycle. This causes transmission of a PHY management frame on MDIO. Reading during the shift operation returns the current contents of the shift register. At the end of management operation, the bits have shifted back to their original locations. For a read operation, the data bits are updated with data read from the PHY. It is important to write the correct values to the register to ensure a valid PHY management frame is produced. The MDIO interface can read IEEE 802.3 clause 45 PHYs as well as clause 22 PHYs. To read clause 45 PHYs, bits[31:28] should be written as 0x0011. For a description of MDC generation, see the network configuration register in the “Network Control Register” on page 624. 617 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.3.12 Media Independent Interface The Ethernet MAC is capable of interfacing to both RMII and MII Interfaces. The RMII bit in the EMAC_USRIO register controls the interface that is selected. When this bit is set, the RMII interface is selected, else the MII interface is selected. The MII and RMII interface are capable of both 10Mb/s and 100Mb/s data rates as described in the IEEE 802.3u standard. The signals used by the MII and RMII interfaces are described in Table 39-5. Table 39-5. Pin Configuration Pin Name ETXCK_EREFCK MII RMII ETXCK: Transmit Clock EREFCK: Reference Clock ECRS ECRS: Carrier Sense ECOL ECOL: Collision Detect ERXDV ERXDV: Data Valid ECRSDV: Carrier Sense/Data Valid ERX0 - ERX3: 4-bit Receive Data ERX0 - ERX1: 2-bit Receive Data ERXER ERXER: Receive Error ERXER: Receive Error ERXCK ERXCK: Receive Clock ETXEN ETXEN: Transmit Enable ETXEN: Transmit Enable ETX0 - ETX3: 4-bit Transmit Data ETX0 - ETX1: 2-bit Transmit Data ERX0 - ERX3 ETX0-ETX3 ETXER ETXER: Transmit Error The intent of the RMII is to provide a reduced pin count alternative to the IEEE 802.3u MII. It uses 2 bits for transmit (ETX0 and ETX1) and two bits for receive (ERX0 and ERX1). There is a Transmit Enable (ETXEN), a Receive Error (ERXER), a Carrier Sense (ECRS_DV), and a 50 MHz Reference Clock (ETXCK_EREFCK) for 100Mb/s data rate. 39.3.12.1 618 RMII Transmit and Receive Operation The same signals are used internally for both the RMII and the MII operations. The RMII maps these signals in a more pin-efficient manner. The transmit and receive bits are converted from a 4-bit parallel format to a 2-bit parallel scheme that is clocked at twice the rate. The carrier sense and data valid signals are combined into the ECRSDV signal. This signal contains information on carrier sense, FIFO status, and validity of the data. Transmit error bit (ETXER) and collision detect (ECOL) are not used in RMII mode. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.4 Programming Interface 39.4.1 39.4.1.1 Initialization Configuration Initialization of the EMAC configuration (e.g., loop-back mode, frequency ratios) must be done while the transmit and receive circuits are disabled. See the description of the network control register and network configuration register earlier in this document. To change loop-back mode, the following sequence of operations must be followed: 1. Write to network control register to disable transmit and receive circuits. 2. Write to network control register to change loop-back mode. 3. Write to network control register to re-enable transmit or receive circuits. Note: 39.4.1.2 These writes to network control register cannot be combined in any way. Receive Buffer List Receive data is written to areas of data (i.e., buffers) in system memory. These buffers are listed in another data structure that also resides in main memory. This data structure (receive buffer queue) is a sequence of descriptor entries as defined in “Receive Buffer Descriptor Entry” on page 609. It points to this data structure. Figure 39-2. Receive Buffer List Receive Buffer 0 Receive Buffer Queue Pointer (MAC Register) Receive Buffer 1 Receive Buffer N Receive Buffer Descriptor List (In memory) (In memory) To create the list of buffers: 1. Allocate a number (n) of buffers of 128 bytes in system memory. 2. Allocate an area 2n words for the receive buffer descriptor entry in system memory and create n entries in this list. Mark all entries in this list as owned by EMAC, i.e., bit 0 of word 0 set to 0. 3. If less than 1024 buffers are defined, the last descriptor must be marked with the wrap bit (bit 1 in word 0 set to 1). 4. Write address of receive buffer descriptor entry to EMAC register receive_buffer queue pointer. 5. The receive circuits can then be enabled by writing to the address recognition registers and then to the network control register. 619 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.4.1.3 Transmit Buffer List Transmit data is read from areas of data (the buffers) in system memory These buffers are listed in another data structure that also resides in main memory. This data structure (Transmit Buffer Queue) is a sequence of descriptor entries (as defined in Table 39-2 on page 612) that points to this data structure. To create this list of buffers: 1. Allocate a number (n) of buffers of between 1 and 2047 bytes of data to be transmitted in system memory. Up to 128 buffers per frame are allowed. 2. Allocate an area 2n words for the transmit buffer descriptor entry in system memory and create N entries in this list. Mark all entries in this list as owned by EMAC, i.e. bit 31 of word 1 set to 0. 3. If fewer than 1024 buffers are defined, the last descriptor must be marked with the wrap bit — bit 30 in word 1 set to 1. 4. Write address of transmit buffer descriptor entry to EMAC register transmit_buffer queue pointer. 5. The transmit circuits can then be enabled by writing to the network control register. 39.4.1.4 Address Matching The EMAC register-pair hash address and the four specific address register-pairs must be written with the required values. Each register-pair comprises a bottom register and top register, with the bottom register being written first. The address matching is disabled for a particular register-pair after the bottom-register has been written and re-enabled when the top register is written. See “Address Checking Block” on page 615. for details of address matching. Each register-pair may be written at any time, regardless of whether the receive circuits are enabled or disabled. 39.4.1.5 Interrupts There are 14 interrupt conditions that are detected within the EMAC. These are ORed to make a single interrupt. Depending on the overall system design, this may be passed through a further level of interrupt collection (interrupt controller). On receipt of the interrupt signal, the CPU enters the interrupt handler (Refer to the AIC programmer datasheet). To ascertain which interrupt has been generated, read the interrupt status register. Note that this register clears itself when read. At reset, all interrupts are disabled. To enable an interrupt, write to interrupt enable register with the pertinent interrupt bit set to 1. To disable an interrupt, write to interrupt disable register with the pertinent interrupt bit set to 1. To check whether an interrupt is enabled or disabled, read interrupt mask register: if the bit is set to 1, the interrupt is disabled. 39.4.1.6 Transmitting Frames To set up a frame for transmission: 1. Enable transmit in the network control register. 2. Allocate an area of system memory for transmit data. This does not have to be contiguous, varying byte lengths can be used as long as they conclude on byte borders. 3. Set-up the transmit buffer list. 4. Set the network control register to enable transmission and enable interrupts. 5. Write data for transmission into these buffers. 6. Write the address to transmit buffer descriptor queue pointer. 7. Write control and length to word one of the transmit buffer descriptor entry. 620 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 8. Write to the transmit start bit in the network control register. 39.4.1.7 Receiving Frames When a frame is received and the receive circuits are enabled, the EMAC checks the address and, in the following cases, the frame is written to system memory: • if it matches one of the four specific address registers. • if it matches the hash address function. • if it is a broadcast address (0xFFFFFFFFFFFF) and broadcasts are allowed. • if the EMAC is configured to copy all frames. The register receive buffer queue pointer points to the next entry (see Table 39-1 on page 609) and the EMAC uses this as the address in system memory to write the frame to. Once the frame has been completely and successfully received and written to system memory, the EMAC then updates the receive buffer descriptor entry with the reason for the address match and marks the area as being owned by software. Once this is complete an interrupt receive complete is set. Software is then responsible for handling the data in the buffer and then releasing the buffer by writing the ownership bit back to 0. If the EMAC is unable to write the data at a rate to match the incoming frame, then an interrupt receive overrun is set. If there is no receive buffer available, i.e., the next buffer is still owned by software, the interrupt receive buffer not available is set. If the frame is not successfully received, a statistic register is incremented and the frame is discarded without informing software. 621 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5 Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) User Interface Table 39-6. Register Mapping Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x00 Network Control Register EMAC_NCR Read-write 0 0x04 Network Configuration Register EMAC_NCFG Read-write 0x800 0x08 Network Status Register EMAC_NSR Read-only - 0x0C Reserved 0x10 Reserved 0x14 Transmit Status Register EMAC_TSR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x18 Receive Buffer Queue Pointer Register EMAC_RBQP Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x1C Transmit Buffer Queue Pointer Register EMAC_TBQP Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x20 Receive Status Register EMAC_RSR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x24 Interrupt Status Register EMAC_ISR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x28 Interrupt Enable Register EMAC_IER Write-only - 0x2C Interrupt Disable Register EMAC_IDR Write-only - 0x30 Interrupt Mask Register EMAC_IMR Read-only 0x0000_3FFF 0x34 Phy Maintenance Register EMAC_MAN Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x38 Pause Time Register EMAC_PTR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x3C Pause Frames Received Register EMAC_PFR Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x40 Frames Transmitted Ok Register EMAC_FTO Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x44 Single Collision Frames Register EMAC_SCF Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x48 Multiple Collision Frames Register EMAC_MCF Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x4C Frames Received Ok Register EMAC_FRO Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x50 Frame Check Sequence Errors Register EMAC_FCSE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x54 Alignment Errors Register EMAC_ALE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x58 Deferred Transmission Frames Register EMAC_DTF Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x5C Late Collisions Register EMAC_LCOL Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x60 Excessive Collisions Register EMAC_ECOL Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x64 Transmit Underrun Errors Register EMAC_TUND Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x68 Carrier Sense Errors Register EMAC_CSE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x6C Receive Resource Errors Register EMAC_RRE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x70 Receive Overrun Errors Register EMAC_ROV Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x74 Receive Symbol Errors Register EMAC_RSE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x78 Excessive Length Errors Register EMAC_ELE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x7C Receive Jabbers Register EMAC_RJA Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x80 Undersize Frames Register EMAC_USF Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x84 SQE Test Errors Register EMAC_STE Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x88 Received Length Field Mismatch Register EMAC_RLE Read-write 0x0000_0000 622 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 39-6. Register Mapping (Continued) Offset Register Name Access Reset 0x90 Hash Register Bottom [31:0] Register EMAC_HRB Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x94 Hash Register Top [63:32] Register EMAC_HRT Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x98 Specific Address 1 Bottom Register EMAC_SA1B Read-write 0x0000_0000 0x9C Specific Address 1 Top Register EMAC_SA1T Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xA0 Specific Address 2 Bottom Register EMAC_SA2B Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xA4 Specific Address 2 Top Register EMAC_SA2T Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xA8 Specific Address 3 Bottom Register EMAC_SA3B Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xAC Specific Address 3 Top Register EMAC_SA3T Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xB0 Specific Address 4 Bottom Register EMAC_SA4B Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xB4 Specific Address 4 Top Register EMAC_SA4T Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xB8 Type ID Checking Register EMAC_TID Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xC0 User Input/output Register EMAC_USRIO Read-write 0x0000_0000 0xC8-0xF8 Reserved – – – 0xC8 - 0xFC Reserved – – – 623 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.1 Network Control Register Register Name: EMAC_NCR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 THALT 9 TSTART 8 BP 7 WESTAT 6 INCSTAT 5 CLRSTAT 4 MPE 3 TE 2 RE 1 LLB 0 LB • LB: LoopBack Asserts the loopback signal to the PHY. • LLB: Loopback local Connects txd to rxd, tx_en to rx_dv, forces full duplex and drives rx_clk and tx_clk with pclk divided by 4. rx_clk and tx_clk may glitch as the EMAC is switched into and out of internal loop back. It is important that receive and transmit circuits have already been disabled when making the switch into and out of internal loop back. • RE: Receive enable When set, enables the EMAC to receive data. When reset, frame reception stops immediately and the receive FIFO is cleared. The receive queue pointer register is unaffected. • TE: Transmit enable When set, enables the Ethernet transmitter to send data. When reset transmission, stops immediately, the transmit FIFO and control registers are cleared and the transmit queue pointer register resets to point to the start of the transmit descriptor list. • MPE: Management port enable Set to one to enable the management port. When zero, forces MDIO to high impedance state and MDC low. • CLRSTAT: Clear statistics registers This bit is write only. Writing a one clears the statistics registers. • INCSTAT: Increment statistics registers This bit is write only. Writing a one increments all the statistics registers by one for test purposes. • WESTAT: Write enable for statistics registers Setting this bit to one makes the statistics registers writable for functional test purposes. • BP: Back Pressure If set in half duplex mode, forces collisions on all received frames. • TSTART: Start transmission Writing one to this bit starts transmission. • THALT: Transmit halt 624 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Writing one to this bit halts transmission as soon as any ongoing frame transmission ends. 39.5.2 Network Configuration Register Register Name: EMAC_NCFGR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 IRXFCS 18 EFRHD 17 DRFCS 16 RLCE 14 13 PAE 12 RTY 11 10 9 8 BIG 5 NBC 4 CAF 3 JFRAME 2 – 1 FD 0 SPD 15 RBOF 7 UNI 6 MTI CLK • SPD: Speed Set to 1 to indicate 100 Mbit/s operation, 0 for 10 Mbit/s. • FD: Full Duplex If set to 1, the transmit block ignores the state of collision and carrier sense and allows receive while transmitting. • CAF: Copy All Frames When set to 1, all valid frames are received. • JFRAME: Jumbo Frames Set to one to enable jumbo frames of up to 10240 bytes to be accepted. • NBC: No Broadcast When set to 1, frames addressed to the broadcast address of all ones are not received. • MTI: Multicast Hash Enable When set, multicast frames are received when the 6-bit hash function of the destination address points to a bit that is set in the hash register. • UNI: Unicast Hash Enable When set, unicast frames are received when the 6-bit hash function of the destination address points to a bit that is set in the hash register. • BIG: Receive 1536 Bytes Frames Setting this bit means the EMAC receives frames up to 1536 bytes in length. Normally, the EMAC would reject any frame above 1518 bytes. 625 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • CLK: MDC clock divider Set according to system clock speed. This determines by what number system clock is divided to generate MDC. For conformance with 802.3, MDC must not exceed 2.5MHz (MDC is only active during MDIO read and write operations). CLK MDC 00 MCK divided by 8 (MCK up to 20 MHz) 01 MCK divided by 16 (MCK up to 40 MHz) 10 MCK divided by 32 (MCK up to 80 MHz) 11 MCK divided by 64 (MCK up to 160 MHz) • RTY: Retry Test Must be set to zero for normal operation. If set to one, the back off between collisions is always one slot time. Setting this bit to one helps testing the too many retries condition. Also used in the pause frame tests to reduce the pause counters decrement time from 512 bit times, to every rx_clk cycle. • PAE: Pause Enable When set, transmission pauses when a valid pause frame is received. • RBOF: Receive Buffer Offset Indicates the number of bytes by which the received data is offset from the start of the first receive buffer. RBOF Offset 00 No offset from start of receive buffer 01 One-byte offset from start of receive buffer 10 Two-byte offset from start of receive buffer 11 Three-byte offset from start of receive buffer • RLCE: Receive Length field Checking Enable When set, frames with measured lengths shorter than their length fields are discarded. Frames containing a type ID in bytes 13 and 14 — length/type ID = 0600 — are not be counted as length errors. • DRFCS: Discard Receive FCS When set, the FCS field of received frames are not be copied to memory. • EFRHD: Enable Frames to be received in half-duplex mode while transmitting. • IRXFCS: Ignore RX FCS When set, frames with FCS/CRC errors are not rejected and no FCS error statistics are counted. For normal operation, this bit must be set to 0. 626 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.3 Network Status Register Register Name: EMAC_NSR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 IDLE 1 MDIO 0 – • MDIO Returns status of the MDIO pin. Use the PHY maintenance register for reading managed frames rather than this bit. • IDLE 0 = The PHY logic is running. 1 = The PHY management logic is idle (i.e., has completed). 627 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.4 Transmit Status Register Register Name: EMAC_TSR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 UND 5 COMP 4 BEX 3 TGO 2 RLE 1 COL 0 UBR This register, when read, provides details of the status of a transmit. Once read, individual bits may be cleared by writing 1 to them. It is not possible to set a bit to 1 by writing to the register. • UBR: Used Bit Read Set when a transmit buffer descriptor is read with its used bit set. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • COL: Collision Occurred Set by the assertion of collision. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • RLE: Retry Limit exceeded Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • TGO: Transmit Go If high transmit is active. • BEX: Buffers exhausted mid frame If the buffers run out during transmission of a frame, then transmission stops, FCS shall be bad and tx_er asserted. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • COMP: Transmit Complete Set when a frame has been transmitted. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • UND: Transmit Underrun Set when transmit DMA was not able to read data from memory, either because the bus was not granted in time, because a not OK hresp(bus error) was returned or because a used bit was read midway through frame transmission. If this occurs, the transmitter forces bad CRC. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. 628 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.5 Receive Buffer Queue Pointer Register Register Name: EMAC_RBQP Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 – 0 – ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR This register points to the entry in the receive buffer queue (descriptor list) currently being used. It is written with the start location of the receive buffer descriptor list. The lower order bits increment as buffers are used up and wrap to their original values after either 1024 buffers or when the wrap bit of the entry is set. Reading this register returns the location of the descriptor currently being accessed. This value increments as buffers are used. Software should not use this register for determining where to remove received frames from the queue as it constantly changes as new frames are received. Software should instead work its way through the buffer descriptor queue checking the used bits. Receive buffer writes also comprise bursts of two words and, as with transmit buffer reads, it is recommended that bit 2 is always written with zero to prevent a burst crossing a 1K boundary, in violation of section 3.6 of the AMBA specification. • ADDR: Receive buffer queue pointer address Written with the address of the start of the receive queue, reads as a pointer to the current buffer being used. 629 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.6 Transmit Buffer Queue Pointer Register Register Name: EMAC_TBQP Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 – 0 – ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR This register points to the entry in the transmit buffer queue (descriptor list) currently being used. It is written with the start location of the transmit buffer descriptor list. The lower order bits increment as buffers are used up and wrap to their original values after either 1024 buffers or when the wrap bit of the entry is set. This register can only be written when bit 3 in the transmit status register is low. As transmit buffer reads consist of bursts of two words, it is recommended that bit 2 is always written with zero to prevent a burst crossing a 1K boundary, in violation of section 3.6 of the AMBA specification. • ADDR: Transmit buffer queue pointer address Written with the address of the start of the transmit queue, reads as a pointer to the first buffer of the frame being transmitted or about to be transmitted. 630 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.7 Receive Status Register Register Name: EMAC_RSR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 OVR 1 REC 0 BNA This register, when read, provides details of the status of a receive. Once read, individual bits may be cleared by writing 1 to them. It is not possible to set a bit to 1 by writing to the register. • BNA: Buffer Not Available An attempt was made to get a new buffer and the pointer indicated that it was owned by the processor. The DMA rereads the pointer each time a new frame starts until a valid pointer is found. This bit is set at each attempt that fails even if it has not had a successful pointer read since it has been cleared. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • REC: Frame Received One or more frames have been received and placed in memory. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. • OVR: Receive Overrun The DMA block was unable to store the receive frame to memory, either because the bus was not granted in time or because a not OK hresp(bus error) was returned. The buffer is recovered if this happens. Cleared by writing a one to this bit. 631 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.8 Interrupt Status Register Register Name: EMAC_ISR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 PTZ 12 PFR 11 HRESP 10 ROVR 9 – 8 – 7 TCOMP 6 TXERR 5 RLE 4 TUND 3 TXUBR 2 RXUBR 1 RCOMP 0 MFD • MFD: Management Frame Done The PHY maintenance register has completed its operation. Cleared on read. • RCOMP: Receive Complete A frame has been stored in memory. Cleared on read. • RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read Set when a receive buffer descriptor is read with its used bit set. Cleared on read. • TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read Set when a transmit buffer descriptor is read with its used bit set. Cleared on read. • TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun The transmit DMA did not fetch frame data in time for it to be transmitted or hresp returned not OK. Also set if a used bit is read mid-frame or when a new transmit queue pointer is written. Cleared on read. • RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded Cleared on read. • TXERR: Transmit Error Transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame - transmit error. Cleared on read. • TCOMP: Transmit Complete Set when a frame has been transmitted. Cleared on read. • ROVR: Receive Overrun Set when the receive overrun status bit gets set. Cleared on read. • HRESP: Hresp not OK Set when the DMA block sees a bus error. Cleared on read. • PFR: Pause Frame Received Indicates a valid pause has been received. Cleared on a read. • PTZ: Pause Time Zero Set when the pause time register, 0x38 decrements to zero. Cleared on a read. 632 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.9 Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: EMAC_IER Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 PTZ 12 PFR 11 HRESP 10 ROVR 9 – 8 – 7 TCOMP 6 TXERR 5 RLE 4 TUND 3 TXUBR 2 RXUBR 1 RCOMP 0 MFD • MFD: Management Frame sent Enable management done interrupt. • RCOMP: Receive Complete Enable receive complete interrupt. • RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read Enable receive used bit read interrupt. • TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read Enable transmit used bit read interrupt. • TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun Enable transmit underrun interrupt. • RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded Enable retry limit exceeded interrupt. • TXERR Enable transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame interrupt. • TCOMP: Transmit Complete Enable transmit complete interrupt. • ROVR: Receive Overrun Enable receive overrun interrupt. • HRESP: Hresp not OK Enable Hresp not OK interrupt. • PFR: Pause Frame Received Enable pause frame received interrupt. • PTZ: Pause Time Zero Enable pause time zero interrupt. 633 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.10 Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: EMAC_IDR Access Type: Write-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 PTZ 12 PFR 11 HRESP 10 ROVR 9 8 – 7 TCOMP 6 TXERR 5 RLE 4 TUND 3 TXUBR 2 RXUBR 1 RCOMP 0 MFD • MFD: Management Frame sent Disable management done interrupt. • RCOMP: Receive Complete Disable receive complete interrupt. • RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read Disable receive used bit read interrupt. • TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read Disable transmit used bit read interrupt. • TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun Disable transmit underrun interrupt. • RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded Disable retry limit exceeded interrupt. • TXERR Disable transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame interrupt. • TCOMP: Transmit Complete Disable transmit complete interrupt. • ROVR: Receive Overrun Disable receive overrun interrupt. • HRESP: Hresp not OK Disable Hresp not OK interrupt. • PFR: Pause Frame Received Disable pause frame received interrupt. • PTZ: Pause Time Zero Disable pause time zero interrupt. 634 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.11 Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: EMAC_IMR Access Type: Read-only 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 PTZ 12 PFR 11 HRESP 10 ROVR 9 8 – 7 TCOMP 6 TXERR 5 RLE 4 TUND 3 TXUBR 2 RXUBR 1 RCOMP 0 MFD • MFD: Management Frame sent Management done interrupt masked. • RCOMP: Receive Complete Receive complete interrupt masked. • RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read Receive used bit read interrupt masked. • TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read Transmit used bit read interrupt masked. • TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun Transmit underrun interrupt masked. • RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded Retry limit exceeded interrupt masked. • TXERR Transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame interrupt masked. • TCOMP: Transmit Complete Transmit complete interrupt masked. • ROVR: Receive Overrun Receive overrun interrupt masked. • HRESP: Hresp not OK Hresp not OK interrupt masked. • PFR: Pause Frame Received Pause frame received interrupt masked. • PTZ: Pause Time Zero Pause time zero interrupt masked. 635 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.12 PHY Maintenance Register Register Name: EMAC_MAN Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 SOF 28 27 26 RW 23 PHYA 22 15 14 21 13 25 24 17 16 PHYA 20 REGA 19 18 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 CODE DATA 7 6 5 4 DATA • DATA For a write operation this is written with the data to be written to the PHY. After a read operation this contains the data read from the PHY. • CODE: Must be written to 10. Reads as written. • REGA: Register Address Specifies the register in the PHY to access. • PHYA: PHY Address • RW: Read/Write 10 is read; 01 is write. Any other value is an invalid PHY management frame • SOF: Start of frame Must be written 01 for a valid frame. 636 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.13 Pause Time Register Register Name: EMAC_PTR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 PTIME 7 6 5 4 PTIME • PTIME: Pause Time Stores the current value of the pause time register which is decremented every 512 bit times. 637 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.14 Hash Register Bottom Register Name: EMAC_HRB Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR: Bits 31:0 of the hash address register. See “Hash Addressing” on page 616. 39.5.15 Hash Register Top Register Name: EMAC_HRT Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR: Bits 63:32 of the hash address register. See “Hash Addressing” on page 616. 638 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.16 Specific Address 1 Bottom Register Register Name: EMAC_SA1B Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received. 39.5.17 Specific Address 1 Top Register Register Name: EMAC_SA1T Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32. 639 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.18 Specific Address 2 Bottom Register Register Name: EMAC_SA2B Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received. 39.5.19 Specific Address 2 Top Register Register Name: EMAC_SA2T Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32. 640 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.20 Specific Address 3 Bottom Register Register Name: EMAC_SA3B Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received. 39.5.21 Specific Address 3 Top Register Register Name: EMAC_SA3T Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32. 641 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.22 Specific Address 4 Bottom Register Register Name: EMAC_SA4B Access Type: 31 Read-write 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 23 22 21 20 ADDR 15 14 13 12 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received. 39.5.23 Specific Address 4 Top Register Register Name: EMAC_SA4T Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 ADDR 7 6 5 4 ADDR • ADDR The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32. 642 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.24 Type ID Checking Register Register Name: EMAC_TID Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 TID 7 6 5 4 TID • TID: Type ID Checking For use in comparisons with received frames TypeID/Length field. 39.5.25 User Input/Output Register Register Name: EMAC_USRIO Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 – 6 – 5 – 4 – 3 – 2 – 1 CLKEN 0 RMII • RMII When set, this bit enables the RMII operation mode. When reset, it selects the MII mode. • CLKEN When set, this bit enables the transceiver input clock. Setting this bit to 0 reduces power consumption when the treasurer is not used. 643 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.26 EMAC Statistic Registers These registers reset to zero on a read and stick at all ones when they count to their maximum value. They should be read frequently enough to prevent loss of data. The receive statistics registers are only incremented when the receive enable bit is set in the network control register. To write to these registers, bit 7 must be set in the network control register. The statistics register block contains the following registers. 39.5.26.1 Pause Frames Received Register Register Name: EMAC_PFR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 FROK 7 6 5 4 FROK • FROK: Pause Frames Received OK A 16-bit register counting the number of good pause frames received. A good frame has a length of 64 to 1518 (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register) and has no FCS, alignment or receive symbol errors. 39.5.26.2 Frames Transmitted OK Register Register Name: EMAC_FTO Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 FTOK 15 14 13 12 FTOK 7 6 5 4 FTOK • FTOK: Frames Transmitted OK A 24-bit register counting the number of frames successfully transmitted, i.e., no underrun and not too many retries. 644 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.26.3 Single Collision Frames Register Register Name: EMAC_SCF Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 SCF 7 6 5 4 SCF • SCF: Single Collision Frames A 16-bit register counting the number of frames experiencing a single collision before being successfully transmitted, i.e., no underrun. 39.5.26.4 Multicollision Frames Register Register Name: EMAC_MCF Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 MCF 7 6 5 4 MCF • MCF: Multicollision Frames A 16-bit register counting the number of frames experiencing between two and fifteen collisions prior to being successfully transmitted, i.e., no underrun and not too many retries. 645 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.26.5 Frames Received OK Register Register Name: EMAC_FRO Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 FROK 15 14 13 12 FROK 7 6 5 4 FROK • FROK: Frames Received OK A 24-bit register counting the number of good frames received, i.e., address recognized and successfully copied to memory. A good frame is of length 64 to 1518 bytes (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register) and has no FCS, alignment or receive symbol errors. 39.5.26.6 Frames Check Sequence Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_FCSE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FCSE • FCSE: Frame Check Sequence Errors An 8-bit register counting frames that are an integral number of bytes, have bad CRC and are between 64 and 1518 bytes in length (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register). This register is also incremented if a symbol error is detected and the frame is of valid length and has an integral number of bytes. 646 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.26.7 Alignment Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_ALE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ALE • ALE: Alignment Errors An 8-bit register counting frames that are not an integral number of bytes long and have bad CRC when their length is truncated to an integral number of bytes and are between 64 and 1518 bytes in length (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register). This register is also incremented if a symbol error is detected and the frame is of valid length and does not have an integral number of bytes. 39.5.26.8 Deferred Transmission Frames Register Register Name: EMAC_DTF Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 DTF 7 6 5 4 DTF • DTF: Deferred Transmission Frames A 16-bit register counting the number of frames experiencing deferral due to carrier sense being active on their first attempt at transmission. Frames involved in any collision are not counted nor are frames that experienced a transmit underrun. 647 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.26.9 Late Collisions Register Register Name: EMAC_LCOL Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LCOL • LCOL: Late Collisions An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that experience a collision after the slot time (512 bits) has expired. A late collision is counted twice; i.e., both as a collision and a late collision. 39.5.26.10 Excessive Collisions Register Register Name: EMAC_EXCOL Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EXCOL • EXCOL: Excessive Collisions An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that failed to be transmitted because they experienced 16 collisions. 648 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.26.11 Transmit Underrun Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_TUND Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TUND • TUND: Transmit Underruns An 8-bit register counting the number of frames not transmitted due to a transmit DMA underrun. If this register is incremented, then no other statistics register is incremented. 39.5.26.12 Carrier Sense Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_CSE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CSE • CSE: Carrier Sense Errors An 8-bit register counting the number of frames transmitted where carrier sense was not seen during transmission or where carrier sense was deasserted after being asserted in a transmit frame without collision (no underrun). Only incremented in half-duplex mode. The only effect of a carrier sense error is to increment this register. The behavior of the other statistics registers is unaffected by the detection of a carrier sense error. 649 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.26.13 Receive Resource Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_RRE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 RRE 7 6 5 4 RRE • RRE: Receive Resource Errors A 16-bit register counting the number of frames that were address matched but could not be copied to memory because no receive buffer was available. 39.5.26.14 Receive Overrun Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_ROVR Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ROVR • ROVR: Receive Overrun An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that are address recognized but were not copied to memory due to a receive DMA overrun. 650 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.26.15 Receive Symbol Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_RSE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSE • RSE: Receive Symbol Errors An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that had rx_er asserted during reception. Receive symbol errors are also counted as an FCS or alignment error if the frame is between 64 and 1518 bytes in length (1536 if bit 8 is set in the network configuration register). If the frame is larger, it is recorded as a jabber error. 39.5.26.16 Excessive Length Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_ELE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EXL • EXL: Excessive Length Errors An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received exceeding 1518 bytes (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register) in length but do not have either a CRC error, an alignment error nor a receive symbol error. 651 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.26.17 Receive Jabbers Register Register Name: EMAC_RJA Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RJB • RJB: Receive Jabbers An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received exceeding 1518 bytes (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register) in length and have either a CRC error, an alignment error or a receive symbol error. 39.5.26.18 Undersize Frames Register Register Name: EMAC_USF Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 USF • USF: Undersize Frames An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received less than 64 bytes in length but do not have either a CRC error, an alignment error or a receive symbol error. 652 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 39.5.26.19 SQE Test Errors Register Register Name: EMAC_STE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SQER • SQER: SQE Test Errors An 8-bit register counting the number of frames where ECOL was not asserted within 96 bit times (an interframe gap) of tx_en being deasserted in half duplex mode. 653 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.5.26.20 Received Length Field Mismatch Register Register Name: EMAC_RLE Access Type: Read-write 31 – 30 – 29 – 28 – 27 – 26 – 25 – 24 – 23 – 22 – 21 – 20 – 19 – 18 – 17 – 16 – 15 – 14 – 13 – 12 – 11 – 10 – 9 – 8 – 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RLFM • RLFM: Receive Length Field Mismatch An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received that have a measured length shorter than that extracted from its length field. Checking is enabled through bit 16 of the network configuration register. Frames containing a type ID in bytes 13 and 14 (i.e., length/type ID ≥ 0x0600) are not counted as length field errors, neither are excessive length frames. 654 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 40. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Electrical Characteristics 40.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 40-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings* Operating Temperature (Industrial).........-40° C to + 85° C Storage Temperature............................-60°C to + 150°C Voltage on Input Pins with Respect to Ground...........................-0.3V to + 5.5V Maximum Operating Voltage (VDDCORE, and VDDPLL)........................................2.0V *NOTICE: Stresses beyond those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Maximum Operating Voltage (VDDIO, VDDIN and VDDFLASH)..............................4.0V Total DC Output Current on all I/O lines 100-lead LQFP package........................................200 mA 655 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.2 DC Characteristics The following characteristics are applicable to the operating temperature range: TA = -40°C to 85°C, unless otherwise specified. Table 40-2. DC Characteristics Symbol Parameter VVDDCORE DC Supply Core VVDDPLL Max Units 1.65 1.95 V DC Supply PLL 1.65 1.95 V VVDDIO DC Supply I/Os 3.0 3.6 V VVDDFLASH DC Supply Flash 3.0 3.6 V VIL Input Low-level Voltage VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V -0.3 0.8 V VIH Input High-level Voltage VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V 2.0 5.5 V IO = 8 mA, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V 0.4 V IO = 0.3 mA, (CMOS) VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V 0.1 V IO = 1.5 mA, VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V 0.2 V IO = 0.3 mA, (CMOS) VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V 0.1 V VOL VOH ILEAK IPULLUP Output Low-level Voltage Output High-level Voltage Input Leakage Current Input Pull-up Current Conditions VDDIO - 0.4 V IO = 0.3 mA, (CMOS) VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V VDDIO - 0.1 V IO = 1.5 mA, VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V VDDIO - 0.2 V IO = 0.3 mA, VVDDIO (CMOS) from 1.65V to 1.95V VDDIO - 0.1 V PA0-PA3, Pull-up resistors disabled (Typ: TA = 25°C, Max: TA = 85°C) 40 400 nA Other PIOs and NRST, Pull-up resistors disabled (Typ: TA = 25°C, Max: TA = 85°C) 20 200 nA PB27-PB30, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, PAx connected to ground 10 20.6 60 µA Other PIOs and NRST, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, PAx connected to ground 143 321 600 µA 135 295 550 µA 13.9 pF Input Pull-down Current, (TST, ERASE, JTAGSEL) VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, Pins connected to VVDDIO CIN Input Capacitance 100 LQFP Package On VVDDCORE = 1.85V, MCK = 500Hz IO TSLOPE Static Current All inputs driven at 1 (AT91SAM7XC512/256/128) (including TMS, TDI, TCK, NRST) Flash in standby mode All peripherals off Output Current Typ IO = 8 mA, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V IPULLDOWN ISC Min TA = 25°C 12 60 µA TA = 85°C 100 400 PA0-PA3, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V 16 mA PB27-PB30 and NRST, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V 2 mA Other PIOs, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V 8 mA Supply Core Slope 6 V/ms Note that even during startup, VVDDFLASH must always be superior or equal to VVDDCORE. 656 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 40-3. 1.8V Voltage Regulator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Units VVDDIN Supply Voltage 3.0 3.3 3.6 V VVDDOUT Output Voltage IO = 20 mA 1.81 1.85 1.89 V IVDDIN Current consumption After startup, no load 90 After startup, Idle mode, no load 10 µA 25 µA TSTART Startup Time Cload = 2.2 µF, after VDDIN > 2.7V 150 µS IO Maximum DC Output Current VDDIN = 3.3V 100 mA IO Maximum DC Output Current VDDIN = 3.3V, in Idle Mode 1 mA Table 40-4. Brownout Detector Characteristics Symbol Parameter VBOT18- VDDCORE Threshold Level VHYST18 VDDCORE Hysteresis VBOT33- VDDFLASH Threshold Level VHYST33 VDDFLASH Hysteresis IDD Current Consumption TSTART Startup Time Table 40-5. Typ Max Units 1.65 1.68 1.71 V 50 65 mV 2.80 2.90 V VHYST33 = VBOT33+ - VBOT33- 70 120 mV BOD on (GPNVM0 bit active) 24 30 µA 1 µA 200 µs VHYST18 = VBOT18+ - VBOT182.70 100 DC Flash Characteristics AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Parameter TPU Power-up delay ICC Min BOD off (GPNVM0 bit inactive) Symbol ISB Conditions Conditions Min Max Units 45 µS @25°C onto VDDCORE = 1.8V onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V 10 30 µA @85°C onto VDDCORE = 1.8V onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V 10 120 µA Random Read @ 30MHz onto VDDCORE = 1.8V onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V 3.0 0.8 mA Write (one bank for AT91SAMX512) onto VDDCORE = 1.8V onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V 400 5.5 µA mA Standby current Active current 657 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.3 Power Consumption • Typical power consumption of PLLs, Slow Clock and Main Oscillator. • Power consumption of power supply in two different modes: Active and ultra Low-power. • Power consumption by peripheral: calculated as the difference in current measurement after having enabled then disabled the corresponding clock. 40.3.1 Power Consumption Versus Modes The values in Table 40-6 and Table 40-7 on page 660 are measured values of the power consumption with operating conditions as follows: • VDDIO = VDDIN = VDDFLASH= 3.3V • VDDCORE = VDDPLL = 1.85V • TA = 25° C • There is no consumption on the I/Os of the device Figure 40-1. Measure Schematics VDDFLASH VDDIO VDDIN 3.3V Voltage Regulator AMP1 VDDOUT AMP2 1.8V VDDCORE VDDPLL 658 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary These figures represent the power consumption typically measured on the power supplies.. Table 40-6. Power Consumption for Different Modes Mode Conditions Active (AT91SAM7XC512/256/128) Ultra Low Power(2) Notes: Consumption Unit Voltage regulator is on. Brown Out Detector is activated. Flash is read. ARM Core clock is 50MHz. Analog-to-Digital Converter activated. All peripheral clocks activated. USB transceiver enabled. onto AMP1 onto AMP2 50 49 mA Voltage regulator is in Low-power mode. Brown Out Detector is de-activated. Flash is in standby mode.(1) ARM Core in idle mode. MCK @ 500Hz. Analog-to-Digital Converter de-activated. All peripheral clocks de-activated. USB transceiver disabled. DDM and DDP pins connected to ground. onto AMP1 onto AMP2 26 12 µA 1. “Flash is in standby mode”, means the Flash is not accessed at all. 2. Low power consumption figures stated above cannot be guaranteed when accesing the Flash in Ultra Low Power mode. In order to meet given low power consumption figures, it is recommended to either stop the processor or jump to SRAM. 659 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.3.2 Peripheral Power Consumption in Active Mode Table 40-7. Power Consumption on VDDCORE(1) Peripheral PIO Controller 12 USART 28 UDP 20 PWM 16 TWI 5 SPI 16 SSC 32 Timer Counter Channels 6 CAN 75 ARM7TDMI 160 EMAC 120 AES 123 TDES 25 System Peripherals (AT91SAM7XC512/256/128) 200 Note: 40.4 Consumption (Typ) Unit µA/MHz 1. Note: VDDCORE = 1.85V, TA = 25° C Crystal Oscillators Characteristics 40.4.1 RC Oscillator Characteristics Table 40-8. RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions 1/(tCPRC) RC Oscillator Frequency VDDPLL = 1.65V Duty Cycle Min Typ Max Unit 22 32 42 kHz 45 50 55 % tST Startup Time VDDPLL = 1.65V 75 µs IOSC Current Consumption After Startup Time 1.9 µA 660 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 40.4.2 Main Oscillator Characteristics Table 40-9. Main Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions 1/(tCPMAIN) Crystal Oscillator Frequency CL1, CL2 Internal Load Capacitance (CL1 = CL2) CL (6) Equivalent Load Capacitance Min Typ Max Unit 3 16 20 MHz Integrated Load Capacitance ((XIN or XOUT)) 34 40 46 pF Integrated Load Capacitance (XIN and XOUT in series) 17 20 23 pF 30 50 70 % Duty Cycle tST Startup Time VDDPLL = 1.2 to 2V CS = 3 pF(1) 1/(tCPMAIN) = 3 MHz CS = 7 pF(1) 1/(tCPMAIN) = 16 MHz CS = 7 pF(1) 1/(tCPMAIN) = 20 MHz IDDST Standby Current Consumption Standby mode 1 µA Drive level @3 MHz @8 MHz @16 MHz @20 MHz 15 30 50 50 µW IDD ON Current dissipation @3 MHz (2) @8 MHz (3) @16 MHz (4) @20 MHz (5) 250 250 450 550 µA CLEXT (6) Maximum external capacitor on XIN and XOUT 10 pF PON Notes: 14.5 1.4 1 150 150 300 400 ms 1. CS is the shunt capacitance. 2. RS = 100-200 Ω; CSHUNT = 2.0 - 2.5 pF; CM = 2 – 1.5 fF (typ, worst case) using 1 K ohm serial resistor on xout. 3. RS = 50-100 Ω; CSHUNT = 2.0 - 2.5 pF; CM = 4 - 3 fF (typ, worst case). 4. RS = 25-50 Ω; CSHUNT = 2.5 - 3.0 pF; CM = 7 -5 fF (typ, worst case). 5. RS = 20-50 Ω; CSHUNT = 3.2 - 4.0 pF; CM = 10 - 8 fF (typ, worst case). 6. CL and CLEXT → AT91SAM7XC CL XIN CLEXT XOUT CLEXT 661 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.4.3 Crystal Characteristics Table 40-10. Crystal Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions ESR Equivalent Series Resistor Rs Fundamental @3 MHz Fundamental @8 MHz Fundamental @16 MHz Fundamental @20 MHz CM CSHUNT 40.4.4 Min Typ Max Unit 200 100 80 50 W Motional capacitance 8 fF Shunt capacitance 7 pF XIN Clock Characteristics Table 40-11. XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics Symbol Parameter 1/(tCPXIN) XIN Clock Frequency (1) tCPXIN XIN Clock Period (1) 20.0 ns XIN Clock High Half-period (1) 8.0 ns tCLXIN XIN Clock Low Half-period (1) 8.0 ns tCLCH Rise Time (1) 400 ns Fall Time (1) 400 ns XIN Input Capacitance (1) 46 pF RIN XIN Pull-down Resistor (1) 500 kΩ VXIN_IL VXIN Input Low-level Voltage (1) -0.3 0.2 x VDDPLL V VXIN Input High-level Voltage (1) 0.8 x VDDPLL 1.95 V Bypass Current Consumption (1) 15 µW/MHz tCHXIN tCHCL CIN VXIN_IH IDDBP Note: Conditions Min Max Units 50.0 MHz 1. These characteristics apply only when the Main Oscillator is in bypass mode (i.e., when MOSCEN = 0 and OSCBYPASS = 1 in the CKGR_MOR register, see the Clock Generator Main Oscillator Register. Figure 40-2. XIN CLock Timing tCLCH tCPXIN tCHXIN tCHCL VXIN_IH VXIN_IL tCPXIN tCPXIN 662 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 40.5 PLL Characteristics Table 40-12. Phase Lock Loop Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions FOUT Output Frequency Field out of CKGR_PLL is: FIN Input Frequency IPLL Current Consumption Note: Min Typ Max Unit 00 80 160 MHz 10 150 200 MHz 1 32 MHz Active mode 4 mA Standby mode 1 µA Startup time depends on PLL RC filter. A calculation tool is provided by Atmel. 663 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.6 USB Transceiver Characteristics 40.6.1 Electrical Characteristics Table 40-13. Electrical Parameters Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit 0.8 V Input Levels VIL Low Level VIH High Level VDI Differential Input Sensitivity VCM Differential Input Common Mode Range CIN Transceiver capacitance Capacitance to ground on each line I Hi-Z State Data Line Leakage 0V < VIN < 3.3V REXT Recommended External USB Series Resistor In series with each USB pin with ±5% |(D+) - (D-)| 2.0 V 0.2 V 0.8 -10 2.5 V 9.18 pF +10 µA Ω 27 Output Levels VOL Low Level Output Measured with RL of 1.425 kOhm tied to 3.6V 0.0 0.3 V VOH High Level Output Measured with RL of 14.25 kOhm tied to GND 2.8 3.6 V VCRS Output Signal Crossover Voltage Measure conditions described in Figure 40-3 1.3 2.0 V 105 200 µA 80 150 µA Typ Max Unit Consumption IVDDIO Current Consumption IVDDCORE Current Consumption 40.6.2 Transceiver enabled in input mode DDP=1 and DDM=0 Switching Characteristics Table 40-14. In Full Speed Symbol Parameter Conditions tFR Transition Rise Time CLOAD = 50 pF 4 20 ns tFE Transition Fall Time CLOAD = 50 pF 4 20 ns tFRFM Rise/Fall time Matching 90 111.11 % 664 Min AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 40-3. USB Data Signal Rise and Fall Times Rise Time Fall Time 90% VCRS 10% Differential Data Lines 10% tR tF (a) REXT=27 ohms Fosc = 6MHz/750kHz Buffer Cload (b) 665 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.7 ADC Characteristics Table 40-15. Channel Conversion Time and ADC Clock Parameter Conditions ADC Clock Frequency ADC Clock Frequency Startup Time Min Max Units 10-bit resolution mode 5 MHz 8-bit resolution mode 8 MHz Return from Idle Mode 20 µs Track and Hold Acquisition Time Typ 600 ns Conversion Time ADC Clock = 5 MHz Conversion Time ADC Clock = 8 MHz 1.25 µs Throughput Rate ADC Clock = 5 MHz 384(1) kSPS Throughput Rate ADC Clock = 8 MHz 533(2) kSPS Notes: 2 µs 1. Corresponds to 13 clock cycles at 5 MHz: 3 clock cycles for track and hold acquisition time and 10 clock cycles for conversion. 2. Corresponds to 15 clock cycles at 8 MHz: 5 clock cycles for track and hold acquisition time and 10 clock cycles for conversion. Table 40-16. External Voltage Reference Input Parameter Conditions Min ADVREF Input Voltage Range ADVREF Input Voltage Range 8-bit resolution mode ADVREF Average Current On 13 samples with ADC Clock = 5 MHz Max Units 2.6 VDDIN V 2.5 VDDIN V Current Consumption on VDDIN Typ 200 250 µA 0.55 1 mA Typ Max Units Table 40-17. Analog Inputs Parameter Min Input Voltage Range 0 VADVREF Input Leakage Current 1 Input Capacitance 12 µA 14 pF The user can drive ADC input with impedance up to: • ZOUT ≤ (SHTIM -470) x 10 in 8-bit resolution mode • ZOUT ≤ (SHTIM -589) x 7.69 in 10-bit resolution mode with SHTIM (Sample and Hold Time register) expressed in ns and ZOUT expressed in ohms. Table 40-18. Transfer Characteristics Parameter Conditions Resolution Min Typ Max 10 Integral Non-linearity Units Bit ±2 LSB ±1 LSB Offset Error ±2 LSB Gain Error ±2 LSB Absolute Accuracy ±4 LSB Differential Non-linearity No missing code For more information on data converter terminology, please refer to the application note: Data Converter Terminology, Atmel lit° 6022. 666 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 40.8 AC Characteristics 40.8.1 Master Clock Characteristics Table 40-19. Master Clock Waveform Parameters Symbol Parameter Conditions 1/(tCPMCK) Master Clock Frequency Min Max Units 55 MHz 40.8.2 I/O Characteristics Criteria used to define the maximum frequency of the I/Os: • output duty cycle (30%-70%) • minimum output swing: 100mV to VDDIO - 100 mV • Addition of rising and falling time inferior to 75% of the period Table 40-20. I/O Characteristics Symbol Parameter FreqMaxI01 Pin Group 1 (1) frequency PulseminHI01 PulseminLI01 Conditions Pin Group 1 (1) Pin Group 1 (1) High Level Pulse Width Low Level Pulse Width FreqMaxI02 Pin Group 2 (2) frequency PulseminHI02 Pin Group 2 (2) High Level Pulse Width PulseminLI02 FreqMaxI03 PulseminHI03 PulseminLI03 Notes: Load: 40 pF(4) Pin Group 3 (3) Pin Group 3 (3) Pin Group 3 (3) frequency High Level Pulse Width Low Level Pulse Width Max Units 12.5 MHz (4) 40 ns (4) 40 ns Load: 40 pF Load: 40 pF (4) Load: 40 pF 25 MHz Load: 20 pF(5) 30 MHz Load: 40 pF(4) 20 ns (5) 10 ns (4) Load: 40 pF 20 ns Load: 20 pF(5) 10 ns Load: 20 pF Pin Group 2 (2) Low Level Pulse Width Min (4) Load: 40 pF 30 MHz (4) 16.6 ns (4) 16.6 ns Load: 40 pF Load: 40 pF 1. Pin Group 1 = PB27 to PB30 2. Pin Group 2 = PA4 to PA30 and PB0 to PB30 3. Pin Group 3 = PA0 to PA3 4. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40pF 5. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 20pF 667 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.8.3 SPI Characteristics Figure 40-4. SPI Master mode with (CPOL = NCPHA =0) or (CPOL = NCPHA =1) SPCK SPI0 SPI1 MISO SPI2 MOSI Figure 40-5. SPI Master mode with (CPOL=0 and NCPHA=1) or (CPOL=1 and NCPHA=0) SPCK SPI3 SPI4 MISO SPI5 MOSI Figure 40-6. SPI Slave mode with (CPOL=0 and NCPHA=1) or (CPOL=1 and NCPHA=0) SPCK SPI6 MISO SPI7 SPI8 MOSI 668 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 40-7. SPI Slave mode with (CPOL = NCPHA = 0) or (CPOL= NCPHA= 1) SPCK SPI9 MISO SPI10 SPI11 MOSI Table 40-21. SPI Timings Symbol SPI0 SPI1 SPI2 SPI3 SPI4 Parameter Conditions MISO Setup time before SPCK rises (master) MISO Hold time after SPCK rises (master) SPCK rising to MOSI Delay (master) MISO Setup time before SPCK falls (master) MISO Hold time after SPCK falls (master) (1) 3.3V domain (1) 3.3V domain 3.3V domain (1) 3.3V domain (1) 3.3V domain (1) (1) Min Max (2) 28.5 + (tCPMCK)/2 Units ns 0 ns 2 (2) 26.5 + (tCPMCK)/2 ns ns 0 ns SPI5 SPCK falling to MOSI Delay (master) 3.3V domain SPI6 SPCK falling to MISO Delay (slave) 3.3V domain (1) SPI7 MOSI Setup time before SPCK rises (slave) 3.3V domain (1) 2 ns 3.3V domain (1) 3 ns 3.3V domain (1) 3.3V domain (1) 3 ns 3.3V domain (1) 3 ns SPI8 SPI9 SPI10 SPI11 Notes: MOSI Hold time after SPCK rises (slave) SPCK rising to MISO Delay (slave) MOSI Setup time before SPCK falls (slave) MOSI Hold time after SPCK falls (slave) 2 ns 28 ns 28 ns 1. 3.3V domain: VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40 pF. 2. tCPMCK: Master Clock period in ns. Note that in SPI master mode the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 does not sample the data (MISO) on the opposite edge where data clocks out (MOSI) but the same edge is used as shown in Figure 40-4 and Figure 40-5. 669 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.8.4 EMAC Characteristics Table 40-22. EMAC Signals Symbol Parameter Conditions EMAC1 Setup for EMDIO from EMDC rising Load: 20pF EMAC2 Hold for EMDIO from EMDC rising Load: 20pF(2) EMAC3 EMDIO toggling from EMDC falling Load: 20pF(2) Notes: Min (ns) (2) Max (ns) 2 ((1/f)-19) + 4(1) 4.5 1. f: MCK frequency (MHz) 2. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 20 pF Table 40-23. EMAC MII Specific Signals Symbol Parameter EMAC4 Setup for ECOL from ETXCK rising Hold for ECOL from ETXCK rising EMAC5 EMAC6 Setup for ECRS from ETXCK rising Conditions Min (ns) Load: 20pF (1) 0 Load: 20pF (1) 2 Load: 20pF (1) 1.5 (1) 2 Max (ns) EMAC7 Hold for ECRS from ETXCK rising Load: 20pF EMAC8 ETXER toggling from ETXCK rising Load: 20pF (1) 25 EMAC9 ETXEN toggling from ETXCK rising Load: 20pF (1) 25 Load: 20pF (1) 25 (1) 0 EMAC10 ETX toggling from ETXCK rising EMAC11 Setup for ERX from ERXCK Load: 20pF EMAC12 Hold for ERX from ERXCK Load: 20pF (1) 4 Load: 20pF (1) 0 Load: 20pF (1) 4 (1) 2 2 EMAC13 EMAC14 Setup for ERXER from ERXCK Hold for ERXER from ERXCK EMAC15 Setup for ERXDV from ERXCK Load: 20pF EMAC16 Hold for ERXDV from ERXCK Load: 20pF (1) Note: 670 1. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 20 pF AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Figure 40-8. EMAC MII Mode EMDC EMAC1 EMAC3 EMAC2 EMDIO EMAC4 EMAC5 EMAC6 EMAC7 ECOL ECRS ETXCK EMAC8 ETXER EMAC9 ETXEN EMAC10 ETX[3:0] ERXCK EMAC11 EMAC12 ERX[3:0] EMAC13 EMAC14 EMAC15 EMAC16 ERXER ERXDV 671 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Table 40-24. EMAC RMII Specific Signals (pertains only to AT91SAM7XC512) Symbol Parameter Min (ns) Max (ns) EMAC21 ETXEN toggling from EREFCK rising 4.9 14.2 EMAC22 ETX toggling from EREFCK rising 4.4 15.9 EMAC23 Setup for ERX from EREFCK 0.5 EMAC24 Hold for ERX from EREFCK 0 EMAC25 Setup for ERXER from EREFCK 1.5 EMAC26 Hold for ERXER from EREFCK 0 EMAC27 Setup for ECRSDV from EREFCK 2 EMAC28 Hold for ECRSDV from EREFCK 0 Figure 40-9. EMAC RMII Mode EREFCK EMAC21 ETXEN EMAC22 ETX[1:0] EMAC23 EMAC24 ERX[1:0] EMAC25 EMAC26 EMAC27 EMAC28 ERXER ECRSDV 672 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 40.8.5 Embedded Flash Characteristics The maximum operating frequency is given in Table 40-25 but it is limited by the Embedded Flash access time when the processor is fetching code out of it. Table 40-25 give the device maximum operating frequency depending on the field FWS of the MC_FMR register. This field defines the number of wait states required to access the Embedded Flash Memory. Table 40-25. Embedded Flash Wait States (AT91SAM7XC256/128) FWS Read Operations Maximum Operating Frequency (MHz) 0 1 cycle 30 1 2 cycles 55 2 3 cycles 55 3 4 cycles 55 Table 40-26. AC Flash Characteristics Parameter Conditions Min Max Units per page including auto-erase 6 ms per page without auto-erase 3 ms Program Cycle Time Full Chip Erase 15 ms 673 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 40.8.6 JTAG/ICE Timings 40.8.6.1 ICE Interface Signals Table 40-27. ICE Interface Timing Specification Symbol Conditions Min TCK Low Half-period (1) 51 ns TCK High Half-period (1) 51 ns ICE2 TCK Period (1) 102 ns ICE3 TDI, TMS, Setup before TCK High (1) 0 ns ICE4 TDI, TMS, Hold after TCK High (1) 3 ns TDO Hold Time (1) 13 ns TCK Low to TDO Valid (1) ICE0 ICE1 ICE5 ICE6 Note: Parameter Max 20 Units ns 1. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40pF Figure 40-10. ICE Interface Signals ICE2 TCK ICE0 ICE1 TMS/TDI ICE3 ICE4 TDO ICE5 ICE6 674 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 40.8.6.2 JTAG Interface Signals Table 40-28. JTAG Interface Timing specification Symbol JTAG0 JTAG1 JTAG2 JTAG3 JTAG4 JTAG5 JTAG6 JTAG7 JTAG8 JTAG9 JTAG10 Note: Parameter Conditions Min TCK Low Half-period (1) Max 6.5 ns TCK High Half-period (1) 5.5 ns TCK Period (1) 12 ns TDI, TMS Setup before TCK High (1) 2 ns TDI, TMS Hold after TCK High (1) 3 ns TDO Hold Time (1) 4 ns TCK Low to TDO Valid (1) Device Inputs Setup Time (1) 0 ns Device Inputs Hold Time (1) 3 ns Device Outputs Hold Time (1) 6 ns TCK to Device Outputs Valid (1) 16 18 Units ns ns 1. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40pF Figure 40-11. JTAG Interface Signals JTAG2 TCK JTAG JTAG1 0 TMS/TDI JTAG3 JTAG4 JTAG7 JTAG8 TDO JTAG5 JTAG6 Device Inputs Device Outputs JTAG9 JTAG10 675 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 41. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Mechanical Characteristics 41.1 Package Drawings Figure 41-1. LQFP Package Drawing 676 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table 41-1. 100-lead LQFP Package Dimensions Millimeter Symbol Min Nom A Inch Max Min Nom 1.60 A1 0.05 A2 1.35 D 1.40 0.63 0.15 0.002 1.45 0.053 0.006 0.055 16.00 BSC 0.630 BSC D1 14.00 BSC 0.551 BSC E 16.00 BSC 0.630 BSC E1 14.00 BSC R2 0.08 R1 0.08 Q 0° 0° 13° 0° 12° 12° 11° L 0.45 L1 0.20 b 0.17 e 3.5° 7° 11° 12° 13° 12° 0° 0.60 13° 11° 0.20 0.004 0.75 0.018 1.00 REF S 0.008 0.003 7° 11° 0.09 0.003 3.5° θ1 θ3 0.057 0.551 BSC 0.20 θ2 c Max 13° 0.008 0.024 0.030 0.039 REF 0.008 0.20 0.27 0.007 0.008 0.50 BSC 0.020 BSC D2 12.00 0.472 E2 12.00 0.472 0.011 Tolerances of Form and Position aaa 0.20 0.008 bbb 0.20 0.008 ccc 0.08 0.003 ddd 0.08 0.003 677 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Figure 41-2. 100-TFBGA Package Drawing All dimensions are in mm Table 41-2. Device and LQFP Package Maximum Weight AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Table 41-3. 800 mg Package Reference JEDEC Drawing Reference MS-026 JESD97 Classification e3 Table 41-4. LQFP Package Characteristics Moisture Sensitivity Level 3 This package respects the recommendations of the NEMI User Group. 678 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 41.2 Soldering Profile Table 41-5 gives the recommended soldering profile from J-STD-020C. Table 41-5. Soldering Profile Profile Feature Green Package Average Ramp-up Rate (217°C to Peak) 3° C/sec. max. Preheat Temperature 175°C ±25°C 180 sec. max. Temperature Maintained Above 217°C 60 sec. to 150 sec. Time within 5° C of Actual Peak Temperature 20 sec. to 40 sec. Peak Temperature Range 260° C Ramp-down Rate 6° C/sec. max. Time 25° C to Peak Temperature 8 min. max. Note: The package is certified to be backward compatible with Pb/Sn soldering profile. A maximum of three reflow passes is allowed per component. 679 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 42. AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information Table 42-1. Ordering Information Temperature Operating Range MLR A Ordering Code MLR B Ordering Code Package Package Type AT91SAM7XC512-AU AT91SAM7XC512-CU – LQFP 100 TFBGA 100 Green Industrial (-40° C to 85° C) AT91SAM7XC256-AU AT91SAM7XC256-CU AT91SAM7XC256B-AU AT91SAM7XC256B-CU LQFP 100 TFBGA 100 Green Industrial (-40° C to 85° C) AT91SAM7XC128-AU AT91SAM7XC128-CU AT91SAM7XC128B-AU AT91SAM7XC128B-CU LQFP 100 TFBGA 100 Green Industrial (-40° C to 85° C) 43. Export Regulations Statement These commodities, technology or software will be exported from France and the applicable Export Administration Regulations will apply. French, United States and other relevant laws, regulations and requirements regarding the export of products may restrict sale, export and reexport of these products; please assure you conduct your activities in accordance with the applicable relevant export regulations. 680 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44. Errata 44.1 Marking All devices are marked with the Atmel logo and the ordering code. Additional marking has the following format: YYWW V XXXXXXXXX ARM where • “YY”: manufactory year • “WW”: manufactory week • “V”: revision • “XXXXXXXXX”: lot number 681 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.2 AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts Refer to Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 681. 44.2.1 44.2.1.1 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ADC: DRDY Bit Cleared The DRDY Flag should be clear only after a read of ADC_LCDR (Last Converted Data Register). A read of any ADC_CDRx register (Channel Data Register) automatically clears the DRDY flag. Problem Fix/Workaround: None 44.2.1.2 ADC: DRDY not Cleared on Disable When reading LCDR at the same instant as an end of conversion, with DRDY already active, DRDY is kept active regardless of the enable status of the current channel. This sets DRDY, whereas new data is not stored. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.1.3 ADC: DRDY Possibly Skipped due to CDR Read Reading CDR for channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with EOC[x] already active, leads to skipping to set the DRDY flag if channel "x" is enabled. Problem Fix/Workaround Use of DRDY functionality with access to CDR registers should be avoided. 44.2.1.4 ADC: Possible Skip on DRDY when Disabling a Channel DRDY does not rise when disabling channel "y" at the same time as an end of "x" channel conversion, although data is stored into CDRx and LCDR. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.1.5 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Updated Read of the Status Register at the same instant as an end of conversion leads to skipping the update of the GOVRE (general overrun) flag. GOVRE is neither reset nor set. For example, if reading the status while an end of conversion is occurring and: 1. GOVRE is active but DRDY is inactive, does not correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not reset. 2. GOVRE is inactive but DRDY is active, does correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not set. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.1.6 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Reading CDR When reading CDRy (Channel Data Register y) at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with the following conditions: • EOC[x] already active, 682 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • DRDY already active, • GOVRE inactive, • previous data stored in LCDR being neither data from channel "y", nor data from channel "x". GOVRE should be set but is not. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.1.7 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Disabling a Channel When disabling channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x", EOC[x] and DRDY being already active, GOVRE does not rise. Note: OVRE[x] rises as expected. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.1.8 ADC: OVRE Flag Behavior When the OVRE flag (on channel i) has been set but the related EOC status (of channel i) has been cleared (by a read of CDRi or LCDR), reading the Status register at the same instant as an end of conversion (causing the set of EOC status on channel i), does not lead to a reset of the OVRE flag (on channel i) as expected. Problem Fix/Workaround: None 44.2.1.9 ADC: EOC Set although Channel Disabled If a channel is disabled while a conversion is running and if a read of CDR is performed at the same time as an end of conversion of any channel occurs, the EOC of the channel with the conversion running may rise (whereas it has been disabled). Problem Fix/Workaround Do not take into account the EOC of a disabled channel 44.2.1.10 ADC: Spurious Clear of EOC Flag If "x" and "y" are two successively converted channels and "z" is yet another enabled channel ("z" being neither "x" nor "y"), reading CDR on channel "z" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "y" automatically clears EOC[x] instead of EOC[z]. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.1.11 ADC: Sleep Mode If Sleep mode is activated while there is no activity (no conversion is being performed), it will take effect only after a conversion occurs. Problem Fix/Workaround To activate sleep mode as soon as possible, it is recommended to write successively, ADC Mode Register (SLEEP) then ADC Control Register (START bit field); to start an analog-to-digital conversion, in order put ADC into sleep mode at the end of this conversion. 683 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.2.2 44.2.2.1 Controller Area Network (CAN) CAN: Low Power Mode and Error Frame If the Low Power Mode is activated while the CAN is generating an error frame, this error frame may be shortened. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.2.2 CAN: Low Power Mode and Pending Transmit Messages No pending transmit messages may be sent once the CAN Controller enters Low-power Mode. Problem Fix/Workaround Check that all messages have been sent by reading the related Flags before entering Lowpower Mode. 44.2.3 44.2.3.1 Ethernet MAC (EMAC) EMAC: RMII Mode RMII mode is not functional. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.3.2 EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR If an event occurs within the same clock cycle in which the EMAC_ISR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared even though it has not been read at 1. This might lead to the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround Each time the software reads EMAC_ISR, it has to check the contents of the Transmit Status Register (EMAC_TSR), the Receive Status Register (EMAC_RSR) and the Network Status Register (EMAC_NSR), as the possible lost event is still notified in one of these registers. 44.2.3.3 EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block If an event occurs within the same clock cycle during which a statistics register is read, the corresponding counter might lose this event. This might lead to the loss of the incrementation of one for this counter. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.2.4 44.2.4.1 Peripheral Input/Output (PIO) PIO: Leakage on PB27 - PB30 When PB27, PB28, PB29 or PB30 (the I/O lines multiplexed with the analog inputs) are set as digital inputs with pull-up disabled, the leakage can be 9 µA in worst case and 90 nA in typical case per I/O when the I/O is set externally at low level. Problem Fix/Workaround Set the I/O to VDDIO by internal or external pull-up. 684 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44.2.4.2 PIO: Electrical Characteristics on NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26 When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, the voltage of the I/O stabilizes at VPull-up. Vpull-up VPull-up Min VPull-up Max VDDIO - 0.65 V VDDIO - 0.45 V This condition causes a leakage through VDDIO. This leakage is 45 µA per pad in worst case at 3.3 V. I Leakage Parameter Typ Max I Leakage at 3,3V 2.5 µA 45 µA Problem Fix/Workaround It is recommended to use an external pull-up if needed. 44.2.4.3 PIO: Drive Low NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26 When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, driving the I/O with an output impedance higher than 500 ohms may not drive the I/O to a logical zero. Problem Fix/Workaround Output impedance must be lower than 500 ohms. 44.2.5 44.2.5.1 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) PWM: Update when PWM_CCNTx = 0 or 1 If the Channel Counter Register value is 0 or 1, the Channel Period Register or Channel Duty Cycle Register is directly modified when writing the Channel Update Register. Problem Fix/Workaround Check the Channel Counter Register before writing the update register. 44.2.5.2 PWM: Update when PWM_CPRDx = 0 When Channel Period Register equals 0, the period update is not operational. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not write 0 in the period register. 44.2.5.3 PWM: Counter Start Value In left aligned mode, the first start value of the counter is 0. For the other periods, the counter starts at 1. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.5.4 PWM: Behavior of CHIDx Status Bits in the PWM_SR Register Erratic behavior of the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR Register. When a channel is disabled by writing in the PWM_DIS Register just after enabling it (before completion of a Clock Period of 685 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 the clock selected for the channel), the PWM line is internally disabled but the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR stays at 1. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not disable a channel before completion of one period of the selected clock. 44.2.6 44.2.6.1 Real Time Timer (RTT) RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle during which the RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This can lead to the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround: The software must handle the RTT event as an interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR. 44.2.7 44.2.7.1 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) SPI: Bad tx_ready Behavior when CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1 If the SPI2 is programmed with CSAAT = 1, SCBR(baudrate) = 1 and two transfers are performed consecutively on the same slave with an IDLE state between them, the tx_ready signal does not rise after the second data has been transferred in the shifter. This can imply for example, that the second data is sent twice. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use the combination CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1. 44.2.7.2 SPI: LASTXFER (Last Transfer) Behavior In FIXED Mode, with CSAAT bit set, and in “PDC mode” the Chip Select can rise depending on the data written in the SPI_TDR when the TX_EMPTY flag is set. If for example, the PDC writes a “1” in the bit 24 (LASTXFER bit) of the SPI_TDR, the chip select will rise as soon as the TXEMPTY flag is set. Problem Fix/Workaround Use the CS in PIO mode when PDC mode is required and CS has to be maintained between transfers. 44.2.7.3 SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode SPCK pin can toggle out before the first transfer in Master Mode. Problem Fix/Workaround In Master Mode, MSTR bit must be set (in SPI_MR register) before configuring SPI_CSRx registers. 44.2.7.4 SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode In fixed Mode, if a transfer is performed through a PDC on a Chip select different from the Chip select 0, the output spi_size sampled by the PDC will depend on the field, BITS (Bits per Transfer) of SPI_CSR0 register, whatever the selected Chip select is. For example, if SPI_CSR0 is configured for a 10-bit transfer whereas SPI_CSR1 is configured for an 8-bit transfer, when a transfer is performed in Fixed mode through the PDC, on Chip select 1, the transfer will be considered as a HalfWord transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround 686 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary If a PDC transfer has to be performed in 8 bits, on a Chip select y (y as different from 0), the BITS field of the SPI_CSR0 must be configured in 8 bits, in the same way as the BITS field of the CSRy Register. 44.2.7.5 SPI: Baudrate Set to 1 When Baudrate is set at 1 (i.e. when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and when the BITS field of the SPI_CSR register (number of bits to be transmitted) equals an ODD value (in this case 9,11,13 or 15), an additional pulse will be generated on output SPCK. Everything is OK if the BITS field equals 8,10,12,14 or 16 and Baudrate = 1. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.7.6 SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select Bad Serial clock generation on the 2nd chip select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0. This occurs using SPI with the following conditions: • Master Mode • CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0 • Multiple chip selects are used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with SCBR are not equal to 1 • Transmitting with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one, then an additional pulse is generated on output SPCK during the second transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if NCPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1. If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear. 44.2.8 44.2.8.1 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode If the Least Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0), the first TAG during the frame synchro is not sent. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.8.2 SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data when the start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro has a Start Delay equal to zero. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.8.3 SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as an input and TF is programmed as an output and requested to be set to low/high during data emission, the Frame Synchro signal is generated one bit clock period after 687 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 the data start and one data bit is lost. This problem does not exist when generating a periodic synchro. Problem Fix/Workaround The data need to be delayed for one bit clock period with an external assembly. In the following schematic, TD, TK and NRST are AT91SAM7XC signals, TXD is the delayed data to connect to the device. 44.2.9 44.2.9.1 Two-wire Interface (TWI) TWI: Clock Divider The value of CLDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191, the value of CHDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191⋅ Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.9.2 TWI: Disabling Does not Operate Correctly Any transfer in progress is immediately frozen if the Control Register (TWI_CR) is written with the bit MSDIS at 1. Furthermore, the status bits TXCOMP and TXRDY in the Status Register (TWI_SR) are not reset. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must wait for the end of transfer before disabling the TWI. In addition, the interrupts must be disabled before disabling the TWI. 44.2.9.3 TWI: NACK Status Bit Lost During a master frame, if TWI_SR is read between the Non Acknowledge condition detection and the TXCOMP bit rising in the TWI_SR, the NACK bit is not set. Problem Fix/Workaround 688 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The user must wait for the TXCOMP status bit by interrupt and must not read the TWI_SR as long as transmission is not completed. TXCOMP and NACK fields are set simultaneously and the NACK field is reset after the read of the TWI_SR. 44.2.9.4 TWI: Possible Receive Holding Register Corruption When loading the TWI_RHR, the transfer direction is ignored. The last data byte received in the TWI_RHR is corrupted at the end of the first subsequent transmit data byte. Neither RXRDY nor OVERRUN status bits are set if this occurs. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must be sure that received data is read before transmitting any new data. 44.2.9.5 TWI: Software Reset when a software reset is performed during a frame and when TWCK is low, it is impossible to initiate a new transfer in READ or WRITE mode. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.10 44.2.10.1 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART) USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking When Hardware Handshaking is used and if CTS goes low near the end of the start bit, a character can be lost. CTS must not go high during a time slot occurring between 2 Master Clock periods before and 16 Master Clock periods after the rising edge of the start bit. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.2.10.2 USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent If CTS switches from 0 to 1 during the TX of a character and if the holding register (US_THR) is not empty, the content of US_THR will also be transmitted. Problem Fix/Workaround Don't use the PDC in transmit mode and do not fill US_THR before TXEMPTY is set at 1. 44.2.10.3 USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode When timeguard is 0, RXBRK is not set when the break character is located just after the Stop bit. FRAME (Frame Error) is set instead. Problem Fix/Workaround Timeguard should be > 0. 44.2.10.4 USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low. The DCD signal is active at High level in the USART Modem Mode . DCD should be active at Low level. Problem Fix/Workaround Add an inverter 689 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.3 AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts Refer to Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 681. 44.3.1 44.3.1.1 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ADC: DRDY Bit Cleared The DRDY Flag should be clear only after a read of ADC_LCDR (Last Converted Data Register). A read of any ADC_CDRx register (Channel Data Register) automatically clears the DRDY flag. Problem Fix/Workaround: None 44.3.1.2 ADC: DRDY not Cleared on Disable When reading LCDR at the same instant as an end of conversion, with DRDY already active, DRDY is kept active regardless of the enable status of the current channel. This sets DRDY, whereas new data is not stored. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.3.1.3 ADC: DRDY Possibly Skipped due to CDR Read Reading CDR for channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with EOC[x] already active, leads to skipping to set the DRDY flag if channel "x" is enabled. Problem Fix/Workaround Use of DRDY functionality with access to CDR registers should be avoided. 44.3.1.4 ADC: Possible Skip on DRDY when Disabling a Channel DRDY does not rise when disabling channel "y" at the same time as an end of "x" channel conversion, although data is stored into CDRx and LCDR. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.3.1.5 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Updated Read of the Status Register at the same instant as an end of conversion leads to skipping the update of the GOVRE (general overrun) flag. GOVRE is neither reset nor set. For example, if reading the status while an end of conversion is occurring and: 1. GOVRE is active but DRDY is inactive, does not correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not reset. 2. GOVRE is inactive but DRDY is active, does correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not set. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.3.1.6 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Reading CDR When reading CDRy (Channel Data Register y) at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with the following conditions: • EOC[x] already active, 690 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary • DRDY already active, • GOVRE inactive, • previous data stored in LCDR being neither data from channel "y", nor data from channel "x". GOVRE should be set but is not. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.3.1.7 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Disabling a Channel When disabling channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x", EOC[x] and DRDY being already active, GOVRE does not rise. Note: OVRE[x] rises as expected. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.3.1.8 ADC: OVRE Flag Behavior When the OVRE flag (on channel i) has been set but the related EOC status (of channel i) has been cleared (by a read of CDRi or LCDR), reading the Status register at the same instant as an end of conversion (causing the set of EOC status on channel i), does not lead to a reset of the OVRE flag (on channel i) as expected. Problem Fix/Workaround: None 44.3.1.9 ADC: EOC Set although Channel Disabled If a channel is disabled while a conversion is running and if a read of CDR is performed at the same time as an end of conversion of any channel occurs, the EOC of the channel with the conversion running may rise (whereas it has been disabled). Problem Fix/Workaround Do not take into account the EOC of a disabled channel 44.3.1.10 ADC: Spurious Clear of EOC Flag If "x" and "y" are two successively converted channels and "z" is yet another enabled channel ("z" being neither "x" nor "y"), reading CDR on channel "z" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "y" automatically clears EOC[x] instead of EOC[z]. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.3.1.11 ADC: Sleep Mode If Sleep mode is activated while there is no activity (no conversion is being performed), it will take effect only after a conversion occurs. Problem Fix/Workaround To activate sleep mode as soon as possible, it is recommended to write successively, ADC Mode Register (SLEEP) then ADC Control Register (START bit field); to start an analog-to-digital conversion, in order put ADC into sleep mode at the end of this conversion. 691 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.3.2 44.3.2.1 Controller Area Network (CAN) CAN: Low Power Mode and Error Frame If the Low Power Mode is activated while the CAN is generating an error frame, this error frame may be shortened. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.3.2.2 CAN: Low Power Mode and Pending Transmit Messages No pending transmit messages may be sent once the CAN Controller enters Low-power Mode. Problem Fix/Workaround Check that all messages have been sent by reading the related Flags before entering Lowpower Mode. 44.3.3 44.3.3.1 Embedded FLash Controller (EFC) EFC: Embedded Flash Access Time The embedded Flash maximum access time is 25 MJHz (instead of 30MHz)at zero Wait State (FWS = 0). The maximum operating frequency with one Wait State (FWS = 1) is still 55 MHz. Problem Fix/Workaround Set one Wait State (FWS = 1) if the frequency is above 25 MHz. 44.3.4 44.3.4.1 Ethernet MAC (EMAC) EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR If an event occurs within the same clock cycle in which the EMAC_ISR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared even though it has not been read at 1. This might lead to the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround Each time the software reads EMAC_ISR, it has to check the contents of the Transmit Status Register (EMAC_TSR), the Receive Status Register (EMAC_RSR) and the Network Status Register (EMAC_NSR), as the possible lost event is still notified in one of these registers. 44.3.4.2 EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block If an event occurs within the same clock cycle during which a statistics register is read, the corresponding counter might lose this event. This might lead to the loss of the incrementation of one for this counter. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.3.5 44.3.5.1 692 Peripheral Input/Output (PIO) PIO: Leakage on PB27 - PB30 When PB27, PB28, PB29 or PB30 (the I/O lines multiplexed with the analog inputs) are set as digital inputs with pull-up disabled, the leakage can be 9 µA in worst case and 90 nA in typical case per I/O when the I/O is set externally at low level. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Problem Fix/Workaround Set the I/O to VDDIO by internal or external pull-up. 44.3.5.2 PIO: Electrical Characteristics on NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26 When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, the voltage of the I/O stabilizes at VPull-up. Vpull-up VPull-up Min VPull-up Max VDDIO - 0.65 V VDDIO - 0.45 V This condition causes a leakage through VDDIO. This leakage is 45 µA per pad in worst case at 3.3 V. I Leakage Parameter Typ Max I Leakage at 3,3V 2.5 µA 45 µA Problem Fix/Workaround It is recommended to use an external pull-up if needed. 44.3.5.3 PIO: Drive Low NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26 When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, driving the I/O with an output impedance higher than 500 ohms may not drive the I/O to a logical zero. Problem Fix/Workaround Output impedance must be lower than 500 ohms. 44.3.6 44.3.6.1 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) PWM: Update when PWM_CCNTx = 0 or 1 If the Channel Counter Register value is 0 or 1, the Channel Period Register or Channel Duty Cycle Register is directly modified when writing the Channel Update Register. Problem Fix/Workaround Check the Channel Counter Register before writing the update register. 44.3.6.2 PWM: Update when PWM_CPRDx = 0 When Channel Period Register equals 0, the period update is not operational. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not write 0 in the period register. 44.3.6.3 PWM: Counter Start Value In left aligned mode, the first start value of the counter is 0. For the other periods, the counter starts at 1. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 693 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.3.6.4 PWM: Behavior of CHIDx Status Bits in the PWM_SR Register Erratic behavior of the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR Register. When a channel is disabled by writing in the PWM_DIS Register just after enabling it (before completion of a Clock Period of the clock selected for the channel), the PWM line is internally disabled but the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR stays at 1. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not disable a channel before completion of one period of the selected clock. 44.3.7 44.3.7.1 Real Time Timer (RTT) RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle during which the RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This can lead to the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround: The software must handle the RTT event as an interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR. 44.3.8 44.3.8.1 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) SPI: Bad tx_ready Behavior when CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1 If the SPI2 is programmed with CSAAT = 1, SCBR(baudrate) = 1 and two transfers are performed consecutively on the same slave with an IDLE state between them, the tx_ready signal does not rise after the second data has been transferred in the shifter. This can imply for example, that the second data is sent twice. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use the combination CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1. 44.3.8.2 SPI: LASTXFER (Last Transfer) Behavior In FIXED Mode, with CSAAT bit set, and in “PDC mode” the Chip Select can rise depending on the data written in the SPI_TDR when the TX_EMPTY flag is set. If for example, the PDC writes a “1” in the bit 24 (LASTXFER bit) of the SPI_TDR, the chip select will rise as soon as the TXEMPTY flag is set. Problem Fix/Workaround Use the CS in PIO mode when PDC mode is required and CS has to be maintained between transfers. 44.3.8.3 SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode SPCK pin can toggle out before the first transfer in Master Mode. Problem Fix/Workaround In Master Mode, MSTR bit must be set (in SPI_MR register) before configuring SPI_CSRx registers. 44.3.8.4 694 SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode In fixed Mode, if a transfer is performed through a PDC on a Chip select different from the Chip select 0, the output spi_size sampled by the PDC will depend on the field, BITS (Bits per Transfer) of SPI_CSR0 register, whatever the selected Chip select is. For example, if SPI_CSR0 is configured for a 10-bit transfer whereas SPI_CSR1 is configured for an 8-bit transfer, when a AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary transfer is performed in Fixed mode through the PDC, on Chip select 1, the transfer will be considered as a HalfWord transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround If a PDC transfer has to be performed in 8 bits, on a Chip select y (y as different from 0), the BITS field of the SPI_CSR0 must be configured in 8 bits, in the same way as the BITS field of the CSRy Register. 44.3.8.5 SPI: Baudrate Set to 1 When Baudrate is set at 1 (i.e. when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and when the BITS field of the SPI_CSR register (number of bits to be transmitted) equals an ODD value (in this case 9,11,13 or 15), an additional pulse will be generated on output SPCK. Everything is OK if the BITS field equals 8,10,12,14 or 16 and Baudrate = 1. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.3.8.6 SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select Bad Serial clock generation on the 2nd chip select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0. This occurs using SPI with the following conditions: • Master Mode • CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0 • Multiple chip selects are used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with SCBR are not equal to 1 • Transmitting with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one, then an additional pulse is generated on output SPCK during the second transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if NCPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1. If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear. 44.3.8.7 SPI: Software Reset must be Written Twice If a software reset (SWRST in the SPI Control Register) is performed, the SPI may not work properly (the clock is enabled before the chip select.) Problem Fix/Workaround The SPI Control Register field, SWRST (Software Reset) needs to be written twice to be correctly set. 44.3.9 44.3.9.1 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode If the Least Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0), the first TAG during the frame synchro is not sent. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 695 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.3.9.2 SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data when the start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro has a Start Delay equal to zero. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.3.9.3 SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as an input and TF is programmed as an output and requested to be set to low/high during data emission, the Frame Synchro signal is generated one bit clock period after the data start and one data bit is lost. This problem does not exist when generating a periodic synchro. Problem Fix/Workaround The data need to be delayed for one bit clock period with an external assembly. In the following schematic, TD, TK and NRST are AT91SAM7XC signals, TXD is the delayed data to connect to the device. 44.3.10 44.3.10.1 Two-wire Interface (TWI) TWI: Clock Divider The value of CLDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191, the value of CHDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191⋅ Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.3.10.2 TWI: Disabling Does not Operate Correctly Any transfer in progress is immediately frozen if the Control Register (TWI_CR) is written with the bit MSDIS at 1. Furthermore, the status bits TXCOMP and TXRDY in the Status Register (TWI_SR) are not reset. Problem Fix/Workaround 696 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary The user must wait for the end of transfer before disabling the TWI. In addition, the interrupts must be disabled before disabling the TWI. 44.3.10.3 TWI: NACK Status Bit Lost During a master frame, if TWI_SR is read between the Non Acknowledge condition detection and the TXCOMP bit rising in the TWI_SR, the NACK bit is not set. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must wait for the TXCOMP status bit by interrupt and must not read the TWI_SR as long as transmission is not completed. TXCOMP and NACK fields are set simultaneously and the NACK field is reset after the read of the TWI_SR. 44.3.10.4 TWI: Possible Receive Holding Register Corruption When loading the TWI_RHR, the transfer direction is ignored. The last data byte received in the TWI_RHR is corrupted at the end of the first subsequent transmit data byte. Neither RXRDY nor OVERRUN status bits are set if this occurs. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must be sure that received data is read before transmitting any new data. 44.3.10.5 TWI: Software Reset when a software reset is performed during a frame and when TWCK is low, it is impossible to initiate a new transfer in READ or WRITE mode. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.3.11 44.3.11.1 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART) USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking When Hardware Handshaking is used and if CTS goes low close to the end of the starting bit, a character can be lost. Problem Fix/Workaround CTS must not go low during a time slot occurring between 2 Master Clock periods before the starting bit and 16 Master Clock periods after the rising edge of the starting bit. 44.3.11.2 USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent If CTS switches from 0 to 1 during the TX of a character and if the holding register (US_THR) is not empty, the content of US_THR will also be transmitted. Problem Fix/Workaround Don't use the PDC in transmit mode and do not fill US_THR before TXEMPTY is set at 1. 44.3.11.3 USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode When timeguard is 0, RXBRK is not set when the break character is located just after the Stop bit. FRAME (Frame Error) is set instead. Problem Fix/Workaround Timeguard should be > 0. 697 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.3.11.4 USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low. The DCD signal is active at High level in the USART Modem Mode . DCD should be active at Low level. Problem Fix/Workaround Add an inverter. 698 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44.4 AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. B Parts Refer to Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 681. 44.4.1 44.4.1.1 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ADC: DRDY Bit Cleared The DRDY Flag should be clear only after a read of ADC_LCDR (Last Converted Data Register). A read of any ADC_CDRx register (Channel Data Register) automatically clears the DRDY flag. Problem Fix/Workaround: None 44.4.1.2 ADC: DRDY not Cleared on Disable When reading LCDR at the same instant as an end of conversion, with DRDY already active, DRDY is kept active regardless of the enable status of the current channel. This sets DRDY, whereas new data is not stored. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.4.1.3 ADC: DRDY Possibly Skipped due to CDR Read Reading CDR for channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with EOC[x] already active, leads to skipping to set the DRDY flag if channel "x" is enabled. Problem Fix/Workaround Use of DRDY functionality with access to CDR registers should be avoided. 44.4.1.4 ADC: Possible Skip on DRDY when Disabling a Channel DRDY does not rise when disabling channel "y" at the same time as an end of "x" channel conversion, although data is stored into CDRx and LCDR. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.1.5 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Updated Read of the Status Register at the same instant as an end of conversion leads to skipping the update of the GOVRE (general overrun) flag. GOVRE is neither reset nor set. For example, if reading the status while an end of conversion is occurring and: 1. GOVRE is active but DRDY is inactive, does not correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not reset. 2. GOVRE is inactive but DRDY is active, does correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not set. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.4.1.6 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Reading CDR When reading CDRy (Channel Data Register y) at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with the following conditions: • EOC[x] already active, 699 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 • DRDY already active, • GOVRE inactive, • previous data stored in LCDR being neither data from channel "y", nor data from channel "x". GOVRE should be set but is not. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.4.1.7 ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Disabling a Channel When disabling channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x", EOC[x] and DRDY being already active, GOVRE does not rise. Note: OVRE[x] rises as expected. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.4.1.8 ADC: OVRE Flag Behavior When the OVRE flag (on channel i) has been set but the related EOC status (of channel i) has been cleared (by a read of CDRi or LCDR), reading the Status register at the same instant as an end of conversion (causing the set of EOC status on channel i), does not lead to a reset of the OVRE flag (on channel i) as expected. Problem Fix/Workaround: None 44.4.1.9 ADC: EOC Set although Channel Disabled If a channel is disabled while a conversion is running and if a read of CDR is performed at the same time as an end of conversion of any channel occurs, the EOC of the channel with the conversion running may rise (whereas it has been disabled). Problem Fix/Workaround Do not take into account the EOC of a disabled channel 44.4.1.10 ADC: Spurious Clear of EOC Flag If "x" and "y" are two successively converted channels and "z" is yet another enabled channel ("z" being neither "x" nor "y"), reading CDR on channel "z" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "y" automatically clears EOC[x] instead of EOC[z]. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.1.11 ADC: Sleep Mode If Sleep mode is activated while there is no activity (no conversion is being performed), it will take effect only after a conversion occurs. Problem Fix/Workaround To activate sleep mode as soon as possible, it is recommended to write successively, ADC Mode Register (SLEEP) then ADC Control Register (START bit field); to start an analog-to-digital conversion, in order put ADC into sleep mode at the end of this conversion. 700 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44.4.2 44.4.2.1 Controller Area Network (CAN) CAN: Low Power Mode and Error Frame If the Low Power Mode is activated while the CAN is generating an error frame, this error frame may be shortened. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.4.2.2 CAN: Low Power Mode and Pending Transmit Messages No pending transmit messages may be sent once the CAN Controller enters Low-power Mode. Problem Fix/Workaround Check that all messages have been sent by reading the related Flags before entering Lowpower Mode. 44.4.3 44.4.3.1 Ethernet MAC (EMAC) EMAC: RMII Mode RMII mode is not functional. Problem Fix/Workaround None 44.4.3.2 EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR If an event occurs within the same clock cycle in which the EMAC_ISR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared even though it has not been read at 1. This might lead to the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround Each time the software reads EMAC_ISR, it has to check the contents of the Transmit Status Register (EMAC_TSR), the Receive Status Register (EMAC_RSR) and the Network Status Register (EMAC_NSR), as the possible lost event is still notified in one of these registers. 44.4.3.3 EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block If an event occurs within the same clock cycle during which a statistics register is read, the corresponding counter might lose this event. This might lead to the loss of the incrementation of one for this counter. Problem Fix/Workaround None 701 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 44.4.4 44.4.4.1 Peripheral Input/Output (PIO) PIO: Electrical Characteristics on NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26 When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, the voltage of the I/O stabilizes at VPull-up. Vpull-up VPull-up Min VPull-up Max VDDIO - 0.65 V VDDIO - 0.45 V This condition causes a leakage through VDDIO. This leakage is 45 µA per pad in worst case at 3.3 V. I Leakage Parameter Typ Max I Leakage at 3,3V 2.5 µA 45 µA Problem Fix/Workaround It is recommended to use an external pull-up if needed. 44.4.4.2 PIO: Drive Low NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26 When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, driving the I/O with an output impedance higher than 500 ohms may not drive the I/O to a logical zero. Problem Fix/Workaround Output impedance must be lower than 500 ohms. 44.4.5 44.4.5.1 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) PWM: Update when PWM_CCNTx = 0 or 1 If the Channel Counter Register value is 0 or 1, the Channel Period Register or Channel Duty Cycle Register is directly modified when writing the Channel Update Register. Problem Fix/Workaround Check the Channel Counter Register before writing the update register. 44.4.5.2 PWM: Update when PWM_CPRDx = 0 When Channel Period Register equals 0, the period update is not operational. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not write 0 in the period register. 44.4.5.3 PWM: Counter Start Value In left aligned mode, the first start value of the counter is 0. For the other periods, the counter starts at 1. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 702 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44.4.5.4 PWM: Behavior of CHIDx Status Bits in the PWM_SR Register Erratic behavior of the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR Register. When a channel is disabled by writing in the PWM_DIS Register just after enabling it (before completion of a Clock Period of the clock selected for the channel), the PWM line is internally disabled but the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR stays at 1. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not disable a channel before completion of one period of the selected clock. 44.4.6 44.4.6.1 Real Time Timer (RTT) RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle during which the RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This can lead to the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround: The software must handle the RTT event as an interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR. 44.4.7 44.4.7.1 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) SPI: Bad tx_ready Behavior when CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1 If the SPI2 is programmed with CSAAT = 1, SCBR(baudrate) = 1 and two transfers are performed consecutively on the same slave with an IDLE state between them, the tx_ready signal does not rise after the second data has been transferred in the shifter. This can imply for example, that the second data is sent twice. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use the combination CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1. 44.4.7.2 SPI: LASTXFER (Last Transfer) Behavior In FIXED Mode, with CSAAT bit set, and in “PDC mode” the Chip Select can rise depending on the data written in the SPI_TDR when the TX_EMPTY flag is set. If for example, the PDC writes a “1” in the bit 24 (LASTXFER bit) of the SPI_TDR, the chip select will rise as soon as the TXEMPTY flag is set. Problem Fix/Workaround Use the CS in PIO mode when PDC mode is required and CS has to be maintained between transfers. 44.4.7.3 SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode SPCK pin can toggle out before the first transfer in Master Mode. Problem Fix/Workaround In Master Mode, MSTR bit must be set (in SPI_MR register) before configuring SPI_CSRx registers. 44.4.7.4 SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode In fixed Mode, if a transfer is performed through a PDC on a Chip select different from the Chip select 0, the output spi_size sampled by the PDC will depend on the field, BITS (Bits per Transfer) of SPI_CSR0 register, whatever the selected Chip select is. For example, if SPI_CSR0 is configured for a 10-bit transfer whereas SPI_CSR1 is configured for an 8-bit transfer, when a 703 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 transfer is performed in Fixed mode through the PDC, on Chip select 1, the transfer will be considered as a HalfWord transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround If a PDC transfer has to be performed in 8 bits, on a Chip select y (y as different from 0), the BITS field of the SPI_CSR0 must be configured in 8 bits, in the same way as the BITS field of the CSRy Register. 44.4.7.5 SPI: Baudrate Set to 1 When Baudrate is set at 1 (i.e. when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and when the BITS field of the SPI_CSR register (number of bits to be transmitted) equals an ODD value (in this case 9,11,13 or 15), an additional pulse will be generated on output SPCK. Everything is OK if the BITS field equals 8,10,12,14 or 16 and Baudrate = 1. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.7.6 SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select Bad Serial clock generation on the 2nd chip select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0. This occurs using SPI with the following conditions: • Master Mode • CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0 • Multiple chip selects are used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with SCBR are not equal to 1 • Transmitting with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one, then an additional pulse is generated on output SPCK during the second transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if NCPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1. If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear. 44.4.7.7 SPI: Software Reset must be Written Twice If a software reset (SWRST in the SPI Control Register) is performed, the SPI may not work properly (the clock is enabled before the chip select.) Problem Fix/Workaround The SPI Control Register field, SWRST (Software Reset) needs to be written twice to be correctly set. 44.4.8 44.4.8.1 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode If the Least Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0), the first TAG during the frame synchro is not sent. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 704 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44.4.8.2 SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data when the start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro has a Start Delay equal to zero. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.8.3 SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as an input and TF is programmed as an output and requested to be set to low/high during data emission, the Frame Synchro signal is generated one bit clock period after the data start and one data bit is lost. This problem does not exist when generating a periodic synchro. Problem Fix/Workaround The data need to be delayed for one bit clock period with an external assembly. In the following schematic, TD, TK and NRST are AT91SAM7XC signals, TXD is the delayed data to connect to the device. 44.4.9 44.4.9.1 Two-wire Interface (TWI) TWI: Clock Divider The value of CLDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191, the value of CHDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191⋅ Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.9.2 TWI: Disabling Does not Operate Correctly Any transfer in progress is immediately frozen if the Control Register (TWI_CR) is written with the bit MSDIS at 1. Furthermore, the status bits TXCOMP and TXRDY in the Status Register (TWI_SR) are not reset. Problem Fix/Workaround 705 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 The user must wait for the end of transfer before disabling the TWI. In addition, the interrupts must be disabled before disabling the TWI. 44.4.9.3 TWI: NACK Status Bit Lost During a master frame, if TWI_SR is read between the Non Acknowledge condition detection and the TXCOMP bit rising in the TWI_SR, the NACK bit is not set. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must wait for the TXCOMP status bit by interrupt and must not read the TWI_SR as long as transmission is not completed. TXCOMP and NACK fields are set simultaneously and the NACK field is reset after the read of the TWI_SR. 44.4.9.4 TWI: Possible Receive Holding Register Corruption When loading the TWI_RHR, the transfer direction is ignored. The last data byte received in the TWI_RHR is corrupted at the end of the first subsequent transmit data byte. Neither RXRDY nor OVERRUN status bits are set if this occurs. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must be sure that received data is read before transmitting any new data. 44.4.9.5 TWI: Software Reset when a software reset is performed during a frame and when TWCK is low, it is impossible to initiate a new transfer in READ or WRITE mode. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.10 44.4.10.1 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART) USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking When Hardware Handshaking is used and if CTS goes low near the end of the start bit, a character can be lost. CTS must not go high during a time slot occurring between 2 Master Clock periods before and 16 Master Clock periods after the rising edge of the start bit. Problem Fix/Workaround None. 44.4.10.2 USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent If CTS switches from 0 to 1 during the TX of a character and if the holding register (US_THR) is not empty, the content of US_THR will also be transmitted. Problem Fix/Workaround Don't use the PDC in transmit mode and do not fill US_THR before TXEMPTY is set at 1. 44.4.10.3 USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode When timeguard is 0, RXBRK is not set when the break character is located just after the Stop bit. FRAME (Frame Error) is set instead. Problem Fix/Workaround Timeguard should be > 0. 706 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 44.4.10.4 USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low. The DCD signal is active at High level in the USART Modem Mode . DCD should be active at Low level. Problem Fix/Workaround Add an inverter 707 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 708 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 45. Revision History The most recent version appears first in the tables that follow. Version 6209F Comments Change Request Ref. FFPI: Section 21.2 ”Parallel Fast Flash Programming”, Section 21.2.1 ”Device Configuration”, added status of PIOs 5059 and Crystal Oscillator Section 21.3 ”Serial Fast Flash Programming”, Section 21.3.1 ”Device Configuration”, added status of PIOs and Crystal Oscillator Mechanical Characteristics: Table 41-4, “LQFP Package Characteristics” Symbol line A, Inch Max value is 0.063. PMC: Section 26.9.1 ”PMC System Clock Enable Register”, Section 26.9.2 ”PMC System Clock Disable Register” and Section 26.9.3 ”PMC System Clock Status Register”, bitfield 11 contains PCK3. 5608 5722 Errata: Section 44.4 ”AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. B Parts”, added to erata. 6064 Ordering Information: Section 42. ”AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information”, MLR B parts added to ordering information. Version 6209E Comments Overview, “Features”,TWI updated to include Atmel TWI compatibility with I2C Standard. “Features”, “Debug Unit (DBGU)” added “Mode for General Purpose 2-wire UART Serial Communication” Section 10.8 ”Two-wire Interface”, updated. Section 10.11 ”Timer Counter” The TC has Two output compare or one input capture per channel. Section 10.17 ”Analog-to-Digital Converter” INL and DNL updated. Table 3-1, “Signal Description List” footnote added to JTAGSEL, ERASE and TST pin comments Section 6.1 ”JTAG Port Pins”, Section 6.2 ”Test Pin” and Section 6.4 ”ERASE Pin” updated. Figure 9-1,”System Controller Block Diagram”, RTT is reset by power_on_reset. Figure 8-1,”AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Memory Mapping”, TDES base address is 0xFFFA 8000 Section 8.4.3 ”Internal Flash”,updated: “At any time, the Flash is mapped ... if GPNVM bit 2 is set and before the Remap Command.” Change Request Ref. 4247 5846 4211 4008 5068 5225 5257 5850 ADC, Section 35.6.2 ”ADC Mode Register”, PRESCAL and STARTUP bit fields widened. 4430 “SHTIM: Sample & Hold Time” on page 496, formula updated in bit description. 5254 Figure 35-1,”Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram”, VDDANA replaced by VDDIN. PMC added to figure. rfo Section 35.5.5 ”Conversion Triggers”, update to the third paragraph detailing hardware trigger. AIC, Section 24.8.16 ”AIC Spurious Interrupt Vector Register”, typo fixed in bit fields. (SIQV is SIVR). Section 24.7.5 ”Protect Mode”, writing PROT in AIC_DCR enables protection mode (3rd paragraph). 4749 5193 709 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Version 6209E (Continued) Comments Change Request Ref. AES, Section 36.3.4.1 ”Countermeasures” and Section 36.4.1 ”AES Control Register” LOADSEED description updated. 4977 CAN, Figure 38-7,”Line Error Mode” Conditions to switch from Error Active mode to Error Passive mode and vice 4089 versa have been inverted. Section 38.6.4.6 ”Error Interrupt Handler”, added to datasheet. 4736 Section 38.8.5 ”CAN Status Register”, added references to the new chapter in bit descriptions, WARN, BOFF, ERRA, ERRP. Debug and Test, Section 12.5.5 ”ID Code Register”, AT91SAM7XC512 product part number and JTAG ID code value updated. 4447 Section 12.5.3 ”Debug Unit”, Debug Unit chip ID, typo corrected. DBGU, Section 27.1 ”Overview”, ...”two-pin UART can be used standalone for general purpose serial communication. Section 27.5.10 ”Debug Unit Chip ID Register”, SRAM bit description added for AT91SAM7L in the bit field. “SRAMSIZ: Internal SRAM Size” on page 254 Corrected bin values for 0x60 and 0xF0 and Architecture Identifier bit description for CAP7, AT91SAM7AQxx Series and CAP11 in the bit description, “ARCH: Architecture Identifier” on page 255 EMAC, Section 39.5.3 ”Network Status Register”, Corrected status for IDLE bit. Section 39.3 ”Functional Description”, Added information on clocks in first paragraph. 5846 3828 3369, 3807 3326 3328 FFPI, Table 21-6, Table 21-7 and Table 21-15 updated. Global update to terms listed below: Fuse →GPNVM SFB →SGPB CFB →CGPB GFB →GGPB Section 21.2.5.6 on page 154 & Section 21.3.4.6 on page 161, security bit restraint on access to FFPI explained. 4410 3933 4744 MC, Table 19-1, “Register Mapping,” on page 126, updated table with line for EFC1, offset 0x70, with note specific 4448 to AT91SAM7XC521 PIO, Section 15.4.5 “Synchronous Data Output” on page 86, PIO_OWSR typo corrected. Section 15.6 “Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) User Interface” on page 90, 10, footnotes updated on PIO_PSR, PIO_ODSR, PIO_PDSR in Register Mapping table. PMC, Section 26.3 ”Processor Clock Controller” ....the processor clock can be disabled by writing.... PMC_SDR. Figure 25-2,”Typical Crystal Connection” updated, removed CL1 and CL2 labels. 3289 3974 3835 3861 PWM, Turned channel-dependent registers into indexed registers: Table 33-2, “Register Mapping”. See Section 4486 33.6.9 ”PWM Channel Mode Register”, Section 33.6.10 ”PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register”, Section 33.6.11 ”PWM Channel Period Register”, Section 33.6.12 ”PWM Channel Counter Register”and Section 33.6.13 ”PWM Channel Update Register” Section 33.6.12 ”PWM Channel Counter Register”, typos corrected in bit description. 5185 710 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Version 6209E (Continued) Comments RSTC, Section 13.2.4.4 ”Software Reset”, PERRST must be used with PROCRST, except for debug purposes. SPI, Section 28.6.4 “SPI Slave Mode” on page 267, corrected information on OVRES (SPI_SR) and data read in SPI_RDR. SSC, Section 30.6.5.1 ”Frame Sync Data”, defined max Frame Sync Data length. Section 30.6.6.1 ”Compare Functions”, updated with max FSLEN length. Section 30.8.3 ”SSC Receive Clock Mode Register”, Corrected bit name to STTDLY , Change Request Ref. 5436 3943 2293 4773 TC, 3342 Figure 32-2,”Clock Chaining Selection”, added to Section 32.5 ”Functional Description”. Section 32.6 ”Timer Counter (TC) User Interface”, register mapping w/indexed register scheme, consolidated in 4583 one table. Section 32.6.3 on page 410 to Section 32.6.13 on page 424, register names updated w/indexed values, WAVE value added where relevant. Section 32.6.2 ”TC Block Mode Register”, typo corrected in bit fields 2 and 3. Section 32.6.4 ”TC Channel Mode Register: Capture Mode”, bit filed 15 updated. TWI, “Two-wire Interface (TWI)”, section has been updated. Important changes to this datasheet include a clarification of Atmel TWI compatibility with I2C Standard. UDP, Table 34-2, “USB Communication Flow”, Supported Endpoint column updated. In the USB_CSR register, the control endpoints are not effected by the bit field, “EPEDS: Endpoint Enable Disable” on page 484 Updated: write 1 =.... in “RX_DATA_BK0: Receive Data Bank 0” bit field of USB_CSR register. Updated: write 0 = ....in “TXPKTRDY: Transmit Packet Ready” bit field of USB_CSR register. Section 34.6.10 “UDP Endpoint Control and Status Register” on page 480, update to code and added instructions regarding USB clock and system clock cycle, and updated “note” appearing under the code. “wait 3 USB clock cycles and 3 system clock cycles before accessing DPR from RX_DATAx and TXPKTRDY bit fields, ditto for RX_DATAx and TXPKTRDY bit field descriptions.” Section 34.2 ”Block Diagram”, in the text below the block diagram, MCK specified as clock used by Master Clock domain, UDPCK specified as 48 MHz clock used by 12 MHz domain, in peripheral clock requirements. Section 34.6 ”USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface”, the register mapping table has been updated. Section 34.6.6 ”UDP Interrupt Mask Register”, Bit 12 of UDP_IMR cannot be masked and is always read at 1. Section 34.6 ”USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface”, reset value for UDP_RST_EP is 0x000_0000. Table 34-1, “USB Endpoint Description”, footnote added to Dual-Bank heading. Section 34.5.2.5 ”Transmit Data Cancellation”, added to datasheet Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset Endpoint Register”, added steps to clear endpoints. 4247 3476 4063 4099 4462 4487 4508 4802 5049 5150 711 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Version 6209E (Continued) Comments Change Request Ref. USART, “CLKO: Clock Output Select” on page 377, bit field in US_MR register, typo fixed in bit field description. “USCLKS: Clock Selection” on page 375, bit field in US_MR register, DIV= 8 in Selected Clock column. Section 31.5.1 ”I/O Lines”, 2nd and 3rd paragraphsupdated. “TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty” on page 382, no characters when at 1 updated. Section 31.6.2 ”Receiver and Transmitter Control”, In the fourth paragraph, Software reset effects (RSTRX and RSTTX in US_CR register) updated by replacing 2nd sentence. Section 31.6.5 ”IrDA Mode”, updated with instruction to receive IrDA signals. Section 31.2 ”Block Diagram”, signal directions from pads to PIO updted in the block diagram. Electrical Characteristics, Section 40.7 ”ADC Characteristics”, INL and DN updated and Absolute accuracy added to Table 40-18, “Transfer Characteristics”, reference to Data Converter Terminology added below table. Table 40.3.2, “Peripheral Power Consumption in Active Mode” AES and TDES added to Table 40-18 Table 40-9, “Main Oscillator Characteristics”, added schematic in footnote to CL and CLEXT symbols. Table 40-11, “XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics” ,added tCLCH and tCHCL to table, tCHXIN and tCLXIN updated. Figure 40-2, ”XIN CLock Timing” on page 662, added figure. Table 40-6, “Power Consumption for Different Modes”; Footnote assigned to Flash In standby mode. Footnote assigned to Ultra Low Power mode. Table 40-2, “DC Characteristics”, CMOS conditions added to IO for VOL and VOH. Table 40-2, “DC Characteristics”, removed reference to Tj. Table 40-16, “External Voltage Reference Input”, added ADVREF input w/conditions “8-bit resolution mode”. Section 41.1 “Thermal Considerations”, removed. Table 41-3, “Package Reference”, JESD97 Classification is e3 Table 40-25, “Embedded Flash Wait States (AT91SAM7XC256/128)” and Table 40-26, “Embedded Flash Wait States (AT91SAM7XC512)” The prododuct specific embedded Flash Wait States are defined. Errata, Section 44.2 ”AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts” Section 44.2.2 ”Controller Area Network (CAN)”, added Section 44.2.10.1 ”USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking”, updated. Section 44.2.10.3 ”USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode”,added Section 44.2.10.4 ”USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.”,added Section 44.2.7.6 ”SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select” Section 44.2.1 ”Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)”, added. USART: XOFF Character Bad Behavior, removed Section 44.3 ”AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts” Section 44.3.2 ”Controller Area Network (CAN)”, added. Section 44.3.3 ”Embedded FLash Controller (EFC)”, ”EFC: Embedded Flash Access Time” added. Section 44.3.11.1 ”USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking” updated. Section 44.3.11.3 ”USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode”, added Section 44.3.11.4 ”USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.”, added Section 44.3.8.6 ”SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select”, added Section 44.3.8.7 ”SPI: Software Reset must be Written Twice”, added Section 44.3.1 ”Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)”,added USART: XOFF Character Bad Behavior, removed 712 3306 3763 3851/4825 3895 4367 4912 4905 4008 3485 3869 3968 4597/4599 rfo 4661 rfo 4970 5363 4649 3957 4644 4753 5339 4649 5990 3957 4644 4753 5787 5339 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Version 6209D Comments AT91SAM7XC512 added to product family. “Features” on page 1, “Description” on page 3 Global and TFBGA package to Section 4. ”Package”, Section 41. ”AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Mechanical Characteristics” and Section 42. ”AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information”. Peripheral and System Controller Memory Maps consolidated in Figure 8-1 on page 18 Internal Memory Area 3 is “Internal ROM” Figure 18-3 on page 95 Change Request Ref. #2724 IP Block Evolution: RSTC:Section 13.3 ”Functional Description” added information on startup counter for crystal oscillator. 3005 RTT: Section 14.3 ”Functional Description”: Note (asynchronization between SCLK and MCK) added to end of section. 2522 WDT: “Block Diagram” on page 85 replaced. (WV changed to WDV) “Functional Description” on page 86 6th and 7th paragraph changed. 3002 EFC: Section 19. ”Embedded Flash Controller (EFC)” updated to reflect EFC configuration for AT91SAM7XC512 with multiple EFCs. 2356 3086 SAM Boot: Section 21.5 “Hardware and Software Constraints” on page 139 updated Section 21.4 “SAM-BA Boot” on page 135 SAM-BA boot principle changed. Figure 21-1, ”Boot Program Algorithm Flow Diagram” on page 135 flow diagram replaced 2285, 2618 3050 PDC: Corrected description of user interface in Section 22.1 “Overview” on page 141. Corrected bit name to ENDTX in Section 22.3.3 “Transfer Counters” on page 142. AIC: Section 23.7.3.1 “Priority Controller” on page 158: incorrect reference of SRCTYPE field to AIC_SVR register changed to AIC_SMR register. Section 23.8 “Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface” on page 166, Table 23-2: Added note (2) in reference to PID2...PID31 bit fields. Naming convention for AIC_FVR register harmonized in Table 23-2, Section 23.8.6 “AIC FIQ Vector Register” on page 169 and Section 23.7.4.5 “Fast Forcing” on page 162. PMC: Section 25.7 “Programming Sequence” on page 183 change to Step 4. on page 184, “Selection of Master Clock and Processor Clock” and to code. Corrected name of bitfield PRES in Section 25.9.10 “PMC Master Clock Register” on page 199. Removed reference to PMC_ACKR register in Table 25-2, “Register Mapping,” on page 190. Updated OUTx bit descriptions in Section 25.9.9 “PMC Clock Generator PLL Register” on page 198. Added note defining PIDx in Section 25.9.4 “PMC Peripheral Clock Enable Register” on page 194, Section 25.9.5 “PMC Peripheral Clock Disable Register” on page 194 and Section 25.9.6 “PMC Peripheral Clock Status Register” on page 195. Changed Section 24.2 “Slow Clock RC Oscillator” on page 177. 05-460 2512 2548 05-506 1603 1719 2467, 2913 2468 1558 DBGU: Corrected references from ice_nreset to Power-on Reset in Figure 26-1 on page 206, Functional Block Diagram, and in FNTRST bit description in Section 26.5.12 “Debug Unit Force NTRST Register” on page 228. 2832 PIO: Section 27.5.4 “Output Control” on page 233, typo corrected. Section 27.5.1 “Pull-up Resistor Control” on page 233 reference to resistor value removed Figure 27-3, ”I/O Line Control Logic” on page 232 change to I/O Line Control Logic 05-346 05-497 3053 713 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Version 6209D (Continued) Change Request Ref. Comments SPI: Section 28.7.5 “SPI Status Register” on page 273 SPI_RCR, SPI_RNCR, SPI_TCR, SPI_TNCR location defined. Section 28.7.4 “SPI Transmit Data Register” on page 272, LASTXFER: Last Transfer text added. Section 28.7.2 “SPI Mode Register” on page 269, PCSDEC: Chip Select Decode changed. Updated Figure 28-1, ”Block Diagram” on page 256, removed Note. Removed bit FDIV from Section 28.7.2 “SPI Mode Register” on page 269 and Section 28.7.9 “SPI Chip Select Register” on page 278. LLB description modified in Section 28.7.2 “SPI Mode Register” on page 269. Updated Figure 28-9, ”Slave Mode Functional Block Diagram” on page 266 to remove FLOAD. Updated information on SPI_RDR in Section 28.6.3 “Master Mode Operations” on page 260. Added information to SWRST bit description in Section 28.7.1 “SPI Control Register” on page 268. Corrected equations in DLYBCT bit description, Section 28.7.9 ”SPI Chip Select Register” on page 279. Changes to Section 28.6.3.8 “Mode Fault Detection” on page 265. TWI: Section 29.6 ”TWI User Interface”: OVRE and UNRE bit fields removed from Status and Interrupt Registers. USART: MANCHESTER FUNCTIONALITY REMOVED. Section 30.5.1 “I/O Lines” on page 302, text concerning TXD line added. Section 30.6.1.3 “Fractional Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode” on page 305, using USART “functional mode” changed to USART “normal mode”. Table 30-3, “Binary and Decimal Values for Di,” on page 307 and Table 30-4, “Binary and Decimal Values for Fi,” on page 307: DI and Fi properly referenced in titles. Figure 30-25, ”IrDA Demodulator Operations” on page 323 modified. Section 30.6.4.1 “ISO7816 Mode Overview” on page 319 clarification of PAR configuration added. Section 30.6.7 “Modem Mode” on page 325 Control of DTR and RTS output pins. Table 30-2, “Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0),” on page 304 lines showing over 50 000 000 MHz clocks removed. Section 30.6.3.2 ”Asynchronous Receiver” changed 2nd sentence in 4th paragraph “For the synchronization Mechanism......” Section 30.6.3.8 ”Receiver Time-out” list of user options rewritten. Section 30.7.1 ”USART Control Register” STTTO bit function related to TIMEOUT in US_CSR register Section 30.7.6 ”USART Channel Status Register” TIMEOUT bit function related to STTTO in US_CR register 714 04-183 05-434 05-476 05-484 1542 1543 1676 2470 #2768 1552 1770 2942 3023 TC: Section 31.5.3.6 “External Event/Trigger Conditions” on page 359 “....(EEVT = 0), TIOB is no longer used as an output and the compare register B is not used to generate waveforms and subsequently no IRQs. Note (1) attached to ”EEVT: External Event Selection” in Section 31.6.7 “TC Channel Mode Register: Waveform Mode” on page 367 further clarifies this condition. 2704 PWM: Section 32.5.3.3 ”Changing the Duty Cycle or the Period”: updated info on waveform generation. 1677 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Version 6209D (Continued) Comments UDP: Added warning to Section 33.6 “USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface” on page 418, to UDP_ TXVC (3), to Section 33.6.12 “UDP Transceiver Control Register” on page 434 and to Section 33.3.2 “Power Management” on page 401. Corrections, improvements, additions and deletions throughout section, new source document. Section 33.5.3.8 ”Sending a Device Remote Wakeup” replaces title: “Sending an External Resume. WAKEUP bit shown in interruput registers: Section 33.6.4 on page 422 thru Section 33.6.8 on page 427 RMWUPE, RSMINPR, ESR bits removed from Section 33.6.2 ”UDP Global State Register”. NOTE: pertinent to USB pullup effect on USB Reset added to Section 33.6.12 ”UDP Transceiver Control Register” ADC:Section 35.5.7 ”ADC Timings” in Warning: “See ADC Characteristics....” typo fixed Figure 35-1, ”Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram” on page 473 dedicated and I/O lines differentiated in new block diagram. Change Request Ref. 05-413 3288 2830 3052 AES: Section 36. “Advanced Encryption Standard (AES)” on page 493 updated to reflect AES configuration for AT91SAM7XC512. CAN: Update to message acceptance example in Section 38.6.2.1 “Message Acceptance Procedure” on page 538. New information on byte priority added to Section 38.8.17 “CAN Message Data Low Register” on page 586 and Section 38.8.18 “CAN Message Data High Register” on page 587. Corrected MDL bit description in Section 38.8.17 “CAN Message Data Low Register” on page 586. Update to specify allowed values for BRP field on Section 38.6.4 ”CAN 2.0 Standard Features”, page 543 and in Section 38.8.6 “CAN Baudrate Register” on page 573. EMAC: “Interrupt Enable Register” on page 617, access changed to Write-only. “Interrupt Disable Register” on page 618, access changed to Write-only. “Interrupt Mask Register” on page 619, access changed to Read-only. 2295, 2296 2476 2597 1725 715 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Version 6209D (Continued) Comments Change Request Ref. Section 40. ”AT91SAM7XC Electrical Characteristics” “Absolute Maximum Ratings” on page 639, change to Maximum Operating Voltages. 3060 Electrical and Mechanical Characteristics: Changed conditions of parameters IPULLUP and ILEAK in Table 40-2, “DC Characteristics,” on page 640. Updated Table 40-5, “DC Flash Characteristics AT91SAM7XC512/256/128,” on page 641 and Table 40-9, “Main Oscillator Characteristics,” on page 644. Added Table 40-10, “Crystal Characteristics,” on page 645. Updated IDDBP in Table 40-11, “XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics,” on page 645. Added information on data sampling in SPI master mode to Table 40-21, “SPI Timings,” on page 652. Added Table 40-24, “EMAC RMII Specific Signals (pertains only to AT91SAM7XC512),” on page 655 and Figure 40-8, ”EMAC RMII Mode” on page 655. Errata updated: Added Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 665. Added new Section 44.3 “AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts” on page 672. Updated Section 44.2 ”AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts”: Section 44.2.4.1 ”RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR” Section 44.2.5.4 ”SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode” Section 44.2.5.5 ”SPI: Baudrate Set to 1” TWI: Behavior of OVRE Bit (removed) Section 44.2.7.5 ”TWI: Software Reset” Section 44.2.8.2 ”USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent” Section 44.2.8.3 ”USART: XOFF Character Bad Behavior” 716 #2872 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Version Comments 6209C The following errata have been added: Section 44.2.1.2 ”EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR” Section 44.2.1.3 ”EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block” Section 44.2.5.3 ”SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode” Section 44.2.2.1 ”PIO: Leakage on PB27 - PB30”: worst case leakage changed to 9 µA. 6209B Section 44. ”Errata” Device package/product number changed Section 44.2.1.1 ”EMAC: RMII Mode” RMII mode is not functional The sections listed below have been added: Section 44.2.3 ”Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)” Section 44.2.5 ”Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)” Section 44.2.6 ”Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)” Section 44.2.7 ”Two-wire Interface (TWI)” Section 44.2.8 ”Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART)” 6209A First Issue Change Request Ref. 2456 2606 1765 717 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 718 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary Table of Contents 1 Description ............................................................................................... 4 1.1- Configuration Summary of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 ....................................4 2 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Block Diagram ............................................. 5 3 Signal Description ................................................................................... 6 4 Package .................................................................................................... 9 4.1- 100-lead LQFP Package Outline ............................................................................9 4.2- 100-lead LQFP Pinout ..........................................................................................10 4.3- 100-ball TFBGA Package Outline .........................................................................11 4.4- 100-ball TFBGA Pinout .........................................................................................11 5 Power Considerations ........................................................................... 12 5.1- Power Supplies .....................................................................................................12 5.2- Power Consumption ..............................................................................................12 5.3- Voltage Regulator .................................................................................................12 5.4- Typical Powering Schematics ...............................................................................13 6 I/O Lines Considerations ....................................................................... 14 6.1- JTAG Port Pins .....................................................................................................14 6.2- Test Pin .................................................................................................................14 6.3- Reset Pin ...............................................................................................................14 6.4- ERASE Pin ............................................................................................................14 6.5- PIO Controller Lines ..............................................................................................14 6.6- I/O Lines Current Drawing .....................................................................................15 7 Processor and Architecture .................................................................. 16 7.1- ARM7TDMI Processor ..........................................................................................16 7.2- Debug and Test Features .....................................................................................16 7.3- Memory Controller .................................................................................................16 7.4- Peripheral DMA Controller ....................................................................................17 8 Memory ................................................................................................... 18 8.1- AT91SAM7XC512 .................................................................................................18 8.2- AT91SAM7XC256 .................................................................................................18 8.3- AT91SAM7XC128 .................................................................................................18 8.4- Memory Mapping ..................................................................................................20 8.5- Embedded Flash ...................................................................................................21 i 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 8.6- Fast Flash Programming Interface ........................................................................23 8.7- SAM-BA Boot Assistant ........................................................................................23 9 System Controller .................................................................................. 25 9.1- Reset Controller ....................................................................................................27 9.2- Clock Generator ....................................................................................................28 9.3- Power Management Controller .............................................................................29 9.4- Advanced Interrupt Controller ...............................................................................29 9.5- Debug Unit ............................................................................................................30 9.6- Periodic Interval Timer ..........................................................................................30 9.7- Watchdog Timer ....................................................................................................30 9.8- Real-time Timer .....................................................................................................30 9.9- PIO Controllers ......................................................................................................31 9.10- Voltage Regulator Controller ...............................................................................31 10 Peripherals ............................................................................................. 32 10.1- User Interface ......................................................................................................32 10.2- Peripheral Identifiers ...........................................................................................32 10.3- Peripheral Multiplexing on PIO Lines ..................................................................33 10.4- PIO Controller A Multiplexing ..............................................................................34 10.5- PIO Controller B Multiplexing ..............................................................................35 10.6- Ethernet MAC ......................................................................................................36 10.7- Serial Peripheral Interface ...................................................................................36 10.8- Two-wire Interface ...............................................................................................37 10.9- USART ................................................................................................................37 10.10- Serial Synchronous Controller ..........................................................................37 10.11- Timer Counter ...................................................................................................38 10.12- Pulse Width Modulation Controller ....................................................................38 10.13- USB Device Port ...............................................................................................39 10.14- CAN Controller ..................................................................................................39 10.15- 128-bit Advanced Encryption Standard .............................................................39 10.16- Triple Data Encryption Standard .......................................................................40 10.17- Analog-to-Digital Converter ...............................................................................40 11 ARM7TDMI Processor Overview .......................................................... 43 11.1- Overview .............................................................................................................43 11.2- ARM7TDMI Processor ........................................................................................44 12 Debug and Test Features ...................................................................... 49 ii AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 12.1- Description ..........................................................................................................49 12.2- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................49 12.3- Application Examples ..........................................................................................50 12.4- Debug and Test Pin Description .........................................................................51 12.5- Functional Description .........................................................................................52 13 Reset Controller (RSTC) ........................................................................ 59 13.1- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................59 13.2- Functional Description .........................................................................................60 13.3- Reset Controller (RSTC) User Interface ..............................................................70 14 Real-time Timer (RTT) ............................................................................ 75 14.1- Overview .............................................................................................................75 14.2- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................75 14.3- Functional Description .........................................................................................75 14.4- Real-time Timer (RTT) User Interface .................................................................77 15 Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) .................................................. 81 15.1- Overview .............................................................................................................81 15.2- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................82 15.3- Product Dependencies ........................................................................................83 15.4- Functional Description .........................................................................................84 15.5- I/O Lines Programming Example ........................................................................89 15.6- Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) User Interface ..........................................90 16 Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) ............................................................... 107 16.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................107 16.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................107 16.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................108 16.4- Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) User Interface ......................................................110 17 Watchdog Timer (WDT) ....................................................................... 113 17.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................113 17.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................113 17.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................114 17.4- Watchdog Timer (WDT) User Interface .............................................................116 18 Voltage Regulator Mode Controller (VREG) ...................................... 119 18.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................119 18.2- Voltage Regulator Power Controller (VREG) User Interface .............................120 iii 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 19 Memory Controller (MC) ...................................................................... 121 19.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................121 19.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................121 19.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................122 19.4- Memory Controller (MC) User Interface ............................................................126 20 Embedded Flash Controller (EFC) ..................................................... 131 20.1- Overview ..........................................................................................................131 20.2- Functional Description .......................................................................................131 20.3- Embedded Flash Controller (EFC ) User Interface ...........................................141 21 Fast Flash Programming Interface (FFPI) .......................................... 147 21.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................147 21.2- Parallel Fast Flash Programming ......................................................................147 21.3- Serial Fast Flash Programming .........................................................................156 22 AT91SAM Boot Program ..................................................................... 163 22.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................163 22.2- Flow Diagram ....................................................................................................163 22.3- Device Initialization ...........................................................................................163 22.4- SAM-BA Boot ....................................................................................................164 22.5- Hardware and Software Constraints .................................................................168 23 Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) ....................................................... 169 23.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................169 23.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................169 23.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................170 23.4- Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) User Interface ..............................................172 24 Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) .................................................. 179 24.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................179 24.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................179 24.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................180 24.4- AIC Detailed Block Diagram ..............................................................................180 24.5- I/O Line Description ...........................................................................................180 24.6- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................181 24.7- Functional Description .......................................................................................182 24.8- Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface ..........................................194 25 Clock Generator ................................................................................... 205 iv AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 25.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................205 25.2- Slow Clock RC Oscillator ..................................................................................205 25.3- Main Oscillator ..................................................................................................205 25.4- Divider and PLL Block .......................................................................................207 26 Power Management Controller (PMC) ................................................ 209 26.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................209 26.2- Master Clock Controller .....................................................................................209 26.3- Processor Clock Controller ................................................................................210 26.4- USB Clock Controller ........................................................................................210 26.5- Peripheral Clock Controller ...............................................................................210 26.6- Programmable Clock Output Controller ............................................................211 26.7- Programming Sequence ...................................................................................211 26.8- Clock Switching Details .....................................................................................215 26.9- Power Management Controller (PMC) User Interface ......................................218 27 Debug Unit (DBGU) .............................................................................. 233 27.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................233 27.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................234 27.3- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................235 27.4- UART Operations ..............................................................................................235 27.5- Debug Unit User Interface ................................................................................242 28 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ......................................................... 257 28.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................257 28.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................258 28.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................258 28.4- Signal Description ............................................................................................259 28.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................259 28.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................260 28.7- Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) User Interface ................................................269 29 Two-wire Interface (TWI) ..................................................................... 283 29.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................283 29.2- List of Abbreviations ..........................................................................................283 29.3- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................284 29.4- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................284 29.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................284 29.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................285 v 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 29.7- Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface ...........................................................296 30 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) ................................................ 305 30.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................305 30.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................306 30.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................306 30.4- Pin Name List ....................................................................................................307 30.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................307 30.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................307 30.7- SSC Application Examples ...............................................................................318 30.8- Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) User Interface ........................................320 31 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) 343 31.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................343 31.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................344 31.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................345 31.4- I/O Lines Description ........................................................................................345 31.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................346 31.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................347 31.7- (Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) User Interface 372 32 Timer Counter (TC) .............................................................................. 391 32.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................391 32.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................392 32.3- Pin Name List ....................................................................................................393 32.4- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................393 32.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................394 32.6- Timer Counter (TC) User Interface ....................................................................407 33 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) ........................................ 425 33.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................425 33.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................425 33.3- I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................426 33.4- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................426 33.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................426 33.6- Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) User Interface ................................435 34 USB Device Port (UDP) ........................................................................ 449 vi AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 34.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................449 34.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................450 34.3- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................451 34.4- Typical Connection ............................................................................................452 34.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................454 34.6- USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface .............................................................468 35 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ..................................................... 487 35.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................487 35.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................487 35.3- Signal Description .............................................................................................488 35.4- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................488 35.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................489 35.6- Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) User Interface ............................................494 36 Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) ............................................... 507 36.1- Description ........................................................................................................507 36.2- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................507 36.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................507 36.4- Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) User Interface .......................................514 37 Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) ........................................... 527 37.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................527 37.2- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................527 37.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................527 37.4- Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) User Interface ...................................534 38 Controller Area Network (CAN) .......................................................... 549 38.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................549 38.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................550 38.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................551 38.4- I/O Lines Description ........................................................................................551 38.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................551 38.6- CAN Controller Features ...................................................................................552 38.7- Functional Description .......................................................................................564 38.8- Controller Area Network (CAN) User Interface ................................................577 39 Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) ............................................................. 607 39.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................607 vii 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 39.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................607 39.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................608 39.4- Programming Interface ......................................................................................619 39.5- Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) User Interface ..................................................622 40 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Electrical Characteristics ....................... 655 40.1- Absolute Maximum Ratings ..............................................................................655 40.2- DC Characteristics ............................................................................................656 40.3- Power Consumption ..........................................................................................658 40.4- Crystal Oscillators Characteristics .....................................................................660 40.5- PLL Characteristics ...........................................................................................663 40.6- USB Transceiver Characteristics ......................................................................664 40.7- ADC Characteristics .........................................................................................666 40.8- AC Characteristics ............................................................................................667 41 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Mechanical Characteristics .................... 676 41.1- Package Drawings ............................................................................................676 41.2- Soldering Profile ................................................................................................679 42 AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information .................................................. 680 43 Export Regulations Statement ............................................................ 680 44 Errata .................................................................................................... 681 44.1- Marking .............................................................................................................681 44.2- AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts ....................................................682 44.3- AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts ...........................................................690 44.4- AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. B Parts ....................................................699 45 Revision History ................................................................................... 709 viii AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09 Headquarters International Atmel Corporation 2325 Orchard Parkway San Jose, CA 95131 USA Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 Fax: 1(408) 487-2600 Atmel Asia Unit 1-5 & 16, 19/F BEA Tower, Millennium City 5 418 Kwun Tong Road Kwun Tong, Kowloon Hong Kong Tel: (852) 2245-6100 Fax: (852) 2722-1369 Atmel Europe Le Krebs 8, Rue Jean-Pierre Timbaud BP 309 78054 Saint-Quentin-enYvelines Cedex France Tel: (33) 1-30-60-70-00 Fax: (33) 1-30-60-71-11 Atmel Japan 9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg. 1-24-8 Shinkawa Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033 Japan Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551 Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581 Technical Support AT91SAM Support Atmel techincal support Sales Contacts www.atmel.com/contacts/ Product Contact Web Site www.atmel.com www.atmel.com/AT91SAM Literature Requests www.atmel.com/literature Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any intellectual property right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMEL’S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE LOCATED ON ATMEL’S WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY WARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes no representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Unless specifically provided otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel’s products are not intended, authorized, or warranted for use as components in applications intended to support or sustain life. © 2008 Atmel Corporation. All rights reserved. Atmel®, Atmel logo and combinations thereof, DataFlash ®, SAM-BA ® and others, are registered trademarks or trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. Windows ® and others, are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the US and/or other countries. ARM ®, the ARM Powered® logo and others, are registered trademarks or trademarks of ARM Limited. Other terms and product names may be the trademarks of others. 6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09